8-bit AVR Microcontroller ATmega324PB DATASHEET PRELIMINARY Introduction ® The Atmel ATmega324PB is a low-power CMOS 8-bit microcontroller based on the AVR® enhanced RISC architecture. By executing powerful instructions in a single clock cycle, the ATmega324PB achieves throughputs close to 1MIPS per MHz. This empowers system designer to optimize the device for power consumption versus processing speed. Feature High Performance, Low Power Atmel®AVR® 8-Bit Microcontroller Family • Advanced RISC Architecture – 131 Powerful Instructions – Most Single Clock Cycle Execution – 32 x 8 General Purpose Working Registers – Fully Static Operation – Up to 20 MIPS Throughput at 20MHz – On-chip 2-cycle Multiplier • High Endurance Non-volatile Memory Segments – 32KBytes of In-System Self-Programmable Flash program memory – 1KBytes EEPROM – 2KBytes Internal SRAM – Write/Erase Cycles: 10,000 Flash/100,000 EEPROM – Data retention: 20 years at 85°C/100 years at 25°C – Optional Boot Code Section with Independent Lock Bits • In-System Programming by On-chip Boot Program • True Read-While-Write Operation – Programming Lock for Software Security • Atmel QTouch® library support – Capacitive touch buttons, sliders and wheels – QTouch and QMatrix acquisition • JTAG (IEEE std. 1149.1 Compliant) Interface – Boundary-scan Capabilities According to the JTAG Standard Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 • – Extensive On-chip Debug Support – Programming of Flash, EEPROM, Fuses, and Lock Bits through the JTAG Interface Peripheral Features – Peripheral Touch Controller (PTC) • Capacitive touch buttons, sliders and wheels • 32 Self-cap channels and 256 mutual cap channels – Two 8-bit Timer/Counters with Separate Prescaler and Compare Mode – Three 16-bit Timer/Counter with Separate Prescaler, Compare Mode, and Capture Mode – – – • • • • • • Real Time Counter with Separate Oscillator Ten PWM Channels 8-channel 10-bit ADC • Differential mode with selectable gain at 1×, 10× or 200× – Three Programmable Serial USART – Two Master/Slave SPI Serial Interface – Two Byte-oriented 2-wire Serial Interface (Philips I2C compatible) – Programmable Watchdog Timer with Separate On-chip Oscillator – On-chip Analog Comparator – Interrupt and Wake-up on Pin Change Special Microcontroller Features – Power-on Reset and Programmable Brown-out Detection – Internal Calibrated Oscillator – External and Internal Interrupt Sources – Six Sleep Modes: Idle, ADC Noise Reduction, Power-save, Power-down, Standby, and Extended Standby – Clock failure detection mechanism and switch to 1MHz internal RC clock in case of failure I/O and Packages – 39 programmable I/O lines – 44-pin TQFP and 44-pin QFN/MLF Operating Voltage: – 1.8 - 5.5V Temperature Range: – -40°C to 105°C Speed Grade: – 0 - 4MHz @ 1.8 - 5.5V – 0 - 10MHz @ 2.7 - 5.5.V – 0 - 20MHz @ 4.5 - 5.5V Power Consumption at 1MHz, 1.8V, 25°C – Active Mode: 0.4mA – Power-down Mode: 0.2μA – Power-save Mode: 1.3μA (Including 32kHz RTC) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 2 Table of Contents Introduction......................................................................................................................1 Feature............................................................................................................................ 1 1. Description.................................................................................................................9 2. Configuration Summary........................................................................................... 10 3. Ordering Information ............................................................................................... 11 4. Block Diagram......................................................................................................... 12 5. Pin Configurations................................................................................................... 13 5.1. Pin Descriptions..........................................................................................................................13 6. I/O Multiplexing........................................................................................................ 15 7. General Information................................................................................................. 17 7.1. 7.2. 7.3. Resources.................................................................................................................................. 17 Data Retention............................................................................................................................17 About Code Examples................................................................................................................17 8. AVR CPU Core........................................................................................................ 18 8.1. 8.2. 8.3. 8.4. 8.5. 8.6. 8.7. Overview.....................................................................................................................................18 ALU – Arithmetic Logic Unit........................................................................................................19 Status Register...........................................................................................................................19 General Purpose Register File................................................................................................... 21 Stack Pointer.............................................................................................................................. 22 Instruction Execution Timing...................................................................................................... 24 Reset and Interrupt Handling..................................................................................................... 25 9. AVR Memories.........................................................................................................27 9.1. 9.2. 9.3. 9.4. Overview.....................................................................................................................................27 In-System Reprogrammable Flash Program Memory................................................................ 27 SRAM Data Memory...................................................................................................................28 EEPROM Data Memory............................................................................................................. 29 9.5. 9.6. I/O Memory.................................................................................................................................30 Register Description................................................................................................................... 31 10. System Clock and Clock Options............................................................................ 42 10.1. 10.2. 10.3. 10.4. 10.5. 10.6. Clock Systems and Their Distribution.........................................................................................42 Clock Sources............................................................................................................................ 43 Low Power Crystal Oscillator......................................................................................................44 Low Frequency Crystal Oscillator...............................................................................................46 Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator................................................................................................47 128kHz Internal Oscillator.......................................................................................................... 47 10.7. External Clock............................................................................................................................ 48 10.8. Clock Output Buffer.................................................................................................................... 49 10.9. Timer/Counter Oscillator.............................................................................................................49 10.10. System Clock Prescaler............................................................................................................. 49 10.11. Register Description................................................................................................................... 50 11. CFD - Clock Failure Detection mechanism..............................................................54 11.1. 11.2. 11.3. 11.4. 11.5. Overview.....................................................................................................................................54 Features..................................................................................................................................... 54 Operations..................................................................................................................................54 Timing Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 55 Register Description................................................................................................................... 56 12. PM - Power Management and Sleep Modes...........................................................58 12.1. Sleep Modes...............................................................................................................................58 12.2. BOD Disable...............................................................................................................................59 12.3. Idle Mode....................................................................................................................................59 12.4. ADC Noise Reduction Mode.......................................................................................................59 12.5. Power-Down Mode.....................................................................................................................60 12.6. Power-save Mode.......................................................................................................................60 12.7. Standby Mode............................................................................................................................ 61 12.8. Extended Standby Mode............................................................................................................ 61 12.9. Power Reduction Register..........................................................................................................61 12.10. Minimizing Power Consumption.................................................................................................61 12.11. Register Description................................................................................................................... 63 13. System Control and Reset.......................................................................................70 13.1. 13.2. 13.3. 13.4. 13.5. 13.6. 13.7. 13.8. 13.9. Resetting the AVR...................................................................................................................... 70 Reset Sources............................................................................................................................70 Power-on Reset..........................................................................................................................71 External Reset............................................................................................................................72 Brown-out Detection...................................................................................................................72 Watchdog System Reset............................................................................................................ 73 Internal Voltage Reference.........................................................................................................73 Watchdog Timer......................................................................................................................... 74 Register Description................................................................................................................... 76 14. INT- Interrupts..........................................................................................................80 14.1. Interrupt Vectors in ATmega324PB............................................................................................ 80 14.2. Register Description................................................................................................................... 83 15. EXINT - External Interrupts..................................................................................... 86 15.1. Pin Change Interrupt Timing.......................................................................................................86 15.2. Register Description................................................................................................................... 87 16. I/O-Ports.................................................................................................................. 99 16.1. Overview.....................................................................................................................................99 16.2. Ports as General Digital I/O........................................................................................................99 16.3. Alternate Port Functions...........................................................................................................103 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 4 16.4. Register Description................................................................................................................. 119 17. TC0 - 8-bit Timer/Counter with PWM.....................................................................137 17.1. 17.2. 17.3. 17.4. 17.5. 17.6. 17.7. 17.8. 17.9. Features................................................................................................................................... 137 Overview...................................................................................................................................137 Timer/Counter Clock Sources.................................................................................................. 138 Counter Unit............................................................................................................................. 138 Output Compare Unit................................................................................................................139 Compare Match Output Unit.....................................................................................................140 Modes of Operation..................................................................................................................141 Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams...............................................................................................146 Register Description................................................................................................................. 147 18. TC - 16-bit Timer/Counter with PWM.....................................................................160 18.1. Features................................................................................................................................... 160 18.2. Overview...................................................................................................................................160 18.3. Accessing 16-bit Registers.......................................................................................................162 18.4. Timer/Counter Clock Sources.................................................................................................. 165 18.5. Counter Unit............................................................................................................................. 165 18.6. Input Capture Unit.................................................................................................................... 166 18.7. Compare Match Output Unit.....................................................................................................169 18.8. Output Compare Units..............................................................................................................170 18.9. Modes of Operation..................................................................................................................171 18.10. Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams.............................................................................................. 178 18.11. Register Description................................................................................................................. 179 19. Timer/Counter0 and Timer/Counter1,3,4 Prescalers............................................. 198 19.1. 19.2. 19.3. 19.4. Internal Clock Source............................................................................................................... 198 Prescaler Reset........................................................................................................................198 External Clock Source..............................................................................................................198 Register Description................................................................................................................. 199 20. TC2 - 8-bit Timer/Counter2 with PWM and Asynchronous Operation................... 201 20.1. Features................................................................................................................................... 201 20.2. Overview...................................................................................................................................201 20.3. Timer/Counter Clock Sources.................................................................................................. 202 20.4. Counter Unit............................................................................................................................. 202 20.5. Output Compare Unit................................................................................................................203 20.6. Compare Match Output Unit.....................................................................................................205 20.7. Modes of Operation..................................................................................................................206 20.8. Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams...............................................................................................210 20.9. Asynchronous Operation of Timer/Counter2............................................................................ 211 20.10. Timer/Counter Prescaler.......................................................................................................... 213 20.11. Register Description................................................................................................................. 213 21. OCM - Output Compare Modulator....................................................................... 226 21.1. Overview...................................................................................................................................226 21.2. Description................................................................................................................................226 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 5 22. SPI – Serial Peripheral Interface........................................................................... 228 22.1. 22.2. 22.3. 22.4. 22.5. Features................................................................................................................................... 228 Overview...................................................................................................................................228 SS Pin Functionality................................................................................................................. 232 Data Modes.............................................................................................................................. 233 Register Description................................................................................................................. 233 23. USART - Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver................242 23.1. Features................................................................................................................................... 242 23.2. Overview...................................................................................................................................242 23.3. Clock Generation......................................................................................................................243 23.4. Frame Formats.........................................................................................................................246 23.5. USART Initialization..................................................................................................................247 23.6. Data Transmission – The USART Transmitter......................................................................... 248 23.7. Data Reception – The USART Receiver.................................................................................. 250 23.8. Asynchronous Data Reception.................................................................................................254 23.9. Multi-Processor Communication Mode.....................................................................................258 23.10. Examples of Baud Rate Setting............................................................................................... 259 23.11. Register Description................................................................................................................. 262 24. USARTSPI - USART in SPI Mode.........................................................................274 24.1. 24.2. 24.3. 24.4. 24.5. 24.6. 24.7. 24.8. Features................................................................................................................................... 274 Overview...................................................................................................................................274 Clock Generation......................................................................................................................274 SPI Data Modes and Timing.....................................................................................................275 Frame Formats.........................................................................................................................275 Data Transfer............................................................................................................................277 AVR USART MSPIM vs. AVR SPI............................................................................................278 Register Description................................................................................................................. 279 25. TWI - 2-wire Serial Interface..................................................................................280 25.1. Features................................................................................................................................... 280 25.2. Two-Wire Serial Interface Bus Definition..................................................................................280 25.3. 25.4. 25.5. 25.6. 25.7. 25.8. 25.9. Data Transfer and Frame Format.............................................................................................281 Multi-master Bus Systems, Arbitration and Synchronization....................................................284 Overview of the TWI Module.................................................................................................... 285 Using the TWI...........................................................................................................................288 Transmission Modes................................................................................................................ 291 Multi-master Systems and Arbitration.......................................................................................307 Register Description................................................................................................................. 309 26. AC - Analog Comparator....................................................................................... 317 26.1. Overview...................................................................................................................................317 26.2. Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input...................................................................................... 317 26.3. Register Description................................................................................................................. 318 27. ADC - Analog to Digital Converter.........................................................................323 27.1. Features................................................................................................................................... 323 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 6 27.2. Overview...................................................................................................................................323 27.3. 27.4. 27.5. 27.6. 27.7. 27.8. Starting a Conversion...............................................................................................................325 Prescaling and Conversion Timing...........................................................................................326 Changing Channel or Reference Selection.............................................................................. 328 ADC Noise Canceler................................................................................................................ 329 ADC Conversion Result............................................................................................................333 Register Description................................................................................................................. 335 28. PTC - Peripheral Touch Controller.........................................................................347 28.1. 28.2. 28.3. 28.4. 28.5. 28.6. 28.7. Overview...................................................................................................................................347 Features................................................................................................................................... 347 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 348 Signal Description.....................................................................................................................348 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 349 Functional Description..............................................................................................................350 QTouch Library......................................................................................................................... 350 29. JTAG Interface and On-chip Debug System..........................................................352 29.1. Features................................................................................................................................... 352 29.2. Overview...................................................................................................................................352 29.3. TAP – Test Access Port............................................................................................................ 353 29.4. TAP Controller.......................................................................................................................... 354 29.5. Using the Boundary-scan Chain...............................................................................................355 29.6. Using the On-chip Debug System............................................................................................ 355 29.7. On-chip Debug Specific JTAG Instructions.............................................................................. 356 29.8. Using the JTAG Programming Capabilities.............................................................................. 357 29.9. Bibliography..............................................................................................................................357 29.10. IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-scan........................................................................................357 29.11. Data Registers..........................................................................................................................358 29.12. Boundry-scan Specific JTAG Instructions................................................................................ 360 29.13. Boundary-scan Chain...............................................................................................................361 29.14. ATmega324PB Boundary-scan Order......................................................................................371 29.15. Boundary-scan Description Language Files............................................................................ 373 29.16. Register Description.................................................................................................................373 30. BTLDR - Boot Loader Support – Read-While-Write Self-Programming................ 378 30.1. 30.2. 30.3. 30.4. 30.5. 30.6. 30.7. 30.8. 30.9. Features................................................................................................................................... 378 Overview...................................................................................................................................378 Application and Boot Loader Flash Sections............................................................................378 Read-While-Write and No Read-While-Write Flash Sections...................................................379 Entering the Boot Loader Program...........................................................................................381 Boot Loader Lock Bits.............................................................................................................. 382 Addressing the Flash During Self-Programming...................................................................... 383 Self-Programming the Flash.....................................................................................................384 Register Description................................................................................................................. 393 31. MEMPROG- Memory Programming......................................................................396 31.1. Program And Data Memory Lock Bits...................................................................................... 396 31.2. Fuse Bits...................................................................................................................................397 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 7 31.3. Signature Bytes........................................................................................................................ 399 31.4. Calibration Byte........................................................................................................................ 399 31.5. Serial Number...........................................................................................................................400 31.6. Page Size................................................................................................................................. 400 31.7. Parallel Programming Parameters, Pin Mapping, and Commands.......................................... 400 31.8. Parallel Programming...............................................................................................................402 31.9. Serial Downloading...................................................................................................................409 31.10. Programming Via the JTAG Interface.......................................................................................414 32. Electrical Characteristics....................................................................................... 428 32.1. 32.2. 32.3. 32.4. 32.5. 32.6. 32.7. 32.8. 32.9. Absolute Maximum Ratings......................................................................................................428 DC Characteristics....................................................................................................................428 Speed Grades.......................................................................................................................... 432 Clock Characteristics................................................................................................................432 System and Reset Characteristics........................................................................................... 433 SPI Timing Characteristics....................................................................................................... 434 Two-wire Serial Interface Characteristics................................................................................. 435 ADC Characteristics................................................................................................................. 437 Parallel Programming Characteristics...................................................................................... 441 33. Typical Characteristics...........................................................................................443 33.1. 33.2. 33.3. 33.4. 33.5. 33.6. 33.7. 33.8. 33.9. Active Supply Current...............................................................................................................443 Idle Supply Current...................................................................................................................444 Power-down Supply Current.....................................................................................................444 Pin Pull-Up................................................................................................................................445 Pin Driver Strength................................................................................................................... 448 Pin Threshold and Hysteresis...................................................................................................450 BOD Threshold.........................................................................................................................451 Internal Oscillator Speed.......................................................................................................... 453 Current Consumption in Reset and Reset Pulse Width........................................................... 456 34. Register Summary.................................................................................................457 35. Instruction Set Summary....................................................................................... 462 36. Packaging Information...........................................................................................466 36.1. 44A........................................................................................................................................... 466 36.2. 44M1.........................................................................................................................................467 37. Errata.....................................................................................................................468 37.1. Rev.A-H.................................................................................................................................... 468 37.2. Rev. I........................................................................................................................................ 468 38. Datasheet Revision History................................................................................... 469 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 8 1. Description The Atmel® ATmega324PB is a low-power CMOS 8-bit microcontroller based on the AVR enhanced RISC architecture. By executing powerful instructions in a single clock cycle, the ATmega324PB achieves throughputs close to 1MIPS per MHz. This empowers system designer to optimize the device for power consumption versus processing speed. The Atmel AVR® core combines a rich instruction set with 32 general purpose working registers. All the 32 registers are directly connected to the Arithmetic Logic Unit (ALU), allowing two independent registers to be accessed in a single instruction executed in one clock cycle. The resulting architecture is more code efficient while achieving throughputs up to ten times faster than conventional CISC microcontrollers. The ATmega324PB provides the following features: 32K bytes of In-System Programmable Flash with Read-While-Write capabilities, 1Kbytes EEPROM, 2Kbytes SRAM, 39 general purpose I/O lines, 32 general purpose working registers, five flexible Timer/Counters with compare modes, internal and external interrupts, three serial programmable USART, two byte-oriented 2-wire Serial Interface (I2C), two SPI serial port, a 8-channel 10-bit ADC with optional differential input stage with programmable gain, a programmable Watchdog Timer with internal Oscillator, IEEE std. 1149.1 compliant JTAG test interface, also used for accessing the On-chip Debug system and programming, Clock failure detection mechanism and six software selectable power saving modes. The Idle mode stops the CPU while allowing the SRAM, Timer/Counters, USART, 2-wire Serial Interface, SPI port, and interrupt system to continue functioning. PTC with enabling up to 32 self-cap and 256 mutual-cap sensors. The Power-down mode saves the register contents but freezes the Oscillator, disabling all other chip functions until the next interrupt or hardware reset. In Power-save mode, the asynchronous timer continues to run, allowing the user to maintain a timer base while the rest of the device is sleeping. Also ability to run PTC in power-save mode/ wake-up on touch and Dynamic on/off of PTC analog and digital portion. The ADC Noise Reduction mode stops the CPU and all I/O modules except asynchronous timer, PTC, and ADC to minimize switching noise during ADC conversions. In Standby mode, the crystal/resonator Oscillator is running while the rest of the device is sleeping. This allows very fast start-up combined with low power consumption. Atmel offers the QTouch® library for embedding capacitive touch buttons, sliders and wheels functionality into AVR microcontrollers. The patented charge-transfer signal acquisition offers robust sensing and includes fully debounced reporting of touch keys and includes Adjacent Key Suppression® (AKS®) technology for unambiguous detection of key events. The easy-to-use QTouch Composer allows you to explore, develop and debug your own touch applications. The device is manufactured using Atmel’s high density non-volatile memory technology. The On-chip ISP Flash allows the program memory to be reprogrammed In-System through an SPI serial interface, by a conventional nonvolatile memory programmer, or by an On-chip Boot program running on the AVR core. The Boot program can use any interface to download the application program in the Application Flash memory. Software in the Boot Flash section will continue to run while the Application Flash section is updated, providing true Read-While-Write operation. By combining an 8-bit RISC CPU with In-System Self-Programmable Flash on a monolithic chip, the Atmel ATmega324PB is a powerful microcontroller that provides a highly flexible and cost effective solution to many embedded control applications. The ATmega324PB is supported with a full suite of program and system development tools including: C Compilers, Macro Assemblers, Program Debugger/Simulators, In-Circuit Emulators, and Evaluation kits. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 9 2. Configuration Summary Features ATmega324PB Pin count 44 Flash (KB) 32 SRAM (KB) 2 EEPROM (KB) 1 General Purpose I/O lines 39 SPI 2 TWI (I2C) 2 USART 3 ADC 10-bit 15ksps ADC channels 8 AC 1 8-bit Timer/Counters 2 16-bit Timer/Counters 3 PWM channels 10 PTC Available Peripheral Touch Controller (PTC) channels (X- x Y-Lines) for mutual capacitance 256 (16 x 16 ) Peripheral Touch Controller (PTC) channels for self capacitance (Y-Lines only) 32 Clock Failure Detector (CFD) Available Output Compare Modulator (OCM1C2) Available Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 10 3. Ordering Information Speed [MHz] Power Supply [V] Ordering Code(2) Package(1) Operational Range 20 1.8 - 5.5 ATmega324PB-AU ATmega324PB-AUR(3) ATmega324PB-MU ATmega324PB-MUR(3) 44A 44A 44M1 44M1 Industrial (-40°C to 85°C) ATmega324PB-AN ATmega324PB-ANR(3) ATmega324PB-MN ATmega324PB-MNR(3) 44A 44A 44M1 44M1 Industrial (-40°C to 105°C) Note: 1. This device can also be supplied in wafer form. Contact your local Atmel sales office for detailed ordering information and minimum quantities. 2. Pb-free packaging complies to the European Directive for Restriction of Hazardous Substances (RoHS directive). Also Halide free and fully Green. 3. Tape & Reel. Package Type 44A 44-lead, Thin (1.0mm) Plastic Quad Flat Package (TQFP) 44M1 44-pad, 7 x 7 x 1.9mm body, Lead Pitch 0.50mm, Very-thin Fine pitch, Quad Flat No Lead Package/Quad Flat No-Lead/Micro Lead Frame Package (VQFN/QFN/MLF) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 11 4. Block Diagram Figure 4-1 Block Diagram SRAM TCK TMS TDI TDO JTAG CPU OCD Clock generation TOSC1 32.768kHz XOSC TOSC2 XTAL1 XTAL2 16MHz LP XOSC 8MHz Calib RC 128kHz int osc External clock Crystal failure detection VCC RESET GND Power Supervision POR/BOD & RESET NVM programming Power management and clock control Watchdog Timer ADC[7:0] AREF ADC X[15:0] Y[31:0] PTC PCINT[38:0] INT[2:0] OC1A/B T1 ICP1 OC2A OC2B OC3A/B T3 ICP3 OC4A/B T4 ICP4 FLASH D A T A B U S EEPROM EEPROMIF I/O PORTS I N / O U T GPIOR[2:0] D A T A B U S TC 0 (8-bit) SPI 0 AC Internal Reference USART 0 RxD0 TxD0 XCK0 EXTINT USART 1 RxD1 TxD1 XCK1 TC 1 USART 2 RxD2 TxD2 XCK2 TC 2 TWI 0 SDA0 SCL0 TC 3 TWI 1 SDA1 SCL1 TC 4 SPI 1 MISO1 MOSI1 SCK1 SS1 (16-bit) (8-bit async) PA[7:0] PB[7:0] PC[7:0] PD[7:0] PE[6:0] T0 OC0A OC0B MISO0 MOSI0 SCK0 SS0 AIN0 AIN1 ACO ADCMUX (16-bit) (16-bit) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 12 5. Pin Configurations PB1 (PTCY/T1/CLKO) PB0 (PTCY/T0/XCK0) PE6 (SCL1) PE5 (SDA1) PA0 (ADC0/PTCY) PA1 (ADC1/PTCY) PA2 (ADC2/PTCY) PA3 (ADC3/PTCY) 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 Crystal/Osc PB2 (AIN0/PTCY/INT2) Analog 42 Digital PB3 (AIN1/PTCY/OC0A) Programming/debug 43 Ground PB4 (PTCY/OC0B/SS0) Power 44 Figure 5-1 Pinout ATmega324PB (MOSI0/ICP3/PTCY) PB5 1 33 PA4 (ADC4/PTCY) (MISO0/OC3A/PTCY) PB6 2 32 PA5 (ADC5/PTCY) (SCK0/OC3B/OC4B/PTCY) PB7 3 31 PA6 (ADC6/PTCY) RESET 4 30 PA7 (ADC7/PTCY) VCC 5 29 PE4 (AREF) GND 6 28 GND (XTAL2) PE0 7 27 AVCC 5.1. Pin Descriptions 5.1.1. VCC Digital supply voltage. 5.1.2. GND Ground. 18 19 20 21 22 (MOSI1/TXD2/PTCXY) PE3 (SCL0/PTCXY) PC0 (SDA0/PTCXY) PC1 (TCK/T4/PTCXY) PC2 (TMS/ICP4/PTCXY) PC3 PC4 (PTCXY/OC4A/TDO) 17 23 (MISO1/RXD2/PTCXY) PE2 11 16 (RXD1/INT0/PTCXY) PD2 (SCK1/XCK2/OC2A/PTCXY) PD7 PC5 (PTCXY/ACO/TDI) 15 24 (SS1/ICP1/OC2B/PTCXY) PD6 10 14 (TXD0/PTCXY) PD1 (OC1A/PTCXY) PD5 PC6 (TOSC1) 13 PC7 (TOSC2) 25 (XCK1/OC1B/PTCXY) PD4 26 12 8 9 (TXD1/INT1/PTCXY) PD3 (XTAL1) PE1 (RXD0/T3/PTCXY) PD0 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 13 5.1.3. Port A (PA[7:0]) This port serves as analog inputs to the Analog-to-digital Converter. This is an 8-bit, bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors, individually selectable for each bit. The output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics, with both high sink and source capability. As inputs, the port pins that are externally pulled low will source current if pull-up resistors are activated. Port pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active, even if the clock is not running. 5.1.4. Port B (PB[7:0]) This is an 8-bit, bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors, individually selectable for each bit. The output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics, with both high sink and source capability. As inputs, the port pins that are externally pulled low will source current if pull-up resistors are activated. Port pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active, even if the clock is not running. This port also serves the functions of various special features. 5.1.5. Port C (PC[7:0]) This is an 8-bit, bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors, individually selectable for each bit. The output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics, with both high sink and source capability. As inputs, the port pins that are externally pulled low will source current if pull-up resistors are activated. Port pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active, even if the clock is not running. This port also serves the functions of the JTAG interface, along with special features. 5.1.6. Port D (PD[7:0]) This is an 8-bit, bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors, individually selectable for each bit. The output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics, with both high sink and source capability. As inputs, the port pins that are externally pulled low will source current if pull-up resistors are activated. Port pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active, even if the clock is not running. This port also serves the functions of various special features. 5.1.7. Port E (PE6:0) XTAL1/XTAL2/AREF This is a 7-bit bi-directional GPIO port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The Port E output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source capability. As inputs, Port E pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up resistors are activated. The Port E pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active, even if the clock is not running. PE0 and PE1 are multiplexed with XTAL1 and XTAL2 input. PE4 is multiplexed with AREF for the A/D Converter. 5.1.8. RESET Reset input. A low level on this pin for longer than the minimum pulse length will generate a reset, even if the clock is not running. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate a reset. 5.1.9. AVCC AVCC is the supply voltage pin for Port A and the Analog-to-digital Converter. It should be externally connected to VCC, even if the ADC is not used. If the ADC is used, it should be connected to VCC through a low-pass filter. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 14 6. I/O Multiplexing Each pin is by default controlled by the PORT as a general purpose I/O and alternatively it can be assigned to one of the peripheral functions. The following table describes the peripheral signals multiplexed to the PORT I/O pins. Table 6-1 PORT Function Multiplexing No. PAD 1 PB[5] EXTINT PCINT13 PCINT ADC/AC PTC X PTC Y Y29 OSC T/C # 0 ICP3 T/C # 1 USART I2C MOSI0 2 PB[6] PCINT14 Y30 OC3A MISO0 3 PB[7] PCINT15 Y31 OC3B 4 RESET 5 VCC 6 GND 7 PE[0] PCINT32 XTAL2 8 PE[1] PCINT33 XTAL1 9 PD[0] PCINT24 X0 Y8 10 PD[1] PCINT25 X1 Y9 TxD0 11 PD[2] INT0 PCINT26 X2 Y10 RxD1 12 PD[3] INT1 PCINT27 X3 Y11 TXD1 13 PD[4] PCINT28 X4 Y12 OC1B 14 PD[5] PCINT29 X5 Y13 OC1A 15 PD[6] PCINT30 X6 Y14 OC2B 16 PD[7] PCINT31 X7 Y15 OC2A 17 PE[2] X8 18 PE[3] 19 PC[0] 20 21 OC4B T3 SPI JTAG SCK0 RxD0 XCK1 ICP1 SS1 XCK2 SCK1 Y16 RxD2 MISO1 X9 Y17 TxD2 MOSI1 PCINT16 X10 Y18 PC[1] PCINT17 X11 Y19 PC[2] PCINT18 X12 Y20 T4 TCK 22 PC[3] PCINT19 X13 Y21 ICP4 TMS 23 PC[4] PCINT20 X14 Y22 OC4A TDO 24 PC[5] PCINT21 X15 Y23 25 PC[6] PCINT22 TOSC1 26 PC[7] PCINT23 TOSC2 27 AVCC 28 GND 29 PE[4] 30 PA[7] PCINT7 ADC7 Y7 31 PA[6] PCINT6 ADC6 Y6 32 PA[5] PCINT5 ADC5 Y5 33 PA[4] PCINT4 ADC4 Y4 34 PA[3] PCINT3 ADC3 Y3 ACO SCL0 SDA0 TDI AREF Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 15 No. PAD 35 EXTINT PCINT ADC/AC PA[2] PCINT2 ADC2 Y2 36 PA[1] PCINT1 ADC1 Y1 37 PA[0] PCINT0 ADC0 Y0 38 PE[5] SDA1 39 PE[6] SCL1 40 PB[0] PCINT8 Y24 41 PB[1] PCINT9 Y25 42 PB[2] 43 44 INT2 PTC X PTC Y OSC T/C # 0 T/C # 1 T0 CLKO USART I2C SPI JTAG XCK0 T1 PCINT10 AIN0 Y26 PB[3] PCINT11 AIN1 Y27 OC0A PB[4] PCINT12 Y28 OC0B SS0 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 16 7. General Information 7.1. Resources A comprehensive set of development tools, application notes, and datasheets are available for download on http://www.atmel.com/avr. 7.2. Data Retention Reliability Qualification results show that the projected data retention failure rate is much less than 1 PPM over 20 years at 85°C or 100 years at 25°C. 7.3. About Code Examples This documentation contains simple code examples that briefly show how to use various parts of the device. These code examples assume that the part specific header file is included before compilation. Be aware that not all C compiler vendors include bit definitions in the header files and interrupt handling in C is compiler dependent. Confirm with the C compiler documentation for more details. For I/O Registers located in extended I/O map, “IN”, “OUT”, “SBIS”, “SBIC”, “CBI”, and “SBI” instructions must be replaced with instructions that allow access to extended I/O. Typically “LDS” and “STS” combined with “SBRS”, “SBRC”, “SBR”, and “CBR”. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 17 8. AVR CPU Core 8.1. Overview This section discusses the AVR core architecture in general. The main function of the CPU core is to ensure correct program execution. The CPU must therefore be able to access memories, perform calculations, control peripherals, and handle interrupts. Figure 8-1 Block Diagram of the AVR Architecture Register file R31 (ZH) R29 (YH) R27 (XH) R25 R23 R21 R19 R17 R15 R13 R11 R9 R7 R5 R3 R1 R30 (ZL) R28 (YL) R26 (XL) R24 R22 R20 R18 R16 R14 R12 R10 R8 R6 R4 R2 R0 Program counter Flash program memory Instruction register Instruction decode Data memory Stack pointer Status register ALU In order to maximize performance and parallelism, the AVR uses a Harvard architecture – with separate memories and buses for program and data. Instructions in the program memory are executed with a single level pipelining. While one instruction is being executed, the next instruction is pre-fetched from the program memory. This concept enables instructions to be executed in every clock cycle. The program memory is In-System Reprogrammable Flash memory. The fast-access Register File contains 32 x 8-bit general purpose working registers with a single clock cycle access time. This allows single-cycle Arithmetic Logic Unit (ALU) operation. In a typical ALU operation, two operands are output from the Register File, the operation is executed, and the result is stored back in the Register File – in one clock cycle. Six of the 32 registers can be used as three 16-bit indirect address register pointers for Data Space addressing – enabling efficient address calculations. One of the these address pointers can also be used as an address pointer for look up tables in Flash program memory. These added function registers are the 16-bit X-, Y-, and Z-register, described later in this section. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 18 The ALU supports arithmetic and logic operations between registers or between a constant and a register. Single register operations can also be executed in the ALU. After an arithmetic operation, the Status Register is updated to reflect information about the result of the operation. Program flow is provided by conditional and unconditional jump and call instructions, able to directly address the whole address space. Most AVR instructions have a single 16-bit word format. Every program memory address contains a 16- or 32-bit instruction. Program Flash memory space is divided in two sections, the Boot Program section and the Application Program section. Both sections have dedicated Lock bits for write and read/write protection. The SPM instruction that writes into the Application Flash memory section must reside in the Boot Program section. During interrupts and subroutine calls, the return address Program Counter (PC) is stored on the Stack. The Stack is effectively allocated in the general data SRAM, and consequently the Stack size is only limited by the total SRAM size and the usage of the SRAM. All user programs must initialize the SP in the Reset routine (before subroutines or interrupts are executed). The Stack Pointer (SP) is read/write accessible in the I/O space. The data SRAM can easily be accessed through the five different addressing modes supported in the AVR architecture. The memory spaces in the AVR architecture are all linear and regular memory maps. A flexible interrupt module has its control registers in the I/O space with an additional Global Interrupt Enable bit in the Status Register. All interrupts have a separate Interrupt Vector in the Interrupt Vector table. The interrupts have priority in accordance with their Interrupt Vector position. The lower the Interrupt Vector address, the higher the priority. The I/O memory space contains 64 addresses for CPU peripheral functions as Control Registers, SPI, and other I/O functions. The I/O Memory can be accessed directly, or as the Data Space locations following those of the Register File, 0x20 - 0x5F. In addition, this device has Extended I/O space from 0x60 - 0xFF in SRAM where only the ST/STS/STD and LD/LDS/LDD instructions can be used. 8.2. ALU – Arithmetic Logic Unit The high-performance AVR ALU operates in direct connection with all the 32 general purpose working registers. Within a single clock cycle, arithmetic operations between general purpose registers or between a register and an immediate are executed. The ALU operations are divided into three main categories – arithmetic, logical, and bit-functions. Some implementations of the architecture also provide a powerful multiplier supporting both signed/unsigned multiplication and fractional format. See Instruction Set Summary section for a detailed description. Related Links Instruction Set Summary on page 462 8.3. Status Register The Status Register contains information about the result of the most recently executed arithmetic instruction. This information can be used for altering program flow in order to perform conditional operations. The Status Register is updated after all ALU operations, as specified in the Instruction Set Reference. This will in many cases remove the need for using the dedicated compare instructions, resulting in faster and more compact code. The Status Register is not automatically stored when entering an interrupt routine and restored when returning from an interrupt. This must be handled by software. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 19 8.3.1. Status Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: SREG Offset: 0x5F Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x3F Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 I T H S V N Z C R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – I: Global Interrupt Enable The Global Interrupt Enable bit must be set for the interrupts to be enabled. The individual interrupt enable control is then performed in separate control registers. If the Global Interrupt Enable Register is cleared, none of the interrupts are enabled independent of the individual interrupt enable settings. The Ibit is cleared by hardware after an interrupt has occurred, and is set by the RETI instruction to enable subsequent interrupts. The I-bit can also be set and cleared by the application with the SEI and CLI instructions, as described in the instruction set reference. Bit 6 – T: Copy Storage The Bit Copy instructions BLD (Bit LoaD) and BST (Bit STore) use the T-bit as source or destination for the operated bit. A bit from a register in the Register File can be copied into T by the BST instruction, and a bit in T can be copied into a bit in a register in the Register File by the BLD instruction. Bit 5 – H: Half Carry Flag The Half Carry Flag H indicates a Half Carry in some arithmetic operations. Half Carry Flag is useful in BCD arithmetic. See the Instruction Set Description for detailed information. Bit 4 – S: Sign Flag, S = N ㊉ V The S-bit is always an exclusive or between the Negative Flag N and the Two’s Complement Overflow Flag V. See the Instruction Set Description for detailed information. Bit 3 – V: Two’s Complement Overflow Flag The Two’s Complement Overflow Flag V supports two’s complement arithmetic. See the Instruction Set Description for detailed information. Bit 2 – N: Negative Flag The Negative Flag N indicates a negative result in an arithmetic or logic operation. See the Instruction Set Description for detailed information. Bit 1 – Z: Zero Flag The Zero Flag Z indicates a zero result in an arithmetic or logic operation. See the Instruction Set Description for detailed information. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 20 Bit 0 – C: Carry Flag The Carry Flag C indicates a carry in an arithmetic or logic operation. See the Instruction Set Description for detailed information. 8.4. General Purpose Register File The Register File is optimized for the AVR Enhanced RISC instruction set. In order to achieve the required performance and flexibility, the following input/output schemes are supported by the Register File: • • • • One 8-bit output operand and one 8-bit result input Two 8-bit output operands and one 8-bit result input Two 8-bit output operands and one 16-bit result input One 16-bit output operand and one 16-bit result input Figure 8-2 AVR CPU General Purpose Working Registers 7 0 Addr. R0 0x00 R1 0x01 R2 0x02 … R13 0x0D Ge ne ra l R14 0x0E P urpos e R15 0x0F Working R16 0x10 Re gis te rs R17 0x11 … R26 0x1A X-re gis te r Low Byte R27 0x1B X-re gis te r High Byte R28 0x1C Y-re gis te r Low Byte R29 0x1D Y-re gis te r High Byte R30 0x1E Z-re gis te r Low Byte R31 0x1F Z-re gis te r High Byte Most of the instructions operating on the Register File have direct access to all registers, and most of them are single cycle instructions. As shown in the figure, each register is also assigned a data memory address, mapping them directly into the first 32 locations of the user Data Space. Although not being physically implemented as SRAM locations, this memory organization provides great flexibility in access of the registers, as the X-, Y-, and Z-pointer registers can be set to index any register in the file. 8.4.1. The X-register, Y-register, and Z-register The registers R26...R31 have some added functions to their general purpose usage. These registers are 16-bit address pointers for indirect addressing of the data space. The three indirect address registers X, Y, and Z are defined as described in the figure. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 21 Figure 8-3 The X-, Y-, and Z-registers 15 X-re gis te r XH 7 0 15 Y-re gis te r Z-re gis te r XL 7 0 R27 R26 YH YL 7 0 0 0 7 0 R29 R28 15 ZH ZL 7 0 7 0 0 R31 R30 In the different addressing modes these address registers have functions as fixed displacement, automatic increment, and automatic decrement. See Instruction Set Summary for details. Related Links Instruction Set Summary on page 462 8.5. Stack Pointer The Stack is mainly used for storing temporary data, for storing local variables and for storing return addresses after interrupts and subroutine calls. The Stack is implemented as growing from higher to lower memory locations. The Stack Pointer Register always points to the top of the Stack. The Stack Pointer points to the data SRAM Stack area where the Subroutine and Interrupt Stacks are located. A Stack PUSH command will decrease the Stack Pointer. The Stack in the data SRAM must be defined by the program before any subroutine calls are executed or interrupts are enabled. Initial Stack Pointer value equals the last address of the internal SRAM and the Stack Pointer must be set to point above start of the SRAM. See the table for Stack Pointer details. Table 8-1 Stack Pointer Instructions Instruction Stack pointer Description PUSH Decremented by 1 Data is pushed onto the stack CALL Decremented by 2 Return address is pushed onto the stack with a subroutine call or interrupt ICALL RCALL POP Incremented by 1 Data is popped from the stack RET Incremented by 2 Return address is popped from the stack with return from subroutine or return from interrupt RETI The AVR Stack Pointer is implemented as two 8-bit registers in the I/O space. The number of bits actually used is implementation dependent. Note that the data space in some implementations of the AVR architecture is so small that only SPL is needed. In this case, the SPH Register will not be present. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 22 8.5.1. Stack Pointer Register Low byte When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the I/O addresses 0x00 - 0x3F must be used. When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, 0x20 must be added to these offset addresses. Name: SPL Offset: 0x5D Reset: 0x11111111 Property: When addressing I/O Registers as data space the offset address is 0x3D Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 (SP[7:0]) SPL[7:0] Access Reset RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 Bits 7:0 – (SP[7:0]) SPL[7:0]: Stack Pointer Register SPL and SPH are combined into SP. It means SPL[7:0] is SP[7:0]. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 23 8.5.2. Stack Pointer Register High byte When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the I/O addresses 0x00 - 0x3F must be used. When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, 0x20 must be added to these offset addresses. Name: SPH Offset: 0x5E Reset: RAMEND Property: When addressing I/O Registers as data space the offset address is 0x3E Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 (SP[11:8]) SPH[3:0] Access Reset RW RW RW RW 0 0 0 0 Bits 3:0 – (SP[11:8]) SPH[3:0]: Stack Pointer Register SPL and SPH are combined into SP. It means SPH[4:0] is SP[11:8]. 8.6. Instruction Execution Timing This section describes the general access timing concepts for instruction execution. The AVR CPU is driven by the CPU clock clkCPU, directly generated from the selected clock source for the chip. No internal clock division is used. The Figure below shows the parallel instruction fetches and instruction executions enabled by the Harvard architecture and the fast-access Register File concept. This is the basic pipelining concept to obtain up to 1 MIPS per MHz with the corresponding unique results for functions per cost, functions per clocks, and functions per power-unit. Figure 8-4 The Parallel Instruction Fetches and Instruction Executions T1 T2 T3 T4 clkCPU 1st Instruction Fetch 1st Instruction Execute 2nd Instruction Fetch 2nd Instruction Execute 3rd Instruction Fetch 3rd Instruction Execute 4th Instruction Fetch The following Figure shows the internal timing concept for the Register File. In a single clock cycle an ALU operation using two register operands is executed, and the result is stored back to the destination register. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 24 Figure 8-5 Single Cycle ALU Operation T1 T2 T3 T4 clkCPU Total Execution Time Register Operands Fetch ALU Operation Execute Result Write Back 8.7. Reset and Interrupt Handling The AVR provides several different interrupt sources. These interrupts and the separate Reset Vector each have a separate program vector in the program memory space. All interrupts are assigned individual enable bits which must be written logic one together with the Global Interrupt Enable bit in the Status Register in order to enable the interrupt. Depending on the Program Counter value, interrupts may be automatically disabled when Boot Lock bits BLB02 or BLB12 are programmed. This feature improves software security. The lowest addresses in the program memory space are by default defined as the Reset and Interrupt Vectors. They have determined priority levels: The lower the address the higher is the priority level. RESET has the highest priority, and next is INT0 – the External Interrupt Request 0. The Interrupt Vectors can be moved to the start of the Boot Flash section by setting the IVSEL bit in the MCU Control Register (MCUCR). The Reset Vector can also be moved to the start of the Boot Flash section by programming the BOOTRST Fuse. When an interrupt occurs, the Global Interrupt Enable I-bit is cleared and all interrupts are disabled. The user software can write logic one to the I-bit to enable nested interrupts. All enabled interrupts can then interrupt the current interrupt routine. The I-bit is automatically set when a Return from Interrupt instruction – RETI – is executed. There are basically two types of interrupts: The first type is triggered by an event that sets the Interrupt Flag. For these interrupts, the Program Counter is vectored to the actual Interrupt Vector in order to execute the interrupt handling routine, and hardware clears the corresponding Interrupt Flag. Interrupt Flags can also be cleared by writing a logic one to the flag bit position(s) to be cleared. If an interrupt condition occurs while the corresponding interrupt enable bit is cleared, the Interrupt Flag will be set and remembered until the interrupt is enabled, or the flag is cleared by software. Similarly, if one or more interrupt conditions occur while the Global Interrupt Enable bit is cleared, the corresponding Interrupt Flag(s) will be set and remembered until the Global Interrupt Enable bit is set, and will then be executed by order of priority. The second type of interrupts will trigger as long as the interrupt condition is present. These interrupts do not necessarily have Interrupt Flags. If the interrupt condition disappears before the interrupt is enabled, the interrupt will not be triggered. When the AVR exits from an interrupt, it will always return to the main program and execute one more instruction before any pending interrupt is served. The Status Register is not automatically stored when entering an interrupt routine, nor restored when returning from an interrupt routine. This must be handled by software. When using the CLI instruction to disable interrupts, the interrupts will be immediately disabled. No interrupt will be executed after the CLI instruction, even if it occurs simultaneously with the CLI instruction. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 25 The following example shows how this can be used to avoid interrupts during the timed EEPROM write sequence. Assembly Code Example in r16, SREG ; store SREG value cli ; disable interrupts during timed sequence sbi EECR, EEMPE ; start EEPROM write sbi EECR, EEPE out SREG, r16 ; restore SREG value (I-bit) C Code Example char cSREG; cSREG = SREG; /* store SREG value */ /* disable interrupts during timed sequence */ _CLI(); EECR |= (1<<EEMPE); /* start EEPROM write */ EECR |= (1<<EEPE); SREG = cSREG; /* restore SREG value (I-bit) */ When using the SEI instruction to enable interrupts, the instruction following SEI will be executed before any pending interrupts, as shown in this example. Assembly Code Example sei ; set Global Interrupt Enable sleep ; enter sleep, waiting for interrupt ; note: will enter sleep before any pending interrupt(s) C Code Example __enable_interrupt(); /* set Global Interrupt Enable */ __sleep(); /* enter sleep, waiting for interrupt */ /* note: will enter sleep before any pending interrupt(s) */ Related Links Memory Programming on page 396 Boot Loader Support – Read-While-Write Self-Programming on page 378 8.7.1. Interrupt Response Time The interrupt execution response for all the enabled AVR interrupts is four clock cycles minimum. After four clock cycles the program vector address for the actual interrupt handling routine is executed. During this four clock cycle period, the Program Counter is pushed onto the Stack. The vector is normally a jump to the interrupt routine, and this jump takes three clock cycles. If an interrupt occurs during execution of a multi-cycle instruction, this instruction is completed before the interrupt is served. If an interrupt occurs when the MCU is in sleep mode, the interrupt execution response time is increased by four clock cycles. This increase comes in addition to the start-up time from the selected sleep mode. A return from an interrupt handling routine takes four clock cycles. During these four clock cycles, the Program Counter (two bytes) is popped back from the Stack, the Stack Pointer is incremented by two, and the I-bit in SREG is set. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 26 9. AVR Memories 9.1. Overview This section describes the different memory types in the device. The AVR architecture has two main memory spaces, the Data Memory and the Program Memory space. In addition, the device features an EEPROM Memory for data storage. All memory spaces are linear and regular. 9.2. In-System Reprogrammable Flash Program Memory The device contains 32Kbytes On-chip In-System Reprogrammable Flash memory for program storage. Since all AVR instructions are 16 or 32 bits wide, the Flash is organized as 32K x 16. For software security, the Flash Program memory space is divided into two sections - Boot Loader Section and Application Program Section in the device. The Flash memory has an endurance of at least 10,000 write/erase cycles. The device Program Counter (PC) is 15 bits wide, thus addressing the 32K program memory locations. Constant tables can be allocated within the entire program memory address space, using the Load Program Memory (LPM) instruction. Timing diagrams for instruction fetch and execution are presented in Instruction Exectution Timing. Figure 9-1 Program Memory Map ATmega324PB Program Memory 0x0000 Application Flash Section Boot Flash Section 0x3FFF Related Links BTLDR - Boot Loader Support – Read-While-Write Self-Programming on page 378 MEMPROG- Memory Programming on page 396 Instruction Execution Timing on page 24 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 27 9.3. SRAM Data Memory The following figure shows how the device SRAM Memory is organized. The device is a complex microcontroller with more peripheral units than can be supported within the 64 locations reserved in the Opcode for the IN and OUT instructions. For the Extended I/O space from 0x60 - 0xFF in SRAM, only the ST/STS/STD and LD/LDS/LDD instructions can be used. The lower 4352 data memory locations address both the Register File, the I/O memory, Extended I/O memory, and the internal data SRAM. The first 32 locations address the Register File, the next 64 location the standard I/O memory, then 160 locations of Extended I/O memory, and the next 4096 locations address the internal data SRAM. The five different addressing modes for the data memory cover: • Direct – The direct addressing reaches the entire data space. • Indirect with Displacement – The Indirect with Displacement mode reaches 63 address locations from the base address given by the Y- or Z-register. • Indirect – In the Register File, registers R26 to R31 feature the indirect addressing pointer registers. • Indirect with Pre-decrement – The address registers X, Y, and Z are decremented. • Indirect with Post-increment – The address registers X, Y, and Z are incremented. The 32 general purpose working registers, 64 I/O Registers, 160 Extended I/O Registers, and the 2048 bytes of internal data SRAM in the device are all accessible through all these addressing modes. Figure 9-2 Data Memory Map Data Memory 32 Registers 64 I/O Registers 160 Ext I/O Reg. 0x0000 - 0x001F 0x0020 - 0x005F 0x0060 - 0x00FF 0x0100 Internal SRAM (2048 x 8) 0x08FF 9.3.1. Data Memory Access Times The internal data SRAM access is performed in two clkCPU cycles as described in the following Figure. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 28 Figure 9-3 On-chip Data SRAM Access Cycles T1 T2 T3 Compute Address Address valid clkCPU Address Write Data WR Read Data RD Memory Access Instruction 9.4. Next Instruction EEPROM Data Memory The device contains 1K bytes of data EEPROM memory. It is organized as a separate data space, in which single bytes can be read and written. The EEPROM has an endurance of at least 100,000 write/ erase cycles. The access between the EEPROM and the CPU is described in the following, specifying the EEPROM Address Registers, the EEPROM Data Register, and the EEPROM Control Register. See the related links for a detailed description on EEPROM Programming in SPI or Parallel Programming mode. Related Links MEMPROG- Memory Programming on page 396 9.4.1. EEPROM Read/Write Access The EEPROM Access Registers are accessible in the I/O space. The write access time for the EEPROM is given in Table 9-2 EEPROM Programming Time on page 36. A self-timing function, however, lets the user software detect when the next byte can be written. If the user code contains instructions that write the EEPROM, some precautions must be taken. In heavily filtered power supplies, VCC is likely to rise or fall slowly on power-up/down. This causes the device for some period of time to run at a voltage lower than specified as minimum for the clock frequency used. Please refer to Preventing EEPROM Corruption on page 30 for details on how to avoid problems in these situations. In order to prevent unintentional EEPROM writes, a specific write procedure must be followed. Refer to the description of the EEPROM Control Register for details on this. When the EEPROM is read, the CPU is halted for four clock cycles before the next instruction is executed. When the EEPROM is written, the CPU is halted for two clock cycles before the next instruction is executed. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 29 9.4.2. Preventing EEPROM Corruption During periods of low VCC, the EEPROM data can be corrupted because the supply voltage is too low for the CPU and the EEPROM to operate properly. These issues are the same as for board level systems using EEPROM, and the same design solutions should be applied. An EEPROM data corruption can be caused by two situations when the voltage is too low. First, a regular write sequence to the EEPROM requires a minimum voltage to operate correctly. Secondly, the CPU itself can execute instructions incorrectly, if the supply voltage is too low. EEPROM data corruption can easily be avoided by following this design recommendation: Keep the AVR RESET active (low) during periods of insufficient power supply voltage. This can be done by enabling the internal Brown-out Detector (BOD). If the detection level of the internal BOD does not match the needed detection level, an external low VCC reset Protection circuit can be used. If a reset occurs while a write operation is in progress, the write operation will be completed provided that the power supply voltage is sufficient. 9.5. I/O Memory The I/O space definition of the device is shown in the Register Summary. All device I/Os and peripherals are placed in the I/O space. All I/O locations may be accessed by the LD/LDS/LDD and ST/STS/STD instructions, transferring data between the 32 general purpose working registers and the I/O space. I/O Registers within the address range 0x00-0x1F are directly bit-accessible using the SBI and CBI instructions. In these registers, the value of single bits can be checked by using the SBIS and SBIC instructions. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the I/O addresses 0x00-0x3F must be used. When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, 0x20 must be added to these addresses. The device is a complex microcontroller with more peripheral units than can be supported within the 64 location reserved in Opcode for the IN and OUT instructions. For the Extended I/O space from 0x60..0xFF in SRAM, only the ST/STS/STD and LD/LDS/LDD instructions can be used. For compatibility with future devices, reserved bits should be written to zero if accessed. Reserved I/O memory addresses should never be written. Some of the Status Flags are cleared by writing a '1' to them; this is described in the flag descriptions. Note that, unlike most other AVRs, the CBI and SBI instructions will only operate on the specified bit, and can therefore be used on registers containing such Status Flags. The CBI and SBI instructions work with registers 0x00-0x1F only. The I/O and Peripherals Control Registers are explained in later sections. Related Links MEMPROG- Memory Programming on page 396 Register Summary on page 457 Instruction Set Summary on page 462 9.5.1. General Purpose I/O Registers The device contains three General Purpose I/O Registers, General Purpose I/O Register 0/1/2 (GPIOR 0/1/2). These registers can be used for storing any information, and they are particularly useful for storing global variables and Status Flags. General Purpose I/O Registers within the address range 0x00 - 0x1F are directly bit-accessible using the SBI, CBI, SBIS, and SBIC instructions. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 30 9.6. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 31 9.6.1. EEPROM Address Register High When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: EEARH Offset: 0x42 Reset: 0x0X Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x22 Bit 7 6 5 Access Reset 4 3 2 1 0 EEAR11 EEAR10 EEAR9 EEAR8 R/W R/W R/W R/W x x x x Bit 3 – EEAR11: EEPROM Address 11 Refer to EEARL on page 33. Bit 2 – EEAR10: EEPROM Address 10 Refer to EEARL on page 33. Bit 1 – EEAR9: EEPROM Address 9 Refer to EEARL on page 33. Bit 0 – EEAR8: EEPROM Address 8 Refer to EEARL on page 33. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 32 9.6.2. EEPROM Address Register Low When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: EEARL Offset: 0x41 Reset: 0xXX Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x21 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EEAR7 EEAR6 EEAR5 EEAR4 EEAR3 EEAR2 EEAR1 EEAR0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W x x x x x x x x Bits 7:0 – EEARn: EEPROM Address The EEPROM Address Registers – EEARH and EEARL specify the EEPROM address in the 1K Bytes EEPROM space. The EEPROM data bytes are addressed linearly between 0 and 1023. The initial value of EEAR is undefined. A proper value must be written before the EEPROM may be accessed. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 33 9.6.3. EEPROM Data Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: EEDR Offset: 0x40 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x20 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EEDR[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – EEDR[7:0]: EEPROM Data For the EEPROM write operation, the EEDR Register contains the data to be written to the EEPROM in the address given by the EEAR Register. For the EEPROM read operation, the EEDR contains the data read out from the EEPROM at the address given by EEAR. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 34 9.6.4. EEPROM Control Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: EECR Offset: 0x3F Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x1F Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EEPM1 EEPM0 EERIE EEMPE EEPE EERE R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W x x 0 0 x x Access Reset Bits 5:4 – EEPMn: EEPROM Programming Mode Bits [n = 1:0] The EEPROM Programming mode bit setting defines which programming action that will be triggered when writing EEPE. It is possible to program data in one atomic operation (erase the old value and program the new value) or to split the Erase and Write operations in two different operations. The Programming times for the different modes are shown in the table below. While EEPE is set, any write to EEPMn will be ignored. During reset, the EEPMn bits will be reset to 0b00 unless the EEPROM is busy programming. Table 9-1 EEPROM Mode Bits EEPM[1:0] Programming Time Operation 00 3.4ms Erase and Write in one operation (Atomic Operation) 01 1.8ms Erase Only 10 1.8ms Write Only 11 - Reserved for future use Bit 3 – EERIE: EEPROM Ready Interrupt Enable Writing EERIE to one enables the EEPROM Ready Interrupt if the I bit in SREG is set. Writing EERIE to zero disables the interrupt. The EEPROM Ready interrupt generates a constant interrupt when EEPE is cleared. The interrupt will not be generated during EEPROM write or SPM. Bit 2 – EEMPE: EEPROM Master Write Enable The EEMPE bit determines whether writing EEPE to '1' causes the EEPROM to be written. When EEMPE is '1', setting EEPE within four clock cycles will write data to the EEPROM at the selected address. If EEMPE is zero, setting EEPE will have no effect. When EEMPE has been written to '1' by software, hardware clears the bit to zero after four clock cycles. See the description of the EEPE bit for an EEPROM write procedure. Bit 1 – EEPE: EEPROM Write Enable The EEPROM Write Enable Signal EEPE is the write strobe to the EEPROM. When address and data are correctly set up, the EEPE bit must be written to '1' to write the value into the EEPROM. The EEMPE bit Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 35 must be written to '1' before EEPE is written to '1', otherwise no EEPROM write takes place. The following procedure should be followed when writing the EEPROM (the order of steps 3 and 4 is not essential): 1. Wait until EEPE becomes zero. 2. Wait until SPMEN in SPMCSR becomes zero. 3. Write new EEPROM address to EEAR (optional). 4. Write new EEPROM data to EEDR (optional). 5. Write a '1' to the EEMPE bit while writing a zero to EEPE in EECR. 6. Within four clock cycles after setting EEMPE, write a '1' to EEPE. The EEPROM can not be programmed during a CPU write to the Flash memory. The software must check that the Flash programming is completed before initiating a new EEPROM write. Step 2 is only relevant if the software contains a Boot Loader allowing the CPU to program the Flash. If the Flash is never being updated by the CPU, step 2 can be omitted. Caution: An interrupt between step 5 and step 6 will make the write cycle fail, since the EEPROM Master Write Enable will time-out. If an interrupt routine accessing the EEPROM is interrupting another EEPROM access, the EEAR or EEDR Register will be modified, causing the interrupted EEPROM access to fail. It is recommended to have the Global Interrupt Flag cleared during all the steps to avoid these problems. When the write access time has elapsed, the EEPE bit is cleared by hardware. The user software can poll this bit and wait for a zero before writing the next byte. When EEPE has been set, the CPU is halted for two cycles before the next instruction is executed. Bit 0 – EERE: EEPROM Read Enable The EEPROM Read Enable Signal EERE is the read strobe to the EEPROM. When the correct address is set up in the EEAR Register, the EERE bit must be written to a '1' to trigger the EEPROM read. The EEPROM read access takes one instruction, and the requested data is available immediately. When the EEPROM is read, the CPU is halted for four cycles before the next instruction is executed. The user should poll the EEPE bit before starting the read operation. If a write operation is in progress, it is neither possible to read the EEPROM, nor to change the EEAR Register. The calibrated Oscillator is used to time the EEPROM accesses. See the following table for typical programming times for EEPROM access from the CPU. Table 9-2 EEPROM Programming Time Symbol Number of Calibrated RC Oscillator Cycles Typ. Programming Time EEPROM write (from CPU) 26,368 3.3ms The following code examples show one assembly and one C function for writing to the EEPROM. The examples assume that interrupts are controlled (e.g. by disabling interrupts globally) so that no interrupts will occur during execution of these functions. The examples also assume that no Flash Boot Loader is present in the software. If such code is present, the EEPROM write function must also wait for any ongoing SPM command to finish. Assembly Code Example EEPROM_write: ; Wait for completion of previous write Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 36 sbic EECR,EEPE rjmp EEPROM_write ; Set up address (r18:r17) in address register out EEARH, r18 out EEARL, r17 ; Write data (r16) to Data Register out EEDR,r16 ; Write logical one to EEMPE sbi EECR,EEMPE ; Start eeprom write by setting EEPE sbi EECR,EEPE ret C Code Example void EEPROM_write(unsigned int uiAddress, unsigned char ucData) { /* Wait for completion of previous write */ while(EECR & (1<<EEPE)) ; /* Set up address and Data Registers */ EEAR = uiAddress; EEDR = ucData; /* Write logical one to EEMPE */ EECR |= (1<<EEMPE); /* Start eeprom write by setting EEPE */ EECR |= (1<<EEPE); } The next code examples show assembly and C functions for reading the EEPROM. The examples assume that interrupts are controlled so that no interrupts will occur during execution of these functions. Assembly Code Example EEPROM_read: ; Wait for completion of previous write sbic EECR,EEPE rjmp EEPROM_read ; Set up address (r18:r17) in address register out EEARH, r18 out EEARL, r17 ; Start eeprom read by writing EERE sbi EECR,EERE ; Read data from Data Register in r16,EEDR ret C Code Example unsigned char EEPROM_read(unsigned int uiAddress) { /* Wait for completion of previous write */ while(EECR & (1<<EEPE)) ; /* Set up address register */ EEAR = uiAddress; /* Start eeprom read by writing EERE */ EECR |= (1<<EERE); /* Return data from Data Register */ return EEDR; } Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 37 9.6.5. GPIOR2 – General Purpose I/O Register 2 When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: GPIOR2 Offset: 0x4B Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x2B Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 GPIOR2[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – GPIOR2[7:0]: General Purpose I/O Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 38 9.6.6. GPIOR1 – General Purpose I/O Register 1 When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: GPIOR1 Offset: 0x4A Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x2A Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 GPIOR1[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – GPIOR1[7:0]: General Purpose I/O Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 39 9.6.7. GPIOR0 – General Purpose I/O Register 0 When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: GPIOR0 Offset: 0x3E Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x1E Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 GPIOR0[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – GPIOR0[7:0]: General Purpose I/O 9.6.8. Unique Device ID Each individual part has a specific unique device ID. This can be used to identify a specify part while it is in the field. The Unique Device ID consists of nine serial number bytes in which the user can access directly from registers. The register address locations are located at 0xF0 to 0xF8. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 40 9.6.8.1. Serial Number Byte 8 to 0 Name: SNOBR8, SNOBR7, SNOBR6, SNOBR0, SNOBR1, SNOBR2, SNOBR3, SNOBR4, SNOBR5 Offset: 0xF0 + n*0x01 [n=0..8] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 SNOBR[7:0] Access Reset Bits 7:0 – SNOBR[7:0]: Serial Number Byte Value Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 41 10. System Clock and Clock Options 10.1. Clock Systems and Their Distribution The following figure illustrates the principal clock systems in the device and their distribution. All the clocks need not be active at a given time. In order to reduce power consumption, the clocks to modules not being used can be halted by using different sleep modes. The clock systems are described in the following sections. The system clock frequency refers to the frequency generated from the System Clock Prescaler. All clock outputs from the AVR Clock Control Unit runs in the same frequency. Figure 10-1 Clock Distribution Peripheral Touch Controller Asynchronous Timer/Counter General I/O Modules ADC CPU Core RAM Flash and EEPROM clkADC clkI/O clkASY AVR Clock Control Unit clkFLASH clkPTC System Clock Prescaler Source clock Clock Multiplexer Timer/Counter Oscillator 10.1.1. External Clock clkCPU Crystal Oscillator Reset Logic Watchdog Timer Watchdog clock Watchdog Oscillator Low-frequency Crystal Oscillator Calibrated RC Oscillator CPU Clock – clkCPU The CPU clock is routed to parts of the system concerned with operation of the AVR core. Examples of such modules are the General Purpose Register File, the Status Register and the data memory holding the Stack Pointer. Halting the CPU clock inhibits the core from performing general operations and calculations. 10.1.2. I/O Clock – clkI/O The I/O clock is used by the majority of the I/O modules, like Timer/Counters, SPI, and USART. The I/O clock is also used by the External Interrupt module, but the start condition detection in the USI module is carried out asynchronously when clkI/O is halted, TWI address recognition in all sleep modes. Note: If a level triggered interrupt is used for wake-up from Power-down, the required level must be held long enough for the MCU to complete the wake-up to trigger the level interrupt. If the level disappears before the end of the Start-up Time, the MCU will still wake up, but no interrupt will be generated. The start-up time is defined by the SUT and CKSEL Fuses. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 42 10.1.3. PTC Clock - clkPTC The PTC is provided with a dedicated clock domain. This allows halting the CPU and I/O clocks in order to reduce noise and power due to digital circuitry. 10.1.4. Flash Clock – clkFLASH The Flash clock controls operation of the Flash interface. The Flash clock is usually active simultaneously with the CPU clock. 10.1.5. Asynchronous Timer Clock – clkASY The Asynchronous Timer clock allows Asynchronous Timer/Counters to be clocked directly from an external clock or an external 32kHz clock crystal. The dedicated clock domain allows using this Timer/ Counter as a real-time counter even when the device is in sleep mode. 10.1.6. ADC Clock – clkADC The ADC is provided with a dedicated clock domain. This allows halting the CPU and I/O clocks in order to reduce noise generated by digital circuitry. This gives more accurate ADC conversion results. 10.2. Clock Sources The device has the following clock source options, selectable by Flash Fuse bits as shown below. The clock from the selected source is input to the AVR clock generator, and routed to the appropriate modules. Table 10-1 Device Clocking Options Select Device Clocking Option CKSEL[3:0] Low Power Crystal Oscillator 1111 - 1000 Low Frequency Crystal Oscillator 0101 - 0100 Internal 128kHz RC Oscillator 0011 Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator 0010 External Clock 0000 Reserved 0001 Note: For all fuses, '1' means unprogrammed while '0' means programmed. 10.2.1. Default Clock Source The device is shipped with internal RC oscillator at 8.0MHz and with the fuse CKDIV8 programmed, resulting in 1.0MHz system clock. The startup time is set to maximum, and the time-out period is enabled: CKSEL=0010, SUT=10, CKDIV8=0. This default setting ensures that all users can make their desired clock source setting using any available programming interface. 10.2.2. Clock Startup Sequence Any clock source needs a sufficient VCC to start oscillating and a minimum number of oscillating cycles before it can be considered stable. To ensure sufficient VCC, the device issues an internal reset with a time-out delay (tTOUT) after the device reset is released by all other reset sources. See the Related Links for a description of the start conditions for the internal reset. The delay (tTOUT) is timed from the Watchdog Oscillator and the number of cycles in Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 43 the delay is set by the SUTx and CKSELx fuse bits. The selectable delays are shown in the Table below. The frequency of the Watchdog Oscillator is voltage dependent. Table 10-2 Number of Watchdog Oscillator Cycles Typ. Time-out (VCC = 5.0V) Typ. Time-out (VCC = 3.0V) Number of Cycles 0ms 0ms 0 4.1ms 4.3ms 512 65ms 69ms 8K (8,192) Main purpose of the delay is to keep the device in reset until it is supplied with minimum VCC. The delay will not monitor the actual voltage, so it is required to select a delay longer than the VCC rise time. If this is not possible, an internal or external Brown-Out Detection circuit should be used. A BOD circuit will ensure sufficient VCC before it releases the reset, and the time-out delay can be disabled. Disabling the time-out delay without utilizing a Brown-Out Detection circuit is not recommended. The oscillator is required to oscillate for a minimum number of cycles before the clock is considered stable. An internal ripple counter monitors the oscillator output clock, and keeps the internal reset active for a given number of clock cycles. The reset is then released and the device will start to execute. The recommended oscillator start-up time is dependent on the clock type, and varies from 6 cycles for an externally applied clock to 32K cycles for a low frequency crystal. The start-up sequence for the clock includes both the time-out delay and the start-up time when the device starts up from reset. When starting up from Power-save or Power-down mode, VCC is assumed to be at a sufficient level and only the start-up time is included. 10.3. Low Power Crystal Oscillator Pins XTAL1 and XTAL2 are input and output, respectively, of an inverting amplifier which can be configured for use as an On-chip Oscillator, as shown in the Figure below. Either a quartz crystal or a ceramic resonator may be used. This Crystal Oscillator is a low power oscillator, with reduced voltage swing on the XTAL2 output. It gives the lowest power consumption, but is not capable of driving other clock inputs, and may be more susceptible to noise in noisy environments. . C1 and C2 should always be equal for both crystals and resonators. The optimal value of the capacitors depends on the crystal or resonator in use, the amount of stray capacitance, and the electromagnetic noise of the environment. Some initial guidelines for choosing capacitors for use with crystals are given in the next Table. For ceramic resonators, the capacitor values given by the manufacturer should be used. Figure 10-2 Crystal Oscillator Connections C2 C1 XTAL2 (TOSC2) XTAL1 (TOSC1) GND The Low Power Oscillator can operate in three different modes, each optimized for a specific frequency range. The operating mode is selected by the fuses CKSEL[3:1], as shown in the following Table: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 44 Table 10-3 Low Power Crystal Oscillator Operating Modes(3) Frequency Range [MHz] Range for Capacitors C1 and C2 [pF] CKSEL[3:1](1) 0.4 - 0.9 – 100(2) 0.9 - 3.0 12 - 22 101 3.0 - 8.0 12 - 22 110 8.0 - 16.0 12 - 22 111 Note: 1. This is the recommended CKSEL settings for the difference frequency ranges. 2. This option should not be used with crystals, only with ceramic resonators. 3. If the crystal frequency exceeds the specification of the device (depends on VCC), the CKDIV8 Fuse can be programmed in order to divide the internal frequency by 8. It must be ensured that the resulting divided clock meets the frequency specification of the device. 4. When selecting the external capacitor value, the stray capacitance from the PCB and device should be deducted. The CKSEL0 Fuse together with the SUT[1:0] Fuses select the start-up times, as shown in the following Table: Table 10-4 Start-up Times for the Low Power Crystal Oscillator Clock Selection Oscillator Source / Power Conditions Start-up Time from Power-down and Power-save Additional Delay from Reset (VCC = 5.0V) CKSEL0 SUT[1:0] Ceramic resonator, fast rising power 258 CK 14CK + 4.1ms(1) 0 00 Ceramic resonator, slowly rising power 258 CK 14CK + 65ms(1) 0 01 Ceramic resonator, BOD enabled 1K CK 14CK(2) 0 10 Ceramic resonator, fast rising power 1K CK 14CK + 4.1ms(2) 0 11 Ceramic resonator, slowly rising power 1K CK 14CK + 65ms(2) 1 00 Crystal Oscillator, BOD enabled 16K CK 14CK 1 01 Crystal Oscillator, fast rising power 16K CK 14CK + 4.1ms 1 10 Crystal Oscillator, slowly rising power 16K CK 14CK + 65ms 1 11 Note: 1. These options should only be used when not operating close to the maximum frequency of the device, and only if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the application. These options are not suitable for crystals. 2. These options are intended for use with ceramic resonators and will ensure frequency stability at start-up. They can also be used with crystals when not operating close to the maximum frequency of the device, and if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the application. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 45 10.4. Low Frequency Crystal Oscillator The Low-frequency Crystal Oscillator is optimized for use with a 32.768kHz watch crystal. When selecting crystals, load capacitance and crystal’s Equivalent Series Resistance (ESR) must be taken into consideration. Both values are specified by the crystal vendor. The oscillator is optimized for very low power consumption, and thus when selecting crystals, consider the Maximum ESR Recommendations: Table 10-5 Maximum ESR Recommendation for 32.768kHz Crystal Crystal CL [pF] Max. ESR [kΩ](1) 9.0 65 12.5 30 Note: 1. Maximum ESR is typical value based on characterization. The Low-frequency Crystal Oscillator provides an internal load capacitance at each TOSC pin: The capacitance (Ce+Ci) needed at each TOSC pin can be calculated by using: � = 2C� − �� where: • • • • Ce - is optional external capacitors as described in Low Power Crystal Oscillator on page 44 Ci - is the pin capacitance in the above table CL - is the load capacitance for a 32.768kHz crystal specified by the crystal vendor CS - is the total stray capacitance for one TOSC pin. Crystals specifying a load capacitance (CL) higher than 6pF require external capacitors applied as described in Low Power Crystal Oscillator on page 44. When this oscillator is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses and CKSEL0 as shown in the following table. Table 10-6 Start-up Times for the Low Frequency Crystal Oscillator Clock Selection Power Conditions Start-up Time Additional Delay CKSEL[0] from Power-down from Reset (VCC = and Power-save 5.0V) SUT[1:0] BOD enabled 1K CK 14CK(1) 0 00 Fast rising power 1K CK 14CK + 4.1 ms(1) 0 01 Slowly rising power 1K CK 14CK + 65 ms(1) 0 10 0 11 Reserved BOD enabled 32K CK 14CK 1 00 Fast rising power 32K CK 14CK + 4.1 ms(1) 1 01 Slowly rising power 32K CK 14CK + 65 ms(1) 1 10 1 11 Reserved Note: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 46 1. 10.5. This option should only be used if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the application. Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator By default, the Internal RC Oscillator provides an 8.0MHz clock. Though voltage and temperature dependent, this clock can be very accurately calibrated by the user. The device is shipped with the CKDIV8 Fuse programmed. This clock may be selected as the system clock by programming the CKSEL Fuses as shown in the following Table. If selected, it will operate with no external components. During reset, hardware loads the pre-programmed calibration value into the OSCCAL Register and thereby automatically calibrates the RC Oscillator. Table 10-7 Internal Calibrated RC Oscillator Operating Modes Frequency Range(1) [MHz] CKSEL[3:0] 7.3 - 8.1 0010(2) Note: 1. If 8MHz frequency exceeds the specification of the device (depends on VCC), the CKDIV8 Fuse can be programmed in order to divide the internal frequency by 8. 2. The device is shipped with this option selected. When this Oscillator is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses: Table 10-8 Start-Up Times for the Internal Calibrated RC Oscillator Clock Selection - SUT Power Conditions Start-Up Time from Power-down and Power-Save Additional Delay from Reset SUT[1:0] (VCC = 5.0V) BOD enabled 6 CK 14CK 00 Fast rising power 6 CK 14CK + 4.1ms 01 Slowly rising power 6 CK 14CK + 65ms(1) 10 Reserved 11 Note: 1. The device is shipped with this option selected. By changing the OSCCAL register from SW, it is possible to get a higher calibration accuracy than by using the factory calibration. When this Oscillator is used as the chip clock, the Watchdog Oscillator will still be used for the Watchdog Timer and for the Reset Time-Out. For more information on the pre-programmed calibration value. Related Links Fuse Bits on page 397 10.6. 128kHz Internal Oscillator The 128kHz internal Oscillator is a low power Oscillator providing a clock of 128kHz. The frequency is nominal at 3V and 25°C. This clock may be select as the system clock by programming the CKSEL Fuses to '0011': Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 47 Table 10-9 128kHz Internal Oscillator Operating Modes Nominal Frequency(1) CKSEL[3:0] 128kHz 0011 Note: 1. The 128kHz oscillator is a very low power clock source, and is not designed for high accuracy. When this clock source is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses: Table 10-10 Start-Up Times for the 128kHz Internal Oscillator Power Conditions Start-Up Time from Power-down and Power-save Additional Delay from Reset SUT[1:0] BOD enabled 6 CK 14CK 00 Fast rising power 6 CK 14CK + 4ms 01 Slowly rising power 6 CK 14CK + 64ms 10 Reserved 10.7. 11 External Clock To drive the device from an external clock source, EXTCLK should be driven as shown in the Figure below. To run the device on an external clock, the CKSEL Fuses must be programmed to '0000': Table 10-11 External Clock Frequency Frequency CKSEL[3:0] 0 - 20MHz 0000 Figure 10-3 External Clock Drive Configuration EXTERNAL CLOCK SIGNAL EXTCLK GND When this clock source is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses: Table 10-12 Start-Up Times for the External Clock Selection - SUT Power Conditions Start-Up Time from Power-down and Power-save Additional Delay from Reset SUT[1:0] (VCC = 5.0V) BOD enabled 6 CK 14CK 00 Fast rising power 6 CK 14CK + 4.1ms 01 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 48 Power Conditions Start-Up Time from Power-down and Power-save Additional Delay from Reset SUT[1:0] (VCC = 5.0V) Slowly rising power 6 CK 14CK + 65ms Reserved 10 11 When applying an external clock, it is required to avoid sudden changes in the applied clock frequency to ensure stable operation of the MCU. A variation in frequency of more than 2% from one clock cycle to the next can lead to unpredictable behavior. If changes of more than 2% is required, ensure that the MCU is kept in Reset during the changes. The System Clock Prescaler can be used to implement run-time changes of the internal clock frequency while still ensuring stable operation. 10.8. Clock Output Buffer The device can output the system clock on the CLKO pin. To enable the output, the CKOUT Fuse has to be programmed. This mode is suitable when the chip clock is used to drive other circuits on the system. The clock also will be output during reset, and the normal operation of I/O pin will be overridden when the fuse is programmed. Any clock source, including the internal RC Oscillator, can be selected when the clock is output on CLKO. If the System Clock Prescaler is used, it is the divided system clock that is output. 10.9. Timer/Counter Oscillator The device uses the same crystal oscillator for Low-frequency Oscillator and Timer/Counter Oscillator. See Low Frequency Crystal Oscillator for details on the oscillator and crystal requirements. On this device, the Timer/Counter Oscillator Pins (TOSC1 and TOSC2) are shared with EXTCLK. When using the Timer/Counter Oscillator, the system clock needs to be four times the oscillator frequency. Due to this and the pin sharing, the Timer/Counter Oscillator can only be used when the Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator is selected as system clock source. Applying an external clock source to TOSC1 can be done if the Enable External Clock Input bit in the Asynchronous Status Register (ASSR.EXCLK) is written to '1'. See the description of the Asynchronous Operation of Timer/Counter2 for further description on selecting external clock as input instead of a 32.768kHz watch crystal. 10.10. System Clock Prescaler The device has a system clock prescaler, and the system clock can be divided by configuring the Clock Prescale Register (CLKPR). This feature can be used to decrease the system clock frequency and the power consumption when the requirement for processing power is low. This can be used with all clock source options, and it will affect the clock frequency of the CPU and all synchronous peripherals. clkI/O, clkADC, clkCPU, and clkFLASH are divided by a factor as shown in the CLKPR description. When switching between prescaler settings, the System Clock Prescaler ensures that no glitches occurs in the clock system. It also ensures that no intermediate frequency is higher than neither the clock frequency corresponding to the previous setting, nor the clock frequency corresponding to the new setting. The ripple counter that implements the prescaler runs at the frequency of the undivided clock, which may be faster than the CPU's clock frequency. Hence, it is not possible to determine the state of the prescaler - even if it were readable, the exact time it takes to switch from one clock division to the Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 49 other cannot be exactly predicted. From the time the Clock Prescaler Selection bits (CLKPS[3:0]) values are written, it takes between T1 + T2 and T1 + 2 * T2 before the new clock frequency is active. In this interval, two active clock edges are produced. Here, T1 is the previous clock period, and T2 is the period corresponding to the new prescaler setting. To avoid unintentional changes of clock frequency, a special write procedure must be followed to change the CLKPS bits: 1. 2. Write the Clock Prescaler Change Enable (CLKPCE) bit to '1' and all other bits in CLKPR to zero: CLKPR=0x80. Within four cycles, write the desired value to CLKPS[3:0] while writing a zero to CLKPCE: CLKPR=0x0N Interrupts must be disabled when changing prescaler setting to make sure the write procedure is not interrupted. 10.11. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 50 10.11.1. Oscillator Calibration Register Name: OSCCAL Offset: 0x66 Reset: Device Specific Calibration Value Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CAL7 CAL6 CAL5 CAL4 CAL3 CAL2 CAL1 CAL0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W x x x x x x x x Bits 7:0 – CALn: Oscillator Calibration Value [n = 7:0] The Oscillator Calibration Register is used to trim the Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator to remove process variations from the oscillator frequency. A pre-programmed calibration value is automatically written to this register during chip reset, giving the Factory calibrated frequency. The application software can write this register to change the oscillator frequency. The oscillator can be calibrated to frequencies as specified in the Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator description. Calibration outside that range is not guaranteed. Note that this oscillator is used to time EEPROM and Flash write accesses, and these write times will be affected accordingly. If the EEPROM or Flash are written, do not calibrate to more than 8.8MHz. Otherwise, the EEPROM or Flash write may fail. The CAL7 bit determines the range of operation for the oscillator. Setting this bit to 0 gives the lowest frequency range, setting this bit to 1 gives the highest frequency range. The two frequency ranges are overlapping, in other words a setting of OSCCAL=0x7F gives a higher frequency than OSCCAL=0x80. The CAL6..0 bits are used to tune the frequency within the selected range. A setting of 0x00 gives the lowest frequency in that range, and a setting of 0x7F gives the highest frequency in the range. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 51 10.11.2. Clock Prescaler Register Name: CLKPR Offset: 0x61 Reset: Refer to the bit description Property: Bit Access Reset 3 2 1 0 CLKPCE 7 6 5 4 CLKPS3 CLKPS2 CLKPS1 CLKPS0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 x x x x Bit 7 – CLKPCE: Clock Prescaler Change Enable The CLKPCE bit must be written to logic one to enable change of the CLKPS bits. The CLKPCE bit is only updated when the other bits in CLKPR are simultaneously written to zero. CLKPCE is cleared by hardware four cycles after it is written or when CLKPS bits are written. Rewriting the CLKPCE bit within this time-out period does neither extend the time-out period, nor clear the CLKPCE bit. Bits 3:0 – CLKPSn: Clock Prescaler Select n [n = 3:0] These bits define the division factor between the selected clock source and the internal system clock. These bits can be written run-time to vary the clock frequency to suit the application requirements. As the divider divides the master clock input to the MCU, the speed of all synchronous peripherals is reduced when a division factor is used. The division factors are given in the table below. The CKDIV8 Fuse determines the initial value of the CLKPS bits. If CKDIV8 is unprogrammed, the CLKPS bits will be reset to “0000”. If CKDIV8 is programmed, CLKPS bits are reset to “0011”, giving a division factor of 8 at start up. This feature should be used if the selected clock source has a higher frequency than the maximum frequency of the device at the present operating conditions. Note that any value can be written to the CLKPS bits regardless of the CKDIV8 Fuse setting. The Application software must ensure that a sufficient division factor is chosen if the selected clock source has a higher frequency than the maximum frequency of the device at the present operating conditions. The device is shipped with the CKDIV8 Fuse programmed. Table 10-13 Clock Prescaler Select CLKPS[3:0] Clock Division Factor 0000 1 0001 2 0010 4 0011 8 0100 16 0101 32 0110 64 0111 128 1000 256 1001 Reserved Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 52 CLKPS[3:0] Clock Division Factor 1010 Reserved 1011 Reserved 1100 Reserved 1101 Reserved 1110 Reserved 1111 Reserved Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 53 11. 11.1. CFD - Clock Failure Detection mechanism Overview The Clock Failure Detection mechanism for the device is enabled by an active high fuse . When the CFD fuse is enabled 128kHz oscillator will be enabled and the CFD circuit works with that clock. 11.2. Features • • • • • 11.3. Fuse enabled CFD and is Active high (Fuse FEB bit 4) External clock failure detection circuit works in 128kHz In case of failure, the system clock will fallback to calibrated RC oscillator output 1MHz fallback clock Interrupt flag (XFDIF) available for external clock failure Operations • • • • • • • • • • • • • The CFD works only if the Low power crystal oscillator and External clocks. When the XOSC is working, "CKSEL to clock sel" (refer to the figure) will be "CKSEL fuse" which will be selected and the appropriate clock will be used as system clock. XOSC failure is monitored by the CFD circuit which works in 128kHz. Once the failure is detected, calibrated RC oscillator is enabled. XFDIF interrupt will be raised. This interrupt is enabled by XFDIE bit of XFDCSR register. When the XOSC is failed, the selected clock will be 4'b0010 (hardcoded) which is the value of calibrated RC and output of calibrated RC will be used as system clock. The fallback clock will be 1MHz. The figure shows system clock generation with CFD mechanism. User can change the clock by changing the prescaler after clock switching. CFD will be autimatically disabled when chip enters power save/down sleep mode and enabled by itself when chip returns to active mode. To use to original clock source, user must provide a reset. User can change the clock frequency by configuring the prescaler after switching the clock. CFD will be enabled only if system frequency is beyond 256kHz. During start-up by default CFD will be disabled. If the external clock is not provided, the device will automatically switch to 1MHz calibrated RC Oscillator output. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 54 Figure 11-1 System Clock Generation with CFD Mechanism Internal 128kHz Calibrated RC Low power crystal osc External osc System clock CKSEL fuse 4'b 0010 fuse value for calibrated RC CKSEL to clock sel XOSC failed WDT 128kHz clk Clock failure detection circuit External / Low power crystal osc clk 11.4. Timing Diagram The RC clock is enabled only after failure detection. Figure 11-2 CFD mechanism timing diagram RC clock Ext clock 128kHz Xos c fa ile d De la ye d xos c fa ile d S ys clock Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 55 11.5. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 56 11.5.1. XOSC Failure Detection Control And Status Register Name: XFDCSR Offset: 0x62 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 XFDIF XFDIE Access R R/W Reset 0 0 Bit 1 – XFDIF: Failure Detection Interrupt Flag This bit is set when a failure is detected. It serves as status bit for CFD. Note: This bit is read only. Bit 0 – XFDIE: Failure Detection Interrupt Enable Setting this bit will enable the interrupt which will be issued when XFDIF is set.This bit is enable only. Once enabled, it is not possible for the user to disable. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 57 12. PM - Power Management and Sleep Modes Sleep modes enable the application to shut down unused modules in the MCU, thereby saving power. The device provides various sleep modes allowing the user to tailor the power consumption to the application requirements. When enabled, the Brown-out Detector (BOD) actively monitors the power supply voltage during the sleep periods. To further save power, it is possible to disable the BOD in some sleep modes. See also BOD Disable. 12.1. Sleep Modes The following Table shows the different sleep modes, their wake-up sources, and BOD disable ability. Table 12-1 Active Clock Domains and Wake-up Sources in the Different Sleep Modes. Active Clock Domains Sleep Mode Idle ADC Noise Reduction clkCP U clkFLA SH Oscillators Wake-up Sources clkADC clkASY clkPTC Main Clock Source Enabled Timer Oscillator Enabled INT and PCINT TWI Addres s Match Timer2 SPM/ EEPROM Ready ADC WDT USART( 4) Other I/O Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes(2) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes(2) Yes(3) Yes Yes(2) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes(3) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes(2) Yes(3) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes(3) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes(3) Yes Yes Yes Yes Power-down Power-save Yes Yes Standby(1) Extended Standby Software BOD Disable clkIO Yes Yes(2) Yes Yes Yes(2) Yes Yes Note: 1. Only recommended with external crystal or resonator selected as clock source. 2. If Timer/Counter2 is running in asynchronous mode. 3. For INT1 and INT0, only level interrupt. 4. Start frame detection, only. To enter any of the six sleep modes, the Sleep Enable bit in the Sleep Mode Control Register (SMCR.SE) must be written to '1' and a SLEEP instruction must be executed. Sleep Mode Select bits (SMCR.SM[2:0]) select which sleep mode (Idle, ADC Noise Reduction, Power-down, Power-save, Standby, or Extended Standby) will be activated by the SLEEP instruction. Note: The block diagram in the section System Clock and Clock Options provides an overview over the different clock systems in the device, and their distribution. This figure is helpful in selecting an appropriate sleep mode. If an enabled interrupt occurs while the MCU is in a sleep mode, the MCU wakes up. The MCU is then halted for four cycles in addition to the start-up time, executes the interrupt routine, and resumes execution from the instruction following SLEEP. The contents of the Register File and SRAM are unaltered when the device wakes up from sleep. If a reset occurs during sleep mode, the MCU wakes up and executes from the Reset Vector. Related Links System Clock and Clock Options on page 42 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 58 12.2. BOD Disable When the Brown-out Detector (BOD) is enabled by BODLEVEL fuses (see also section Fuse Bits), the BOD is actively monitoring the power supply voltage during a sleep period. To save power, it is possible to disable the BOD by software for some of the sleep modes. The sleep mode power consumption will then be at the same level as when BOD is globally disabled by fuses. If BOD is disabled in software, the BOD function is turned off immediately after entering the sleep mode. Upon wake-up from sleep, BOD is automatically enabled again. This ensures safe operation in case the VCC level has dropped during the sleep period. When the BOD has been disabled, the wake-up time from sleep mode will be approximately 60μs to ensure that the BOD is working correctly before the MCU continues executing code. BOD disable is controlled by the BOD Sleep bit in the MCU Control Register (MCUCR.BODS). Writing this bit to '1' turns off the BOD in relevant sleep modes, while a zero in this bit keeps BOD active. The default setting, BODS=0, keeps BOD active. Note: Writing to the BODS bit is controlled by a timed sequence and an enable bit. Related Links MCUCR on page 65 Fuse Bits on page 397 12.3. Idle Mode When the SM[2:0] bits are written to '000', the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Idle mode, stopping the CPU but allowing the SPI, USART, Analog Comparator, 2-wire Serial Interface, ADC, Timer/ Counters, Watchdog, and the interrupt system to continue operating. This sleep mode basically halts clkCPU and clkFLASH, while allowing the other clocks to run. Idle mode enables the MCU to wake up from external triggered interrupts as well as internal ones like the Timer Overflow and USART Transmit Complete interrupts. If wake-up from the Analog Comparator interrupt is not required, the Analog Comparator can be powered down by setting the ACD bit in the Analog Comparator Control and Status Register – ACSR. This will reduce power consumption in Idle mode. If the ADC is enabled, a conversion starts automatically when this mode is entered. 12.4. ADC Noise Reduction Mode When the SM[2:0] bits are written to '001', the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter ADC Noise Reduction mode, stopping the CPU but allowing the ADC, the external interrupts, the 2-wire Serial Interface address watch, Timer/Counter2(1), and the Watchdog to continue operating (if enabled). This sleep mode basically halts clkI/O, clkCPU, and clkFLASH, while allowing the other clocks to run. This improves the noise environment for the ADC, enabling higher resolution measurements. If the ADC is enabled, a conversion starts automatically when this mode is entered. Apart from the ADC Conversion Complete interrupt, only these events can wake up the MCU from ADC Noise Reduction mode: • External Reset • Watchdog System Reset • Watchdog Interrupt • Brown-out Reset • 2-wire Serial Interface address match • Timer/Counter2 interrupt Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 59 • • • SPM/EEPROM ready interrupt External level interrupt on INT Pin change interrupt Note: 1. Timer/Counter2 will only keep running in asynchronous mode. Related Links 8-bit Timer/Counter2 with PWM and Asynchronous Operation on page 201 12.5. Power-Down Mode When the SM[2:0] bits are written to '010', the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Power-Down mode. In this mode, the external Oscillator is stopped, while the external interrupts, the 2-wire Serial Interface address watch, and the Watchdog continue operating (if enabled). Only one of these events can wake up the MCU: • External Reset • Watchdog System Reset • Watchdog Interrupt • Brown-out Reset • • • 2-wire Serial Interface address match External level interrupt on INT Pin change interrupt This sleep mode basically halts all generated clocks, allowing operation of asynchronous modules only. Note: If a level triggered interrupt is used for wake-up from Power-Down, the required level must be held long enough for the MCU to complete the wake-up to trigger the level interrupt. If the level disappears before the end of the Start-up Time, the MCU will still wake up, but no interrupt will be generated. The start-up time is defined by the SUT and CKSEL Fuses. When waking up from Power-Down mode, there is a delay from the wake-up condition occurs until the wake-up becomes effective. This allows the clock to restart and become stable after having been stopped. The wake-up period is defined by the same CKSEL Fuses that define the Reset Time-out period. Related Links System Clock and Clock Options on page 42 12.6. Power-save Mode When the SM[2:0] bits are written to 011, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Power-save mode. This mode is identical to Power-down, with one exception: If Timer/Counter2 is enabled, it will keep running during sleep. The device can wake up from either Timer Overflow or Output Compare event from Timer/Counter2 if the corresponding Timer/Counter2 interrupt enable bits are set in TIMSK2, and the Global Interrupt Enable bit in SREG is set. If Timer/Counter2 is not running, Power-down mode is recommended instead of Power-save mode. The Timer/Counter2 can be clocked both synchronously and asynchronously in Power-save mode. If Timer/Counter2 is not using the asynchronous clock, the Timer/Counter Oscillator is stopped during sleep. If Timer/Counter2 is not using the synchronous clock, the clock source is stopped during sleep. Even if the synchronous clock is running in Power-save, this clock is only available for Timer/Counter2. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 60 12.7. Standby Mode When the SM[2:0] bits are written to '110' and an external crystal/resonator clock option is selected, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Standby mode. This mode is identical to Power-Down with the exception that the Oscillator is kept running. From Standby mode, the device wakes up in six clock cycles. 12.8. Extended Standby Mode When the SM[2:0] bits are written to '111' and an external crystal/resonator clock option is selected, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Extended Standby mode. This mode is identical to Power-Save mode with the exception that the Oscillator is kept running. From Extended Standby mode, the device wakes up in six clock cycles. 12.9. Power Reduction Register The Power Reduction Register (PRR) provides a method to stop the clock to individual peripherals to reduce power consumption. The current state of the peripheral is frozen and the I/O registers can not be read or written. Resources used by the peripheral when stopping the clock will remain occupied, hence the peripheral should in most cases be disabled before stopping the clock. Waking up a module, which is done by clearing the bit in PRR, puts the module in the same state as before shutdown. Module shutdown can be used in Idle mode and Active mode to significantly reduce the overall power consumption. In all other sleep modes, the clock is already stopped. 12.10. Minimizing Power Consumption There are several possibilities to consider when trying to minimize the power consumption in an AVR controlled system. In general, sleep modes should be used as much as possible, and the sleep mode should be selected so that as few as possible of the device’s functions are operating. All functions not needed should be disabled. In particular, the following modules may need special consideration when trying to achieve the lowest possible power consumption. 12.10.1. Analog to Digital Converter If enabled, the ADC will be enabled in all sleep modes. To save power, the ADC should be disabled before entering any sleep mode. When the ADC is turned off and on again, the next conversion will be an extended conversion. Related Links Analog-to-Digital Converter on page 323 12.10.2. Analog Comparator When entering Idle mode, the Analog Comparator should be disabled if not used. When entering ADC Noise Reduction mode, the Analog Comparator should be disabled. In other sleep modes, the Analog Comparator is automatically disabled. However, if the Analog Comparator is set up to use the Internal Voltage Reference as input, the Analog Comparator should be disabled in all sleep modes. Otherwise, the Internal Voltage Reference will be enabled, independent of sleep mode. Related Links Analog Comparator on page 317 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 61 12.10.3. Brown-Out Detector If the Brown-Out Detector (BOD) is not needed by the application, this module should be turned off. If the BOD is enabled by the BODLEVEL Fuses, it will be enabled in all sleep modes, and hence, always consume power. In the deeper sleep modes, this will contribute significantly to the total current consumption. Related Links System Control and Reset on page 70 12.10.4. Internal Voltage Reference The Internal Voltage Reference will be enabled when needed by the Brown-Out Detection, the Analog Comparator or the Analog-to-Digital Converter. If these modules are disabled as described in the sections above, the internal voltage reference will be disabled and it will not be consuming power. When turned on again, the user must allow the reference to start up before the output is used. If the reference is kept on in sleep mode, the output can be used immediately. Related Links System Control and Reset on page 70 12.10.5. Watchdog Timer If the Watchdog Timer is not needed in the application, the module should be turned off. If the Watchdog Timer is enabled, it will be enabled in all sleep modes and hence always consume power. In the deeper sleep modes, this will contribute significantly to the total current consumption. Related Links System Control and Reset on page 70 12.10.6. Port Pins When entering a sleep mode, all port pins should be configured to use minimum power. The most important is then to ensure that no pins drive resistive loads. In sleep modes where both the I/O clock (clkI/O) and the ADC clock (clkADC) are stopped, the input buffers of the device will be disabled. This ensures that no power is consumed by the input logic when not needed. In some cases, the input logic is needed for detecting wake-up conditions, and it will then be enabled. Refer to the section Digital Input Enable and Sleep Modes for details on which pins are enabled. If the input buffer is enabled and the input signal is left floating or have an analog signal level close to VCC/2, the input buffer will use excessive power. For analog input pins, the digital input buffer should be disabled at all times. An analog signal level close to VCC/2 on an input pin can cause significant current even in active mode. Digital input buffers can be disabled by writing to the Digital Input Disable Registers (DIDR0 for ADC, DIDR1 for AC). Related Links Digital Input Enable and Sleep Modes on page 103 12.10.7. On-chip Debug System If the On-chip debug system is enabled by the OCDEN Fuse and the chip enters sleep mode, the main clock source is enabled and hence always consumes power. In the deeper sleep modes, this will contribute significantly to the total current consumption. There are three alternative ways to disable the OCD system: • Disable the OCDEN Fuse • Disable the JTAGEN Fuse • Write one to the JTD bit in MCUCR Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 62 12.11. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 63 12.11.1. Sleep Mode Control Register The Sleep Mode Control Register contains control bits for power management. When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: SMCR Offset: 0x53 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x33 Bit 7 6 5 4 Access 3 2 1 0 SM2 SM1 SM0 SE R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 Reset Bit 3 – SM2: Sleep Mode Select 2 The SM[2:0] bits select between the five available sleep modes. Table 12-2 Sleep Mode Select SM2,SM1,SM0 000 Sleep Mode Idle 001 010 Power-down 011 Power-save 100 Reserved 101 Reserved 110 Standby(1) 111 Extended Standby(1) Note: 1. Standby mode is only recommended for use with external crystals or resonators. Bit 2 – SM1: Sleep Mode Select 1 Refer to SM2. Bit 1 – SM0: Sleep Mode Select 0 Refer to SM2. Bit 0 – SE: Sleep Enable The SE bit must be written to logic one to make the MCU enter the sleep mode when the SLEEP instruction is executed. To avoid the MCU entering the sleep mode unless it is the programmer’s purpose, it is recommended to write the Sleep Enable (SE) bit to one just before the execution of the SLEEP instruction and to clear it immediately after waking up. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 64 12.11.2. MCU Control Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: MCUCR Offset: 0x55 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x35 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 1 0 JTD BODS BODSE PUD 3 2 IVSEL IVCE R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – JTD When this bit is zero, the JTAG interface is enabled if the JTAGEN Fuse is programmed. If this bit is one, the JTAG interface is disabled. In order to avoid unintentional disabling or enabling of the JTAG interface, a timed sequence must be followed when changing this bit: The application software must write this bit to the desired value twice within four cycles to change its value. Note that this bit must not be altered when using the On-chip Debug system. Bit 6 – BODS: BOD Sleep The BODS bit must be written to '1' in order to turn off BOD during sleep. Writing to the BODS bit is controlled by a timed sequence and the enable bit BODSE. To disable BOD in relevant sleep modes, both BODS and BODSE must first be written to '1'. Then, BODS must be written to '1' and BODSE must be written to zero within four clock cycles. The BODS bit is active three clock cycles after it is set. A sleep instruction must be executed while BODS is active in order to turn off the BOD for the actual sleep mode. The BODS bit is automatically cleared after three clock cycles. Bit 5 – BODSE: BOD Sleep Enable BODSE enables setting of BODS control bit, as explained in BODS bit description. BOD disable is controlled by a timed sequence. Bit 4 – PUD: Pull-up Disable When this bit is written to one, the pull-ups in the I/O ports are disabled even if the DDxn and PORTxn Registers are configured to enable the pull-ups ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b01). Bit 1 – IVSEL: Interrupt Vector Select When the IVSEL bit is cleared (zero), the Interrupt Vectors are placed at the start of the Flash memory. When this bit is set (one), the Interrupt Vectors are moved to the beginning of the Boot Loader section of the Flash. The actual address of the start of the Boot Flash Section is determined by the BOOTSZ Fuses. To avoid unintentional changes of Interrupt Vector tables, a special write procedure must be followed to change the IVSEL bit: 1. 2. Write the Interrupt Vector Change Enable (IVCE) bit to one. Within four cycles, write the desired value to IVSEL while writing a zero to IVCE. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 65 Interrupts will automatically be disabled while this sequence is executed. Interrupts are disabled in the cycle IVCE is set, and they remain disabled until after the instruction following the write to IVSEL. If IVSEL is not written, interrupts remain disabled for four cycles. The I-bit in the Status Register is unaffected by the automatic disabling. Note: If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Boot Loader section and Boot Lock bit BLB02 is programmed, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Application section and Boot Lock bit BLB12 is programed, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader section. Bit 0 – IVCE: Interrupt Vector Change Enable The IVCE bit must be written to logic one to enable change of the IVSEL bit. IVCE is cleared by hardware four cycles after it is written or when IVSEL is written. Setting the IVCE bit will disable interrupts, as explained in the IVSEL description above. See Code Example below. Assembly Code Example Move_interrupts: ; Get MCUCR in r16, MCUCR mov r17, r16 ; Enable change of Interrupt Vectors ori r16, (1<<IVCE) out MCUCR, r16 ; Move interrupts to Boot Flash section ori r17, (1<<IVSEL) out MCUCR, r17 ret C Code Example void Move_interrupts(void) { uchar temp; /* GET MCUCR*/ temp = MCUCR; /* Enable change of Interrupt Vectors */ MCUCR = temp|(1<<IVCE); /* Move interrupts to Boot Flash section */ MCUCR = temp|(1<<IVSEL); } Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 66 12.11.3. Power Reduction Register 0 Name: PRR0 Offset: 0x64 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PRTWI0 PRTIM2 PRTIM0 PRUSART1 PRTIM1 PRSPI0 PRUSART0 PRADC R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – PRTWI0: Power Reduction TWI0 Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the TWI 0 by stopping the clock to the module. When waking up the TWI again, the TWI should be re initialized to ensure proper operation. Bit 6 – PRTIM2: Power Reduction Timer/Counter2 Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter2 module in synchronous mode (AS2 is 0). When the Timer/Counter2 is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown. Bit 5 – PRTIM0: Power Reduction Timer/Counter0 Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter0 module. When the Timer/Counter0 is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown. Bit 4 – PRUSART1: Power Reduction USART1 Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the USART by stopping the clock to the module. When waking up the USART again, the USART should be re initialized to ensure proper operation. Bit 3 – PRTIM1: Power Reduction Timer/Counter1 Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter1 module. When the Timer/Counter1 is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown. Bit 2 – PRSPI0: Power Reduction Serial Peripheral Interface 0 If using debugWIRE On-chip Debug System, this bit should not be written to one. Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Serial Peripheral Interface by stopping the clock to the module. When waking up the SPI again, the SPI should be re initialized to ensure proper operation. Bit 1 – PRUSART0: Power Reduction USART0 Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the USART by stopping the clock to the module. When waking up the USART again, the USART should be re initialized to ensure proper operation. Bit 0 – PRADC: Power Reduction ADC Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the ADC. The ADC must be disabled before shut down. The analog comparator cannot use the ADC input MUX when the ADC is shut down. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 67 12.11.4. Power Reduction Register 1 Name: PRR1 Offset: 0x65 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PRTIM4 PRTIM3 R/W R/W 0 0 Bit 1 – PRTIM4: Power Reduction Timer/Counter4 Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter4 module. When the Timer/Counter4 is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown. Bit 0 – PRTIM3: Power Reduction Timer/Counter3 Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter3 module. When the Timer/Counter3 is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 68 12.11.5. Power Reduction Register 2 Name: PRR2 Offset: 0x63 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PRPTC PRUSART2 PRSPI1 PRTWI1 R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 Bit 3 – PRPTC: Power Reduction Timer/Counter0 Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter0 module. When the Timer/Counter0 is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown. Bit 2 – PRUSART2: Power Reduction USART2 Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the USART2 by stopping the clock to the module. When waking up the USART2 again, the USART2 should be re initialized to ensure proper operation. Bit 1 – PRSPI1: Power Reduction Serial Peripheral Interface If using debugWIRE On-chip Debug System, this bit should not be written to one. Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Serial Peripheral Interface by stopping the clock to the module. When waking up the SPI again, the SPI should be re initialized to ensure proper operation. Bit 0 – PRTWI1: Power Reduction TWI1 Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the TWI1 by stopping the clock to the module. When waking up the TWI1 again, the TWI1 should be re initialized to ensure proper operation. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 69 13. System Control and Reset 13.1. Resetting the AVR During reset, all I/O Registers are set to their initial values, and the program starts execution from the Reset Vector. The instruction placed at the Reset Vector must be an Absolute Jump instruction (JMP) to the reset handling routine. If the program never enables an interrupt source, the Interrupt Vectors are not used, and regular program code can be placed at these locations. This is also the case if the Reset Vector is in the Application section while the Interrupt Vectors are in the Boot section or vice versa. The circuit diagram in the next section shows the reset logic. The I/O ports of the AVR are immediately reset to their initial state when a reset source goes active. This does not require any clock source to be running. After all reset sources have gone inactive, a delay counter is invoked, stretching the internal reset. This allows the power to reach a stable level before normal operation starts. The time-out period of the delay counter is defined by the user through the SUT and CKSEL Fuses. The different selections for the delay period are presented in the System Clock and Clock Options chapter. Related Links System Clock and Clock Options on page 42 13.2. Reset Sources The device has four sources of reset: • • • • • Power-on Reset. The MCU is reset when the supply voltage is less than the Power-on Reset threshold (VPOT). External Reset. The MCU is reset when a low level is present on the RESET pin for longer than the minimum pulse length. Watchdog System Reset. The MCU is reset when the Watchdog Timer period expires and the Watchdog System Reset mode is enabled. Brown-out Reset. The MCU is reset when the supply voltage VCC is less than the Brown-out Reset threshold (VBOT) and the Brown-out Detector is enabled. JTAG AVR Reset. The MCU is reset as long as there is a logic one in the Reset Register, one of the scan chains of the JTAG system. Refer to the section IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-scan for details. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 70 Figure 13-1 Reset Logic DATA BUS P ORF BORF EXTRF WDRF J TRF MCU S ta tus Re gis te r (MCUS R) Powe r-on Re s e t Circuit Brown-out Re s e t Circuit BODLEVEL [2..0] P ull-up Re s is tor S P IKE FILTER J TAG Re s e t Re gis te r Wa tchdog Os cilla tor Clock Ge ne ra tor CK De lay Counte rs TIMEOUT CKS EL[3:0] S UT[1:0] Related Links IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-scan on page 357 Features on page 357 System Overview on page 357 13.3. Power-on Reset A Power-on Reset (POR) pulse is generated by an On-chip detection circuit. The POR is activated whenever VCC is below the detection level. The POR circuit can be used to trigger the start-up Reset, as well as to detect a failure in supply voltage. A Power-on Reset (POR) circuit ensures that the device is reset from Power-on. Reaching the Power-on Reset threshold voltage invokes the delay counter, which determines how long the device is kept in Reset after VCC rise. The Reset signal is activated again, without any delay, when VCC decreases below the detection level. Figure 13-2 MCU Start-up, RESET Tied to VCC VCC RESET TIME-OUT VPOT VRST tTOUT INTERNAL RESET Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 71 Figure 13-3 MCU Start-up, RESET Extended Externally VCC VPOT RESET TIME-OUT VRST tTOUT INTERNAL RESET 13.4. External Reset An External Reset is generated by a low level on the RESET pin. Reset pulses longer than the minimum pulse width will generate a reset, even if the clock is not running. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate a reset. When the applied signal reaches the Reset Threshold Voltage (VRST) on its positive edge, the delay counter starts the MCU after the Time-out period (tTOUT ) has expired. The External Reset can be disabled by the RSTDISBL fuse. Figure 13-4 External Reset During Operation CC 13.5. Brown-out Detection The device has an On-chip Brown-out Detection (BOD) circuit for monitoring the VCC level during operation by comparing it to a fixed trigger level. The trigger level for the BOD can be selected by the BODLEVEL Fuses. The trigger level has a hysteresis to ensure spike free Brown-out Detection. The hysteresis on the detection level should be interpreted as VBOT+ = VBOT + VHYST/2 and VBOT- = VBOT VHYST/2. When the BOD is enabled, and VCC decreases to a value below the trigger level (VBOT- in the following figure), the Brown-out Reset is immediately activated. When VCC increases above the trigger level (VBOT+ in the following figure), the delay counter starts the MCU after the Time-out period tTOUT has expired. The BOD circuit will only detect a drop in VCC if the voltage stays below the trigger level for longer than tBOD. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 72 Figure 13-5 Brown-out Reset During Operation VCC VBOT+ VBOT- RESET t TOUT TIME-OUT INTERNAL RESET 13.6. Watchdog System Reset When the Watchdog times out, it will generate a short reset pulse of one CK cycle duration. On the falling edge of this pulse, the delay timer starts counting the Time-out period tTOUT. Figure 13-6 Watchdog System Reset During Operation CC CK 13.7. Internal Voltage Reference The device features an internal bandgap reference. This reference is used for Brown-out Detection, and it can be used as an input to the Analog Comparator or the ADC. 13.7.1. Voltage Reference Enable Signals and Start-up Time The voltage reference has a start-up time that may influence the way it should be used. To save power, the reference is not always turned on. The reference is on during the following situations: 1. When the BOD is enabled (by programming the BODLEVEL [2:0] Fuses). 2. When the bandgap reference is connected to the Analog Comparator (by setting the ACBG bit in ACSR (ACSR.ACBG)). 3. When the ADC is enabled. Thus, when the BOD is not enabled, after setting ACSR.ACBG or enabling the ADC, the user must always allow the reference to start up before the output from the Analog Comparator or ADC is used. To reduce power consumption in Power-Down mode, the user can avoid the three conditions above to ensure that the reference is turned off before entering Power-Down mode. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 73 13.8. Watchdog Timer If the watchdog timer is not needed in the application, the module should be turned off. If the watchdog timer is enabled, it will be enabled in all sleep modes and hence always consume power. In the deeper sleep modes, this will contribute significantly to the total current consumption. Refer to Watchdog System Reset on page 73 for details on how to configure the watchdog timer. Features • • • • 13.8.2. Clocked from separate On-chip Oscillator Three operating modes: – Interrupt – System Reset – Interrupt and System Reset Selectable Time-out period from 16ms to 8s Possible Hardware fuse Watchdog always on (WDTON) for fail-safe mode Overview The device has an Enhanced Watchdog Timer (WDT). The WDT is a timer counting cycles of a separate on-chip 128kHz oscillator. The WDT gives an interrupt or a system reset when the counter reaches a given time-out value. In normal operation mode, it is required that the system uses the Watchdog Timer Reset (WDR) instruction to restart the counter before the time-out value is reached. If the system doesn't restart the counter, an interrupt or system reset will be issued. Figure 13-7 Watchdog Timer 128kHz OSCILLATOR WATCHDOG RESET WDE OSC/2K OSC/4K OSC/8K OSC/16K OSC/32K OSC/64K OSC/128K OSC/256K OSC/512K OSC/1024K 13.8.1. WDP0 WDP1 WDP2 WDP3 MCU RESET WDIF WDIE INTERRUPT In Interrupt mode, the WDT gives an interrupt when the timer expires. This interrupt can be used to wake the device from sleep-modes, and also as a general system timer. One example is to limit the maximum time allowed for certain operations, giving an interrupt when the operation has run longer than expected. In System Reset mode, the WDT gives a reset when the timer expires. This is typically used to prevent system hang-up in case of runaway code. The third mode, Interrupt and System Reset mode, combines the other two modes by first giving an interrupt and then switch to System Reset mode. This mode will for instance allow a safe shutdown by saving critical parameters before a system reset. The Watchdog always on (WDTON) fuse, if programmed, will force the Watchdog Timer to System Reset mode. With the fuse programmed the System Reset mode bit (WDE) and Interrupt mode bit (WDIE) are locked to 1 and 0 respectively. To further ensure program security, alterations to the Watchdog set-up must follow timed sequences. The sequence for clearing WDE and changing time-out configuration is as follows: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 74 1. 2. In the same operation, write a logic one to the Watchdog change enable bit (WDCE) and Watchdog System Reset Enable (WDE) in Watchdog Timer Control Register (WDTCSR.WDCE and WDTCSR.WDE). A logic one must be written to WDTCSR.WDE regardless of the previous value of the WDTCSR.WDE. Within the next four clock cycles, write the WDTCSR.WDE and Watchdog prescaler bits group (WDTCSR.WDP) as desired, but with the WDTCSR.WDCE cleared. This must be done in one operation. The following examples show a function for turning off the Watchdog Timer. The examples assume that interrupts are controlled (e.g. by disabling interrupts globally) so that no interrupts will occur during the execution of these functions. Assembly Code Example WDT_off: ; Turn off global interrupt cli ; Reset Watchdog Timer wdr ; Clear WDRF in MCUSR in r16, MCUSR andi r16, (0xff & (0<<WDRF)) out MCUSR, r16 ; Write '1' to WDCE and WDE ; Keep old prescaler setting to prevent unintentional timeout lds r16, WDTCSR ori r16, (1<<WDCE) | (1<<WDE) sts WDTCSR, r16 ; Turn off WDT ldi r16, (0<<WDE) sts WDTCSR, r16 ; Turn on global interrupt sei ret C Code Example void WDT_off(void) { __disable_interrupt(); __watchdog_reset(); /* Clear WDRF in MCUSR */ MCUSR &= ~(1<<WDRF); /* Write logical one to WDCE and WDE */ /* Keep old prescaler setting to prevent unintentional time-out */ WDTCSR |= (1<<WDCE) | (1<<WDE); /* Turn off WDT */ WDTCSR = 0x00; __enable_interrupt(); } Note: If the Watchdog is accidentally enabled, for example by a runaway pointer or brown-out condition, the device will be reset and the Watchdog Timer will stay enabled. If the code is not set up to handle the Watchdog, this might lead to an eternal loop of timeout resets. To avoid this situation, the application software should always clear the Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 75 Watchdog System Reset Flag (WDRF) and the WDE control bit in the initialization routine, even if the Watchdog is not in use. The following code examples shows how to change the time-out value of the Watchdog Timer. Assembly Code Example WDT_Prescaler_Change: ; Turn off global interrupt cli ; Reset Watchdog Timer wdr ; Start timed sequence lds r16, WDTCSR ori r16, (1<<WDCE) | (1<<WDE) sts WDTCSR, r16 ; -- Got four cycles to set the new values from here ; Set new prescaler(time-out) value = 64K cycles (~0.5 s) ldi r16, (1<<WDE) | (1<<WDP2) | (1<<WDP0) sts WDTCSR, r16 ; -- Finished setting new values, used 2 cycles ; Turn on global interrupt sei ret C Code Example void WDT_Prescaler_Change(void) { __disable_interrupt(); __watchdog_reset(); /* Start timed sequence */ WDTCSR |= (1<<WDCE) | (1<<WDE); /* Set new prescaler(time-out) value = 64K cycles (~0.5 s) */ WDTCSR = (1<<WDE) | (1<<WDP2) | (1<<WDP0); __enable_interrupt(); } Note: The Watchdog Timer should be reset before any change of the WDTCSR.WDP bits, since a change in the WDTCSR.WDP bits can result in a time-out when switching to a shorter time-out period. 13.9. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 76 13.9.1. MCU Status Register To make use of the Reset Flags to identify a reset condition, the user should read and then Reset the MCUSR as early as possible in the program. If the register is cleared before another reset occurs, the source of the reset can be found by examining the Reset Flags. When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: MCUSR Offset: 0x54 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x34 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 JTRF WDRF BORF EXTRF PORF R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 4 – JTRF: JTAG Reset Flag This bit is set if a reset is being caused by a logic one in the JTAG Reset Register selected by the JTAG instruction AVR_RESET. This bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a logic zero to the flag. Bit 3 – WDRF: Watchdog System Reset Flag This bit is set if a Watchdog System Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a '0' to it. Bit 2 – BORF: Brown-out Reset Flag This bit is set if a Brown-out Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a '0' to it. Bit 1 – EXTRF: External Reset Flag This bit is set if an External Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a '0' to it. Bit 0 – PORF: Power-on Reset Flag This bit is set if a Power-on Reset occurs. The bit is reset only by writing a '0' to it. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 77 13.9.2. WDTCSR – Watchdog Timer Control Register Name: WDTCSR Offset: 0x60 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access 7 6 5 4 3 WDIF WDIE WDP[3] WDCE WDE R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 Reset 2 1 0 WDP[2:0] R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 Bit 7 – WDIF: Watchdog Interrupt Flag This bit is set when a timeout occurs in the Watchdog Timer and the Watchdog Timer is configured for interrupt. WDIF is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, WDIF is cleared by writing a '1' to it. When the I-bit in SREG and WDIE are set, the Watchdog Timeout Interrupt is executed. Bit 6 – WDIE: Watchdog Interrupt Enable When this bit is written to '1' and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the Watchdog Interrupt is enabled. If WDE is cleared in combination with this setting, the Watchdog Timer is in Interrupt Mode, and the corresponding interrupt is executed if timeout in the Watchdog Timer occurs. If WDE is set, the Watchdog Timer is in Interrupt and System Reset Mode. The first timeout in the Watchdog Timer will set WDIF. Executing the corresponding interrupt vector will clear WDIE and WDIF automatically by hardware (the Watchdog goes to System Reset Mode). This is useful for keeping the Watchdog Timer security while using the interrupt. To stay in Interrupt and System Reset Mode, WDIE must be set after each interrupt. This should however not be done within the interrupt service routine itself, as this might compromise the safety function of the Watchdog System Reset mode. If the interrupt is not executed before the next timeout, a System Reset will be applied. Table 13-1 Watchdog Timer Configuration WDTON(1) WDE WDIE Mode Action on Time(out 1 0 0 Stopped None 1 0 1 Interrupt Mode Interrupt 1 1 0 System Reset Mode Reset 1 1 1 Interrupt and System Reset Mode Interrupt, then go to System Reset Mode 0 x x System Reset Mode Reset Note: 1. WDTON Fuse set to '0' means programmed and '1' means unprogrammed. Bit 5 – WDP[3]: Watchdog Timer Prescaler 3 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 78 Bit 4 – WDCE: Watchdog Change Enable This bit is used in timed sequences for changing WDE and prescaler bits. To clear the WDE bit, and/or change the prescaler bits, WDCE must be set. Once written to '1', hardware will clear WDCE after four clock cycles. Bit 3 – WDE: Watchdog System Reset Enable WDE is overridden by WDRF in MCUSR. This means that WDE is always set when WDRF is set. To clear WDE, WDRF must be cleared first. This feature ensures multiple resets during conditions causing failure, and a safe startup after the failure. Bits 2:0 – WDP[2:0]: Watchdog Timer Prescaler 2, 1, and 0 The WDP[3:0] bits determine the Watchdog Timer prescaling when the Watchdog Timer is running. The different prescaling values and their corresponding timeout periods are shown in the following table. Table 13-2 Watchdog Timer Prescale Select WDP3 WDP2 WDP1 WDP0 Number of WDT Oscillator (Cycles) Oscillator 0 0 0 0 2K (2048) 16ms 0 0 0 1 4K (4096) 32ms 0 0 1 0 8K (8192) 64ms 0 0 1 1 16K (16384) 0.125s 0 1 0 0 32K (32768) 0.25s 0 1 0 1 64K (65536) 0.5s 0 1 1 0 128K (131072) 1.0s 0 1 1 1 256K (262144) 2.0s 1 0 0 0 512K (524288) 4.0s 1 0 0 1 1024K (1048576) 8.0s Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 79 14. INT- Interrupts This section describes the specifics of the interrupt handling of the device. For a general explanation of the AVR interrupt handling, refer to the description of Reset and Interrupt Handling. In general: • • Each Interrupt Vector occupies two instruction words The Reset Vector is affected by the BOOTRST fuse, and the Interrupt Vector start address is affected by the IVSEL bit in MCUCR Related Links Reset and Interrupt Handling on page 25 14.1. Interrupt Vectors in ATmega324PB Table 14-1 Reset and Interrupt Vectors in ATmega324PB Vector No Program Address(2) Source Interrupts definition 1 0x0000(1) RESET External Pin, Power-on Reset, Brown-out Reset and Watchdog System Reset 2 0x0002 INT0 External Interrupt Request 0 3 0x0004 INT1 External Interrupt Request 1 4 0x0006 INT2 External Interrupt Request 2 5 0x0008 PCINT0 Pin Change Interrupt Request 0 6 0x000A PCINT1 Pin Change Interrupt Request 1 7 0x000C PCINT2 Pin Change Interrupt Request 2 8 0x000E PCINT3 Pin Change Interrupt Request 3 9 0x0010 WDT Watchdog Time-out Interrupt 10 0x0012 TIMER2_COMPA Timer/Counter2 Compare Match A 11 0x0014 TIMER2_COMPB Timer/Coutner2 Compare Match B 12 0x0016 TIMER2_OVF Timer/Counter2 Overflow 13 0x0018 TIMER1_CAPT Timer/Counter1 Capture Event 14 0x001A TIMER1_COMPA Timer/Counter1 Compare Match A 15 0x001C TIMER1_COMPB Timer/Coutner1 Compare Match B 16 0x001E TIMER1_OVF 17 0x0020 TIMER0_COMPA Timer/Counter0 Compare Match A 18 0x0022 TIMER0_COMPB Timer/Coutner0 Compare Match B 19 0x0024 TIMER0_OVF Timer/Counter0 Overflow 20 0x0026 SPI0_STC SPI0 Serial Transfer Complete 21 0x0028 USART0_RX USART0 Rx Complete 22 0x002A USART0_UDRE USART0, Data Register Empty Timer/Counter1 Overflow Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 80 Vector No Program Address(2) Source Interrupts definition 23 0x002C USART0_TX USART0, Tx Complete 24 0x002E ANALOG_COMP Analog Comparator 25 0x0030 ADC ADC Conversion Complete 26 0x0032 EE_READY EEPROM Ready 27 0x0034 TWI0 TWI0 Transfer complete 28 0x0036 SPM_READY Store Program Memory Ready 29 0x0038 USART1_RX USART1 Rx Complete 30 0x003A USART1_UDRE USART1, Data Register Empty 31 0x003C USART1_TX USART0, Tx Complete 32 0x003E TIMER3_CAPT Timer/Counter3 Capture Event 33 0x0040 TIMER3_COMPA Timer/Counter3 Compare Match A 34 0x0042 TIMER3_COMPB Timer/Coutner3 Compare Match B 35 0x0044 TIMER3_OVF 36 0x0046 USART0_START USART0 Start Frame detection 37 0x0048 USART1_START USART1 Start Frame detection 38 0x004A PCINT4 Pin Change Interrupt 4 39 0x004C CFD Crystal Failure Detection 40 0x004E PTC_EOC PTC End of Conversion 41 0x0050 PTC_WCOMP PTC Window comparator mode 42 0x0052 SPI1_STC SPI1 Serial Transfer Complete 43 0x0054 TWI1 TWI1 Transfer complete 44 0x0056 TIMER4_CAPT Timer/Counter4 Capture Event 45 0x0058 TIMER4_COMPA Timer/Counter4 Compare Match A 46 0x005A TIMER4_COMPB Timer/Coutner4 Compare Match B 47 0x005C TIMER4_OVF Timer/Counter4 Overflow 48 0x005E USART2_RX USART2 Rx Complete 49 0x0060 USART2_UDRE USART2, Data Register Empty 50 0x0062 USART2_TX USART2, Tx Complete 51 0x0064 USART2_START USART2 Start Frame detection Timer/Counter3 Overflow Note: 1. When the BOOTRST Fuse is programmed, the device will jump to the Boot Loader address at reset, see Memory programming 2. When the IVSEL bit in MCUCR is set, Interrupt Vectors will be moved to the start of the Boot Flash Section. The address of each Interrupt Vector will then be the address in this table added to the start address of the Boot Flash Section. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 81 The table below shows reset and Interrupt Vectors placement for the various combinations of BOOTRST and IVSEL settings. If the program never enables an interrupt source, the Interrupt Vectors are not used, and regular program code can be placed at these locations. This is also the case if the Reset Vector is in the Application section while the Interrupt Vectors are in the Boot section or vice versa. Table 14-2 Reset and Interrupt Vectors placement BOOTRST IVSEL Reset Address Interrupt Vectors Start Address 1 0 0x0000 0x0002 1 1 0x0000 Boot Reset Address + 0x0002 0 0 Boot Reset Address 0x0002 0 1 Boot Reset Address Boot Reset Address + 0x0002 Note: The Boot Reset Address is shown in Table Boot size configuration in Boot Loader Parameters. For the BOOTRST Fuse “1” means unprogrammed while “0” means programmed. When the BOOTRST Fuse is unprogrammed, the Boot section size set to 8K bytes and the IVSEL bit in the MCUCR Register is set before any interrupts are enabled, the most typical and general program setup for the Reset and Interrupt Vector Addresses is: Address Labels 0x00000 RESET: 0x00001 of RAM 0x00002 0x00003 0x00004 0x00005 ; .org 0x1F002 0x1F002 0x1F004 ... ... 0x1FO36 Code ldi r16,high(RAMEND) out SPH,r16 ldi r16,low(RAMEND) out SPL,r16 sei <instr> xxx jmp EXT_INT0 jmp EXT_INT1 ... jmp SPM_RDY Comments ; Main program start ; Set Stack Pointer to top ; Enable interrupts ; IRQ0 Handler ; IRQ1 Handler ; ; SPM Ready Handler When the BOOTRST Fuse is programmed and the Boot section size set to 8K bytes, the most typical and general program setup for the Reset and Interrupt Vector Addresses is: Address Labels .org 0x0002 0x00002 0x00004 ... ... 0x00036 ; .org 0x1F000 0x1F000 RESET: 0x1F001 of RAM 0x1F002 0x1F003 0x1F004 0x1F005 Code Comments jmp EXT_INT0 jmp EXT_INT1 ... jmp SPM_RDY ; IRQ0 Handler ; IRQ1 Handler ; ; SPM Ready Handler ldi r16,high(RAMEND) out SPH,r16 ; Main program start ; Set Stack Pointer to top ldi r16,low(RAMEND) out SPL,r16 sei <instr> xxx ; Enable interrupts Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 82 When the BOOTRST Fuse is programmed, the Boot section size set to 8K bytes and the IVSEL bit in the MCUCR Register is set before any interrupts are enabled, the most typical and general program setup for the Reset and Interrupt Vector Addresses is: Address Labels ; .org 0x1F000 0x1F000 0x1F002 0x1F004 ... ... 0x1F036 ; 0x1F03E RESET: 0x1F03F of RAM 0x1F040 0x1F041 0x1F042 0x1FO43 Code jmp jmp jmp ... jmp Comments RESET EXT_INT0 EXT_INT1 ; ; ; ; ; SPM_RDY ldi r16,high(RAMEND) out SPH,r16 ldi r16,low(RAMEND) out SPL,r16 sei <instr> xxx Reset handler IRQ0 Handler IRQ1 Handler SPM Ready Handler ; Main program start ; Set Stack Pointer to top ; Enable interrupts 14.2. Register Description 14.2.1. Moving Interrupts Between Application and Boot Space The MCU Control Register controls the placement of the Interrupt Vector table. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 83 14.2.2. MCU Control Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: MCUCR Offset: 0x55 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x35 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 1 0 JTD BODS BODSE PUD 3 2 IVSEL IVCE R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – JTD When this bit is zero, the JTAG interface is enabled if the JTAGEN Fuse is programmed. If this bit is one, the JTAG interface is disabled. In order to avoid unintentional disabling or enabling of the JTAG interface, a timed sequence must be followed when changing this bit: The application software must write this bit to the desired value twice within four cycles to change its value. Note that this bit must not be altered when using the On-chip Debug system. Bit 6 – BODS: BOD Sleep The BODS bit must be written to '1' in order to turn off BOD during sleep. Writing to the BODS bit is controlled by a timed sequence and the enable bit BODSE. To disable BOD in relevant sleep modes, both BODS and BODSE must first be written to '1'. Then, BODS must be written to '1' and BODSE must be written to zero within four clock cycles. The BODS bit is active three clock cycles after it is set. A sleep instruction must be executed while BODS is active in order to turn off the BOD for the actual sleep mode. The BODS bit is automatically cleared after three clock cycles. Bit 5 – BODSE: BOD Sleep Enable BODSE enables setting of BODS control bit, as explained in BODS bit description. BOD disable is controlled by a timed sequence. Bit 4 – PUD: Pull-up Disable When this bit is written to one, the pull-ups in the I/O ports are disabled even if the DDxn and PORTxn Registers are configured to enable the pull-ups ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b01). Bit 1 – IVSEL: Interrupt Vector Select When the IVSEL bit is cleared (zero), the Interrupt Vectors are placed at the start of the Flash memory. When this bit is set (one), the Interrupt Vectors are moved to the beginning of the Boot Loader section of the Flash. The actual address of the start of the Boot Flash Section is determined by the BOOTSZ Fuses. To avoid unintentional changes of Interrupt Vector tables, a special write procedure must be followed to change the IVSEL bit: 1. 2. Write the Interrupt Vector Change Enable (IVCE) bit to one. Within four cycles, write the desired value to IVSEL while writing a zero to IVCE. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 84 Interrupts will automatically be disabled while this sequence is executed. Interrupts are disabled in the cycle IVCE is set, and they remain disabled until after the instruction following the write to IVSEL. If IVSEL is not written, interrupts remain disabled for four cycles. The I-bit in the Status Register is unaffected by the automatic disabling. Note: If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Boot Loader section and Boot Lock bit BLB02 is programmed, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Application section and Boot Lock bit BLB12 is programed, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader section. Bit 0 – IVCE: Interrupt Vector Change Enable The IVCE bit must be written to logic one to enable change of the IVSEL bit. IVCE is cleared by hardware four cycles after it is written or when IVSEL is written. Setting the IVCE bit will disable interrupts, as explained in the IVSEL description above. See Code Example below. Assembly Code Example Move_interrupts: ; Get MCUCR in r16, MCUCR mov r17, r16 ; Enable change of Interrupt Vectors ori r16, (1<<IVCE) out MCUCR, r16 ; Move interrupts to Boot Flash section ori r17, (1<<IVSEL) out MCUCR, r17 ret C Code Example void Move_interrupts(void) { uchar temp; /* GET MCUCR*/ temp = MCUCR; /* Enable change of Interrupt Vectors */ MCUCR = temp|(1<<IVCE); /* Move interrupts to Boot Flash section */ MCUCR = temp|(1<<IVSEL); } Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 85 15. EXINT - External Interrupts The External Interrupts are triggered by the INT pin or any of the PCINT pins. Observe that, if enabled, the interrupts will trigger even if the INT or PCINT pins are configured as outputs. This feature provides a way of generating a software interrupt. The Pin Change Interrupt Request 4 (PCI4) will trigger if any enabled PCINT[38:32] pin toggles. The Pin Change Interrupt Request 3 (PCI3) will trigger if any enabled PCINT[31:24] pin toggles. The Pin Change Interrupt Request 2 (PCI2) will trigger if any enabled PCINT[23:16] pin toggles. The Pin Change Interrupt Request 1 (PCI1) will trigger if any enabled PCINT[15:8] pin toggles. The Pin Change Interrupt Request 0 (PCI0) will trigger if any enabled PCINT[7:0] pin toggles. The PCMSK4, PCMSK3, PCMSK2, PCMSK1 and PCMSK0 Registers control which pins contribute to the pin change interrupts. Pin change interrupts on PCINT are detected asynchronously. This implies that these interrupts can be used for waking the part also from sleep modes other than Idle mode. The INT0 interrupts can be triggered by a falling or rising edge or a low level. This is set up as indicated in the specification for the External Interrupt Control Register A (EICRA). When the INT0 interrupts are enabled and are configured as level triggered, the interrupts will trigger as long as the pin is held low. Note that recognition of falling or rising edge interrupts on INT0 requires the presence of an I/O clock. Low level interrupt on INT0 is detected asynchronously. This implies that this interrupt can be used for waking the part also from sleep modes other than Idle mode. The I/O clock is halted in all sleep modes except Idle mode. Note: Note that if a level triggered interrupt is used for wake-up from Power-down, the required level must be held long enough for the MCU to complete the wake-up to trigger the level interrupt. If the level disappears before the end of the Start-up Time, the MCU will still wake up, but no interrupt will be generated. The start-up time is defined by the SUT and CKSEL Fuses. Related Links System Control and Reset on page 70 Clock Systems and Their Distribution on page 42 System Clock and Clock Options on page 42 15.1. Pin Change Interrupt Timing An example of timing of a pin change interrupt is shown in the following figure. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 86 Figure 15-1 Timing of pin change interrupts pin_lat PCINT(0) D LE clk pcint_in_(0) Q pin_sync 0 pcint_syn PCINT(0) in PCMSK(x) pcint_setflag PCIF x clk clk PCINT(0) pin_lat pin_sync pcint_in_(0) pcint_syn pcint_setflag PCIF 15.2. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 87 15.2.1. External Interrupt Control Register A The External Interrupt Control Register A contains control bits for interrupt sense control. Name: EICRA Offset: 0x69 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 Access Reset 5 4 3 2 1 0 ISC21 ISC20 ISC11 ISC10 ISC01 ISC00 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 5:4 – ISC2n: Interrupt Sense Control 2 [n = 1:0] The External Interrupt 2 is activated by the external pin INT2 if the SREG I-flag and the corresponding interrupt mask are set. The level and edges on the external INT2 pin that activate the interrupt are defined in table below. The value on the INT2 pin is sampled before detecting edges. If edge or toggle interrupt is selected, pulses that last longer than one clock period will generate an interrupt. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate an interrupt. If low level interrupt is selected, the low level must be held until the completion of the currently executing instruction to generate an interrupt. Value Description 00 The low level of INT2 generates an interrupt request. 01 Any logical change on INT2 generates an interrupt request. 10 The falling edge of INT2 generates an interrupt request. 11 The rising edge of INT2 generates an interrupt request. Bits 3:2 – ISC1n: Interrupt Sense Control 1 [n = 1:0] The External Interrupt 1 is activated by the external pin INT1 if the SREG I-flag and the corresponding interrupt mask are set. The level and edges on the external INT1 pin that activate the interrupt are defined in the table below. The value on the INT1 pin is sampled before detecting edges. If edge or toggle interrupt is selected, pulses that last longer than one clock period will generate an interrupt. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate an interrupt. If low level interrupt is selected, the low level must be held until the completion of the currently executing instruction to generate an interrupt. Value Description 00 The low level of INT1 generates an interrupt request. 01 Any logical change on INT1 generates an interrupt request. 10 The falling edge of INT1 generates an interrupt request. 11 The rising edge of INT1 generates an interrupt request. Bits 1:0 – ISC0n: Interrupt Sense Control 0 [n = 1:0] The External Interrupt 0 is activated by the external pin INT0 if the SREG I-flag and the corresponding interrupt mask are set. The level and edges on the external INT0 pin that activate the interrupt are defined in table below. The value on the INT0 pin is sampled before detecting edges. If edge or toggle interrupt is selected, pulses that last longer than one clock period will generate an interrupt. Shorter pulses are not Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 88 guaranteed to generate an interrupt. If low level interrupt is selected, the low level must be held until the completion of the currently executing instruction to generate an interrupt. Value Description 00 The low level of INT0 generates an interrupt request. 01 Any logical change on INT0 generates an interrupt request. 10 The falling edge of INT0 generates an interrupt request. 11 The rising edge of INT0 generates an interrupt request. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 89 15.2.2. External Interrupt Mask Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: EIMSK Offset: 0x3D Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x1D Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 INT2 INT1 INT0 R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 Bit 2 – INT2: External Interrupt Request 2 Enable When the INT2 bit is set and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set, the external pin interrupt is enabled. The Interrupt Sense Control2 bits 1/0 (ISC21 and ISC20) in the External Interrupt Control Register A (EICRA) define whether the external interrupt is activated on rising and/or falling edge of the INT2 pin or level sensed. Activity on the pin will cause an interrupt request even if INT2 is configured as an output. The corresponding interrupt of External Interrupt Request 2 is executed from the INT2 Interrupt Vector. Bit 1 – INT1: External Interrupt Request 1 Enable When the INT1 bit is set and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set, the external pin interrupt is enabled. The Interrupt Sense Control1 bits 1/0 (ISC11 and ISC10) in the External Interrupt Control Register A (EICRA) define whether the external interrupt is activated on rising and/or falling edge of the INT1 pin or level sensed. Activity on the pin will cause an interrupt request even if INT1 is configured as an output. The corresponding interrupt of External Interrupt Request 1 is executed from the INT1 Interrupt Vector. Bit 0 – INT0: External Interrupt Request 0 Enable When the INT0 bit is set and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set, the external pin interrupt is enabled. The Interrupt Sense Control0 bits 1/0 (ISC01 and ISC00) in the External Interrupt Control Register A (EICRA) define whether the external interrupt is activated on rising and/or falling edge of the INT0 pin or level sensed. Activity on the pin will cause an interrupt request even if INT0 is configured as an output. The corresponding interrupt of External Interrupt Request 0 is executed from the INT0 Interrupt Vector. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 90 15.2.3. External Interrupt Flag Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: EIFR Offset: 0x3C Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x1C Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 INTF2 INTF1 INTF0 R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 Bit 2 – INTF2: External Interrupt Flag 2 When an edge or logic change on the INT2 pin triggers an interrupt request, INTF2 will be set. If the I-bit in SREG and the INT2 bit in EIMSK are set, the MCU will jump to the corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by writing '1' to it. This flag is always cleared when INT2 is configured as a level interrupt. Bit 1 – INTF1: External Interrupt Flag 1 When an edge or logic change on the INT1 pin triggers an interrupt request, INTF1 will be set. If the I-bit in SREG and the INT1 bit in EIMSK are set, the MCU will jump to the corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by writing '1' to it. This flag is always cleared when INT1 is configured as a level interrupt. Bit 0 – INTF0: External Interrupt Flag 0 When an edge or logic change on the INT0 pin triggers an interrupt request, INTF0 will be set. If the I-bit in SREG and the INT0 bit in EIMSK are set, the MCU will jump to the corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by writing '1' to it. This flag is always cleared when INT0 is configured as a level interrupt. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 91 15.2.4. Pin Change Interrupt Control Register Name: PCICR Offset: 0x68 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PCIE4 PCIE3 PCIE2 PCIE1 PCIE0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 4 – PCIE4: Pin Change Interrupt Enable 4 When the PCIE4 bit is set and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set, pin change interrupt 4 is enabled. Any change on any enabled PCINT[39:32] pin will cause an interrupt. The corresponding interrupt of Pin Change Interrupt Request is executed from the PCI4 Interrupt Vector. PCINT[39:32] pins are enabled individually by the PCMSK4 Register. Bit 3 – PCIE3: Pin Change Interrupt Enable 3 When the PCIE3 bit is set and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set, pin change interrupt 3 is enabled. Any change on any enabled PCINT[31:24] pin will cause an interrupt. The corresponding interrupt of Pin Change Interrupt Request is executed from the PCI3 Interrupt Vector. PCINT[31:24] pins are enabled individually by the PCMSK3 Register. Bit 2 – PCIE2: Pin Change Interrupt Enable 2 When the PCIE2 bit is set and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set, pin change interrupt 2 is enabled. Any change on any enabled PCINT[23:16] pin will cause an interrupt. The corresponding interrupt of Pin Change Interrupt Request is executed from the PCI2 Interrupt Vector. PCINT[23:16] pins are enabled individually by the PCMSK2 Register. Bit 1 – PCIE1: Pin Change Interrupt Enable 1 When the PCIE1 bit is set and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set, pin change interrupt 1 is enabled. Any change on any enabled PCINT[14:8] pin will cause an interrupt. The corresponding interrupt of Pin Change Interrupt Request is executed from the PCI1 Interrupt Vector. PCINT[14:8] pins are enabled individually by the PCMSK1 Register. Bit 0 – PCIE0: Pin Change Interrupt Enable 0 When the PCIE0 bit is set and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set, pin change interrupt 0 is enabled. Any change on any enabled PCINT[7:0] pin will cause an interrupt. The corresponding interrupt of Pin Change Interrupt Request is executed from the PCI0 Interrupt Vector. PCINT[7:0] pins are enabled individually by the PCMSK0 Register. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 92 15.2.5. Pin Change Interrupt Flag Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: PCIFR Offset: 0x3B Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x1B Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PCIF4 PCIF3 PCIF2 PCIF1 PCIF0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 4 – PCIF4: Pin Change Interrupt Flag 4 When a logic change on any PCINT[39:32] pin triggers an interrupt request, PCIF4 will be set. If the I-bit in SREG and the PCIE4 bit in PCICR are set, the MCU will jump to the corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by writing '1' to it. Bit 3 – PCIF3: Pin Change Interrupt Flag 3 When a logic change on any PCINT[31:24] pin triggers an interrupt request, PCIF3 will be set. If the I-bit in SREG and the PCIE3 bit in PCICR are set, the MCU will jump to the corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by writing '1' to it. Bit 2 – PCIF2: Pin Change Interrupt Flag 2 When a logic change on any PCINT[23:16] pin triggers an interrupt request, PCIF2 will be set. If the I-bit in SREG and the PCIE2 bit in PCICR are set, the MCU will jump to the corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by writing '1' to it. Bit 1 – PCIF1: Pin Change Interrupt Flag 1 When a logic change on any PCINT[15:8] pin triggers an interrupt request, PCIF1 will be set. If the I-bit in SREG and the PCIE1 bit in PCICR are set, the MCU will jump to the corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by writing '1' to it. Bit 0 – PCIF0: Pin Change Interrupt Flag 0 When a logic change on any PCINT[7:0] pin triggers an interrupt request, PCIF0 will be set. If the I-bit in SREG and the PCIE0 bit in PCICR are set, the MCU will jump to the corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by writing '1' to it. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 93 15.2.6. Pin Change Mask Register 0 Name: PCMSK0 Offset: 0x6B Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PCINT7 PCINT6 PCINT5 PCINT4 PCINT3 PCINT2 PCINT1 PCINT0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – PCINTn: Pin Change Enable Mask [n = 7:0] Each PCINT[7:0] bit selects whether pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT[7:0] is set and the PCIE0 bit in PCICR is set, pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT[7:0] is cleared, pin change interrupt on the corresponding I/O pin is disabled. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 94 15.2.7. Pin Change Mask Register 1 Name: PCMSK1 Offset: 0x6C Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PCINT15 PCINT14 PCINT13 PCINT12 PCINT11 PCINT10 PCINT9 PCINT8 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 – PCINT8, PCINT9, PCINT10, PCINT11, PCINT12, PCINT13, PCINT14, PCINT15: Pin Change Enable Mask Each PCINT[15:8]-bit selects whether pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT[15:8] is set and the PCIE1 bit in PCICR is set, pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT[15:8] is cleared, pin change interrupt on the corresponding I/O pin is disabled. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 95 15.2.8. Pin Change Mask Register 2 Name: PCMSK2 Offset: 0x6D Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PCINT23 PCINT22 PCINT21 PCINT20 PCINT19 PCINT18 PCINT17 PCINT16 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 – PCINT16, PCINT17, PCINT18, PCINT19, PCINT20, PCINT21, PCINT22, PCINT23: Pin Change Enable Mask Each PCINT[23:16]-bit selects whether pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT[23:16] is set and the PCIE2 bit in PCICR is set, pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT[23:16] is cleared, pin change interrupt on the corresponding I/O pin is disabled. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 96 15.2.9. Pin Change Mask Register 3 Name: PCMSK3 Offset: 0x73 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PCINT31 PCINT30 PCINT29 PCINT28 PCINT27 PCINT26 PCINT25 PCINT24 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 – PCINT24, PCINT25, PCINT26, PCINT27, PCINT28, PCINT29, PCINT30, PCINT31: Pin Change Enable Mask Each PCINT[31:24]-bit selects whether pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT[31:24] is set and the PCIE3 bit in PCICR is set, pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT[31:24] is cleared, pin change interrupt on the corresponding I/O pin is disabled. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 97 15.2.10. Pin Change Mask Register 4 Name: PCMSK4 Offset: 0x74 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PCINT7 PCINT38 PCINT37 PCINT36 PCINT35 PCINT34 PCINT33 PCINT32 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 – PCINT32, PCINT33, PCINT34, PCINT35, PCINT36, PCINT37, PCINT38, PCINT7: Pin Change Enable Mask Each PCINT[38:32]-bit selects whether pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT[38:32] is set and the PCIE4 bit in PCICR is set, pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT[38:32] is cleared, pin change interrupt on the corresponding I/O pin is disabled. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 98 16. I/O-Ports 16.1. Overview All AVR ports have true Read-Modify-Write functionality when used as general digital I/O ports. This means that the direction of one port pin can be changed without unintentionally changing the direction of any other pin with the SBI and CBI instructions. The same applies when changing drive value (if configured as output) or enabling/disabling of pull-up resistors (if configured as input). Each output buffer has symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source capability. The pin driver is strong enough to drive LED displays directly. All port pins have individually selectable pull-up resistors with a supply-voltage invariant resistance. All I/O pins have protection diodes to both VCC and Ground as indicated in the following figure. Figure 16-1 I/O Pin Equivalent Schematic R pu Logic Pxn C pin See Figure "General Digital I/O" for Details All registers and bit references in this section are written in general form. A lower case “x” represents the numbering letter for the port, and a lower case “n” represents the bit number. However, when using the register or bit defines in a program, the precise form must be used. For example, PORTB3 for bit no. 3 in Port B, here documented generally as PORTxn. I/O memory address locations are allocated for each port, one each for the Data Register – PORTx, Data Direction Register – DDRx, and the Port Input Pins – PINx. The Port Input Pins I/O location is read only, while the Data Register and the Data Direction Register are read/write. However, writing '1' to a bit in the PINx Register will result in a toggle in the corresponding bit in the Data Register. In addition, the Pull-up Disable – PUD bit in MCUCR disables the pull-up function for all pins in all ports when set. Using the I/O port as General Digital I/O is described in next section. Most port pins are multiplexed with alternate functions for the peripheral features on the device. How each alternate function interferes with the port pin is described in Alternate Port Functions section in this chapter. Refer to the individual module sections for a full description of the alternate functions. Enabling the alternate function of some of the port pins does not affect the use of the other pins in the port as general digital I/O. 16.2. Ports as General Digital I/O The ports are bi-directional I/O ports with optional internal pull-ups. The following figure shows the functional description of one I/O-port pin, here generically called Pxn. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 99 Figure 16-2 General Digital I/O(1) PUD Q D DDxn Q CLR WDx RESET 1 Q Pxn D 0 PORTxn Q CLR RESET SLEEP RRx SYNCHRONIZER D Q L Q D WRx WPx DATA BUS RDx RPx Q PINxn Q clk I/O PUD: SLEEP: clkI/O: PULLUP DISABLE SLEEP CONTROL I/O CLOCK WDx: RDx: WRx: RRx: RPx: WPx: WRITE DDRx READ DDRx WRITE PORTx READ PORTx REGISTER READ PORTx PIN WRITE PINx REGISTER Note: 1. WRx, WPx, WDx, RRx, RPx, and RDx are common to all pins within the same port. clkI/O, SLEEP, and PUD are common to all ports. 16.2.1. Configuring the Pin Each port pin consists of three register bits: DDxn, PORTxn, and PINxn. As shown in the Register Description, the DDxn bits are accessed at the DDRx I/O address, the PORTxn bits at the PORTx I/O address, and the PINxn bits at the PINx I/O address. The DDxn bit in the DDRx Register selects the direction of this pin. If DDxn is written to '1', Pxn is configured as an output pin. If DDxn is written to '0', Pxn is configured as an input pin. If PORTxn is written to '1' when the pin is configured as an input pin, the pull-up resistor is activated. To switch the pull-up resistor off, PORTxn has to be written to '0' or the pin has to be configured as an output pin. The port pins are tri-stated when reset condition becomes active, even if no clocks are running. If PORTxn is written to '1' when the pin is configured as an output pin, the port pin is driven high. If PORTxn is written logic zero when the pin is configured as an output pin, the port pin is driven low. 16.2.2. Toggling the Pin Writing a '1' to PINxn toggles the value of PORTxn, independent on the value of DDRxn. The SBI instruction can be used to toggle one single bit in a port. 16.2.3. Switching Between Input and Output When switching between tri-state ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b00) and output high ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b11), an intermediate state with either pull-up enabled {DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b01) or output low ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b10) must occur. Normally, the pull-up enabled state is fully acceptable, as a highimpedance environment will not notice the difference between a strong high driver and a pull-up. If this is not the case, the PUD bit in the MCUCR Register can be set to disable all pull-ups in all ports. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 100 Switching between input with pull-up and output low generates the same problem. The user must use either the tri-state ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b00) or the output high state ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b11) as an intermediate step. The following table summarizes the control signals for the pin value. Table 16-1 Port Pin Configurations DDxn PORTxn PUD (in MCUCR) I/O Pull-up Comment 0 0 X Input No Tri-state (Hi-Z) 0 1 0 Input Yes Pxn will source current if ext. pulled low 0 1 1 Input No Tri-state (Hi-Z) 1 0 X Output No Output Low (Sink) 1 1 X Output No Output High (Source) 16.2.4. Reading the Pin Value Independent of the setting of Data Direction bit DDxn, the port pin can be read through the PINxn Register bit. As shown in Figure 16-2 General Digital I/O(1) on page 100, the PINxn Register bit and the preceding latch constitute a synchronizer. This is needed to avoid metastability if the physical pin changes value near the edge of the internal clock, but it also introduces a delay. The following figure shows a timing diagram of the synchronization when reading an externally applied pin value. The maximum and minimum propagation delays are denoted tpd,max and tpd,min respectively. Figure 16-3 Synchronization when Reading an Externally Applied Pin value SYSTEM CLK INSTRUCTIONS XXX XXX in r17, PINx SYNC LATCH PINxn r17 0x00 0xFF t pd, max t pd, min Consider the clock period starting shortly after the first falling edge of the system clock. The latch is closed when the clock is low, and goes transparent when the clock is high, as indicated by the shaded region of the “SYNC LATCH” signal. The signal value is latched when the system clock goes low. It is clocked into the PINxn Register at the succeeding positive clock edge. As indicated by the two arrows tpd,max and tpd,min, a single signal transition on the pin will be delayed between ½ and 1½ system clock period depending upon the time of assertion. When reading back a software assigned pin value, a nop instruction must be inserted as indicated in the following figure. The out instruction sets the “SYNC LATCH” signal at the positive edge of the clock. In this case, the delay tpd through the synchronizer is 1 system clock period. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 101 Figure 16-4 Synchronization when Reading a Software Assigned Pin Value SYSTEM CLK r16 INSTRUCTIONS 0xFF out PORTx, r16 nop in r17, PINx SYNC LATCH PINxn r17 0x00 0xFF t pd The following code example shows how to set port B pins 0 and 1 high, 2 and 3 low, and define the port pins from 4 to 7 as input with pull-ups assigned to port pins 6 and 7. The resulting pin values are read back again, but as previously discussed, a nop instruction is included to be able to read back the value recently assigned to some of the pins. Assembly Code Example(1) ... ; Define pull-ups and set outputs high ; Define directions for port pins ldi r16,(1<<PB7)|(1<<PB6)|(1<<PB1)|(1<<PB0) ldi r17,(1<<DDB3)|(1<<DDB2)|(1<<DDB1)|(1<<DDB0) out PORTB,r16 out DDRB,r17 ; Insert nop for synchronization nop ; Read port pins in r16,PINB ... Note: 1. For the assembly program, two temporary registers are used to minimize the time from pull-ups are set on pins 0, 1, 6, and 7, until the direction bits are correctly set, defining bit 2 and 3 as low and redefining bits 0 and 1 as strong high drivers. C Code Example unsigned char i; ... /* Define pull-ups and set outputs high */ /* Define directions for port pins */ PORTB = (1<<PB7)|(1<<PB6)|(1<<PB1)|(1<<PB0); DDRB = (1<<DDB3)|(1<<DDB2)|(1<<DDB1)|(1<<DDB0); /* Insert nop for synchronization*/ __no_operation(); /* Read port pins */ i = PINB; ... Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 102 16.2.5. Digital Input Enable and Sleep Modes As shown in the figure of General Digital I/O, the digital input signal can be clamped to ground at the input of the Schmitt Trigger. The signal denoted SLEEP in the figure, is set by the MCU Sleep Controller in Power-down mode and Standby mode to avoid high power consumption if some input signals are left floating, or have an analog signal level close to VCC/2. SLEEP is overridden for port pins enabled as external interrupt pins. If the external interrupt request is not enabled, SLEEP is active also for these pins. SLEEP is also overridden by various other alternate functions as described in Alternate Port Functions section in this chapter. If a logic high level is present on an asynchronous external interrupt pin configured as “Interrupt on Rising Edge, Falling Edge, or Any Logic Change on Pin” while the external interrupt is not enabled, the corresponding External Interrupt Flag will be set when resuming from the above mentioned Sleep mode, as the clamping in these sleep mode produces the requested logic change. 16.2.6. Unconnected Pins If some pins are unused, it is recommended to ensure that these pins have a defined level. Even though most of the digital inputs are disabled in the deep sleep modes as described above, floating inputs should be avoided to reduce current consumption in all other modes where the digital inputs are enabled (Reset, Active mode and Idle mode). The simplest method to ensure a defined level of an unused pin, is to enable the internal pull-up. In this case, the pull-up will be disabled during reset. If low power consumption during reset is important, it is recommended to use an external pull-up or pull-down. Connecting unused pins directly to VCC or GND is not recommended, since this may cause excessive currents if the pin is accidentally configured as an output. 16.3. Alternate Port Functions Most port pins have alternate functions in addition to being general digital I/Os. The following figure shows how the port pin control signals from the simplified Figure 16-2 General Digital I/O(1) on page 100 can be overridden by alternate functions. The overriding signals may not be present in all port pins, but the figure serves as a generic description applicable to all port pins in the AVR microcontroller family. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 103 Figure 16-5 Alternate Port Functions(1) PUOExn 1 PUOVxn PUD 0 DDOExn 1 DDOVxn Q D DDxn 0 Q CLR PVOExn WDx RESET RDx 1 DATA BUS PVOVxn 1 Pxn Q 0 D 0 PORTxn Q CLR DIEOExn 1 0 DIEOVxn WPx RESET WRx RRx SLEEP SYNCHRONIZER D SET Q D RPx Q PINxn L CLR Q CLR Q clk I/O DIxn AIOxn PUOExn: PUOVxn: DDOExn: DDOVxn: PVOExn: PVOVxn: DIEOExn: DIEOVxn: SLEEP: Pxn PULL-UP OVERRIDE ENABLE Pxn PULL-UP OVERRIDE VALUE Pxn DATA DIRECTION OVERRIDE ENABLE Pxn DATA DIRECTION OVERRIDE VALUE Pxn PORT VALUE OVERRIDE ENABLE Pxn PORT VALUE OVERRIDE VALUE Pxn DIGITAL INPUT-ENABLE OVERRIDE ENABLE Pxn DIGITAL INPUT-ENABLE OVERRIDE VALUE SLEEP CONTROL PUD: WDx: RDx: RRx: WRx: RPx: WPx: clkI/O: DIxn: AIOxn: PULLUP DISABLE WRITE DDRx READ DDRx READ PORTx REGISTER WRITE PORTx READ PORTx PIN WRITE PINx I/O CLOCK DIGITAL INPUT PIN n ON PORTx ANALOG INPUT/OUTPUT PIN n ON PORTx Note: 1. WRx, WPx, WDx, RRx, RPx, and RDx are common to all pins within the same port. clkI/O, SLEEP, and PUD are common to all ports. All other signals are unique for each pin. The following table summarizes the function of the overriding signals. The pin and port indexes from previous figure are not shown in the succeeding tables. The overriding signals are generated internally in the modules having the alternate function. Table 16-2 Generic Description of Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions Signal Name Full Name Description PUOE Pull-up Override Enable If this signal is set, the pull-up enable is controlled by the PUOV signal. If this signal is cleared, the pull-up is enabled when {DDxn, PORTxn, PUD} = 0b010. PUOV Pull-up Override Value If PUOE is set, the pull-up is enabled/disabled when PUOV is set/ cleared, regardless of the setting of the DDxn, PORTxn, and PUD Register bits. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 104 Signal Name Full Name Description DDOE Data Direction Override Enable If this signal is set, the Output Driver Enable is controlled by the DDOV signal. If this signal is cleared, the Output driver is enabled by the DDxn Register bit. DDOV Data Direction Override Value If DDOE is set, the Output Driver is enabled/disabled when DDOV is set/cleared, regardless of the setting of the DDxn Register bit. PVOE Port Value Override Enable If this signal is set and the Output Driver is enabled, the port value is controlled by the PVOV signal. If PVOE is cleared, and the Output Driver is enabled, the port Value is controlled by the PORTxn Register bit. PVOV Port Value Override Value If PVOE is set, the port value is set to PVOV, regardless of the setting of the PORTxn Register bit. DIEOE Digital Input Enable Override Enable If this bit is set, the Digital Input Enable is controlled by the DIEOV signal. If this signal is cleared, the Digital Input Enable is determined by MCU state (Normal mode, sleep mode). DIEOV Digital Input Enable Override Value If DIEOE is set, the Digital Input is enabled/disabled when DIEOV is set/ cleared, regardless of the MCU state (Normal mode, sleep mode). DI Digital Input This is the Digital Input to alternate functions. In the figure, the signal is connected to the output of the Schmitt Trigger but before the synchronizer. Unless the Digital Input is used as a clock source, the module with the alternate function will use its own synchronizer. AIO Analog Input/Output This is the Analog Input/output to/from alternate functions. The signal is connected directly to the pad, and can be used bi-directionally. The following subsections shortly describe the alternate functions for each port, and relate the overriding signals to the alternate function. Refer to the alternate function description for further details. Related Links Fuse Bits on page 397 16.3.1. Alternate Functions of Port A The Port A pins with alternate functions are shown in the table below: Table 16-3 Port A Pins Alternate Functions Port Pin Alternate Functions PA7 ADC7 (ADC input channel 7) PCINT7 (Pin Change Interrupt 7) PA6 ADC6 (ADC input channel 6) PCINT6 (Pin Change Interrupt 6) PA5 ADC5 (ADC input channel 5) PCINT5 (Pin Change Interrupt 5) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 105 Port Pin Alternate Functions PA4 ADC4 (ADC input channel 4) PCINT4 (Pin Change Interrupt 4) PA3 ADC3 (ADC input channel 3) PCINT3 (Pin Change Interrupt 3) PA2 ADC2 (ADC input channel 2) PCINT2 (Pin Change Interrupt 2) PA1 ADC1 (ADC input channel 1) PCINT1 (Pin Change Interrupt 1) PA0 ADC0 (ADC input channel 0) PCINT0 (Pin Change Interrupt 0) The alternate pin configuration is as follows: • ADC[7:0]/PCINT[7:0] – Port A, Bit [7:0] – ADC[7:0]: Analog to Digital Converter Channels [7:0]. – PCINT[7:0]: Pin Change Interrupt source [7:0]. The PA[7:0] pins can serve as external interrupt sources. Table 16-4 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PA7...PA4 Signal PA7/ADC7/ PCINT7 Name PA6/ADC6/ PCINT6 PA5/ADC5/ PCINT5 PA4/ADC4/ PCINT4 PUOE 0 0 0 0 PUOV 0 0 0 0 DDOE 0 0 0 0 DDOV 0 0 0 0 PVOE 0 0 0 0 PVOV 0 0 0 0 DIEOE PCINT7 • PCIE0 + ADC7D PCINT6 • PCIE0 + ADC6D PCINT5 • PCIE0 + ADC5D PCINT4 • PCIE0 + ADC4D DIEOV PCINT7 • PCIE0 PCINT6 • PCIE0 PCINT5 • PCIE0 PCINT4 • PCIE0 DI PCINT7 INPUT PCINT6 INPUT PCINT5 INPUT PCINT4 INPUT AIO ADC7 INPUT ADC6 INPUT ADC5 INPUT ADC4 INPUT Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 106 Table 16-5 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PA3...PA0 Signal PA3/ADC3/ PCINT3 Name PA2/ADC2/ PCINT2 PA1/ADC1/ PCINT1 PA0/ADC0/ PCINT0 PUOE 0 0 0 0 PUOV 0 0 0 0 DDOE 0 0 0 0 DDOV 0 0 0 0 PVOE 0 0 0 0 PVOV 0 0 0 0 DIEOE PCINT3 • PCIE0 + ADC3D PCINT2 • PCIE0 + ADC2D PCINT1 • PCIE0 + ADC1D PCINT0 • PCIE0 + ADC0D DIEOV PCINT3 • PCIE0 PCINT2 • PCIE0 PCINT1 • PCIE0 PCINT0 • PCIE0 DI PCINT3 INPUT PCINT2 INPUT PCINT1 INPUT PCINT0 INPUT AIO ADC3 INPUT ADC2 INPUT ADC1 INPUT ADC0 INPUT 16.3.2. Alternate Functions of Port B The Port B pins with alternate functions are shown in the table below: Table 16-6 Port B Pins Alternate Functions Port Pin Alternate Functions PB7 SCK0 (SPI0 Bus Master clock input) OC3B (Timer/Counter 3 Output Compare Match B Output) OC4B (Timer/Counter 4 Output Compare Match B Output) PCINT15 (Pin Change Interrupt 15) PB6 MISO0 (SPI0 Bus Master Input/Slave Output) OC3A (Timer/Counter 3 Output Compare Match A Output) PCINT14 (Pin Change Interrupt 14) PB5 MOSI0 (SPI0 Bus Master Output/Slave Input) ICP3 (Timer/Counter3 Input Capture Trigger) PCINT13 (Pin Change Interrupt 13) PB4 SS0 (SPI0 Slave Select input) OC0B (Timer/Counter 0 Output Compare Match B Output) PCINT12 (Pin Change Interrupt 12) PB3 AIN1 (Analog Comparator Negative Input) OC0A (Timer/Counter 0 Output Compare Match A Output) PCINT11 (Pin Change Interrupt 11) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 107 Port Pin Alternate Functions PB2 AIN0 (Analog Comparator Positive Input) INT2 (External Interrupt 2 Input) PCINT10 (Pin Change Interrupt 10) PB1 T1 (Timer/Counter 1 External Counter Input) CLKO (Divided System Clock Output) PCINT9 (Pin Change Interrupt 9) PB0 T0 (Timer/Counter 0 External Counter Input) XCK0 (USART0 External Clock Input/Output) PCINT8 (Pin Change Interrupt 8) The alternate pin configuration is as follows: • SCK0/OC3B/OC4B/PCINT15 – Port B, Bit 7 – SCK0: Master Clock output, Slave Clock input pin for SPI0 channel. When the SPI0 is enabled as a slave, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDB7. When the SPI0 is enabled as a master, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDB7. When the pin is forced to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTB7 bit. – OC3B: Output Compare Match B output. The PB7 pin can serve as an external output for the Timer/Counter3 Output Compare. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB7 set “1”) to serve this function. The OC3B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function. – OC4B: Output Compare Match B output. The PB7 pin can serve as an external output for the Timer/Counter4 Output Compare. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB7 set “1”) to serve this function. The OC4B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function. – PCINT15: Pin Change Interrupt source 15. The PB7 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • MISO0/OC3A/PCINT14 – Port B, Bit 6 – MISO0: Master Data input, Slave Data output pin for SPI0 channel. When the SPI0 is enabled as a master, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDB6. When the SPI0 is enabled as a slave, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDB6. When the pin is forced to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTB6 bit. – OC3A: Output Compare Match A output. The PB6 pin can serve as an external output for the Timer/Counter3 Output Compare. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB6 set “1”) to serve this function. The OC3A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function. – PCINT14: Pin Change Interrupt source 14. The PB6 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • MOSI0/ICP3/PCINT13 – Port B, Bit 5 – MOSI0: SPI0 Master Data output, Slave Data input for SPI0 channel. When the SPI0 is enabled as a slave, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDB5. When the SPI0 is enabled as a master, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDB5. When the pin is forced to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTB5 bit. – ICP3: Input Capture Pin 3. The PB5 pin can act as an input capture pin for Timer/Counter3. – PCINT13: Pin Change Interrupt source 13. The PB5 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 108 • SS0/OC0B/PCINT12 – Port B, Bit 4 – SS0: Slave Port Select input. When the SPI0 is enabled as a slave, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDB4. As a slave, the SPI0 is activated when this pin is driven low. When the SPI0 is enabled as a master, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDB4. When the pin is forced to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTB4 bit. – OC0B: Output Compare Match B output. The PB4 pin can serve as an external output for the Timer/Counter0 Output Compare. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB4 set “1”) to serve this function. The OC0B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function. – PCINT12: Pin Change Interrupt source 12. The PB4 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • AIN1/OC0A/PCINT11– Port B, Bit 3 – AIN1: Analog Comparator Negative input. This pin is directly connected to the negative input of the Analog Comparator. – OC0A: Output Compare Match A output. The PB3 pin can serve as an external output for the Timer/Counter0 Output Compare. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB3 set “1”) to serve this function. The OC0A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function. – PCINT11: Pin Change Interrupt source 11. The PB3 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • AIN0/INT2/PCINT10 – Port B, Bit 2 – AIN0: Analog Comparator Positive input. This pin is directly connected to the positive input of the Analog Comparator. – INT2: External Interrupt source 2. The PB2 pin can serve as an External Interrupt source to the MCU. – PCINT10: Pin Change Interrupt source 10. The PB2 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • T1/CLKO/PCINT9 – Port B, Bit 1 – T1: Timer/Counter1 counter source. – CLKO: Divided System Clock: The divided system clock can be output on the PB1 pin. The divided system clock will be output if the CKOUT Fuse is programmed, regardless of the PORTB1 and DDB1 settings. It will also be output during reset. – PCINT9: Pin Change Interrupt source 9: The PB1 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • T0/XCK0/PCINT8 – Port B, Bit 0 – T0: Timer/Counter0 counter source. – XCK0: USART0 External clock. The Data Direction Register (DDB0) controls whether the clock is output (DDB0 set “1”) or input (DDB0 cleared). The XCK0 pin is active only when the USART0 operates in Synchronous mode. – PCINT8: Pin Change Interrupt source 8. The PB0 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. Table 16-7 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PB7...PB4 (TBD) on page 110 and Table 16-8 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PB3...PB0 (TBD) on page 110 relate the alternate functions of Port B to the overriding signals shown in Figure 16-5 Alternate Port Functions(1) on page 104. SPI MSTR INPUT and SPI SLAVE OUTPUT constitute the MISO signal, while MOSI is divided into SPI MSTR OUTPUT and SPI SLAVE INPUT. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 109 Table 16-7 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PB7...PB4 (TBD) Signal PB7/SCK0/OC3B/OC4B/ Name PCINT15 PB6/MISO0/OC3A/ PCINT14 PB5/MOSI0/ICP3/ PCINT13 PB4/SS0/OC0B/ PCINT12 PUOE SPE0 • MSTR SPE0 • MSTR SPE0 • MSTR SPE0 • MSTR PUOV PORTB7 • PUD PORTB6 • PUD PORTB5 • PUD PORTB4 • PUD DDOE SPE0 • MSTR SPE0 • MSTR SPE0 • MSTR SPE0 • MSTR DDOV 0 0 0 0 PVOE SPE0 • MSTR OC3B/OC4B ENABLE SPE0 • MSTR OC3A ENABLE SPE0 • MSTR OC0B ENABLE PVOV SCK0 OUTPUT + OC3B/ OC4B SPI0 SLAVE OUTPUT + OC3A SPI0 MSTR OUTPUT OC0B DIEOE PCINT15 • PCIE1 PCINT14 • PCIE1 PCINT13 • PCIE1 PCINT12 • PCIE1 DIEOV 1 1 1 1 DI SCK0 INPUT PCINT15 INPUT SPI0 MSTR INPUT PCINT14 INPUT SPI0 SLAVE INPUT ICP3 INPUT PCINT13 INPUT SPI SS0 PCINT12 INPUT AIO - - – – Table 16-8 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PB3...PB0 (TBD) Signal PB3/AIN1/OC0A/PCINT11 PB2/AIN0/INT2/PCINT10 PB1/T1/CLKO/PCINT9 PB0/T0/XCK0/PCINT8 Name PUOE 0 0 0 0 PUOV 0 0 0 0 DDOE 0 0 CKOUT 0 DDOV 0 0 CKOUT 0 PVOE OC0A ENABLE 0 CKOUT UMSEL PVOV OC0A 0 CLK I/O XCK0 OUTPUT INT2 ENABLE PCINT9 • PCIE1 PCINT8 • PCIE1 DIEOE PCINT11 • PCIE1 PCINT10 • PCIE1 DIEOV 1 1 1 1 DI PCINT11 INPUT INT2 INPUT PCINT10 INPUT T1 INPUT PCINT9 INPUT T0 INPUT XCK0 INPUT PCINT8 INPUT AIO AIN1 INPUT AIN0 INPUT – – Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 110 16.3.3. Alternate Functions of Port C The Port C pins with alternate functions are shown in the table below: Table 16-9 Port C Pins Alternate Functions Port Pin Alternate Function PC7 TOSC2 (Timer Oscillator pin 2) PCINT23 (Pin Change Interrupt 23) PC6 TOSC1 (Timer Oscillator pin 1) PCINT22 (Pin Change Interrupt 22) PC5 ACO TDI (JTAG Test Data Input) PCINT21 (Pin Change Interrupt 21) PC4 OC4A (Timer/Counter 4 Output Compare Match A Output) TDO (JTAG Test Data Output) PCINT20 (Pin Change Interrupt 20) PC3 ICP4 (Timer/Counter4 Input Capture Trigger) TMS (JTAG Test Mode Select) PCINT19 (Pin Change Interrupt 19) PC2 T4 (Timer/Counter 4 External Counter Input) TCK (JTAG Test Clock) PCINT18 (Pin Change Interrupt 18) PC1 SDA0 (two-wire Serial Bus0 Data Input/Output Line) PCINT17 (Pin Change Interrupt 17) PC0 SCL0 (two-wire Serial Bus0 Clock Line) PCINT16 (Pin Change Interrupt 16) The alternate pin configuration is as follows: • • • TOSC2/PCINT23 – Port C, Bit 7 – TOSC2, Timer Oscillator pin 2. The PC7 pin can serve as an external interrupt source to the MCU. – PCINT23: Pin Change Interrupt source 23. The PC7 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. TOSC1/PCINT22 – Port C, Bit 6 – TOSC1, Timer Oscillator pin 1. The PC6 pin can serve as an external interrupt source to the MCU. – PCINT22: Pin Change Interrupt source 22. The PC6 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. TDI/PCINT21 – Port C, Bit 5 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 111 – – TDI: JTAG Test Data Input PCINT21: Pin Change Interrupt source 21. The PC5 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • OC4A/TDO/PCINT20 – Port C, Bit 4 – OC4A: Timer/Counter 4 Output Compare Match A Output – TDO: JTAG Test Data Output – PCINT20: Pin Change Interrupt source 20. The PC4 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • TMS/ICP4/PCINT19 – Port C, Bit 3 – TMS: JTAG Test Mode Select – ICP4: Timer/Counter4 Input Capture Trigger – PCINT19: Pin Change Interrupt source 19. The PC3 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • TCK/T4/PCINT18 – Port C, Bit 2 – TCK: JTAG Test Clock – T4: Timer/Counter 4 External Counter Input – PCINT18: Pin Change Interrupt source 18. The PC2 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • SDA0/PCINT17 – Port C, Bit 1 – SDA0: two-wire Serial Bus0 Data Input/Output Line – PCINT17: Pin Change Interrupt source 17. The PC1 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • SCL0/PCINT16 – Port C, Bit 0 – SCL0: two-wire Serial Bus0 Clock Line – PCINT16: Pin Change Interrupt source 16. The PC0 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. The tables below relate the alternate functions of Port C to the overriding signals shown in Figure 16-5 Alternate Port Functions(1) on page 104. Table 16-10 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PC7...PC4 (TBD) Signal PC7/TOSC2/PCINT23 Name PC6/TOSC1/PCINT22 PC5/TDI/PCINT21 PC4/OC4A/TDO/PCINT20 PUOE AS2 • EXCLK AS2 JTAGEN JTAGEN PUOV 0 0 1 1 DDOE AS2 • EXCLK AS2 JTAGEN JTAGEN OC4A ENABLE DDOV 0 0 0 SHIFT_IR + SHIFT_DR + OC4A PVOE 0 0 0 JTAGEN PVOV 0 0 0 TDO Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 112 Signal PC7/TOSC2/PCINT23 Name PC6/TOSC1/PCINT22 PC5/TDI/PCINT21 PC4/OC4A/TDO/PCINT20 DIEOE AS2 • EXCLK + PCINT23 • PCIE2 AS2 + PCINT22 • PCIE2 JTAGEN + PCINT21 • JTAGEN + PCINT20 • PCIE2 PCIE2 DIEOV AS2 EXCLK + AS2 JTAGEN JTAGEN DI PCINT23 INPUT PCINT22 INPUT PCINT21 INPUT PCINT20 INPUT AIO T/C2 OSC OUTPUT T/C1 OSC INPUT TDI INPUT - Table 16-11 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PC3...PC0 (TBD) Signal PC3/TMS/ICP4/PCINT19 Name PC2/T4/PCINT18 PC1/SDA0/PCINT17 PC0/SCL0/PCINT16 PUOE JTAGEN JTAGEN TWEN TWEN PUOV 1 1 PORTC1 • PUD PORTC0 • PUD DDOE JTAGEN JTAGEN TWEN TWEN DDOV 0 0 0 0 PVOE 0 0 TWEN TWEN PVOV 0 0 SDA OUT SCL OUT DIEOE JTAGEN + PCINT19 • PCIE2 JTAGEN + PCINT18 • PCIE2 PCINT17 • PCIE2 PCINT16 • PCIE2 DIEOV JTAGEN JTAGEN 1 1 DI ICP4 INPUT PCINT19 INPUT T4 INPUT PCINT18 INPUT PCINT17 INPUT PCINT16 INPUT AIO TMS INPUT TCK INPUT SDA0 INPUT SCL0 INPUT 16.3.4. Alternate Functions of Port D The Port D pins with alternate functions are shown in the table below: Table 16-12 Port D Pins Alternate Functions Port Pin Alternate Function PD7 OC2A (Timer/Counter2 Output Compare Match A Output) XCK2 (USART2 External Clock Input/Output) SCK1 (SPI1 Bus Master clock Input) PCINT31 (Pin Change Interrupt 31) PD6 ICP1 (Timer/Counter1 Input Capture Trigger) OC2B (Timer/Counter2 Output Compare Match B Output) SS1 (SPI1 Slave Select input) PCINT30 (Pin Change Interrupt 30) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 113 Port Pin Alternate Function PD5 OC1A (Timer/Counter1 Output Compare Match A Output) PCINT29 (Pin Change Interrupt 29) PD4 OC1B (Timer/Counter1 Output Compare Match B Output) XCK1 (USART1 External Clock Input/Output) PCINT28 (Pin Change Interrupt 28) PD3 INT1 (External Interrupt1 Input) TXD1 (USART1 Transmit Pin) PCINT27 (Pin Change Interrupt 27) PD2 INT0 (External Interrupt0 Input) RXD1 (USART1 Receive Pin) PCINT26 (Pin Change Interrupt 26) PD1 TXD0 (USART0 Transmit Pin) PCINT25 (Pin Change Interrupt 25) PD0 RXD0 (USART0 Receive Pin) T3 (Timer/Counter 3 External Counter Input) PCINT24 (Pin Change Interrupt 24) The alternate pin configuration is as follows: • OC2A/XCK2/SCK1/PCINT31 – Port D, Bit 7 – OC2A: Output Compare Match output. The PD7 pin can serve as an external output for the Timer/Counter2 Compare Match A. The PD7 pin has to be configured as an output (DDD7 set '1') to serve this function. The OC2A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function. – XCK2: USART2 External clock. The Data Direction Register (DDD7) controls whether the clock is output (DDD7 set “1”) or input (DDD7 cleared). The XCK2 pin is active only when the USART2 operates in Synchronous mode. – SCK1: Master Clock output, Slave Clock input pin for SPI1 channel. When the SPI1 is enabled as a Slave, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDD7. When the SPI1 is enabled as a Master, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDD7. – PCINT31: Pin Change Interrupt source 31. The PD7 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • ICP1/OC2B/SS1/PCINT30 – Port D, Bit 6 – ICP1: Input Capture Pin 1. The PD6 pin can act as an input capture pin for Timer/Counter1. – OC2B: Output Compare Match B output. The PD6 pin can serve as an external output for the Timer/Counter2 Output Compare B. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDD6 set '1') to serve this function. The OC2B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function. – SS1: Slave Port Select input. When the SPI1 is enabled as a slave, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDD6. As a slave, the SPI1 is activated when this pin is driven low. When the SPI1 is enabled as a master, the data direction of this pin is controlled Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 114 – • by DDD6. When the pin is forced to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTD6 bit. PCINT30: Pin Change Interrupt source 30. The PD6 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. OC1A/PCINT29 – Port D, Bit 5 – OC1A: Output Compare Match output. The PD5 pin can serve as an external output for the Timer/Counter1 Compare Match A. The PD5 pin has to be configured as an output (DDD5 set '1') to serve this function. The OC1A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function. – PCINT29: Pin Change Interrupt source 29. The PD4 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • OC1B/XCK1/PCINT28 – Port D, Bit 4 – OC1B: Output Compare Match B output. The PD4 pin can serve as an external output for the Timer/Counter1 Output Compare B. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDD4 set '1') to serve this function. The OC1B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function. – XCK1: USART1 external clock. – PCINT28: Pin Change Interrupt source 28. The PD4 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • INT1/TXD1/PCINT27 – Port D, Bit 3 – INT1: External Interrupt source 1. The PD3 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. – TXD1: Transmit Data (Data output pin for the USART). When the USART Transmitter is enabled, this pin is configured as an output regardless of the value of DDD3. – PCINT27: Pin Change Interrupt source 27. The PD3 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • INT0/RXD1/PCINT26 – Port D, Bit 2 – INT0: External Interrupt source 0. The PD2 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. – RXD1: Receive Data (Data input pin for the USART1). When the USART1 Receiver is enabled this pin is configured as an input regardless of the value of DDD2. When the USART forces this pin to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTD0 bit. – PCINT26: Pin Change Interrupt source 26. The PD2 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • TXD0/PCINT25 – Port D, Bit 1 – TXD0: Transmit Data (Data output pin for the USART0). When the USART0 Transmitter is enabled, this pin is configured as an output regardless of the value of DDD1. – PCINT25: Pin Change Interrupt source 25. The PD1 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. • RXD0/PCINT24 – Port D, Bit 0 – RXD0: Receive Data (Data input pin for the USART0). When the USART0 Receiver is enabled this pin is configured as an input regardless of the value of DDD0. When the USART forces this pin to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTD0 bit. – T3: Timer/Counter 3 External Counter Input – PCINT24: Pin Change Interrupt source 24. The PD0 pin can serve as an external interrupt source. The tables below relate the alternate functions of Port D to the overriding signals shown in Figure 16-5 Alternate Port Functions(1) on page 104. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 115 Table 16-13 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions PD7...PD4 (TBD) Signal PD7/OC2A/XCK2/SCK1/ Name PCINT31 PD6/ICP1/OC2B/SS1/ PCINT30 PD5/OC1A/PCINT29 PD4/OC1B/XCK1/ PCINT28 PUOE SPE1 • MSTR SPE1 • MSTR 0 0 PUO PORTD6 • PUD 0 0 DDOE SPE1 • MSTR SPE1 • MSTR 0 0 DDOV 0 0 0 0 PVOE SPE1 • MSTR OC2B ENABLE OC1A ENABLE OC1B ENABLE OC2B OC1A OC1B DIEOE PCINT31 • PCIE3 PCINT30 • PCIE3 PCINT29 • PCIE3 PCINT28 • PCIE3 DIEOV 1 1 1 1 DI SCK1 INPUT ICP1 INPUT PCINT29 INPUT T1 INPUT PCINT28 INPUT PCINT31 INPUT SPI1 SS – – PORTD7 • PUD OC2A ENABLE PVOV OC2A SCK1 OUTPUT PCINT30 INPUT AIO - - Table 16-14 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PD3...PD0 (TBD) Signal PD3/INT1/TXD1/PCINT27 Name PD2/INT0/RXD1/PCINT26 PD1/TXD0/PCINT25 PD0/T3/RXD0/PCINT24 PUOE TXEN1 RXEN1 TXEN0 RXEN0 PUO 0 PORTD2 • PUD 0 PORTD0 • PUD DDOE TXEN1 RXEN1 TXEN0 RXEN0 DDOV 1 0 1 0 PVOE TXEN1 0 TXEN0 0 PVOV TXD1 0 TXD0 0 INT2 ENABLE PCINT25 • PCIE3 PCINT24 • PCIE3 1 1 DIEOE INT1 ENABLE PCINT27 • PCIE3 DIEOV 1 PCINT26 • PCIE3 1 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 116 Signal PD3/INT1/TXD1/PCINT27 Name DI AIO 16.3.5. INT1 INPUT PCINT27 INPUT – PD2/INT0/RXD1/PCINT26 PD1/TXD0/PCINT25 PD0/T3/RXD0/PCINT24 PCINT25 INPUT RXD0 T4 INPUT PCINT24 INPUT – – INT0 INPUT RXD1 PCINT26 INPUT – Alternate Functions of Port E The Port E pins with alternate functions are shown in this table: Table 16-15 Port E Pins Alternate Functions Port Pin Alternate Function PE6 SCL1 (two-wire Serial Bus1 Clock Line) PE5 SDA1 (two-wire Serial Bus1 Data Input/Output Line)) PE4 AREF (Analog Reference Pin) PE3 TXD2 (USART2 Transmit Pin) MOSI1 (SPI Bus1 Master Output/Slave Input) PE2 RXD2 (USART2 Receive Pin) MISO1 (SPI Bus1 Master Input/Slave Output) PE1 XTAL1 (Chip Clock Oscillator pin 1) PE0 XTAL2 (Chip Clock Oscillator pin 2) The alternate pin configuration is as follows: • SCL1 – Port E, Bit 6 – SCL1: two-wire Serial Bus1 Clock Line. • SDA1 – Port E, Bit 5 – SDA1: two-wire Serial Bus1 Data Input/Output Line. • AREF – Port E, Bit 4 – AREF (Analog Reference Pin) • TXD2/MOSI1– Port E, Bit 3 – TXD2: Transmit Data (Data output pin for the USART2). When the USART2 Transmitter is enabled, this pin is configured as an output regardless of the value of DDE3. – MOSI1: SPI Master Data output, Slave Data input for SPI1 channel. When the SPI1 is enabled as a slave, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDE3. When the SPI1 is enabled as a master, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDE3. When the pin is forced to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTE3 bit. • RXD2/MISO1 – Port E, Bit 2 – RXD2: Receive Data (Data input pin for the USART2). When the USART2 receiver is enabled this pin is configured as an input regardless of the value of DDE2. When the USART forces this pin to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTE2 bit. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 117 – • • MISO1: Master Data input, Slave Data output pin for SPI1 channel. When the SPI1 is enabled as a master, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDE2. When the SPI1 is enabled as a slave, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDE2. When the pin is forced to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTE2 bit. XTAL1 – Port E, Bit 1 – XTAL1: Chip clock Oscillator pin 1. Used for all chip clock sources except internal calibrated RC Oscillator. When used as a clock pin, the pin can not be used as an I/O pin. XTAL2 – Port E, Bit 0 – XTAL2: Chip clock Oscillator pin 1. Used for all chip clock sources except internal calibrated RC Oscillator. When used as a clock pin, the pin can not be used as an I/O pin. Table 16-16 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PE6...PE3(TBD) on page 118 relate the alternate functions of Port E to the overriding signals shown in Figure 16-5 Alternate Port Functions(1) on page 104. Table 16-16 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PE6...PE3(TBD) Signal Name PE6/SCL1 PE5/SDA1 PE4/AREF PE3/TXD2/MOSI1 PUOE TWEN1 TWEN1 0 TXEN2+SPE1 • MSTR PUOV PORTE6 • PUD PORTE5 • PUD 0 PORTE3 • PUD DDOE TWEN1 TWEN1 0 TXEN2+SPE1 • MSTR PVOE 0 0 0 1 PVOV TWEN1 TWEN1 0 TXEN2+SPE1 • MSTR DIEOE SCL1 OUT SDA1 OUT 0 SPI1 MSTR OUTPUT DIEOV 1 1 0 1 DI SCL1 INPUT SDA1 INPUT 0 SPI1 SLAVE INPUT AIO - - - - Table 16-17 Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PE2...PE0(TBD) Signal Name PE2/RXD2/MISO1 PE1/XTAL1 PE0/XTAL2 PUOE RXEN2+SPE1 • MSTR 0 0 PUOV PORTE2 • PUD 0 0 DDOE RXEN2+SPE1 • MSTR 0 0 PVOE 0 0 0 PVOV RXEN2+SPE1 • MSTR 0 0 DIEOE SPI1 SLAVE OUTPUT 0 0 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 118 Signal Name PE2/RXD2/MISO1 PE1/XTAL1 PE0/XTAL2 DIEOV 1 0 0 DI RXD2 0 0 - - SPI1 MSTR INPUT AIO 16.4. - Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 119 16.4.1. MCU Control Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: MCUCR Offset: 0x55 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x35 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 1 0 JTD BODS BODSE PUD 3 2 IVSEL IVCE R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – JTD When this bit is zero, the JTAG interface is enabled if the JTAGEN Fuse is programmed. If this bit is one, the JTAG interface is disabled. In order to avoid unintentional disabling or enabling of the JTAG interface, a timed sequence must be followed when changing this bit: The application software must write this bit to the desired value twice within four cycles to change its value. Note that this bit must not be altered when using the On-chip Debug system. Bit 6 – BODS: BOD Sleep The BODS bit must be written to '1' in order to turn off BOD during sleep. Writing to the BODS bit is controlled by a timed sequence and the enable bit BODSE. To disable BOD in relevant sleep modes, both BODS and BODSE must first be written to '1'. Then, BODS must be written to '1' and BODSE must be written to zero within four clock cycles. The BODS bit is active three clock cycles after it is set. A sleep instruction must be executed while BODS is active in order to turn off the BOD for the actual sleep mode. The BODS bit is automatically cleared after three clock cycles. Bit 5 – BODSE: BOD Sleep Enable BODSE enables setting of BODS control bit, as explained in BODS bit description. BOD disable is controlled by a timed sequence. Bit 4 – PUD: Pull-up Disable When this bit is written to one, the pull-ups in the I/O ports are disabled even if the DDxn and PORTxn Registers are configured to enable the pull-ups ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b01). Bit 1 – IVSEL: Interrupt Vector Select When the IVSEL bit is cleared (zero), the Interrupt Vectors are placed at the start of the Flash memory. When this bit is set (one), the Interrupt Vectors are moved to the beginning of the Boot Loader section of the Flash. The actual address of the start of the Boot Flash Section is determined by the BOOTSZ Fuses. To avoid unintentional changes of Interrupt Vector tables, a special write procedure must be followed to change the IVSEL bit: 1. 2. Write the Interrupt Vector Change Enable (IVCE) bit to one. Within four cycles, write the desired value to IVSEL while writing a zero to IVCE. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 120 Interrupts will automatically be disabled while this sequence is executed. Interrupts are disabled in the cycle IVCE is set, and they remain disabled until after the instruction following the write to IVSEL. If IVSEL is not written, interrupts remain disabled for four cycles. The I-bit in the Status Register is unaffected by the automatic disabling. Note: If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Boot Loader section and Boot Lock bit BLB02 is programmed, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Application section and Boot Lock bit BLB12 is programed, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader section. Bit 0 – IVCE: Interrupt Vector Change Enable The IVCE bit must be written to logic one to enable change of the IVSEL bit. IVCE is cleared by hardware four cycles after it is written or when IVSEL is written. Setting the IVCE bit will disable interrupts, as explained in the IVSEL description above. See Code Example below. Assembly Code Example Move_interrupts: ; Get MCUCR in r16, MCUCR mov r17, r16 ; Enable change of Interrupt Vectors ori r16, (1<<IVCE) out MCUCR, r16 ; Move interrupts to Boot Flash section ori r17, (1<<IVSEL) out MCUCR, r17 ret C Code Example void Move_interrupts(void) { uchar temp; /* GET MCUCR*/ temp = MCUCR; /* Enable change of Interrupt Vectors */ MCUCR = temp|(1<<IVCE); /* Move interrupts to Boot Flash section */ MCUCR = temp|(1<<IVSEL); } Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 121 16.4.2. Port A Data Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: PORTA Offset: 0x22 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x02 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PORTA7 PORTA6 PORTA5 PORTA4 PORTA3 PORTA2 PORTA1 PORTA0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – PORTAn: Port A Data [n = 0:7] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 122 16.4.3. Port A Data Direction Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: DDRA Offset: 0x21 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x01 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DDRA7 DDRA6 DDRA5 DDRA4 DDRA3 DDRA2 DDRA1 DDRA0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – DDRAn: Port A Data Direction [n = 7:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 123 16.4.4. Port A Input Pins Address When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: PINA Offset: 0x20 Reset: N/A Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x00 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PINA7 PINA6 PINA5 PINA4 PINA3 PINA2 PINA1 PINA0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W x x x x x x x x Bits 7:0 – PINAn: Port A Input Pins Address [n = 7:0] Writing to the pin register provides toggle functionality for IO. Refer to Toggling the Pin on page 100. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 124 16.4.5. Port B Data Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: PORTB Offset: 0x25 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x05 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PORTB7 PORTB6 PORTB5 PORTB4 PORTB3 PORTB2 PORTB1 PORTB0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – PORTBn: Port B Data [n = 0:7] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 125 16.4.6. Port B Data Direction Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: DDRB Offset: 0x24 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x04 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DDRB7 DDRB6 DDRB5 DDRB4 DDRB3 DDRB2 DDRB1 DDRB0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – DDRBn: Port B Data Direction [n = 7:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 126 16.4.7. Port B Input Pins Address When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: PINB Offset: 0x23 Reset: N/A Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x03 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PINB7 PINB6 PINB5 PINB4 PINB3 PINB2 PINB1 PINB0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W x x x x x x x x Bits 7:0 – PINBn: Port B Input Pins Address [n = 7:0] Writing to the pin register provides toggle functionality for IO. Refer to Toggling the Pin on page 100. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 127 16.4.8. Port C Data Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: PORTC Offset: 0x28 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x08 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PORTC7 PORTC6 PORTC5 PORTC4 PORTC3 PORTC2 PORTC1 PORTC0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – PORTCn: Port C Data [n = 7:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 128 16.4.9. Port C Data Direction Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: DDRC Offset: 0x27 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x07 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DDRC7 DDRC6 DDRC5 DDRC4 DDRC3 DDRC2 DDRC1 DDRC0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – DDRCn: Port C Data Direction [n = 7:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 129 16.4.10. Port C Input Pins Address When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: PINC Offset: 0x26 Reset: N/A Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x06 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PINC7 PINC6 PINC5 PINC4 PINC3 PINC2 PINC1 PINC0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 x x x x x x x Bits 7:0 – PINCn: Port C Input Pins Address [n = 7:0] Writing to the pin register provides toggle functionality for IO. Refer to Toggling the Pin on page 100. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 130 16.4.11. Port D Data Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: PORTD Offset: 0x2B Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x0B Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PORTD7 PORTD6 PORTD5 PORTD4 PORTD3 PORTD2 PORTD1 PORTD0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – PORTDn: Port D Data [n = 7:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 131 16.4.12. Port D Data Direction Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: DDRD Offset: 0x2A Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x0A Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DDRD7 DDRD6 DDRD5 DDRD4 DDRD3 DDRD2 DDRD1 DDRD0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – DDRDn: Port D Data Direction [n = 7:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 132 16.4.13. Port D Input Pins Address When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: PIND Offset: 0x29 Reset: N/A Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x09 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PIND7 PIND6 PIND5 PIND4 PIND3 PIND2 PIND1 PIND0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W x x x x x x x x Bits 7:0 – PINDn: Port D Input Pins Address [n = 7:0] Writing to the pin register provides toggle functionality for IO. Refer to Toggling the Pin on page 100. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 133 16.4.14. Port E Data Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: PORTE Offset: 0x2E Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x0E Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PORTE6 PORTE5 PORTE4 PORTE3 PORTE2 PORTE1 PORTE0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 6:0 – PORTEn: Port E Data [n = 6:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 134 16.4.15. Port E Data Direction Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: DDRE Offset: 0x2D Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x0D Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DDRE6 DDRE5 DDRE4 DDRE3 DDRE2 DDRE1 DDRE0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 6:0 – DDREn: Port E Data Direction [n = 6:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 135 16.4.16. Port E Input Pins Address When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: PINE Offset: 0x2C Reset: N/A Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x0C Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PINE6 PINE5 PINE4 PINE3 PINE2 PINE1 PINE0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W x x x x x x x Bits 6:0 – PINEn: Port E Input Pins Address [n = 6:0] Writing to the pin register provides toggle functionality for IO. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 136 17. TC0 - 8-bit Timer/Counter with PWM 17.1. Features • • • • • • • Overview Timer/Counter0 (TC0) is a general purpose 8-bit Timer/Counter module, with two independent Output Compare Units, and PWM support. It allows accurate program execution timing (event management) and wave generation. A simplified block diagram of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is shown below. CPU accessible I/O Registers, including I/O bits and I/O pins, are shown in bold. The device-specific I/O Register and bit locations are listed in the Register Description. For the actual placement of I/O pins, refer to the pinout diagram. The TC0 is enabled by writing the PRTIM0 bit in ”Minimizing Power Consumption” to '0'. Figure 17-1 8-bit Timer/Counter Block Diagram Count Clear Direction TOVn (Int.Req.) Control Logic clkTn Clock Select Edge Detector TOP TCNTn Tn BOTTOM ( From Prescaler ) Timer/Counter = =0 OCnA (Int.Req.) Waveform Generation = OCnA OCRnA DATA BUS 17.2. Two independent Output Compare Units Double Buffered Output Compare Registers Clear Timer on Compare Match (Auto Reload) Glitch free, phase correct Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Variable PWM period Frequency generator Three independent interrupt sources (TOV0, OCF0A, and OCF0B) Fixed TOP Value OCnB (Int.Req.) Waveform Generation = OCnB OCRnB TCCRnA TCCRnB Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 137 17.2.1. Definitions Many register and bit references in this section are written in general form: • n=0..2 represents the Timer/Counter number • x=A,B represents the Output Compare Unit A or B However, when using the register or bit definitions in a program, the precise form must be used, i.e., TCNT0 for accessing Timer/Counter0 counter value. The following definitions are used throughout the section: Table 17-1 Definitions BOTTOM The counter reaches the BOTTOM when it becomes zero (0x0 for 8-bit counters, or 0x00 for 16-bit counters). 17.2.2. MAX The counter reaches its MAXimum when it becomes 0xF (decimal 15, for 8-bit counters) or 0xFF (decimal 255, for 16-bit counters). TOP The counter reaches the TOP when it becomes equal to the highest value in the count sequence. The TOP value can be assigned to be the fixed value MAX or the value stored in the OCRnA Register. The assignment is dependent on the mode of operation. Registers The Timer/Counter 0 register (TCNT0) and Output Compare TC0x registers (OCR0x) are 8-bit registers. Interrupt request (abbreviated to Int.Req. in the block diagram) signals are all visible in the Timer Interrupt Flag Register 0 (TIFR0). All interrupts are individually masked with the Timer Interrupt Mask Register 0 (TIMSK0). TIFR0 and TIMSK0 are not shown in the figure. The TC can be clocked internally, via the prescaler, or by an external clock source on the T0 pin. The Clock Select logic block controls which clock source and edge is used by the Timer/Counter to increment (or decrement) its value. The TC is inactive when no clock source is selected. The output from the Clock Select logic is referred to as the timer clock (clkT0). The double buffered Output Compare Registers (OCR0A and OCR0B) are compared with the Timer/ Counter value at all times. The result of the compare can be used by the Waveform Generator to generate a PWM or variable frequency output on the Output Compare pins (OC0A and OC0B). See Output Compare Unit on page 139 for details. The compare match event will also set the Compare Flag (OCF0A or OCF0B) which can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt request. Related Links Timer/Counter0 and Timer/Counter1,3,4 Prescalers on page 198 17.3. Timer/Counter Clock Sources The TC can be clocked by an internal or an external clock source. The clock source is selected by writing to the Clock Select (CS02:0) bits in the Timer/Counter Control Register (TCCR0B). 17.4. Counter Unit The main part of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is the programmable bi-directional counter unit. Below is the block diagram of the counter and its surroundings. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 138 Figure 17-2 Counter Unit Block Diagram TOVn (Int.Req.) DATA BUS Clock Select count clear TCNTn direction Control Logic clkTn Edge Detector Tn ( From Prescaler ) bottom top Depending of the mode of operation used, the counter is cleared, incremented, or decremented at each timer clock (clkT0). clkT0 can be generated from an external or internal clock source, selected by the Clock Select bits (CS0[2:0]). When no clock source is selected (CS0=0x0) the timer is stopped. However, the TCNT0 value can be accessed by the CPU, regardless of whether clkT0 is present or not. A CPU write overrides (has priority over) all counter clear or count operations. The counting sequence is determined by the setting of the WGM01 and WGM00 bits located in the Timer/ Counter Control Register (TCCR0A) and the WGM02 bit located in the Timer/Counter Control Register B (TCCR0B). There are close connections between how the counter behaves (counts) and how waveforms are generated on the Output Compare outputs OC0A and OC0B. For more details about advanced counting sequences and waveform generation, see Modes of Operation. The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set according to the mode of operation selected by the WGM02:0 bits. TOV0 can be used for generating a CPU interrupt. 17.5. Output Compare Unit The 8-bit comparator continuously compares TCNTn with the Output Compare Registers (OCRnA and OCRnB). Whenever TCNTn equals OCRnA or OCRnB, the comparator signals a match. A match will set the Output Compare Flag (OCFnA or OCFnB) at the next timer clock cycle. If the corresponding interrupt is enabled, the Output Compare Flag generates an Output Compare interrupt. The Output Compare Flag is automatically cleared when the interrupt is executed. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by software by writing a '1' to its I/O bit location. The Waveform Generator uses the match signal to generate an output according to operating mode set by the WGMn2, WGMn1, and WGMn0 bits and Compare Output mode (COMnx[1:0]) bits. The max and bottom signals are used by the Waveform Generator for handling the special cases of the extreme values in some modes of operation Figure 17-3 Output Compare Unit, Block Diagram DATA BUS OCRnx TCNTn = (8-bit Comparator ) OCFnx (Int.Req.) top bottom Waveform Generator OCnx FOCn WGMn1:0 COMnx1:0 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 139 The OCRnx Registers are double buffered when using any of the Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) modes. When double buffering is enabled, the CPU has access to the OCR0x Buffer Register. The double buffering synchronizes the update of the OCRnx Compare Registers to either top or bottom of the counting sequence. The synchronization prevents the occurrence of odd-length, non-symmetrical PWM pulses, thereby making the output glitch-free. The double buffering is disabled for the normal and Clear Timer on Compare (CTC) modes of operation, and the CPU will access the OCRnx directly. 17.5.1. Force Output Compare In non-PWM waveform generation modes, the match output of the comparator can be forced by writing a '1' to the Force Output Compare (FOCnx) bit. Forcing compare match will not set the OCFnx Flag or reload/clear the timer, but the OCnx pin will be updated as if a real compare match had occurred (the COMnx[1:0] bits define whether the OCnx pin is set, cleared or toggled). 17.5.2. Compare Match Blocking by TCNTn Write All CPU write operations to the TCNTn Register will block any compare match that occur in the next timer clock cycle, even when the timer is stopped. This feature allows OCRnx to be initialized to the same value as TCNTn without triggering an interrupt when the Timer/Counter clock is enabled. 17.5.3. Using the Output Compare Unit Since writing TCNTn in any mode of operation will block all compare matches for one timer clock cycle, there are risks involved when changing TCNTn when using the Output Compare Unit, independently of whether the Timer/Counter is running or not. If the value written to TCNTn equals the OCRnx value, the compare match will be missed, resulting in incorrect waveform generation. Similarly, do not write the TCNTn value equal to BOTTOM when the counter is down counting. The setup of the OCnx should be performed before setting the Data Direction Register for the port pin to output. The easiest way of setting the OCnx value is to use the Force Output Compare (FOCnx) strobe bits in Normal mode. The OCnx Registers keep their values even when changing between Waveform Generation modes. Be aware that the COMnx[1:0] bits are not double buffered together with the compare value. Changing the COMnx[1:0] bits will take effect immediately. 17.6. Compare Match Output Unit The Compare Output mode bits in the Timer/Counter Control Register A (TCCRnA.COMnx) have two functions: • • The Waveform Generator uses the COMnx bits for defining the Output Compare (OCnx) register state at the next compare match. The COMnx bits control the OCnx pin output source The figure below shows a simplified schematic of the logic affected by COMnx. The I/O Registers, I/O bits, and I/O pins in the figure are shown in bold. Only the parts of the general I/O port control registers that are affected by the COMnx bits are shown, namely PORT and DDR. On system reset the OCnx Register is reset to 0x00. Note: 'OCnx state' is always referring to internal OCnx registers, not the OCnx pin. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 140 Figure 17-4 Compare Match Output Unit, Schematic COMnx1 COMnx0 FOCn Waveform Generator D Q 1 OCnx DATA BUS D 0 OCnx Pin Q PORT D Q DDR clk I/O The general I/O port function is overridden by the Output Compare (OCnx) from the Waveform Generator if either of the COMnx[1:0] bits are set. However, the OCnx pin direction (input or output) is still controlled by the Data Direction Register (DDR) for the port pin. The In the Data Direction Register, the bit for the OCnx pin (DDR.OCnx) must be set as output before the OCnx value is visible on the pin. The port override function is independent of the Waveform Generation mode. The design of the Output Compare pin logic allows initialization of the OCnx register state before the output is enabled. Some COMnx[1:0] bit settings are reserved for certain modes of operation. The COMnx[1:0] bits have no effect on the Input Capture unit. 17.6.1. Compare Output Mode and Waveform Generation The Waveform Generator uses the TCCR0A.COM0x[1:0] bits differently in Normal, CTC, and PWM modes. For all modes, setting the TCCR0A.COM0x[1:0]=0x0 tells the Waveform Generator that no action on the OC0x Register is to be performed on the next compare match. Refer also to the descriptions of the output modes. A change of the TCCR0A.COM0x[1:0] bits state will have effect at the first compare match after the bits are written. For non-PWM modes, the action can be forced to have immediate effect by using the TCCR0C.FOC0x strobe bits. 17.7. Modes of Operation The mode of operation determines the behavior of the Timer/Counter and the Output Compare pins. It is defined by the combination of the Waveform Generation mode bits and Compare Output mode bits in the Timer/Counter control Registers A and B (TCCR0B.WGMn2, TCCR0A.WGM01, TCCR0A.WGM00, and TCCR0A.COM0x[1:0]). The Compare Output mode bits do not affect the counting sequence, while the Waveform Generation mode bits do. The COM0x[1:0] bits control whether the PWM output generated should be inverted or not (inverted or non-inverted PWM). For non-PWM modes the COM0x[1:0] bits control whether the output should be set, cleared, or toggled at a compare match (See previous section Compare Match Output Unit). For detailed timing information refer to the following section Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams. Related Links Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 141 Compare Match Output Unit on page 205 Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams on page 146 17.7.1. Normal Mode The simplest mode of operation is the Normal mode (WGM0[2:0] = 0x0). In this mode the counting direction is always up (incrementing), and no counter clear is performed. The counter simply overruns when it passes its maximum 8-bit value (TOP=0xFF) and then restarts from the bottom (0x00). In Normal mode operation, the Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) will be set in the same clock cycle in which the TCNT0 becomes zero. In this case, the TOV0 Flag behaves like a ninth bit, except that it is only set, not cleared. However, combined with the timer overflow interrupt that automatically clears the TOV0 Flag, the timer resolution can be increased by software. There are no special cases to consider in the Normal mode, a new counter value can be written anytime. The Output Compare unit can be used to generate interrupts at some given time. Using the Output Compare to generate waveforms in Normal mode is not recommended, since this will occupy too much of the CPU time. 17.7.2. Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) Mode In Clear Timer on Compare or CTC mode (WGM0[2:0]=0x2), the OCR0A Register is used to manipulate the counter resolution: the counter is cleared to ZERO when the counter value (TCNT0) matches the OCR0A. The OCR0A defines the top value for the counter, hence also its resolution. This mode allows greater control of the compare match output frequency. It also simplifies the counting of external events. The timing diagram for the CTC mode is shown below. The counter value (TCNT0) increases until a compare match occurs between TCNT0 and OCR0A, and then counter (TCNT0) is cleared. Figure 17-5 CTC Mode, Timing Diagram OCnx Interrupt Flag Set TCNTn OCn (Toggle) Period (COMnx1:0 = 1) 1 2 3 4 An interrupt can be generated each time the counter value reaches the TOP value by setting the OCF0A Flag. If the interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the TOP value. Note: Changing TOP to a value close to BOTTOM while the counter is running must be done with care, since the CTC mode does not provide double buffering. If the new value written to OCR0A is lower than the current value of TCNT0, the counter will miss the compare match. The counter will then count to its maximum value (0xFF for a 8-bit counter, 0xFFFF for a 16-bit counter) and wrap around starting at 0x00 before the compare match will occur. For generating a waveform output in CTC mode, the OC0A output can be set to toggle its logical level on each compare match by writing the two least significant Compare Output mode bits in the Timer/Counter Control Register A Control to toggle mode (TCCR0A.COM0A[1:0]=0x1). The OC0A value will only be visible on the port pin unless the data direction for the pin is set to output. The waveform generated will have a maximum frequency of fOC0 = fclk_I/O/2 when OCR0A is written to 0x00. The waveform frequency is defined by the following equation: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 142 �OCnx = �clk_I/O 2 ⋅ � ⋅ 1 + OCRnx N represents the prescaler factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024). As for the Normal mode of operation, the Timer/Counter Overflow Flag TOV0 is set in the same clock cycle that the counter wraps from MAX to 0x00. 17.7.3. Fast PWM Mode The Fast Pulse Width Modulation or Fast PWM modes (WGM0[2:0]=0x3 or WGM0[2:0]=0x7) provide a high frequency PWM waveform generation option. The Fast PWM modes differ from the other PWM options by their single-slope operation. The counter counts from BOTTOM to TOP, then restarts from BOTTOM. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM0[2:0]=0x3. TOP is defined as OCR0A when WGM[2:0]=0x7. In non-inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare register (OC0x) is cleared on the compare match between TCNT0 and OCR0x, and set at BOTTOM. In inverting Compare Output mode, the output is set on compare match and cleared at BOTTOM. Due to the single-slope operation, the operating frequency of the Fast PWM mode can be twice as high as the phase correct PWM modes, which use dual-slope operation. This high frequency makes the Fast PWM mode well suited for power regulation, rectification, and DAC applications. High frequency allows physically small sized external components (coils, capacitors), and therefore reduces total system cost. In Fast PWM mode, the counter is incremented until the counter value matches the TOP value. The counter is then cleared at the following timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the Fast PWM mode is shown below. The TCNT0 value is in the timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating the singleslope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal lines on the TCNT0 slopes mark compare matches between OCR0x and TCNT0. Figure 17-6 Fast PWM Mode, Timing Diagram OCRnx Interrupt Flag Set OCRnx Update and TOVn Interrupt Flag Set TCNTn OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2) OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3) Period 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set each time the counter reaches TOP. If the interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the compare value. In Fast PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the OC0x pins. Writing the TCCR0A.COM0x[1:0] bits to 0x2 will produce a non-inverted PWM; TCCRnA.COMnx[1:0]=0x3 will produce an inverted PWM output. Writing the TCCR0A.COM0A[1:0] bits to 0x1 allows the OC0A pin to toggle on Compare Matches if the TCCRnB.WGMn2 bit is set. This option is not available for the OC0B pin. The actual OC0x value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM waveform is generated by setting (or clearing) the OC0x Register at the compare Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 143 match between OCR0x and TCNT0, and clearing (or setting) the OC0x Register at the timer clock cycle the counter is cleared (changes from TOP to BOTTOM). The PWM frequency for the output can be calculated by the following equation: �OCnxPWM = �clk_I/O � ⋅ 256 N represents the prescale divider (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024). The extreme values for the OCR0A register represents special cases for PWM waveform output in the Fast PWM mode: If OCR0A is written equal to BOTTOM, the output will be a narrow spike for each MAX +1 timer clock cycle. Writing OCR0A=MAX will result in a constantly high or low output (depending on the polarity of the output set by the COM0A[1:0] bits.) A frequency waveform output with 50% duty cycle can be achieved in Fast PWM mode by selecting OC0x to toggle its logical level on each compare match (COM0x[1:0]=0x1). The waveform generated will have a maximum frequency of fOC0 = fclk_I/O/2 when OCR0A=0x00. This feature is similar to the OC0A toggle in CTC mode, except double buffering of the Output Compare unit is enabled in the Fast PWM mode. 17.7.4. Phase Correct PWM Mode The Phase Correct PWM mode (WGMWGM0[2:0]=0x1 or WGM0[2:0]=0x5) provides a high resolution, phase correct PWM waveform generation. The Phase Correct PWM mode is based on dual-slope operation: The counter counts repeatedly from BOTTOM to TOP, and then from TOP to BOTTOM. When WGM0[2:0]=0x1 TOP is defined as 0xFF. When WGM0[2:0]=0x5, TOP is defined as OCR0A. In noninverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OC0x) bit is cleared on compare match between TCNT0 and OCR0x while up-counting, and OC0x is set on the compare match while down-counting. In inverting Output Compare mode, the operation is inverted. The dual-slope operation has a lower maximum operation frequency than single slope operation. Due to the symmetric feature of the dual-slope PWM modes, these modes are preferred for motor control applications. In Phase Correct PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches TOP. When the counter reaches TOP, it changes the count direction. The TCNT0 value will be equal to TOP for one timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the Phase Correct PWM mode is shown below. The TCNT0 value is shown as a histogram for illustrating the dual-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNT0 slopes represent compare matches between OCR0x and TCNT0. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 144 Figure 17-7 Phase Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram OCnx Interrupt Flag Set OCRnx Update TOVn Interrupt Flag Set TCNTn OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2) OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3) Period 1 2 3 The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set each time the counter reaches BOTTOM. The Interrupt Flag can be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter reaches the BOTTOM value. In Phase Correct PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the OC0x pin. Writing the COM0x[1:0] bits to 0x2 will produce a non-inverted PWM. An inverted PWM output can be generated by writing COM0x[1:0]=0x3: Setting the Compare Match Output A Mode bit to '1' (TCCR0A.COM0A0) allows the OC0A pin to toggle on Compare Matches if the TCCR0B.WGM02 bit is set. This option is not available for the OC0B pin. The actual OC0x value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM waveform is generated by clearing (or setting) the OC0x Register at the compare match between OCR0x and TCNT0 when the counter increments, and setting (or clearing) the OC0x Register at compare match between OCR0x and TCNT0 when the counter decrements. The PWM frequency for the output when using Phase Correct PWM can be calculated by: �OCnxPCPWM = �clk_I/O � ⋅ 510 N represents the prescaler factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024). The extreme values for the OCR0A Register represent special cases when generating a PWM waveform output in the Phase Correct PWM mode: If the OCR0A register is written equal to BOTTOM, the output will be continuously low. If OCR0A is written to MAX, the output will be continuously high for non-inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values. At the very start of period 2 in the timing diagram above, OC0x has a transition from high to low even though there is no Compare Match. This transition serves to guarantee symmetry around BOTTOM. There are two cases that give a transition without Compare Match: • • OCR0x changes its value from MAX, as in the timing diagram. When the OCR0A value is MAX, the OC0 pin value is the same as the result of a down-counting Compare Match. To ensure symmetry around BOTTOM the OC0x value at MAX must correspond to the result of an up-counting Compare Match. The timer starts up-counting from a value higher than the one in OCR0x, and for that reason misses the Compare Match and consequently, the OC0x does not undergo the change that would have happened on the way up. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 145 17.8. Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams The Timer/Counter is a synchronous design and the timer clock (clkT0) is therefore shown as a clock enable signal in the following figures. If the given instance of the TC0 supports an asynchronous mode, clkI/O should be replaced by the TC oscillator clock. The figures include information on when interrupt flags are set. The first figure below illustrates timing data for basic Timer/Counter operation close to the MAX value in all modes other than Phase Correct PWM mode. Figure 17-8 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, no Prescaling clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O /1) TCNTn MAX - 1 MAX BOTTOM BOTTOM + 1 TOVn The next figure shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled. Figure 17-9 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8) clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O /8) TCNTn MAX - 1 MAX BOTTOM BOTTOM + 1 TOVn The next figure shows the setting of OCF0B in all modes and OCF0A in all modes (except CTC mode and PWM mode where OCR0A is TOP). Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 146 Figure 17-10 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCF0x, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8) clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O /8) TCNTn OCRnx - 1 OCRnx OCRnx OCRnx + 1 OCRnx + 2 OCRnx Value OCFnx The next figure shows the setting of OCF0A and the clearing of TCNT0 in CTC mode and fast PWM mode where OCR0A is TOP. Figure 17-11 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Clear Timer on Compare Match mode, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8) clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O /8) TCNTn (CTC) TOP - 1 OCRnx TOP BOTTOM BOTTOM + 1 TOP OCFnx 17.9. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 147 17.9.1. TC0 Control Register A When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: TCCR0A Offset: 0x44 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x24 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 1 0 COM0A1 COM0A0 COM0B1 COM0B0 3 2 WGM01 WGM00 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:6 – COM0An: Compare Output Mode for Channel A [n = 1:0] These bits control the Output Compare pin (OC0A) behavior. If one or both of the COM0A1:0 bits are set, the OC0A output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected to. However, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OC0A pin must be set in order to enable the output driver. When OC0A is connected to the pin, the function of the COM0A1:0 bits depends on the WGM02:0 bit setting. The table below shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to a normal or CTC mode (non- PWM). Table 17-2 Compare Output Mode, non-PWM COM0A1 COM0A0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC0A disconnected. 0 1 Toggle OC0A on Compare Match. 1 0 Clear OC0A on Compare Match. 1 1 Set OC0A on Compare Match . The table below shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM01:0 bits are set to fast PWM mode. Table 17-3 Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM(1) COM0A1 COM0A0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC0A disconnected. 0 1 WGM02 = 0: Normal Port Operation, OC0A Disconnected WGM02 = 1: Toggle OC0A on Compare Match 1 0 Clear OC0A on Compare Match, set OC0A at BOTTOM (non-inverting mode) 1 1 Set OC0A on Compare Match, clear OC0A at BOTTOM (inverting mode) Note: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 148 1. A special case occurs when OCR0A equals TOP and COM0A1 is set. In this case the compare match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at BOTTOM. Refer to Fast PWM Mode on page 143 for details. The table below shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to phase correct PWM mode. Table 17-4 Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct PWM Mode(1) COM0A1 COM0A0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC0A disconnected. 0 1 WGM02 = 0: Normal Port Operation, OC0A Disconnected. WGM02 = 1: Toggle OC0A on Compare Match. 1 0 Clear OC0A on Compare Match when up-counting. Set OC0A on Compare Match when down-counting. 1 1 Set OC0A on Compare Match when up-counting. Clear OC0A on Compare Match when down-counting. Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR0A equals TOP and COM0A1 is set. In this case, the Compare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. Refer to Phase Correct PWM Mode on page 144 for details. Bits 5:4 – COM0Bn: Compare Output Mode for Channel B [n = 1:0] These bits control the Output Compare pin (OC0B) behavior. If one or both of the COM0B1:0 bits are set, the OC0B output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected to. However, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OC0B pin must be set in order to enable the output driver. When OC0B is connected to the pin, the function of the COM0B1:0 bits depends on the WGM02:0 bit setting. The table shows the COM0B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to a normal or CTC mode (non- PWM). Table 17-5 Compare Output Mode, non-PWM COM0B1 COM0B0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC0B disconnected. 0 1 Toggle OC0B on Compare Match. 1 0 Clear OC0B on Compare Match. 1 1 Set OC0B on Compare Match. The table below shows the COM0B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to fast PWM mode. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 149 Table 17-6 Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM(1) COM0B1 COM0B0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC0B disconnected. 0 1 Reserved 1 0 Clear OC0B on Compare Match, set OC0B at BOTTOM, (non-inverting mode) 1 1 Set OC0B on Compare Match, clear OC0B at BOTTOM, (inverting mode) Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR0B equals TOP and COM0B1 is set. In this case, the Compare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. Refer to Fast PWM Mode on page 143 for details. The table below shows the COM0B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to phase correct PWM mode. Table 17-7 Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct PWM Mode(1) COM0B1 COM0B0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC0B disconnected. 0 1 Reserved 1 0 Clear OC0B on Compare Match when up-counting. Set OC0B on Compare Match when down-counting. 1 1 Set OC0B on Compare Match when up-counting. Clear OC0B on Compare Match when down-counting. Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR0B equals TOP and COM0B1 is set. In this case, the Compare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. Refer to Phase Correct PWM Mode on page 144 for details. Bits 1:0 – WGM0n: Waveform Generation Mode [n = 1:0] Combined with the WGM02 bit found in the TCCR0B Register, these bits control the counting sequence of the counter, the source for maximum (TOP) counter value, and what type of waveform generation to be used. Modes of operation supported by the Timer/Counter unit are: Normal mode (counter), Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) mode, and two types of Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) modes (see Modes of Operation on page 141). Table 17-8 Waveform Generation Mode Bit Description Mode WGM02 WGM01 WGM00 Timer/Counter Mode of Operation TOP Update of OCR0x at 0 0 0 1 0 0 2 0 1 3 0 1 4 1 0 TOV Flag Set on(1)(2) 0 Normal 0xFF Immediate MAX 1 PWM, Phase Correct 0xFF TOP BOTTOM 0 CTC OCRA Immediate MAX 1 Fast PWM 0xFF BOTTOM MAX 0 Reserved - - - Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 150 Mode WGM02 WGM01 WGM00 Timer/Counter Mode of Operation TOP Update of OCR0x at TOV Flag Set on(1)(2) 5 1 0 1 PWM, Phase Correct OCRA TOP BOTTOM 6 1 1 0 Reserved - - - 7 1 1 1 Fast PWM OCRA BOTTOM TOP Note: 1. MAX = 0xFF 2. BOTTOM = 0x00 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 151 17.9.2. TC0 Control Register B When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: TCCR0B Offset: 0x45 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x25 Bit Access Reset 7 6 3 2 1 0 FOC0A FOC0B 5 4 WGM02 CS02 CS01 CS00 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – FOC0A: Force Output Compare A The FOC0A bit is only active when the WGM bits specify a non-PWM mode. To ensure compatibility with future devices, this bit must be set to zero when TCCR0B is written when operating in PWM mode. When writing a logical one to the FOC0A bit, an immediate Compare Match is forced on the Waveform Generation unit. The OC0A output is changed according to its COM0A1:0 bits setting. The FOC0A bit is implemented as a strobe. Therefore it is the value present in the COM0A1:0 bits that determines the effect of the forced compare. A FOC0A strobe will not generate any interrupt, nor will it clear the timer in CTC mode using OCR0A as TOP. The FOC0A bit is always read as zero. Bit 6 – FOC0B: Force Output Compare B The FOC0B bit is only active when the WGM bits specify a non-PWM mode. To ensure compatibility with future devices, this bit must be set to zero when TCCR0B is written when operating in PWM mode. When writing a logical one to the FOC0B bit, an immediate Compare Match is forced on the Waveform Generation unit. The OC0B output is changed according to its COM0B1:0 bits setting. The FOC0B bit is implemented as a strobe. Therefore it is the value present in the COM0B1:0 bits that determines the effect of the forced compare. A FOC0B strobe will not generate any interrupt, nor will it clear the timer in CTC mode using OCR0B as TOP. The FOC0B bit is always read as zero. Bit 3 – WGM02: Waveform Generation Mode Refer to TCCR0A on page 148. Bits 2:0 – CS0n: Clock Select [n = 0..2] The three Clock Select bits select the clock source to be used by the Timer/Counter. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 152 Table 17-9 Clock Select Bit Description CA02 CA01 CS00 0 0 0 No clock source (Timer/Counter stopped). 1 clkI/O/1 (No prescaling) 0 Description 0 1 0 clkI/O/8 (From prescaler) 0 1 1 clkI/O/64 (From prescaler) 1 0 0 clkI/O/256 (From prescaler) 1 0 1 clkI/O/1024 (From prescaler) 1 1 0 External clock source on T0 pin. Clock on falling edge. 1 1 1 External clock source on T0 pin. Clock on rising edge. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 153 17.9.3. TC0 Interrupt Mask Register Name: TIMSK0 Offset: 0x6E Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCIE0B OCIE0A TOIE0 R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 Bit 2 – OCIE0B: Timer/Counter0, Output Compare B Match Interrupt Enable When the OCIE0B bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the Timer/Counter Compare Match B interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if a Compare Match in Timer/Counter occurs, i.e., when the OCF0B bit is set in TIFR0 on page 159. Bit 1 – OCIE0A: Timer/Counter0, Output Compare A Match Interrupt Enable When the OCIE0A bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the Timer/Counter0 Compare Match A interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if a Compare Match in Timer/Counter0 occurs, i.e., when the OCF0A bit is set in TIFR0 on page 159. Bit 0 – TOIE0: Timer/Counter0, Overflow Interrupt Enable When the TOIE0 bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the Timer/Counter0 Overflow interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if an overflow in Timer/Counter0 occurs, i.e., when the TOV0 bit is set in TIFR0 on page 159. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 154 17.9.4. General Timer/Counter Control Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: GTCCR Offset: 0x43 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x23 Bit Access Reset 1 0 TSM 7 6 5 4 3 2 PSRASY PSRSYNC R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 Bit 7 – TSM: Timer/Counter Synchronization Mode Writing the TSM bit to one activates the Timer/Counter Synchronization mode. In this mode, the value that is written to the PSRASY and PSRSYNC bits is kept, hence keeping the corresponding prescaler reset signals asserted. This ensures that the corresponding Timer/Counters are halted and can be configured to the same value without the risk of one of them advancing during configuration. When the TSM bit is written to zero, the PSRASY and PSRSYNC bits are cleared by hardware, and the Timer/ Counters start counting simultaneously. Bit 1 – PSRASY: Prescaler Reset Timer/Counter2 When this bit is one, the Timer/Counter2 prescaler will be reset. This bit is normally cleared immediately by hardware. If the bit is written when Timer/Counter2 is operating in asynchronous mode, the bit will remain one until the prescaler has been reset. The bit will not be cleared by hardware if the TSM bit is set. Bit 0 – PSRSYNC: Prescaler Reset When this bit is one, Timer/Counter1 and Timer/Counter0 prescaler will be Reset. This bit is normally cleared immediately by hardware, except if the TSM bit is set. Note that Timer/Counter1 and Timer/ Counter0 share the same prescaler and a reset of this prescaler will affect both timers. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 155 17.9.5. TC0 Counter Value Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: TCNT0 Offset: 0x46 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x26 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TCNT0[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – TCNT0[7:0]: TC0 Counter Value The Timer/Counter Register gives direct access, both for read and write operations, to the Timer/Counter unit 8-bit counter. Writing to the TCNT0 Register blocks (removes) the Compare Match on the following timer clock. Modifying the counter (TCNT0) while the counter is running, introduces a risk of missing a Compare Match between TCNT0 and the OCR0x Registers. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 156 17.9.6. TC0 Output Compare Register A When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: OCR0A Offset: 0x47 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x27 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCR0A[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – OCR0A[7:0]: Output Compare 0 A The Output Compare Register A contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the counter value (TCNT0). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to generate a waveform output on the OC0A pin. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 157 17.9.7. TC0 Output Compare Register B When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: OCR0B Offset: 0x48 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x28 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCR0B[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – OCR0B[7:0]: Output Compare 0 B The Output Compare Register B contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the counter value (TCNT0). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to generate a waveform output on the OC0B pin. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 158 17.9.8. T0 Interrupt Flag Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: TIFR0 Offset: 0x35 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x15 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCF0B OCF0A TOV0 R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 Bit 2 – OCF0B: Timer/Counter0, Output Compare B Match Flag The OCF0B bit is set when a Compare Match occurs between the Timer/Counter and the data in OCR0B – Output Compare Register0 B. OCF0B is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF0B is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE0B (Timer/Counter Compare B Match Interrupt Enable), and OCF0B are set, the Timer/ Counter Compare Match Interrupt is executed. Bit 1 – OCF0A: Timer/Counter0, Output Compare A Match Flag The OCF0A bit is set when a Compare Match occurs between the Timer/Counter0 and the data in OCR0A – Output Compare Register0. OCF0A is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF0A is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE0A (Timer/Counter0 Compare Match Interrupt Enable), and OCF0A are set, the Timer/ Counter0 Compare Match Interrupt is executed. Bit 0 – TOV0: Timer/Counter0, Overflow Flag The bit TOV0 is set when an overflow occurs in Timer/Counter0. TOV0 is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, TOV0 is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag. When the SREG I-bit, TOIE0 (Timer/Counter0 Overflow Interrupt Enable), and TOV0 are set, the Timer/Counter0 Overflow interrupt is executed. The setting of this flag is dependent of the WGM02:0 bit setting. Refer to Table 17-8 Waveform Generation Mode Bit Description on page 150. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 159 18. TC - 16-bit Timer/Counter with PWM 18.1. Features • • • • • • • • • • • • 18.2. Three 16-bit Timer/Counter instances TC1, TC3, TC4. True 16-bit Design (i.e., allows 16-bit PWM) Two independent Output Compare Units Double Buffered Output Compare Registers One Input Capture Unit Input Capture Noise Canceler Clear Timer on Compare Match (Auto Reload) Glitch-free, Phase Correct Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Variable PWM Period Frequency Generator External Event Counter Independent interrupt Sources (TOV, OCFA, OCFB, and ICF) Overview The 16-bit Timer/Counter unit allows accurate program execution timing (event management), wave generation, and signal timing measurement. A block diagram of the 16-bit Timer/Counter is shown below. CPU accessible I/O Registers, including I/O bits and I/O pins, are shown in bold. The device-specific I/O Register and bit locations are listed in Register Description on page 179. For the actual placement of I/O pins, refer to the Pin Configurations description. The Power Reduction TCn bit in the Power Reduction Register (PRR.PRTIMn) must be written to zero to enable the TCn module. Timer1 is in PRR , and Timer 3 and 4 are present in PRR1. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 160 Figure 18-1 16-bit Timer/Counter Block Diagram Count Clear Direction TOVn (Int.Req.) Control Logic Clock Select clkTn Edge Detector TOP BOTTOM ( From Prescaler ) Timer/Counter TCNTn Tn =0 = OCnA (Int.Req.) Waveform Generation = OCnA OCRnA OCnB (Int.Req.) DATA BUS Fixed TOP Values Waveform Generation = OCRnB OCnB ( From Analog Comparator Ouput ) ICFn (Int.Req.) Edge Detector ICRn Noise Canceler ICPn TCCRnA TCCRnB See the related links for actual pin placement. Related Links I/O-Ports on page 99 Pin Configurations on page 13 18.2.1. Definitions Many register and bit references in this section are written in general form: • n=1,3,4 represents the Timer/Counter number • x=A,B represents the Output Compare Unit A or B However, when using the register or bit definitions in a program, the precise form must be used, i.e., TCNT3 for accessing Timer/Counter 3 counter value. The following definitions are used extensively throughout the section: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 161 Table 18-1 Definitions BOTTOM The counter reaches the BOTTOM when it becomes zero (0x0 for 8-bit counters, or 0x00 for 16-bit counters). 18.2.2. MAX The counter reaches its MAXimum when it becomes 0xF (decimal 15, for 8-bit counters) or 0xFF (decimal 255, for 16-bit counters). TOP The counter reaches the TOP when it becomes equal to the highest value in the count sequence. The TOP value can be assigned to be the fixed value MAX or the value stored in the OCRnA Register. The assignment is dependent on the mode of operation. Registers The Timer/Counter (TCNTn), Output Compare Registers (OCRA/B), and Input Capture Register (ICRn) are all 16-bit registers. Special procedures must be followed when accessing the 16-bit registers. These procedures are described in section Accessing 16-bit Registers. The Timer/Counter Control Registers (TCCRnA/B) are 8-bit registers and have no CPU access restrictions. Interrupt requests (abbreviated to Int.Req. in the block diagram) signals are all visible in the Timer Interrupt Flag Register (TIFRn). All interrupts are individually masked with the Timer Interrupt Mask Register (TIMSKn). TIFRn and TIMSKn are not shown in the figure. The Timer/Counter can be clocked internally, via the prescaler, or by an external clock source on the Tn pin. The Clock Select logic block controls which clock source and edge the Timer/Counter uses to increment (or decrement) its value. The Timer/Counter is inactive when no clock source is selected. The output from the Clock Select logic is referred to as the timer clock (clkTn). The double buffered Output Compare Registers (OCRnA/B) are compared with the Timer/Counter value at all time. The result of the compare can be used by the Waveform Generator to generate a PWM or variable frequency output on the Output Compare pin (OCnA/B). See Output Compare Units. The compare match event will also set the Compare Match Flag (OCFnA/B) which can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt request. The Input Capture Register can capture the Timer/Counter value at a given external (edge triggered) event on either the Input Capture pin (ICPn) or on the Analog Comparator pins. The Input Capture unit includes a digital filtering unit (Noise Canceler) for reducing the chance of capturing noise spikes. The TOP value, or maximum Timer/Counter value, can in some modes of operation be defined by either the OCRnA Register, the ICRn Register, or by a set of fixed values. When using OCRnA as TOP value in a PWM mode, the OCRnA Register can not be used for generating a PWM output. However, the TOP value will in this case be double buffered allowing the TOP value to be changed in run time. If a fixed TOP value is required, the ICRn Register can be used as an alternative, freeing the OCRnA to be used as PWM output. 18.3. Accessing 16-bit Registers The TCNTn, OCRnA/B, and ICRn are 16-bit registers that can be accessed by the AVR CPU via the 8-bit data bus. The 16-bit register must be accessed byte-wise, using two read or write operations. Each 16-bit timer has a single 8-bit TEMP register for temporary storing of the high byte of the 16-bit access. The same temporary register is shared between all 16-bit registers within each 16-bit timer. Accessing the low byte triggers the 16-bit read or write operation: When the low byte of a 16-bit register is written by the CPU, the high byte that is currently stored in TEMP and the low byte being written are both copied into the 16-bit register in the same clock cycle. When the low byte of a 16-bit register is read by Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 162 the CPU, the high byte of the 16-bit register is copied into the TEMP register in the same clock cycle as the low byte is read, and must be read subsequently. Note: To perform a 16-bit write operation, the high byte must be written before the low byte. For a 16-bit read, the low byte must be read before the high byte. Not all 16-bit accesses uses the temporary register for the high byte. Reading the OCRnA/B 16-bit registers does not involve using the temporary register. 16-bit Access The following code examples show how to access the 16-bit Timer Registers assuming that no interrupts updates the temporary register. The same principle can be used directly for accessing the OCRnA/B and ICRn Registers. Note that when using C, the compiler handles the 16-bit access. Assembly Code Example ... ; Set TCNT01 to 0x01FF ldi r17,0x01 ldi r16,0xFF out TCNT01H,r17 out TCNT01L,r16 ; Read TCNT01 into r17:r16 in r16,TCNT01L in r17,TCNT01H ... The assembly code example returns the TCNT01 value in the r17:r16 register pair. C Code Example unsigned int i; ... /* Set TCNT01 to 0x01FF */ TCNT01 = 0x1FF; /* Read TCNT01 into i */ i = TCNT01; ... Atomic Read It is important to notice that accessing 16-bit registers are atomic operations. If an interrupt occurs between the two instructions accessing the 16-bit register, and the interrupt code updates the temporary register by accessing the same or any other of the 16-bit Timer Registers, then the result of the access outside the interrupt will be corrupted. Therefore, when both the main code and the interrupt code update the temporary register, the main code must disable the interrupts during the 16-bit access. The following code examples show how to perform an atomic read of the TCNT01 Register contents. The OCRnA/B or ICRn Registers can be ready by using the same principle. Assembly Code Example TIM16_ReadTCNT01: ; Save global interrupt flag in r18,SREG ; Disable interrupts cli Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 163 ; Read TCNT01 into r17:r16 in r16,TCNT01L in r17,TCNT01H ; Restore global interrupt flag out SREG,r18 ret The assembly code example returns the TCNT01 value in the r17:r16 register pair. C Code Example unsigned int TIM16_ReadTCNT01( void ) { unsigned char sreg; unsigned int i; /* Save global interrupt flag */ sreg = SREG; /* Disable interrupts */ _CLI(); /* Read TCNT01 into i */ i = TCNT01; /* Restore global interrupt flag */ SREG = sreg; return i; } Atomic Write The following code examples show how to do an atomic write of the TCNT01 Register contents. Writing any of the OCRnA/B or ICRn Registers can be done by using the same principle. Assembly Code Example TIM16_WriteTCNT01: ; Save global interrupt flag in r18,SREG ; Disable interrupts cli ; Set TCNT01 to r17:r16 out TCNT01H,r17 out TCNT01L,r16 ; Restore global interrupt flag out SREG,r18 ret The assembly code example requires that the r17:r16 register pair contains the value to be written to TCNT01. C Code Example void TIM16_WriteTCNT01( unsigned int i ) { unsigned char sreg; unsigned int i; /* Save global interrupt flag */ sreg = SREG; /* Disable interrupts */ _CLI(); /* Set TCNT01 to i */ Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 164 } TCNT01 = i; /* Restore global interrupt flag */ SREG = sreg; Related Links About Code Examples on page 17 18.3.1. Reusing the Temporary High Byte Register If writing to more than one 16-bit register where the high byte is the same for all registers written, the high byte only needs to be written once to TEMP. However, the same rule of atomic operation described previously also applies in this case. 18.4. Timer/Counter Clock Sources The Timer/Counter can be clocked by an internal or an external clock source. The clock source is selected by the Clock Select logic which is controlled by the Clock Select bits in the Timer/Counter control Register B (TCCRnB.CS[2:0]). Related Links Timer/Counter0 and Timer/Counter1,3,4 Prescalers on page 198 18.5. Counter Unit The main part of the 16-bit Timer/Counter is the programmable 16-bit bi-directional counter unit, as shown in the block diagram: Figure 18-2 Counter Unit Block Diagram DATA BUS (8-bit) TOVn (Int.Req.) TEMP (8-bit) Clock Select Count TCNTnH (8-bit) TCNTnL (8-bit) TCNTn (16-bit Counter) Clear Direction Control Logic clkTn Edge Detector Tn ( From Prescaler ) TOP BOTTOM Note: The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). Table 18-2 Signal description (internal signals) Signal Name Description Count Increment or decrement TCNTn by 1. Direction Select between increment and decrement. Clear Clear TCNTn (set all bits to zero). clkTn Timer/Counter clock. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 165 Signal Name Description TOP Signalize that TCNTn has reached maximum value. BOTTOM Signalize that TCNTn has reached minimum value (zero). The 16-bit counter is mapped into two 8-bit I/O memory locations: Counter High (TCNTnH) containing the upper eight bits of the counter, and Counter Low (TCNTnL) containing the lower eight bits. The TCNTnH Register can only be accessed indirectly by the CPU. When the CPU does an access to the TCNTnH I/O location, the CPU accesses the high byte temporary register (TEMP). The temporary register is updated with the TCNTnH value when the TCNTnL is read, and TCNTnH is updated with the temporary register value when TCNTnL is written. This allows the CPU to read or write the entire 16-bit counter value within one clock cycle via the 8-bit data bus. Note: That there are special cases when writing to the TCNTn Register while the counter is counting will give unpredictable results. These special cases are described in the sections where they are of importance. Depending on the selected mode of operation, the counter is cleared, incremented, or decremented at each timer clock (clkTn). The clock clkTn can be generated from an external or internal clock source, as selected by the Clock Select bits in the Timer/Countern Control Register B (TCCRnB.CS[2:0]). When no clock source is selected (CS[2:0]=0x0) the timer is stopped. However, the TCNTn value can be accessed by the CPU, independent of whether clkTn is present or not. A CPU write overrides (i.e., has priority over) all counter clear or count operations. The counting sequence is determined by the setting of the Waveform Generation mode bits in the Timer/ Counter Control Registers A and B (TCCRnB.WGM[3:2] and TCCRnA.WGM[1:0]). There are close connections between how the counter behaves (counts) and how waveforms are generated on the Output Compare outputs OC0x. For more details about advanced counting sequences and waveform generation, see Modes of Operation on page 171. The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag in the TCn Interrupt Flag Register (TIFRn.TOV) is set according to the mode of operation selected by the WGM[3:0] bits. TOV can be used for generating a CPU interrupt. 18.6. Input Capture Unit The Timer/Countern incorporates an Input Capture unit that can capture external events and give them a time-stamp indicating time of occurrence. The external signal indicating an event, or multiple events, can be applied via the ICPn pin or alternatively, via the analog-comparator unit. The time-stamps can then be used to calculate frequency, duty-cycle, and other features of the signal applied. Alternatively the timestamps can be used for creating a log of the events. The Input Capture unit is illustrated by the block diagram below. The elements of the block diagram that are not directly a part of the Input Capture unit are gray shaded. The lower case “n” in register and bit names indicates the Timer/Counter number. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 166 Figure 18-3 Input Capture Unit Block Diagram for TCn DATA BUS (8-bit) TEMP (8-bit) ICRnH (8-bit) WRITE ICRnL (8-bit) TCNTnH (8-bit) ACO* TCNTnL (8-bit) TCNTn (16-bit Counter) ICRn (16-bit Register) ACIC* Analog Comparator ICNC ICES Noise Canceler Edge Detector ICFn (Int.Req.) ICPn Figure 18-4 Input Capture Unit Block Diagram for Timer/Counter3 and Timer/Counter4 DATA BUS (8-bit) TEMP (8-bit) ICRnH (8-bit) WRITE ICPn ICRnL (8-bit) TCNTnH (8-bit) ICRn (16-bit Register) TCNTnL (8-bit) TCNTn (16-bit Counter) ICNC ICES Noise Canceler Edge Detector ICFn (Int.Req.) Note: The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). Note: Analog comparator can be used for only Timer/Counter1 and not applicable for Timer/Counter3 or Timer/Counter4. When a change of the logic level (an event) occurs on the Input Capture pin (ICPn), or alternatively on the Analog Comparator output (ACO), and this change confirms to the setting of the edge detector, a capture will be triggered: the 16-bit value of the counter (TCNTn) is written to the Input Capture Register (ICRn). The Input Capture Flag (ICF) is set at the same system clock cycle as the TCNTn value is copied into the ICRn Register. If enabled (TIMSKn.ICIE=1), the Input Capture Flag generates an Input Capture interrupt. The ICFn Flag is automatically cleared when the interrupt is executed. Alternatively the ICF Flag can be cleared by software by writing '1' to its I/O bit location. Reading the 16-bit value in the Input Capture Register (ICRn) is done by first reading the low byte (ICRnL) and then the high byte (ICRnH). When the low byte is read form ICRnL, the high byte is copied Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 167 into the high byte temporary register (TEMP). When the CPU reads the ICRnH I/O location it will access the TEMP Register. The ICRn Register can only be written when using a Waveform Generation mode that utilizes the ICRn Register for defining the counter’s TOP value. In these cases the Waveform Generation mode bits (WGM[3:0]) must be set before the TOP value can be written to the ICRn Register. When writing the ICRn Register, the high byte must be written to the ICRnH I/O location before the low byte is written to ICRnL. See also Accessing 16-bit Registers on page 162. 18.6.1. Input Capture Trigger Source The main trigger source for the Input Capture unit is the Input Capture pin (ICPn). Timer/Countern can alternatively use the Analog Comparator output as trigger source for the Input Capture unit. The Analog Comparator is selected as trigger source by setting the Analog Comparator Input Capture (ACIC) bit in the Analog Comparator Control and Status Register (ACSR). Be aware that changing trigger source can trigger a capture. The Input Capture Flag must therefore be cleared after the change. Both the Input Capture pin (ICPn) and the Analog Comparator output (ACO) inputs are sampled using the same technique as for the Tn pin. The edge detector is also identical. However, when the noise canceler is enabled, additional logic is inserted before the edge detector, which increases the delay by four system clock cycles. The input of the noise canceler and edge detector is always enabled unless the Timer/ Counter is set in a Waveform Generation mode that uses ICRn to define TOP. An Input Capture can be triggered by software by controlling the port of the ICPn pin. Related Links Timer/Counter0 and Timer/Counter1,3,4 Prescalers on page 198 18.6.2. Noise Canceler The noise canceler improves noise immunity by using a simple digital filtering scheme. The noise canceler input is monitored over four samples, and all four must be equal for changing the output that in turn is used by the edge detector. The noise canceler is enabled by setting the Input Capture Noise Canceler bit in the Timer/Counter Control Register B (TCCRnB.ICNC). When enabled, the noise canceler introduces an additional delay of four system clock cycles between a change applied to the input and the update of the ICRn Register. The noise canceler uses the system clock and is therefore not affected by the prescaler. 18.6.3. Using the Input Capture Unit The main challenge when using the Input Capture unit is to assign enough processor capacity for handling the incoming events. The time between two events is critical. If the processor has not read the captured value in the ICRn Register before the next event occurs, the ICRn will be overwritten with a new value. In this case the result of the capture will be incorrect. When using the Input Capture interrupt, the ICRn Register should be read as early in the interrupt handler routine as possible. Even though the Input Capture interrupt has relatively high priority, the maximum interrupt response time is dependent on the maximum number of clock cycles it takes to handle any of the other interrupt requests. Using the Input Capture unit in any mode of operation when the TOP value (resolution) is actively changed during operation, is not recommended. Measurement of an external signal’s duty cycle requires that the trigger edge is changed after each capture. Changing the edge sensing must be done as early as possible after the ICRn Register has been read. After a change of the edge, the Input Capture Flag (ICF) must be cleared by software (writing a Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 168 logical one to the I/O bit location). For measuring frequency only, the clearing of the ICF Flag is not required (if an interrupt handler is used). 18.7. Compare Match Output Unit The Compare Output mode (COMx1:0) bits have two functions. The Waveform Generator uses the COMx1:0 bits for defining the Output Compare (OCnx) state at the next compare match. Secondly the COMx1:0 bits control the OCnx pin output source. The figure below shows a simplified schematic of the logic affected by the COMx[1:0] bit setting. The I/O Registers, I/O bits, and I/O pins in the figure are shown in bold. Only the parts of the general I/O Port Control Registers (DDR and PORT) that are affected by the COMx[1:0] bits are shown. When referring to the OCnx state, the reference is for the internal OCnx Register, not the OCnx pin. If a system reset occur, the OCnx Register is reset to “0”. Figure 18-5 Compare Match Output Unit, Schematic COMnx1 COMnx0 FOCnx Waveform Generator D Q 1 OCnx DATA BUS D 0 OCnx Pin Q PORT D Q DDR clk I/O The general I/O port function is overridden by the Output Compare (OCnx) from the Waveform Generator if either of the COMx[1:0] bits are set. However, the OCnx pin direction (input or output) is still controlled by the Data Direction Register (DDR) for the port pin. The Data Direction Register bit for the OCnx pin (DDR_OCnx) must be set as output before the OCnx value is visible on the pin. The port override function is generally independent of the Waveform Generation mode, but there are some exceptions. The design of the Output Compare pin logic allows initialization of the OCnx state before the output is enabled. Note that some COMx[1:0] bit settings are reserved for certain modes of operation. The COMx[1:0] bits have no effect on the Input Capture unit. 18.7.1. Compare Output Mode and Waveform Generation The Waveform Generator uses the COMx[1:0] bits differently in normal, CTC, and PWM modes. For all modes, setting the COMx[1:0] = 0 tells the Waveform Generator that no action on the OCnx Register is to be performed on the next compare match. Refer also to the descriptions of the output modes. A change of the COMx[1:0] bits state will have effect at the first compare match after the bits are written. For non-PWM modes, the action can be forced to have immediate effect by using the FOCx strobe bits. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 169 18.8. Output Compare Units The 16-bit comparator continuously compares TCNTn with the Output Compare Register (OCRnx). If TCNT equals OCRnx the comparator signals a match. A match will set the Output Compare Flag (TIFRn.OCFx) at the next timer clock cycle. If enabled (TIMSKn.OCIEx = 1), the Output Compare Flag generates an Output Compare interrupt. The OCFx Flag is automatically cleared when the interrupt is executed. Alternatively the OCFx Flag can be cleared by software by writing a logical one to its I/O bit location. The Waveform Generator uses the match signal to generate an output according to operating mode set by the Waveform Generation mode (WGM[3:0]) bits and Compare Output mode (COMx[1:0]) bits. The TOP and BOTTOM signals are used by the Waveform Generator for handling the special cases of the extreme values in some modes of operation, see Modes of Operation on page 171. A special feature of Output Compare unit A allows it to define the Timer/Counter TOP value (i.e., counter resolution). In addition to the counter resolution, the TOP value defines the period time for waveforms generated by the Waveform Generator. Below is a block diagram of the Output Compare unit. The elements of the block diagram that are not directly a part of the Output Compare unit are gray shaded. Figure 18-6 Output Compare Unit, Block Diagram DATA BUS (8-bit) TEMP (8-bit) OCRnxH Buf. (8-bit) OCRnxL Buf. (8-bit) TCNTnH (8-bit) OCRnx Buffer (16-bit Register) OCRnxH (8-bit) TCNTnL (8-bit) TCNTn (16-bit Counter) OCRnxL (8-bit) OCRnx (16-bit Register) = (16-bit Comparator ) OCFnx (Int.Req.) TOP BOTTOM Waveform Generator WGMn3:0 OCnx COMnx1:0 Note: The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). The OCRnx Register is double buffered when using any of the twelve Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) modes. For the Normal and Clear Timer on Compare (CTC) modes of operation, the double buffering is disabled. The double buffering synchronizes the update of the OCRnx Compare Register to either TOP or BOTTOM of the counting sequence. The synchronization prevents the occurrence of odd-length, nonsymmetrical PWM pulses, thereby making the output glitch-free. When double buffering is enabled, the CPU has access to the OCRnx Buffer Register. When double buffering is disabled, the CPU will access the OCRnx directly. The content of the OCRnx (Buffer or Compare) Register is only changed by a write operation (the Timer/ Counter does not update this register automatically as the TCNTn and ICRn Register). Therefore OCRnx Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 170 is not read via the high byte temporary register (TEMP). However, it is good practice to read the low byte first as when accessing other 16-bit registers. Writing the OCRnx Registers must be done via the TEMP Register since the compare of all 16 bits is done continuously. The high byte (OCRnxH) has to be written first. When the high byte I/O location is written by the CPU, the TEMP Register will be updated by the value written. Then when the low byte (OCRnxL) is written to the lower eight bits, the high byte will be copied into the upper 8-bits of either the OCRnx buffer or OCRnx Compare Register in the same system clock cycle. For more information of how to access the 16-bit registers refer to Accessing 16-bit Registers on page 162. 18.9. Modes of Operation The mode of operation, i.e., the behavior of the Timer/Counter and the Output Compare pins, is defined by the combination of the Waveform Generation mode (WGM[3:0]) and Compare Output mode (TCCRnA.COMx[1:0]) bits. The Compare Output mode bits do not affect the counting sequence, while the Waveform Generation mode bits do. The TCCRnA.COMx[1:0] bits control whether the PWM output generated should be inverted or not (inverted or non-inverted PWM). For non-PWM modes the TCCRnA.COMx[1:0] bits control whether the output should be set, cleared, or toggle at a compare match. Related Links Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams on page 178 Compare Match Output Unit on page 169 18.9.1. Normal Mode The simplest mode of operation is the Normal mode (WGM[3:0]=0x0). In this mode the counting direction is always up (incrementing), and no counter clear is performed. The counter simply overruns when it passes its maximum 16-bit value (MAX=0xFFFF) and then restarts from BOTTOM=0x0000. In normal operation the Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TIFRn.TOV) will be set in the same timer clock cycle as the TCNTn becomes zero. In this case, the TOV Flag in behaves like a 17th bit, except that it is only set, not cleared. However, combined with the timer overflow interrupt that automatically clears the TOV Flag, the timer resolution can be increased by software. There are no special cases to consider in the Normal mode, a new counter value can be written anytime. The Input Capture unit is easy to use in Normal mode. However, observe that the maximum interval between the external events must not exceed the resolution of the counter. If the interval between events are too long, the timer overflow interrupt or the prescaler must be used to extend the resolution for the capture unit. The Output Compare units can be used to generate interrupts at some given time. Using the Output Compare to generate waveforms in Normal mode is not recommended, since this will occupy too much of the CPU time. 18.9.2. Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) Mode In Clear Timer on Compare or CTC modes (mode 4 or 12, WGM[3:0]=0x4 or 0xC), the OCRnA or ICRn registers are used to manipulate the counter resolution: the counter is cleared to ZERO when the counter value (TCNTn) matches either the OCRnA (if WGM[3:0]=0x4) or the ICRn (WGM[3:0]=0xC). The OCRnA or ICRn define the top value for the counter, hence also its resolution. This mode allows greater control of the compare match output frequency. It also simplifies the operation of counting external events. The timing diagram for the CTC mode is shown below. The counter value (TCNTn) increases until a compare match occurs with either OCRnA or ICRn, and then TCNTn is cleared. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 171 Figure 18-7 CTC Mode, Timing Diagram OCnA Interrupt Flag Set or ICFn Interrupt Flag Set (Interrupt on TOP) TCNTn OCnA (Toggle) Period (COMnA1:0 = 1) 1 2 3 4 Note: The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). An interrupt can be generated at each time the counter value reaches the TOP value by either using the OCFnA or ICFn Flag, depending on the actual CTC mode. If the interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the TOP value. Note: Changing TOP to a value close to BOTTOM while the counter is running must be done with care, since the CTC mode does not provide double buffering. If the new value written to OCRnA is lower than the current value of TCNTn, the counter will miss the compare match. The counter will then count to its maximum value (0xFF for a 8-bit counter, 0xFFFF for a 16-bit counter) and wrap around starting at 0x00 before the compare match will occur. In many cases this feature is not desirable. An alternative will then be to use the Fast PWM mode using OCRnA for defining TOP (WGM[3:0]=0xF), since the OCRnA then will be double buffered. For generating a waveform output in CTC mode, the OCnA output can be set to toggle its logical level on each compare match by setting the Compare Output mode bits to toggle mode (COMA[1:0]=0x1). The OCnA value will not be visible on the port pin unless the data direction for the pin is set to output (DDR_OCnA=1). The waveform generated will have a maximum frequency of fOCnA = fclk_I/O/2 when OCRnA is set to ZERO (0x0000). The waveform frequency is defined by the following equation: �OCnA = �clk_I/O 2 ⋅ � ⋅ 1 + OCRnA Note: • The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0). • N represents the prescaler factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024). As for the Normal mode of operation, the Timer Counter TOV Flag is set in the same timer clock cycle that the counter counts from MAX to 0x0000. 18.9.3. Fast PWM Mode The Fast Pulse Width Modulation or Fast PWM modes (modes 5, 6, 7, 14,and 15, WGM[3:0]= 0x5, 0x6, 0x7, 0xE, 0xF) provide a high frequency PWM waveform generation option. The Fast PWM differs from the other PWM options by its single-slope operation. The counter counts from BOTTOM to TOP then restarts from BOTTOM. In non-inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OCnx) is cleared on the compare match between TCNTn and OCRnx, and set at BOTTOM. In inverting Compare Output mode output is set on compare match and cleared at BOTTOM. Due to the single-slope operation, the operating frequency of the Fast PWM mode can be twice as high as the phase correct and phase and frequency correct PWM modes that use dual-slope operation. This high frequency makes the Fast PWM mode well suited for Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 172 power regulation, rectification, and DAC applications. High frequency allows physically small sized external components (coils, capacitors), hence reduces total system cost. The PWM resolution for Fast PWM can be fixed to 8-, 9-, or 10-bit, or defined by either ICRn or OCRnA. The minimum resolution allowed is 2-bit (ICRn or OCRnA register set to 0x0003), and the maximum resolution is 16-bit (ICRn or OCRnA registers set to MAX). The PWM resolution in bits can be calculated by using the following equation: �FPWM = log TOP+1 log 2 In Fast PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches either one of the fixed values 0x00FF, 0x01FF, or 0x03FF (WGM[3:0] = 0x5, 0x6, or 0x7), the value in ICRn (WGM[3:0]=0xE), or the value in OCRnA (WGM[3:0]=0xF). The counter is then cleared at the following timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the Fast PWM mode using OCRnA or ICRn to define TOP is shown below. The TCNTn value is in the timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating the single-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal lines on the TCNTn slopes mark compare matches between OCRnx and TCNTn. The OCnx Interrupt Flag will be set when a compare match occurs. Figure 18-8 Fast PWM Mode, Timing Diagram OCRnx/TOP Update and TOVn Interrupt Flag Set and OCnA Interrupt Flag Set or ICFn Interrupt Flag Set (Interrupt on TOP) TCNTn OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2) OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3) Period 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Note: The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOVn) is set each time the counter reaches TOP. In addition, when either OCRnA or ICRn is used for defining the TOP value, the OCnA or ICFn Flag is set at the same timer clock cycle TOVn is set. If one of the interrupts are enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the TOP and compare values. When changing the TOP value the program must ensure that the new TOP value is higher or equal to the value of all of the Compare Registers. If the TOP value is lower than any of the Compare Registers, a compare match will never occur between the TCNTn and the OCRnx. Note that when using fixed TOP values the unused bits are masked to zero when any of the OCRnx Registers are written. The procedure for updating ICRn differs from updating OCRnA when used for defining the TOP value. The ICRn Register is not double buffered. This means that if ICRn is changed to a low value when the counter is running with none or a low prescaler value, there is a risk that the new ICRn value written is lower than the current value of TCNTn. As result, the counter will miss the compare match at the TOP value. The counter will then have to count to the MAX value (0xFFFF) and wrap around starting at 0x0000 before the compare match can occur. The OCRnA Register however, is double buffered. This feature allows the OCRnA I/O location to be written anytime. When the OCRnA I/O location is written the Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 173 value written will be put into the OCRnA Buffer Register. The OCRnA Compare Register will then be updated with the value in the Buffer Register at the next timer clock cycle the TCNTn matches TOP. The update is done at the same timer clock cycle as the TCNTn is cleared and the TOVn Flag is set. Using the ICRn Register for defining TOP works well when using fixed TOP values. By using ICRn, the OCRnA Register is free to be used for generating a PWM output on OCnA. However, if the base PWM frequency is actively changed (by changing the TOP value), using the OCRnA as TOP is clearly a better choice due to its double buffer feature. In Fast PWM mode, the compare units allow generation of PWM waveforms on the OCnx pins. Writing the COMx[1:0] bits to 0x2 will produce an inverted PWM and a non-inverted PWM output can be generated by writing the COMx[1:0] to 0x3. The actual OCnx value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output (DDR_OCnx). The PWM waveform is generated by setting (or clearing) the OCnx Register at the compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn, and clearing (or setting) the OCnx Register at the timer clock cycle the counter is cleared (changes from TOP to BOTTOM). The PWM frequency for the output can be calculated by the following equation: �OCnxPWM = �clk_I/O � ⋅ 1 + TOP Note: • The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). • N represents the prescale divider (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024). The extreme values for the OCRnx registers represents special cases when generating a PWM waveform output in the Fast PWM mode. If the OCRnx is set equal to BOTTOM (0x0000) the output will be a narrow spike for each TOP+1 timer clock cycle. Setting the OCRnx equal to TOP will result in a constant high or low output (depending on the polarity of the output which is controlled by COMx[1:0]). A frequency waveform output with 50% duty cycle can be achieved in Fast PWM mode by selecting OCnA to toggle its logical level on each compare match (COMA[1:0]=0x1). This applies only if OCRnA is used to define the TOP value (WGM[3:0]=0xF). The waveform generated will have a maximum frequency of fOCnA = fclk_I/O/2 when OCRnA is set to zero (0x0000). This feature is similar to the OCnA toggle in CTC mode, except the double buffer feature of the Output Compare unit is enabled in the Fast PWM mode. 18.9.4. Phase Correct PWM Mode The Phase Correct Pulse Width Modulation or Phase Correct PWM modes (WGM[3:0]= 0x1, 0x2, 0x3, 0xA, and 0xB) provide a high resolution, phase correct PWM waveform generation option. The Phase Correct PWM mode is, like the phase and frequency correct PWM mode, based on a dual-slope operation. The counter counts repeatedly from BOTTOM (0x0000) to TOP and then from TOP to BOTTOM. In non-inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OCnx) is cleared on the compare match between TCNTn and OCRnx while up-counting, and set on the compare match while down-counting. In inverting Output Compare mode, the operation is inverted. The dual-slope operation has lower maximum operation frequency than single slope operation. However, due to the symmetric feature of the dual-slope PWM modes, these modes are preferred for motor control applications. The PWM resolution for the Phase Correct PWM mode can be fixed to 8-, 9-, or 10-bit, or defined by either ICRn or OCRnA. The minimum resolution allowed is 2-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to 0x0003), and the maximum resolution is 16-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to MAX). The PWM resolution in bits can be calculated by using the following equation: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 174 �PCPWM = log TOP+1 log 2 In Phase Correct PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches either one of the fixed values 0x00FF, 0x01FF, or 0x03FF (WGM[3:0]= 0x1, 0x2, or 0x3), the value in ICRn (WGM[3:0]=0xA), or the value in OCRnA (WGM[3:0]=0xB). The counter has then reached the TOP and changes the count direction. The TCNTn value will be equal to TOP for one timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the Phase Correct PWM mode is shown below, using OCRnA or ICRn to define TOP. The TCNTn value is in the timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating the dual-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal lines on the TCNTn slopes mark compare matches between OCRnx and TCNTn. The OCnx Interrupt Flag will be set when a compare match occurs. Figure 18-9 Phase Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram OCRnx/TOP Update and OCnA Interrupt Flag Set or ICFn Interrupt Flag Set (Interrupt on TOP) TOVn Interrupt Flag Set (Interrupt on Bottom) TCNTn OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2) OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3) Period 1 2 3 4 The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOVn) is set each time the counter reaches BOTTOM. When either OCRnA or ICRn is used for defining the TOP value, the OCnA or ICFn Flag is set accordingly at the same timer clock cycle as the OCRnx Registers are updated with the double buffer value (at TOP). The Interrupt Flags can be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter reaches the TOP or BOTTOM value. When changing the TOP value the program must ensure that the new TOP value is higher or equal to the value of all of the Compare Registers. If the TOP value is lower than any of the Compare Registers, a compare match will never occur between the TCNTn and the OCRnx. Note that when using fixed TOP values, the unused bits are masked to zero when any of the OCRnx registers is written. As illustrated by the third period in the timing diagram, changing the TOP actively while the Timer/Counter is running in the phase correct mode can result in an unsymmetrical output. The reason for this can be found in the time of update of the OCRnx Register. Since the OCRnx update occurs at TOP, the PWM period starts and ends at TOP. This implies that the length of the falling slope is determined by the previous TOP value, while the length of the rising slope is determined by the new TOP value. When these two values differ the two slopes of the period will differ in length. The difference in length gives the unsymmetrical result on the output. It is recommended to use the phase and frequency correct mode instead of the phase correct mode when changing the TOP value while the Timer/Counter is running. When using a static TOP value, there are practically no differences between the two modes of operation. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 175 In Phase Correct PWM mode, the compare units allow generation of PWM waveforms on the OCnx pins. Writing COMx[1:0] bits to 0x2 will produce a non-inverted PWM. An inverted PWM output can be generated by writing the COMx[1:0] to 0x3. The actual OCnx value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output (DDR_OCnx). The PWM waveform is generated by setting (or clearing) the OCnx Register at the compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn when the counter increments, and clearing (or setting) the OCnx Register at compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn when the counter decrements. The PWM frequency for the output when using Phase Correct PWM can be calculated by the following equation: �OCnxPCPWM = �clk_I/O 2 ⋅ � ⋅ TOP N represents the prescale divider (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024). The extreme values for the OCRnx Register represent special cases when generating a PWM waveform output in the Phase Correct PWM mode. If the OCRnx is set equal to BOTTOM the output will be continuously low and if set equal to TOP the output will be continuously high for non-inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values. If OCRnA is used to define the TOP value (WGM[3:0]=0xB) and COMA[1:0]=0x1, the OCnA output will toggle with a 50% duty cycle. 18.9.5. Phase and Frequency Correct PWM Mode The phase and frequency correct Pulse Width Modulation, or phase and frequency correct PWM mode (WGM[3:0] = 0x8 or 0x9) provides a high resolution phase and frequency correct PWM waveform generation option. The phase and frequency correct PWM mode is, like the phase correct PWM mode, based on a dual-slope operation. The counter counts repeatedly from BOTTOM (0x0000) to TOP and then from TOP to BOTTOM. In non-inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OCnx) is cleared on the compare match between TCNTn and OCRnx while up-counting, and set on the compare match while down-counting. In inverting Compare Output mode, the operation is inverted. The dual-slope operation gives a lower maximum operation frequency compared to the single-slope operation. However, due to the symmetric feature of the dual-slope PWM modes, these modes are preferred for motor control applications. The main difference between the phase correct, and the phase and frequency correct PWM mode is the time the OCRnx Register is updated by the OCRnx Buffer Register, (see Figure 18-9 Phase Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram on page 175 and the Timing Diagram below). The PWM resolution for the phase and frequency correct PWM mode can be defined by either ICRn or OCRnA. The minimum resolution allowed is 2-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to 0x0003), and the maximum resolution is 16-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to MAX). The PWM resolution in bits can be calculated using the following equation: �PFCPWM = log TOP+1 log 2 In phase and frequency correct PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches either the value in ICRn (WGM[3:0]=0x8), or the value in OCRnA (WGM[3:0]=0x9). The counter has then reached the TOP and changes the count direction. The TCNTn value will be equal to TOP for one timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the phase correct and frequency correct PWM mode is shown below. The figure shows phase and frequency correct PWM mode when OCRnA or ICRn is used to define TOP. The TCNTn value is in the timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating the dual-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNTn slopes represent compare matches between OCRnx and TCNTn. The OCnx Interrupt Flag will be set when a compare match occurs. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 176 Figure 18-10 Phase and Frequency Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram OCnA Interrupt Flag Set or ICFn Interrupt Flag Set (Interrupt on TOP) OCRnx/TOP Updateand TOVn Interrupt Flag Set (Interrupt on Bottom) TCNTn OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2) OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3) Period 1 2 3 4 Note: The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOVn) is set at the same timer clock cycle as the OCRnx Registers are updated with the double buffer value (at BOTTOM). When either OCRnA or ICRn is used for defining the TOP value, the OCnA or ICFn Flag set when TCNTn has reached TOP. The Interrupt Flags can then be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter reaches the TOP or BOTTOM value. When changing the TOP value the program must ensure that the new TOP value is higher or equal to the value of all of the Compare Registers. If the TOP value is lower than any of the Compare Registers, a compare match will never occur between the TCNTn and the OCRnx. As shown in the timing diagram above, the output generated is, in contrast to the phase correct mode, symmetrical in all periods. Since the OCRnx Registers are updated at BOTTOM, the length of the rising and the falling slopes will always be equal. This gives symmetrical output pulses and is therefore frequency correct. Using the ICRn Register for defining TOP works well when using fixed TOP values. By using ICRn, the OCRnA Register is free to be used for generating a PWM output on OCnA. However, if the base PWM frequency is actively changed by changing the TOP value, using the OCRnA as TOP is clearly a better choice due to its double buffer feature. In phase and frequency correct PWM mode, the compare units allow generation of PWM waveforms on the OCnx pins. Setting the COMx[1:0] bits to 0x2 will produce a non-inverted PWM and an inverted PWM output can be generated by setting the COMx[1:0] to 0x3 (See description of TCCRA.COMx). The actual OCnx value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output (DDR_OCnx). The PWM waveform is generated by setting (or clearing) the OCnx Register at the compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn when the counter increments, and clearing (or setting) the OCnx Register at compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn when the counter decrements. The PWM frequency for the output when using phase and frequency correct PWM can be calculated by the following equation: �OCnxPFCPWM = Note: �clk_I/O 2 ⋅ � ⋅ TOP Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 177 • • The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). N represents the prescale divider (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024). The extreme values for the OCRnx Register represents special cases when generating a PWM waveform output in the phase correct PWM mode. If the OCRnx is set equal to BOTTOM the output will be continuously low and if set equal to TOP the output will be set to high for non-inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values. If OCRnA is used to define the TOP value (WGM[3:0]=0x9) and COMA[1:0]=0x1, the OCnA output will toggle with a 50% duty cycle. 18.10. Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams The Timer/Counter is a synchronous design and the timer clock (clkTn) is therefore shown as a clock enable signal in the following figures. The figures include information on when Interrupt Flags are set, and when the OCRnx Register is updated with the OCRnx buffer value (only for modes utilizing double buffering). The first figure shows a timing diagram for the setting of OCFnx. Figure 18-11 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCFnx, no Prescaling clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O /1) TCNTn OCRnx - 1 OCRnx OCRnx OCRnx + 1 OCRnx + 2 OCRnx Value OCFnx Note: The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). The next figure shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled. Figure 18-12 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCFnx, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8) clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O /8) TCNTn OCRnx OCRnx - 1 OCRnx OCRnx + 1 OCRnx + 2 OCRnx Value OCFnx Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 178 Note: The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). The next figure shows the count sequence close to TOP in various modes. When using phase and frequency correct PWM mode the OCRnx Register is updated at BOTTOM. The timing diagrams will be the same, but TOP should be replaced by BOTTOM, TOP-1 by BOTTOM+1 and so on. The same renaming applies for modes that set the TOVn Flag at BOTTOM. Figure 18-13 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, no Prescaling. clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O /1) TCNTn (CTC and FPWM) TCNTn (PC and PFC PWM) TOP - 1 TOP BOTTOM TOP - 1 TOP TOP - 1 BOTTOM + 1 TOP - 2 TOVn (FPWM) and ICF n (if used as TOP) OCRnx (Update at TOP) New OCRnx Value Old OCRnx Value Note: The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). The next figure shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled. Figure 18-14 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8) clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O/8) TCNTn (CTC and FPWM) TCNTn (PC and PFC PWM) TOP - 1 TOP BOTTOM TOP - 1 TOP TOP - 1 BOTTOM + 1 TOP - 2 TOVn(FPWM) and ICF n (if used as TOP) OCRnx (Update at TOP) Old OCRnx Value New OCRnx Value Note: The “n” in the register and bit names indicates the device number (n = 0 for Timer/Counter 0), and the “x” indicates Output Compare unit (A/B). 18.11. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 179 18.11.1. TCn Control Register A Name: TCCR1A, TCCR3A, TCCR4A Offset: 0x80 + n*0x10 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 COMA[1:0] Access Reset 4 3 2 1 COMB[1:0] 0 WGM[1:0] R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:6 – COMA[1:0]: Compare Output Mode for Channel A [n = 1:0] Bits 5:4 – COMB[1:0]: Compare Output Mode for Channel B [n = 1:0] The COMA[1:0] and COMB[1:0] control the Output Compare pins (OCnA and OCnB respectively) behavior. If one or both of the COMA[1:0] bits are written to one, the OCnA output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected to. If one or both of the COMB[1:0] bit are written to one, the OCnB output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected to. However, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OCnA or OCnB pin must be set in order to enable the output driver. When the OCnA or OCnB is connected to the pin, the function of the COMx[1:0] bits is dependent of the WGM[3:0] bits setting. The table below shows the COMx[1:0] bit functionality when the WGM[3:0] bits are set to a Normal or a CTC mode (non-PWM). Table 18-3 Compare Output Mode, non-PWM COMA1/COMB1 COMA0/COMB0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OCnA/OCnB disconnected. 0 1 Toggle OCnA/OCnB on Compare Match. 1 0 Clear OCnA/OCnB on Compare Match (Set output to low level). 1 1 Set OCnA/OCnB on Compare Match (Set output to high level). The table below shows the COMx[1:0] bit functionality when the WGM[3:0] bits are set to the fast PWM mode. Table 18-4 Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM COMA1/ COMB1 COMA0/ COMB0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OCnA/OCnB disconnected. 0 1 WGM[3:0] = 14 or 15: Toggle OCnA on Compare Match, OCnB disconnected (normal port operation). For all other WGM settings, normal port operation, OCnA/OCnB disconnected. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 180 COMA1/ COMB1 COMA0/ COMB0 Description 1 0 Clear OCnA/OCnB on Compare Match, set OCnA/OCnB at BOTTOM (non-inverting mode) 1 1 Set OCnA/OCnB on Compare Match, clear OCnA/OCnB at BOTTOM (inverting mode) Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCRnA/OCRnB equals TOP and COMA1/COMB1 is set. In this case the compare match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at BOTTOM. Refer to Fast PWM Mode on page 172 for details. The table below shows the COMx[1:0] bit functionality when the WGM[3:0] bits are set to the phase correct or the phase and frequency correct, PWM mode. Table 18-5 Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct and Phase and Frequency Correct PWM COMA1/ COMB1 COMA0/ COMB0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OCnA/OCnB disconnected. 0 1 WGM[3:0] = 9 or 11: Toggle OCnA on Compare Match, OCnB disconnected (normal port operation). For all other WGM settings, normal port operation, OCnA/OCnB disconnected. 1 0 Clear OCnA/OCnB on Compare Match when up-counting. Set OCnA/ OCnB on Compare Match when down-counting. 1 1 Set OCnA/OCnB on Compare Match when up-counting. Clear OCnA/ OCnB on Compare Match when down-counting. Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCRnA/OCRnB equals TOP and COMA1/COMB1 is set. Refer to Phase Correct PWM Mode on page 174 for details. Bits 1:0 – WGM[1:0]: Waveform Generation Mode [n = 1:0] Combined with the WGM[3:2] bits found in the TCCRnB Register, these bits control the counting sequence of the counter, the source for maximum (TOP) counter value, and what type of waveform generation to be used. Modes of operation supported by the Timer/Counter unit are: Normal mode (counter), Clear Timer on Compare match (CTC) mode, and three types of Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) modes. (See Modes of Operation on page 171). Table 18-6 Waveform Generation Mode Bit Description Mode WGM3 WGM2 WGM1 WGM0 (CTC1)(1) (PWM11)(1) (PWM10)(1) Timer/ Counter TOP Update of TOV1 Flag OCRnx at Set on Mode of Operation 0 0 0 0 0 Normal 0xFFFF Immediate MAX 1 0 0 0 1 PWM, Phase Correct, 8-bit 0x00FF TOP BOTTOM 2 0 0 1 0 PWM, Phase Correct, 9-bit 0x01FF TOP BOTTOM Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 181 Mode WGM3 WGM2 WGM1 WGM0 (CTC1)(1) (PWM11)(1) (PWM10)(1) Timer/ Counter TOP Update of TOV1 Flag OCRnx at Set on Mode of Operation 3 0 0 1 1 PWM, Phase Correct, 10-bit 0x03FF TOP BOTTOM 4 0 1 0 5 0 1 0 0 CTC OCR4A Immediate MAX 1 Fast PWM, 8bit 0x00FF BOTTOM TOP 6 0 1 1 0 Fast PWM, 9bit 0x01FF BOTTOM TOP 7 0 1 1 1 Fast PWM, 10bit 0x03FF BOTTOM TOP 8 1 0 0 0 PWM, Phase and Frequency Correct ICR1 BOTTOM BOTTOM 9 1 0 0 1 PWM, Phase and Frequency Correct OCR4A BOTTOM BOTTOM 10 1 0 1 0 PWM, Phase Correct ICR1 TOP BOTTOM 11 1 0 1 1 PWM, Phase Correct OCR4A TOP BOTTOM 12 1 1 0 0 CTC ICR1 Immediate MAX 13 1 1 0 1 Reserved - - - 14 1 1 1 0 Fast PWM ICR1 BOTTOM TOP 15 1 1 1 1 Fast PWM OCR4A BOTTOM TOP Note: 1. The CTC1 and PWM1[1:0] bit definition names are obsolete. Use the WGM[2:0] definitions. However, the functionality and location of these bits are compatible with previous versions of the timer. 2. n=1,3,4. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 182 18.11.2. TCn Control Register B Name: TCCR1B, TCCR3B, TCCR4B Offset: 0x81 + n*0x10 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access 7 6 4 3 ICNC ICES WGM3 WGM2 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Reset 5 2 1 0 CS[2:0] Bit 7 – ICNC: Input Capture Noise Canceler Writing this bit to '1' activates the Input Capture Noise Canceler. When the noise canceler is activated, the input from the Input Capture pin (ICPn) is filtered. The filter function requires four successive equal valued samples of the ICPn pin for changing its output. The Input Capture is therefore delayed by four Oscillator cycles when the noise canceler is enabled. Bit 6 – ICES: Input Capture Edge Select This bit selects which edge on the Input Capture pin (ICPn) that is used to trigger a capture event. When the ICES bit is written to zero, a falling (negative) edge is used as trigger, and when the ICES bit is written to '1', a rising (positive) edge will trigger the capture. When a capture is triggered according to the ICES setting, the counter value is copied into the Input Capture Register (ICRn). The event will also set the Input Capture Flag (ICF), and this can be used to cause an Input Capture Interrupt, if this interrupt is enabled. When the ICRn is used as TOP value (see description of the WGM[3:0] bits located in the TCCRnA and the TCCRnB Register), the ICPn is disconnected and consequently the Input Capture function is disabled. Bit 4 – WGM3: Waveform Generation Mode bit 3 Refer to TCCR4A. Bit 3 – WGM2: Waveform Generation Mode bit 2 Refer to TCCR4A. Bits 2:0 – CS[2:0]: Clock Select The three Clock Select bits select the clock source to be used by the Timer/Counter. Refer to Figure 18-11 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCFnx, no Prescaling on page 178 and Figure 18-12 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCFnx, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8) on page 178. Table 18-7 Clock Select Bit Description CS[2] CS[1] CS[0] 0 0 0 No clock source (Timer/Counter stopped). 1 clkI/O/1 (No prescaling) 0 Description 0 1 0 clkI/O/8 (From prescaler) 0 1 1 clkI/O/64 (From prescaler) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 183 CS[2] CS[1] CS[0] Description 1 0 0 clkI/O/256 (From prescaler) 1 0 1 clkI/O/1024 (From prescaler) 1 1 0 External clock source on Tn pin. Clock on falling edge. 1 1 1 External clock source on Tn pin. Clock on rising edge. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 184 18.11.3. TCn Control Register C Name: TCCR1C, TCCR3C, TCCR4C Offset: 0x82 + n*0x10 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 FOCA FOCB R/W R/W 0 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 – FOCA: Force Output Compare for Channel A Bit 6 – FOCB: Force Output Compare for Channel B The FOCA/FOCB bits are only active when the WGM[3:0] bits specifies a non-PWM mode. When writing a logical one to the FOCA/FOCB bit, an immediate compare match is forced on the Waveform Generation unit. The OCnA/OCnB output is changed according to its COMx[1:0] bits setting. Note that the FOCA/ FOCB bits are implemented as strobes. Therefore it is the value present in the COMx[1:0] bits that determine the effect of the forced compare. A FOCA/FOCB strobe will not generate any interrupt nor will it clear the timer in Clear Timer on Compare match (CTC) mode using OCRnA as TOP. The FOCA/FOCB bits are always read as zero. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 185 18.11.4. TCn Counter Value Low byte Name: TCNT1L, TCNT3L, TCNT4L Offset: 0x84 + n*0x10 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TCNTL[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – TCNTL[7:0]: Timer/Counter Counter Value Low byte The two Timer/Counter I/O locations (TCNTH and TCNTL, combined TCNT) give direct access, both for read and for write operations, to the Timer/Counter unit 16-bit counter. To ensure that both the high and low bytes are read and written simultaneously when the CPU accesses these registers, the access is performed using an 8-bit temporary High Byte Register (TEMP). This temporary register is shared by all the other 16-bit registers. Refer to Accessing 16-bit Registers on page 162 for details. Modifying the counter (TCNT) while the counter is running introduces a risk of missing a compare match between TCNT and one of the OCRnx Registers. Writing to the TCNTn Register blocks (removes) the compare match on the following timer clock for all compare units. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 186 18.11.5. TCn Counter High byte Name: TCNT1H, TCNT3H, TCNT4H Offset: 0x85 + n*0x10 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TCNTH[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – TCNTH[7:0]: Timer/Counter n High byte Refer to TCNT4L. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 187 18.11.6. Input Capture Register n Low byte Name: ICR1L, ICR3L, ICR4L Offset: 0x86 + n*0x10 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ICRL[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – ICRL[7:0]: Input Capture Low byte The Input Capture is updated with the counter (TCNTn) value each time an event occurs on the ICPn pin (or optionally on the Analog Comparator output for Timer/Counter n). The Input Capture can be used for defining the counter TOP value. The Input Capture Register is 16-bit in size. To ensure that both the high and low bytes are read simultaneously when the CPU accesses these registers, the access is performed using an 8-bit temporary High Byte Register (TEMP). This temporary register is shared by all the other 16-bit registers. Refer to Accessing 16-bit Registers on page 162 for details. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 188 18.11.7. Input Capture Register n High byte Name: ICR1H, ICR3H, ICR4H Offset: 0x87 + n*0x10 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ICRH[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – ICRH[7:0]: Input Capture High byte Refer to ICR1L, ICR3L, ICR4L on page 188. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 189 18.11.8. Output Compare Register n A Low byte Name: OCR1AL, OCR3AL, OCR4AL Offset: 0x88 + n*0x10 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCRAL[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – OCRAL[7:0]: Output Compare n A Low byte The Output Compare Registers contain a 16-bit value that is continuously compared with the counter value (TCNTn). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to generate a waveform output on the OCnx pin. The Output Compare Registers are 16-bit in size. To ensure that both the high and low bytes are written simultaneously when the CPU writes to these registers, the access is performed using an 8-bit temporary High Byte Register (TEMP). This temporary register is shared by all the other 16-bit registers. Refer to Accessing 16-bit Registers on page 162 for details. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 190 18.11.9. Output Compare Register n A High byte Name: OCR1AH, OCR3AH, OCR4AH Offset: 0x89 + n*0x10 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCRAH[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – OCRAH[7:0]: Output Compare A High byte Refer to OCR1AL, OCR3AL, OCR4AL on page 190. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 191 18.11.10. Output Compare Register n B Low byte Name: OCR1BL, OCR3BL, OCR4BL Offset: 0x8A + n*0x10 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCRBL[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – OCRBL[7:0]: Output Compare B Low byte Refer to OCR4AL. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 192 18.11.11. Output Compare Register n B High byte Name: OCR1BH, OCR3BH, OCR4BH Offset: 0x8B + n*0x10 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCRBH[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – OCRBH[7:0]: Output Compare B High byte Refer to OCR4BL. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 193 18.11.12. Timer/Counter 1 Interrupt Mask Register Name: TIMSK1 Offset: 0x6F Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 2 1 0 ICIE 5 4 3 OCIEB OCIEA TOIE R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 Bit 5 – ICIE: Input Capture Interrupt Enable When this bit is written to '1', and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally enabled), the Timer/Counter1 Input Capture interrupt is enabled. The corresponding Interrupt Vector is executed when the ICF Flag, located in TIFR1, is set. Bit 2 – OCIEB: Output Compare B Match Interrupt Enable When this bit is written to '1', and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally enabled), the Timer/Counter Output Compare B Match interrupt is enabled. The corresponding Interrupt Vector is executed when the OCFB Flag, located in TIFR1, is set. Bit 1 – OCIEA: Output Compare A Match Interrupt Enable When this bit is written to '1', and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally enabled), the Timer/Counter Output Compare A Match interrupt is enabled. The corresponding Interrupt Vector is executed when the OCFA Flag, located in TIFR1, is set. Bit 0 – TOIE: Overflow Interrupt Enable When this bit is written to '1', and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally enabled), the Timer/Counter 1 Overflow interrupt is enabled. The corresponding Interrupt Vector is executed when the TOV Flag, located in TIFR1, is set. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 194 18.11.13. Timer/Counter n Interrupt Mask Register Name: TIMSK3, TIMSK4 Offset: 0x71 + n*0x01 [n=0..1] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 2 1 0 ICIE 5 4 3 OCIEB OCIEA TOIE R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 Bit 5 – ICIE: Input Capture Interrupt Enable When this bit is written to one, and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally enabled), the Timer/Counter n Input Capture interrupt is enabled. The corresponding Interrupt Vector is executed when the ICF Flag, located in TIFRn, is set. Bit 2 – OCIEB: Output Compare B Match Interrupt Enable When this bit is written to one, and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally enabled), the Timer/Counter n Output Compare B Match interrupt is enabled. The corresponding Interrupt Vector is executed when the OCFnB Flag, located in TIFRn, is set. Bit 1 – OCIEA: Output Compare A Match Interrupt Enable When this bit is written to one, and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally enabled), the Timer/Counter n Output Compare A Match interrupt is enabled. The corresponding Interrupt Vector is executed when the OCFnA Flag, located in TIFRn, is set. Bit 0 – TOIE: Overflow Interrupt Enable When this bit is written to one, and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally enabled), the Timer/Counter n Overflow interrupt is enabled. The corresponding Interrupt Vector is executed when the TOV Flag, located in TIFRn, is set. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 195 18.11.14. TC1 Interrupt Flag Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: TIFR1 Offset: 0x36 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x16 Bit Access Reset 7 6 2 1 0 ICF 5 4 3 OCFB OCFA TOV R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 Bit 5 – ICF: Input Capture Flag This flag is set when a capture event occurs on the ICP1 pin. When the Input Capture Register (ICR1) is set by the WGM[3:0] to be used as the TOP value, the ICF Flag is set when the counter reaches the TOP value. ICF is automatically cleared when the Input Capture Interrupt Vector is executed. Alternatively, ICF can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location. Bit 2 – OCFB: Output Compare B Match Flag This flag is set in the timer clock cycle after the counter (TCNT1) value matches the Output Compare Register B (OCR1B). Note that a Forced Output Compare (FOCB) strobe will not set the OCFB Flag. OCFB is automatically cleared when the Output Compare Match B Interrupt Vector is executed. Alternatively, OCFB can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location. Bit 1 – OCFA: Output Compare A Match Flag This flag is set in the timer clock cycle after the counter (TCNT1) value matches the Output Compare Register A (OCR1A). Note that a Forced Output Compare (FOCA) strobe will not set the OCFA Flag. OCFA is automatically cleared when the Output Compare Match A Interrupt Vector is executed. Alternatively, OCFA can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location. Bit 0 – TOV: Overflow Flag The setting of this flag is dependent of the WGM[3:0] bits setting. In Normal and CTC modes, the TOV Flag is set when the timer overflows. Refer to the Waveform Generation Mode bit description for the TOV Flag behavior when using another WGM[3:0] bit setting. TOV is automatically cleared when the Timer/Counter 1 Overflow Interrupt Vector is executed. Alternatively, TOV can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 196 18.11.15. TCn Interrupt Flag Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: TIFR3, TIFR4 Offset: 0x38 + n*0x01 [n=0..1] Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x18, 0x19 Bit Access Reset 7 6 2 1 0 ICF 5 4 3 OCFB OCFA TOV R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 Bit 5 – ICF: Input Capture Flag This flag is set when a capture event occurs on the ICPn pin. When the Input Capture Register (ICRn) is set by the WGM[3:0] to be used as the TOP value, the ICF Flag is set when the counter reaches the TOP value. ICF is automatically cleared when the Input Capture Interrupt Vector is executed. Alternatively, ICF can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location. Bit 2 – OCFB: Output Compare B Match Flag This flag is set in the timer clock cycle after the counter (TCNTn) value matches the Output Compare Register B (OCRnB). Note that a Forced Output Compare (FOCB) strobe will not set the OCFB Flag. OCFB is automatically cleared when the Output Compare Match B Interrupt Vector is executed. Alternatively, OCFB can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location. Bit 1 – OCFA: Output Compare A Match Flag This flag is set in the timer clock cycle after the counter (TCNTn) value matches the Output Compare Register A (OCRnA). Note that a Forced Output Compare (FOCA) strobe will not set the OCFA Flag. OCFA is automatically cleared when the Output Compare Match A Interrupt Vector is executed. Alternatively, OCFA can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location. Bit 0 – TOV: Overflow Flag The setting of this flag is dependent of the WGM[3:0] bits setting. In Normal and CTC modes, the TOV Flag is set when the timer overflows. Refer to the Waveform Generation Mode bit description for the TOV Flag behavior when using another WGM[3:0] bit setting. TOV is automatically cleared when the Timer/Counter n Overflow Interrupt Vector is executed. Alternatively, TOV can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 197 19. Timer/Counter0 and Timer/Counter1,3,4 Prescalers The 8-bit Timer/Counter0 (TC0) , 16-bit Timer/Counters 1,3,4 (TC1, TC3, TC4) share the same prescaler module, but the Timer/Counters can have different prescaler settings. The following description applies to TC0 , TC1, TC3 and TC4. Related Links 8-bit Timer/Counter0 with PWM on page 137 16-bit Timer/Counter1 with PWM on page 160 19.1. Internal Clock Source The Timer/Counter can be clocked directly by the system clock (by setting the CSn[2:0]=0x1). This provides the fastest operation, with a maximum Timer/Counter clock frequency equal to system clock frequency (fCLK_I/O). Alternatively, one of four taps from the prescaler can be used as a clock source. The prescaled clock has a frequency of either fCLK_I/O/8, fCLK_I/O/64, fCLK_I/O/256, or fCLK_I/O/1024. 19.2. Prescaler Reset The prescaler is free running, i.e., operates independently of the Clock Select logic of the Timer/Counter, and it is shared by Timer/Counter1 and Timer/Counter0. Since the prescaler is not affected by the Timer/ Counter’s clock select, the state of the prescaler will have implications for situations where a prescaled clock is used. One example of prescaling artifacts occurs when the timer is enabled and clocked by the prescaler (0x6 > CSn[2:0] > 0x1). The number of system clock cycles from when the timer is enabled to the first count occurs can be from 1 to N+1 system clock cycles, where N equals the prescaler divisor (8, 64, 256, or 1024). It is possible to use the prescaler reset for synchronizing the Timer/Counter to program execution. However, care must be taken if the other Timer/Counter that shares the same prescaler also uses prescaling. A prescaler reset will affect the prescaler period for all Timer/Counters it is connected to. 19.3. External Clock Source An external clock source applied to the T1/T0 pin can be used as Timer/Counter clock (clkT1/clkT0). The T1/T0 pin is sampled once every system clock cycle by the pin synchronization logic. The synchronized (sampled) signal is then passed through the edge detector. See also the block diagram of the T1/T0 synchronization and edge detector logic below. The registers are clocked at the positive edge of the internal system clock (clkI/O). The latch is transparent in the high period of the internal system clock. The edge detector generates one clkT1/clkT0 pulse for each positive (CSn[2:0]=0x7) or negative (CSn[2:0]=0x6) edge it detects. Figure 19-1 T1/T0 Pin Sampling Tn D Q D Q D Tn_sync (To Clock Select Logic) Q LE clk I/O Synchronization Edge Detector Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 198 The synchronization and edge detector logic introduces a delay of 2.5 to 3.5 system clock cycles from an edge has been applied to the T1/T0 pin to the counter is updated. Enabling and disabling of the clock input must be done when T1/T0 has been stable for at least one system clock cycle, otherwise it is a risk that a false Timer/Counter clock pulse is generated. Each half period of the external clock applied must be longer than one system clock cycle to ensure correct sampling. The external clock must be guaranteed to have less than half the system clock frequency (fExtClk < fclk_I/O/2) given a 50% duty cycle. Since the edge detector uses sampling, the maximum frequency of an external clock it can detect is half the sampling frequency (Nyquist sampling theorem). However, due to variation of the system clock frequency and duty cycle caused by the tolerances of the oscillator source (crystal, resonator, and capacitors), it is recommended that maximum frequency of an external clock source is less than fclk_I/O/2.5. An external clock source can not be prescaled. Figure 19-2 Prescaler for Timer/Counter0 and Timer/Counter1(1) clk I/O 10-BIT T/C PRESCALER CK/1024 CK/256 PSR10 CK/64 CK/8 Clear OFF Tn Synchronization CSn0 CSn1 CSn2 TIMER /COUNTERn CLOCK SOURCE clk Tn Note: 1. The synchronization logic on the input pins (T1/T0) is shown in the block diagram above. 19.4. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 199 19.4.1. General Timer/Counter Control Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: GTCCR Offset: 0x43 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x23 Bit Access Reset 1 0 TSM 7 6 5 4 3 2 PSRASY PSRSYNC R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 Bit 7 – TSM: Timer/Counter Synchronization Mode Writing the TSM bit to one activates the Timer/Counter Synchronization mode. In this mode, the value that is written to the PSRASY and PSRSYNC bits is kept, hence keeping the corresponding prescaler reset signals asserted. This ensures that the corresponding Timer/Counters are halted and can be configured to the same value without the risk of one of them advancing during configuration. When the TSM bit is written to zero, the PSRASY and PSRSYNC bits are cleared by hardware, and the Timer/ Counters start counting simultaneously. Bit 1 – PSRASY: Prescaler Reset Timer/Counter2 When this bit is one, the Timer/Counter2 prescaler will be reset. This bit is normally cleared immediately by hardware. If the bit is written when Timer/Counter2 is operating in asynchronous mode, the bit will remain one until the prescaler has been reset. The bit will not be cleared by hardware if the TSM bit is set. Bit 0 – PSRSYNC: Prescaler Reset When this bit is one, Timer/Counter1 and Timer/Counter0 prescaler will be Reset. This bit is normally cleared immediately by hardware, except if the TSM bit is set. Note that Timer/Counter1 and Timer/ Counter0 share the same prescaler and a reset of this prescaler will affect both timers. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 200 20. TC2 - 8-bit Timer/Counter2 with PWM and Asynchronous Operation 20.1. Features • • • • • • • Overview Timer/Counter2 (TC2) is a general purpose, singledual channel, 8-bit Timer/Counter module. A simplified block diagram of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is shown below. CPU accessible I/O Registers, including I/O bits and I/O pins, are shown in bold. The device-specific I/O Register and bit locations are listed in the following Register Description. For the actual placement of I/O pins, refer to the pinout diagram. The TC2 is enabled when the PRTIM2 bit in the Power Reduction Register (PRR.PRTIM2) is written to '1'. Figure 20-1 8-bit Timer/Counter Block Diagram Count Clear Direction TOVn (Int.Req.) Control Logic clkTn Clock Select Edge Detector TOP TCNTn Tn BOTTOM ( From Prescaler ) Timer/Counter = =0 OCnA (Int.Req.) Waveform Generation = OCnA OCRnA Fixed TOP Value DATA BUS 20.2. Dual Channel Counter Clear Timer on Compare Match (Auto Reload) Glitch-free, Phase Correct Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Frequency Generator 10-bit Clock Prescaler Overflow and Compare Match Interrupt Sources (TOV2, OCF2A, and OCF2B) Allows Clocking from External 32kHz Watch Crystal Independent of the I/O Clock OCnB (Int.Req.) Waveform Generation = OCnB OCRnB TCCRnA TCCRnB Related Links Pin Configurations on page 13 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 201 20.2.1. Definitions Many register and bit references in this section are written in general form: • n=0..2 represents the Timer/Counter number • x=A,B represents the Output Compare Unit A or B However, when using the register or bit definitions in a program, the precise form must be used, i.e., TCNT0 for accessing Timer/Counter0 counter value. The following definitions are used throughout the section: Table 20-1 Definitions BOTTOM The counter reaches the BOTTOM when it becomes zero (0x0 for 8-bit counters, or 0x00 for 16-bit counters). 20.2.2. MAX The counter reaches its MAXimum when it becomes 0xF (decimal 15, for 8-bit counters) or 0xFF (decimal 255, for 16-bit counters). TOP The counter reaches the TOP when it becomes equal to the highest value in the count sequence. The TOP value can be assigned to be the fixed value MAX or the value stored in the OCRnA Register. The assignment is dependent on the mode of operation. Registers The Timer/Counter (TCNT2) and Output Compare Register (OCR2A and OCR2B) are 8-bit registers. Interrupt request (shorten as Int.Req.) signals are all visible in the Timer Interrupt Flag Register (TIFR2). All interrupts are individually masked with the Timer Interrupt Mask Register (TIMSK2). TIFR2 and TIMSK2 are not shown in the figure. The Timer/Counter can be clocked internally, via the prescaler, or asynchronously clocked from the TOSC1/2 pins, as detailed later in this section. The asynchronous operation is controlled by the Asynchronous Status Register (ASSR). The Clock Select logic block controls which clock source he Timer/Counter uses to increment (or decrement) its value. The Timer/Counter is inactive when no clock source is selected. The output from the Clock Select logic is referred to as the timer clock (clkT2). The double buffered Output Compare Register (OCR2A and OCR2B) are compared with the Timer/ Counter value at all times. The result of the compare can be used by the Waveform Generator to generate a PWM or variable frequency output on the Output Compare pins (OC2A and OC2B). See Output Compare Unit on page 139 for details. The compare match event will also set the Compare Flag (OCF2A or OCF2B) which can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt request. 20.3. Timer/Counter Clock Sources The Timer/Counter can be clocked by an internal synchronous or an external asynchronous clock source: The clock source clkT2 is by default equal/synchronous to the MCU clock, clkI/O. When the Asynchronous TC2 bit in the Asynchronous Status Register (ASSR.AS2) is written to '1', the clock source is taken from the Timer/Counter Oscillator connected to TOSC1 and TOSC2. For details on asynchronous operation, see the description of the ASSR. For details on clock sources and prescaler, see Timer/Counter Prescaler. 20.4. Counter Unit The main part of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is the programmable bi-directional counter unit. Below is the block diagram of the counter and its surroundings. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 202 Figure 20-2 Counter Unit Block Diagram TOVn (Int.Req.) DATA BUS count TCNTn clear clk Tn Control Logic Prescaler 128kHz Watchdog oscillator direction bottom clkI/O top Table 20-2 Signal description (internal signals): count Increment or decrement TCNT2 by 1. direction Selects between increment and decrement. clear Clear TCNT2 (set all bits to zero). clkTn Timer/Counter clock, referred to as clkT2 in the following. top Signalizes that TCNT2 has reached maximum value. bottom Signalizes that TCNT2 has reached minimum value (zero). Depending on the mode of operation used, the counter is cleared, incremented, or decremented at each timer clock (clkT2). clkT2 can be generated from an external or internal clock source, selected by the Clock Select bits (CS2[2:0]). When no clock source is selected (CS2[2:0]=0x0) the timer is stopped. However, the TCNT2 value can be accessed by the CPU, regardless of whether clkT2 is present or not. A CPU write overrides (has priority over) all counter clear or count operations. The counting sequence is determined by the setting of the WGM21 and WGM20 bits located in the Timer/ Counter Control Register (TCCR2A) and the WGM22 bit located in the Timer/Counter Control Register B (TCCR2B). There are close connections between how the counter behaves (counts) and how waveforms are generated on the Output Compare outputs OC2A and OC2B. For more details about advanced counting sequences and waveform generation, see Modes of Operation. The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV2) is set according to the mode of operation selected by the TCC2B.WGM2[2:0] bits. TOV2 can be used for generating a CPU interrupt. 20.5. Output Compare Unit The 8-bit comparator continuously compares TCNT2 with the Output Compare Register (OCR2A and OCR2B). Whenever TCNT2 equals OCR2A or OCR2B, the comparator signals a match. A match will set the Output Compare Flag (OCF2A or OCF2B) at the next timer clock cycle. If the corresponding interrupt is enabled, the Output Compare Flag generates an Output Compare interrupt. The Output Compare Flag is automatically cleared when the interrupt is executed. Alternatively, the Output Compare Flag can be cleared by software by writing a logical one to its I/O bit location. The Waveform Generator uses the match signal to generate an output according to operating mode set by the WGM2[2:0] bits and Compare Output mode (COM2x[1:0]) bits. The max and bottom signals are used by the Waveform Generator for handling the special cases of the extreme values in some modes of operation (See Modes of Operation). The following figure shows a block diagram of the Output Compare unit. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 203 Figure 20-3 Output Compare Unit, Block Diagram DATA BUS TCNTn OCRnx = (8-bit Comparator ) OCFnx (Int.Req.) top bottom Waveform Generator OCnx FOCn WGMn1:0 COMnx1:0 The OCR2x Register is double buffered when using any of the Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) modes. For the Normal and Clear Timer on Compare (CTC) modes of operation, the double buffering is disabled. The double buffering synchronizes the update of the OCR2x Compare Register to either top or bottom of the counting sequence. The synchronization prevents the occurrence of odd-length, non-symmetrical PWM pulses, thereby making the output glitch-free. The OCR2x Register access may seem complex, but this is not case. When the double buffering is enabled, the CPU has access to the OCR2x Buffer Register, and if double buffering is disabled the CPU will access the OCR2x directly. Related Links Modes of Operation on page 141 20.5.1. Force Output Compare In non-PWM waveform generation modes, the match output of the comparator can be forced by writing a one to the Force Output Compare (FOC2x) bit. Forcing compare match will not set the OCF2x Flag or reload/clear the timer, but the OC2x pin will be updated as if a real compare match had occurred (the COM2x[1:0] bits settings define whether the OC2x pin is set, cleared or toggled). 20.5.2. Compare Match Blocking by TCNT2 Write All CPU write operations to the TCNT2 Register will block any compare match that occurs in the next timer clock cycle, even when the timer is stopped. This feature allows OCR2x to be initialized to the same value as TCNT2 without triggering an interrupt when the Timer/Counter clock is enabled. 20.5.3. Using the Output Compare Unit Since writing TCNT2 in any mode of operation will block all compare matches for one timer clock cycle, there are risks involved when changing TCNT2 when using the Output Compare channel, independently of whether the Timer/Counter is running or not. If the value written to TCNT2 equals the OCR2x value, the compare match will be missed, resulting in incorrect waveform generation. Similarly, do not write the TCNT2 value equal to BOTTOM when the counter is downcounting. The setup of the OC2x should be performed before setting the Data Direction Register for the port pin to output. The easiest way of setting the OC2x value is to use the Force Output Compare (FOC2x) strobe bit in Normal mode. The OC2x Register keeps its value even when changing between Waveform Generation modes. Be aware that the COM2x[1:0] bits are not double buffered together with the compare value. Changing the COM2x[1:0] bits will take effect immediately. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 204 20.6. Compare Match Output Unit The Compare Output mode (COM2x[1:0]) bits have two functions. The Waveform Generator uses the COM2x[1:0] bits for defining the Output Compare (OC2x) state at the next compare match. Also, the COM2x[1:0] bits control the OC2x pin output source. The following figure shows a simplified schematic of the logic affected by the COM2x[1:0] bit setting. The I/O Registers, I/O bits, and I/O pins in the figure are shown in bold. Only the parts of the general I/O Port Control Registers (DDR and PORT) that are affected by the COM2x[1:0] bits are shown. When referring to the OC2x state, the reference is for the internal OC2x Register, not the OC2x pin. Figure 20-4 Compare Match Output Unit, Schematic COMnx1 COMnx0 FOCn Waveform Generator D Q 1 OCnx DATA BUS D 0 OCnx Pin Q PORT D Q DDR clk I/O The general I/O port function is overridden by the Output Compare (OC2x) from the Waveform Generator if either of the COM2x1:0 bits are set. However, the OC2x pin direction (input or output) is still controlled by the Data Direction Register (DDR) for the port pin. The Data Direction Register bit for the OC2x pin (DDR_OC2x) must be set as output before the OC2x value is visible on the pin. The port override function is independent of the Waveform Generation mode. The design of the Output Compare pin logic allows initialization of the OC2x state before the output is enabled. Note that some COM2x[1:0] bit settings are reserved for certain modes of operation. See Register Description. Related Links Register Description on page 147 Modes of Operation on page 141 20.6.1. Compare Output Mode and Waveform Generation The Waveform Generator uses the COM2x[1:0] bits differently in normal, CTC, and PWM modes. For all modes, setting the COM2x[1:0] = 0 tells the Waveform Generator that no action on the OC2x Register is to be performed on the next compare match. Refer also to the descriptions of the output modes. A change of the COM2x[1:0] bits state will have effect at the first compare match after the bits are written. For non-PWM modes, the action can be forced to have immediate effect by using the FOC2x strobe bits. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 205 20.7. Modes of Operation The mode of operation, i.e., the behavior of the Timer/Counter and the Output Compare pins, is defined by the combination of the Waveform Generation mode (WGM2[2:0]) and Compare Output mode (COM2x[1:0]) bits. The Compare Output mode bits do not affect the counting sequence, while the Waveform Generation mode bits do. The COM2x[1:0] bits control whether the PWM output generated should be inverted or not (inverted or non-inverted PWM). For non-PWM modes the COM2x[1:0] bits control whether the output should be set, cleared, or toggled at a compare match (See Compare Match Output Unit). For detailed timing information refer to Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams. 20.7.1. Normal Mode The simplest mode of operation is the Normal mode (WGM22:0 = 0). In this mode the counting direction is always up (incrementing), and no counter clear is performed. The counter simply overruns when it passes its maximum 8-bit value (TOP = 0xFF) and then restarts from the bottom (0x00). In normal operation the Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV2) will be set in the same timer clock cycle as the TCNT2 becomes zero. The TOV2 Flag in this case behaves like a ninth bit, except that it is only set, not cleared. However, combined with the timer overflow interrupt that automatically clears the TOV2 Flag, the timer resolution can be increased by software. There are no special cases to consider in the Normal mode, a new counter value can be written anytime. The Output Compare unit can be used to generate interrupts at some given time. Using the Output Compare to generate waveforms in Normal mode is not recommended, since this will occupy too much of the CPU time. 20.7.2. Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) Mode In Clear Timer on Compare or CTC mode (WGM22:0 = 2), the OCR2A Register is used to manipulate the counter resolution. In CTC mode the counter is cleared to zero when the counter value (TCNT2) matches the OCR2A. The OCR2A defines the top value for the counter, hence also its resolution. This mode allows greater control of the compare match output frequency. It also simplifies the operation of counting external events. The timing diagram for the CTC mode is as follows. The counter value (TCNT2) increases until a compare match occurs between TCNT2 and OCR2A, and then counter (TCNT2) is cleared. Figure 20-5 CTC Mode, Timing Diagram OCnx Interrupt Flag Set TCNTn OCn (Toggle) Period (COMnx1:0 = 1) 1 2 3 4 An interrupt can be generated each time the counter value reaches the TOP value by using the OCF2A Flag. If the interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the TOP value. However, changing TOP to a value close to BOTTOM when the counter is running with none or a low prescaler value must be done with care since the CTC mode does not have the double buffering feature. If the new value written to OCR2A is lower than the current value of TCNT2, the counter will miss the Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 206 compare match. The counter will then have to count to its maximum value (0xFF) and wrap around starting at 0x00 before the compare match can occur. For generating a waveform output in CTC mode, the OC2A output can be set to toggle its logical level on each compare match by setting the Compare Output mode bits to toggle mode (COM2A1:0 = 1). The OC2A value will not be visible on the port pin unless the data direction for the pin is set to output. The waveform generated will have a maximum frequency of fOC2A = fclk_I/O/2 when OCR2A is set to zero (0x00). The waveform frequency is defined by the following equation: �OCnx = �clk_I/O 2 ⋅ � ⋅ 1 + OCRnx The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 32, 64, 128, 256, or 1024). As for the Normal mode of operation, the TOV2 Flag is set in the same timer clock cycle that the counter counts from MAX to 0x00. 20.7.3. Fast PWM Mode The fast Pulse Width Modulation or fast PWM mode (WGM22:0 = 3 or 7) provides a high frequency PWM waveform generation option. The fast PWM differs from the other PWM option by its single-slope operation. The counter counts from BOTTOM to TOP then restarts from BOTTOM. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM2:0 = 3, and OCR2A when MGM2:0 = 7. In non-inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OC2x) is cleared on the compare match between TCNT2 and OCR2x, and set at BOTTOM. In inverting Compare Output mode, the output is set on compare match and cleared at BOTTOM. Due to the single-slope operation, the operating frequency of the fast PWM mode can be twice as high as the phase correct PWM mode that uses dual-slope operation. This high frequency makes the fast PWM mode well suited for power regulation, rectification, and DAC applications. High frequency allows physically small sized external components (coils, capacitors), and therefore reduces total system cost. In fast PWM mode, the counter is incremented until the counter value matches the TOP value. The counter is then cleared at the following timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the fast PWM mode is depicted in the following figure. The TCNT2 value is in the timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating the single-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNT2 slopes represent compare matches between OCR2x and TCNT2. Figure 20-6 Fast PWM Mode, Timing Diagram OCRnx Interrupt Flag Set OCRnx Update and TOVn Interrupt Flag Set TCNTn OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2) OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3) Period 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 207 The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV2) is set each time the counter reaches TOP. If the interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the compare value. In fast PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the OC2x pin. Setting the COM2x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and an inverted PWM output can be generated by setting the COM2x1:0 to three. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM2:0 = 3, and OCR2A when MGM2:0 = 7. The actual OC2x value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM waveform is generated by setting (or clearing) the OC2x Register at the compare match between OCR2x and TCNT2, and clearing (or setting) the OC2x Register at the timer clock cycle the counter is cleared (changes from TOP to BOTTOM). The PWM frequency for the output can be calculated by the following equation: �OCnxPWM = �clk_I/O � ⋅ 256 The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 32, 64, 128, 256, or 1024). The extreme values for the OCR2A Register represent special cases when generating a PWM waveform output in the fast PWM mode. If the OCR2A is set equal to BOTTOM, the output will be a narrow spike for each MAX+1 timer clock cycle. Setting the OCR2A equal to MAX will result in a constantly high or low output (depending on the polarity of the output set by the COM2A1:0 bits.) A frequency (with 50% duty cycle) waveform output in fast PWM mode can be achieved by setting OC2x to toggle its logical level on each compare match (COM2x1:0 = 1). The waveform generated will have a maximum frequency of foc2 = fclk_I/O/2 when OCR2A is set to zero. This feature is similar to the OC2A toggle in CTC mode, except the double buffer feature of the Output Compare unit is enabled in the fast PWM mode. 20.7.4. Phase Correct PWM Mode The phase correct PWM mode (WGM22:0 = 1 or 5) provides a high resolution phase correct PWM waveform generation option. The phase correct PWM mode is based on a dual-slope operation. The counter counts repeatedly from BOTTOM to TOP and then from TOP to BOTTOM. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM2:0 = 3, and OCR2A when MGM2:0 = 7. In non-inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OC2x) is cleared on the compare match between TCNT2 and OCR2x while upcounting, and set on the compare match while downcounting. In inverting Output Compare mode, the operation is inverted. The dual-slope operation has lower maximum operation frequency than single slope operation. However, due to the symmetric feature of the dual-slope PWM modes, these modes are preferred for motor control applications. In phase correct PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches TOP. When the counter reaches TOP, it changes the count direction. The TCNT2 value will be equal to TOP for one timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the phase correct PWM mode is shown on Figure 20-7 Phase Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram on page 209. The TCNT2 value is in the timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating the dual-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNT2 slopes represent compare matches between OCR2x and TCNT2. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 208 Figure 20-7 Phase Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram OCnx Interrupt Flag Set OCRnx Update TOVn Interrupt Flag Set TCNTn OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2) OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3) Period 1 2 3 The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV2) is set each time the counter reaches BOTTOM. The Interrupt Flag can be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter reaches the BOTTOM value. In phase correct PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the OC2x pin. Setting the COM2x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM. An inverted PWM output can be generated by setting the COM2x1:0 to three. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM2:0 = 3, and OCR2A when MGM2:0 = 7. The actual OC2x value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM waveform is generated by clearing (or setting) the OC2x Register at the compare match between OCR2x and TCNT2 when the counter increments, and setting (or clearing) the OC2x Register at compare match between OCR2x and TCNT2 when the counter decrements. The PWM frequency for the output when using phase correct PWM can be calculated by the following equation: �OCnxPCPWM = �clk_I/O � ⋅ 510 The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 32, 64, 128, 256, or 1024). The extreme values for the OCR2A Register represent special cases when generating a PWM waveform output in the phase correct PWM mode. If the OCR2A is set equal to BOTTOM, the output will be continuously low and if set equal to MAX the output will be continuously high for non-inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values. Note: 1. At the very start of period 2 in the above figure OCnx has a transition from high to low even though there is no Compare Match. The point of this transition is to guarantee symmetry around BOTTOM. There are two cases that give a transition without Compare Match. • OCR2A changes its value from MAX, as shown in the preceeding figure. When the OCR2A value is MAX the OCn pin value is the same as the result of a down-counting compare match. To ensure symmetry around BOTTOM the OCn value at MAX must correspond to the result of an up-counting Compare Match. • The timer starts counting from a value higher than the one in OCR2A, and for that reason misses the Compare Match and hence the OCn change that would have happened on the way up. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 209 20.8. Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams The following figures show the Timer/Counter in synchronous mode, and the timer clock (clkT2) is therefore shown as a clock enable signal. In asynchronous mode, clkI/O should be replaced by the Timer/ Counter Oscillator clock. The figures include information on when Interrupt Flags are set. The following figure contains timing data for basic Timer/Counter operation. The figure shows the count sequence close to the MAX value in all modes other than phase correct PWM mode. Figure 20-8 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, no Prescaling clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O /1) TCNTn MAX - 1 MAX BOTTOM BOTTOM + 1 TOVn The following figure shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled. Figure 20-9 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8) clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O /8) TCNTn MAX - 1 MAX BOTTOM BOTTOM + 1 TOVn The following figure shows the setting of OCF2A in all modes except CTC mode. Figure 20-10 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCF2A, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8) clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O /8) TCNTn OCRnx OCRnx - 1 OCRnx OCRnx + 1 OCRnx + 2 OCRnx Value OCFnx The following figure shows the setting of OCF2A and the clearing of TCNT2 in CTC mode. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 210 Figure 20-11 Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Clear Timer on Compare Match mode, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8) clkI/O clkTn (clkI/O /8) TCNTn (CTC) TOP - 1 TOP BOTTOM OCRnx BOTTOM + 1 TOP OCFnx 20.9. Asynchronous Operation of Timer/Counter2 When TC2 operates asynchronously, some considerations must be taken: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. When switching between asynchronous and synchronous clocking of TC2, the registers TCNT2, OCR2x, and TCCR2x might be corrupted. A safe procedure for switching clock source is: 1.1. Disable the TC2 interrupts by clearing OCIE2x and TOIE2. 1.2. Select clock source by setting AS2 as appropriate. 1.3. Write new values to TCNT2, OCR2x, and TCCR2x. 1.4. To switch to asynchronous operation: Wait for TCN2xUB, OCR2xUB, and TCR2xUB. 1.5. Clear the TC2 Interrupt Flags. 1.6. Enable interrupts, if needed. The CPU main clock frequency must be more than four times the oscillator frequency. When writing to one of the registers TCNT2, OCR2x, or TCCR2x, the value is transferred to a temporary register, and latched after two positive edges on TOSC1. The user should not write a new value before the contents of the temporary register have been transferred to its destination. Each of the five mentioned registers has its individual temporary register, which means that e.g. writing to TCNT2 does not disturb an OCR2x write in progress. The Asynchronous Status Register (ASSR) indicates that a transfer to the destination register has taken place. When entering Power-save or ADC Noise Reduction mode after having written to TCNT2, OCR2x, or TCCR2x, the user must wait until the written register has been updated if TC2 is used to wake up the device. Otherwise, the MCU will enter sleep mode before the changes are effective. This is particularly important if any of the Output Compare2 interrupts is used to wake up the device, since the Output Compare function is disabled during writing to OCR2x or TCNT2. If the write cycle is not finished, and the MCU enters sleep mode before the corresponding OCR2xUB bit returns to zero, the device will never receive a compare match interrupt, and the MCU will not wake up. If TC2 is used to wake the device up from Power-save or ADC Noise Reduction mode, precautions must be taken if the user wants to re-enter one of these modes: If re-entering sleep mode within the TOSC1 cycle, the interrupt will immediately occur and the device wake up again. The result is multiple interrupts and wake-ups within one TOSC1 cycle from the first interrupt. If the user is in doubt whether the time before re-entering Power-save or ADC Noise Reduction mode is sufficient, the following algorithm can be used to ensure that one TOSC1 cycle has elapsed: 5.1. Write a value to TCCR2x, TCNT2, or OCR2x. 5.2. Wait until the corresponding Update Busy Flag in ASSR returns to zero. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 211 6. 7. 8. 5.3. Enter Power-save or ADC Noise Reduction mode. When the asynchronous operation is selected, the 32.768kHz oscillator for TC2 is always running, except in Power-down and Standby modes. After a Power-up Reset or wake-up from Power-down or Standby mode, the user should be aware of the fact that this oscillator might take as long as one second to stabilize. The user is advised to wait for at least one second before using TC2 after power-up or wake-up from Power-down or Standby mode. The contents of all TC2 Registers must be considered lost after a wake-up from Power-down or Standby mode due to unstable clock signal upon start-up, no matter whether the Oscillator is in use or a clock signal is applied to the TOSC1 pin. Description of wake up from Power-save or ADC Noise Reduction mode when the timer is clocked asynchronously: When the interrupt condition is met, the wake up process is started on the following cycle of the timer clock, that is, the timer is always advanced by at least one before the processor can read the counter value. After wake-up, the MCU is halted for four cycles, it executes the interrupt routine, and resumes execution from the instruction following SLEEP. Reading of the TCNT2 Register shortly after wake-up from Power-save may give an incorrect result. Since TCNT2 is clocked on the asynchronous TOSC clock, reading TCNT2 must be done through a register synchronized to the internal I/O clock domain. Synchronization takes place for every rising TOSC1 edge. When waking up from Power-save mode, and the I/O clock (clkI/O) again becomes active, TCNT2 will read as the previous value (before entering sleep) until the next rising TOSC1 edge. The phase of the TOSC clock after waking up from Power-save mode is essentially unpredictable, as it depends on the wake-up time. The recommended procedure for reading TCNT2 is thus as follows: 8.1. Wait for the corresponding Update Busy Flag to be cleared. 8.2. Read TCNT2. During asynchronous operation, the synchronization of the Interrupt Flags for the asynchronous timer takes 3 processor cycles plus one timer cycle. The timer is therefore advanced by at least one before the processor can read the timer value causing the setting of the Interrupt Flag. The Output Compare pin is changed on the timer clock and is not synchronized to the processor clock. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 212 20.10. Timer/Counter Prescaler Figure 20-12 Prescaler for TC2 PSRASY clkT2S/1024 clkT2S/256 clkT2S/128 clkT2S/64 AS2 10-BIT T/C PRESCALER Clear clkT2S/32 TOSC1 clkT2S clkT2S/8 clkI/O 0 CS20 CS21 CS22 TIMER/COUNTER2 CLOCK SOURCE clkT2 The clock source for TC2 is named clkT2S. It is by default connected to the main system I/O clock clkI/O. By writing a '1' to the Asynchronous TC2 bit in the Asynchronous Status Register (ASSR.AS2), TC2 is asynchronously clocked from the TOSC1 pin. This enables use of TC2 as a Real Time Counter (RTC). When AS2 is set, pins TOSC1 and TOSC2 are disconnected from Port B. A crystal can then be connected between the TOSC1 and TOSC2 pins to serve as an independent clock source for TC2. The Oscillator is optimized for use with a 32.768kHz crystal. For TC2, the possible prescaled selections are: clkT2S/8, clkT2S/32, clkT2S/64, clkT2S/128, clkT2S/256, and clkT2S/1024. Additionally, clkT2S as well as 0 (stop) may be selected. The prescaler is reset by writing a '1' to the Prescaler Reset TC2 bit in the General TC2 Control Register (GTCCR.PSRASY). This allows the user to operate with a defined prescaler. 20.11. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 213 20.11.1. TC2 Control Register A Name: TCCR2A Offset: 0xB0 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 1 0 COM2A1 COM2A0 COM2B1 COM2B0 3 2 WGM21 WGM20 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:6 – COM2An: Compare Output Mode for Channel A [n = 1:0] These bits control the Output Compare pin (OC2A) behavior. If one or both of the COM2A1:0 bits are set, the OC2A output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected to. However, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OC2A pin must be set in order to enable the output driver. When OC2A is connected to the pin, the function of the COM2A1:0 bits depends on the WGM22:0 bit setting. The table below shows the COM2A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits are set to a normal or CTC mode (non- PWM). Table 20-3 Compare Output Mode, non-PWM COM2A1 COM2A0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC2A disconnected. 0 1 Toggle OC2A on Compare Match. 1 0 Clear OC2A on Compare Match. 1 1 Set OC2A on Compare Match . The table below shows the COM2A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM21:0 bits are set to fast PWM mode. Table 20-4 Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM(1) COM2A1 COM2A0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC2A disconnected. 0 1 WGM22 = 0: Normal Port Operation, OC2A Disconnected WGM22 = 1: Toggle OC2A on Compare Match 1 0 Clear OC2A on Compare Match, set OC2A at BOTTOM (non-inverting mode) 1 1 Set OC2A on Compare Match, clear OC2A at BOTTOM (inverting mode) Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR2A equals TOP and COM2A1 is set. In this case the compare match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at BOTTOM. Refer to Fast PWM Mode on page 143 for details. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 214 The table below shows the COM2A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits are set to phase correct PWM mode. Table 20-5 Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct PWM Mode(1) COM2A1 COM2A0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC2A disconnected. 0 1 WGM22 = 0: Normal Port Operation, OC2A Disconnected. WGM22 = 1: Toggle OC2A on Compare Match. 1 0 Clear OC2A on Compare Match when up-counting. Set OC2A on Compare Match when down-counting. 1 1 Set OC2A on Compare Match when up-counting. Clear OC2A on Compare Match when down-counting. Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR2A equals TOP and COM2A1 is set. In this case, the Compare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. Refer to Phase Correct PWM Mode on page 144 for details. Bits 5:4 – COM2Bn: Compare Output Mode for Channel B [n = 1:0] These bits control the Output Compare pin (OC2B) behavior. If one or both of the COM2B1:0 bits are set, the OC2B output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected to. However, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OC2B pin must be set in order to enable the output driver. When OC2B is connected to the pin, the function of the COM2B1:0 bits depends on the WGM22:0 bit setting. The table shows the COM2B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits are set to a normal or CTC mode (non- PWM). Table 20-6 Compare Output Mode, non-PWM COM2B1 COM2B0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC2B disconnected. 0 1 Toggle OC2B on Compare Match. 1 0 Clear OC2B on Compare Match. 1 1 Set OC2B on Compare Match. The table below shows the COM0B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to fast PWM mode. Table 20-7 Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM(1) COM0B1 COM0B0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC0B disconnected. 0 1 Reserved 1 0 Clear OC0B on Compare Match, set OC0B at BOTTOM, (non-inverting mode) 1 1 Set OC0B on Compare Match, clear OC0B at BOTTOM, (inverting mode) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 215 Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR2B equals TOP and COM2B1 is set. In this case, the Compare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. Refer to Fast PWM Mode on page 143 for details. The table below shows the COM2B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits are set to phase correct PWM mode. Table 20-8 Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct PWM Mode(1) COM2B1 COM2B0 Description 0 0 Normal port operation, OC2B disconnected. 0 1 Reserved 1 0 Clear OC2B on Compare Match when up-counting. Set OC2B on Compare Match when down-counting. 1 1 Set OC2B on Compare Match when up-counting. Clear OC2B on Compare Match when down-counting. Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR2B equals TOP and COM2B1 is set. In this case, the Compare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. Refer to Phase Correct PWM Mode on page 144 for details. Bits 1:0 – WGM2n: Waveform Generation Mode [n = 1:0] Combined with the WGM22 bit found in the TCCR2B Register, these bits control the counting sequence of the counter, the source for maximum (TOP) counter value, and what type of waveform generation to be used. Modes of operation supported by the Timer/Counter unit are: Normal mode (counter), Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) mode, and two types of Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) modes (see Modes of Operation on page 141). Table 20-9 Waveform Generation Mode Bit Description Mode WGM22 WGM21 WGM20 Timer/Counter Mode of Operation TOP Update of OCR0x at 0 0 0 1 0 0 2 0 1 3 0 1 4 1 5 TOV Flag Set on(1) 0 Normal 0xFF Immediate MAX 1 PWM, Phase Correct 0xFF TOP BOTTOM 0 CTC OCRA Immediate MAX 1 Fast PWM 0xFF BOTTOM MAX 0 0 Reserved - - - 1 0 1 PWM, Phase Correct OCRA TOP BOTTOM 6 1 1 0 Reserved - - - 7 1 1 1 Fast PWM OCRA BOTTOM TOP Note: 1. MAX = 0xFF 2. BOTTOM = 0x00 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 216 20.11.2. TC2 Control Register B Name: TCCR2B Offset: 0xB1 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 3 2 1 0 FOC2A FOC2B 5 4 WGM22 CS22 CS21 CS20 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – FOC2A: Force Output Compare A The FOC2A bit is only active when the WGM bits specify a non-PWM mode. To ensure compatibility with future devices, this bit must be set to zero when TCCR2B is written when operating in PWM mode. When writing a logical one to the FOC2A bit, an immediate Compare Match is forced on the Waveform Generation unit. The OC2A output is changed according to its COM2A1:0 bits setting. Note that the FOC2A bit is implemented as a strobe. Therefore it is the value present in the COM2A1:0 bits that determines the effect of the forced compare. A FOC2A strobe will not generate any interrupt, nor will it clear the timer in CTC mode using OCR2A as TOP. The FOC2A bit is always read as zero. Bit 6 – FOC2B: Force Output Compare B The FOC2B bit is only active when the WGM bits specify a non-PWM mode. To ensure compatibility with future devices, this bit must be set to zero when TCCR2B is written when operating in PWM mode. When writing a logical one to the FOC2B bit, an immediate Compare Match is forced on the Waveform Generation unit. The OC2B output is changed according to its COM2B1:0 bits setting. Note that the FOC2B bit is implemented as a strobe. Therefore it is the value present in the COM2B1:0 bits that determines the effect of the forced compare. A FOC2B strobe will not generate any interrupt, nor will it clear the timer in CTC mode using OCR2B as TOP. The FOC2B bit is always read as zero. Bit 3 – WGM22: Waveform Generation Mode Refer to TCCR2A on page 214. Bits 2:0 – CS2n: Clock Select [n = 0..2] The three Clock Select bits select the clock source to be used by the Timer/Counter. Table 20-10 Clock Select Bit Description CA22 CA21 CS20 0 0 0 No clock source (Timer/Counter stopped). 1 clkI/O/1 (No prescaling) 0 clkI/O/8 (From prescaler) 0 0 1 Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 217 CA22 CA21 CS20 Description 0 1 1 clkI/O/32 (From prescaler) 1 0 0 clkI/O/64 (From prescaler) 1 0 1 clkI/O/128 (From prescaler) 1 1 0 clkI/O/256 (From prescaler) 1 1 1 clkI/O/1024 (From prescaler) If external pin modes are used for the Timer/Counter0, transitions on the T0 pin will clock the counter even if the pin is configured as an output. This feature allows software control of the counting. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 218 20.11.3. TC2 Counter Value Register Name: TCNT2 Offset: 0xB2 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TCNT2[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – TCNT2[7:0]: Timer/Counter 2 Counter Value The Timer/Counter Register gives direct access, both for read and write operations, to the Timer/Counter unit 8-bit counter. Writing to the TCNT2 Register blocks (removes) the Compare Match on the following timer clock. Modifying the counter (TCNT2) while the counter is running, introduces a risk of missing a Compare Match between TCNT2 and the OCR2x Registers. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 219 20.11.4. TC2 Output Compare Register A Name: OCR2A Offset: 0xB3 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCR2A[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – OCR2A[7:0]: Output Compare 2 A The Output Compare Register A contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the counter value (TCNT2). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to generate a waveform output on the OC2A pin. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 220 20.11.5. TC2 Output Compare Register B Name: OCR2B Offset: 0xB4 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCR2B[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – OCR2B[7:0]: Output Compare 2 B The Output Compare Register B contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the counter value (TCNT2). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to generate a waveform output on the OC2B pin. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 221 20.11.6. TC2 Interrupt Mask Register Name: TIMSK2 Offset: 0x70 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCIE2B OCIE2A TOIE2 R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 Bit 2 – OCIE2B: Timer/Counter2, Output Compare B Match Interrupt Enable When the OCIE2B bit is written to '1' and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the Timer/Counter2 Compare Match B interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if a compare match in Timer/Counter2 occurs, i.e., when the OCF2B bit is set in TIFR2 on page 223. Bit 1 – OCIE2A: Timer/Counter2, Output Compare A Match Interrupt Enable When the OCIE2A bit is written to '1' and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the Timer/Counter2 Compare Match A interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if a compare match in Timer/Counter2 occurs, i.e., when the OCF2A bit is set in TIFR2 on page 223. Bit 0 – TOIE2: Timer/Counter2, Overflow Interrupt Enable When the TOIE2 bit is written to '1' and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the Timer/Counter2 Overflow interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if an overflow in Timer/Counter2 occurs, i.e., when the TOV2 bit is set in TIFR2 on page 223. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 222 20.11.7. TC2 Interrupt Flag Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: TIFR2 Offset: 0x37 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x17 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OCF2B OCF2A TOV2 R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 Bit 2 – OCF2B: Timer/Counter2, Output Compare B Match Flag The OCF2B bit is set (one) when a compare match occurs between the Timer/Counter2 and the data in OCR2B – Output Compare Register2. OCF2B is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF2B is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE2B (Timer/Counter2 Compare match Interrupt Enable), and OCF2B are set (one), the Timer/Counter2 Compare match Interrupt is executed. Bit 1 – OCF2A: Timer/Counter2, Output Compare A Match Flag The OCF2A bit is set (one) when a compare match occurs between the Timer/Counter2 and the data in OCR2A – Output Compare Register2. OCF2A is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF2A is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE2A (Timer/Counter2 Compare match Interrupt Enable), and OCF2A are set (one), the Timer/Counter2 Compare match Interrupt is executed. Bit 0 – TOV2: Timer/Counter2, Overflow Flag The TOV2 bit is set (one) when an overflow occurs in Timer/Counter2. TOV2 is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, TOV2 is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag. When the SREG I-bit, TOIE2A (Timer/Counter2 Overflow Interrupt Enable), and TOV2 are set (one), the Timer/Counter2 Overflow interrupt is executed. In PWM mode, this bit is set when Timer/Counter2 changes counting direction at 0x00. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 223 20.11.8. Asynchronous Status Register Name: ASSR Offset: 0xB6 Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EXCLK AS2 TCN2UB OCR2AUB OCR2BUB TCR2AUB TCR2BUB Access R R R R R R R Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 – EXCLK: Enable External Clock Input When EXCLK is written to one, and asynchronous clock is selected, the external clock input buffer is enabled and an external clock can be input on Timer Oscillator 1 (TOSC1) pin instead of a 32kHz crystal. Writing to EXCLK should be done before asynchronous operation is selected. Note that the crystal Oscillator will only run when this bit is zero. Bit 5 – AS2: Asynchronous Timer/Counter2 When AS2 is written to zero, Timer/Counter2 is clocked from the I/O clock, clkI/O. When AS2 is written to one, Timer/Counter2 is clocked from a crystal Oscillator connected to the Timer Oscillator 1 (TOSC1) pin. When the value of AS2 is changed, the contents of TCNT2, OCR2A, OCR2B, TCCR2A and TCCR2B might be corrupted. Bit 4 – TCN2UB: Timer/Counter2 Update Busy When Timer/Counter2 operates asynchronously and TCNT2 is written, this bit becomes set. When TCNT2 has been updated from the temporary storage register, this bit is cleared by hardware. A logical zero in this bit indicates that TCNT2 is ready to be updated with a new value. Bit 3 – OCR2AUB: Enable External Clock Input When Timer/Counter2 operates asynchronously and OCR2A is written, this bit becomes set. When OCR2A has been updated from the temporary storage register, this bit is cleared by hardware. A logical zero in this bit indicates that OCR2A is ready to be updated with a new value. Bit 2 – OCR2BUB: Output Compare Register2 Update Busy When Timer/Counter2 operates asynchronously and OCR2B is written, this bit becomes set. When OCR2B has been updated from the temporary storage register, this bit is cleared by hardware. A logical zero in this bit indicates that OCR2B is ready to be updated with a new value. Bit 1 – TCR2AUB: Timer/Counter Control Register2 Update Busy When Timer/Counter2 operates asynchronously and TCCR2A is written, this bit becomes set. When TCCR2A has been updated from the temporary storage register, this bit is cleared by hardware. A logical zero in this bit indicates that TCCR2A is ready to be updated with a new value. Bit 0 – TCR2BUB: Timer/Counter Control Register2 Update Busy When Timer/Counter2 operates asynchronously and TCCR2B is written, this bit becomes set. When TCCR2B has been updated from the temporary storage register, this bit is cleared by hardware. A logical zero in this bit indicates that TCCR2B is ready to be updated with a new value. If a write is performed to any of the five Timer/Counter2 Registers while its update busy flag is set, the updated value might get corrupted and cause an unintentional interrupt to occur. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 224 20.11.9. General Timer/Counter Control Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: GTCCR Offset: 0x43 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x23 Bit Access Reset 1 0 TSM 7 6 5 4 3 2 PSRASY PSRSYNC R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 Bit 7 – TSM: Timer/Counter Synchronization Mode Writing the TSM bit to one activates the Timer/Counter Synchronization mode. In this mode, the value that is written to the PSRASY and PSRSYNC bits is kept, hence keeping the corresponding prescaler reset signals asserted. This ensures that the corresponding Timer/Counters are halted and can be configured to the same value without the risk of one of them advancing during configuration. When the TSM bit is written to zero, the PSRASY and PSRSYNC bits are cleared by hardware, and the Timer/ Counters start counting simultaneously. Bit 1 – PSRASY: Prescaler Reset Timer/Counter2 When this bit is one, the Timer/Counter2 prescaler will be reset. This bit is normally cleared immediately by hardware. If the bit is written when Timer/Counter2 is operating in asynchronous mode, the bit will remain one until the prescaler has been reset. The bit will not be cleared by hardware if the TSM bit is set. Bit 0 – PSRSYNC: Prescaler Reset When this bit is one, Timer/Counter1 and Timer/Counter0 prescaler will be Reset. This bit is normally cleared immediately by hardware, except if the TSM bit is set. Note that Timer/Counter1 and Timer/ Counter0 share the same prescaler and a reset of this prescaler will affect both timers. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 225 21. OCM - Output Compare Modulator 21.1. Overview The Output Compare Modulator (OCM) allows generation of waveforms modulated with a carrier frequency. The modulator uses the outputs from the Output Compare Unit B of the 16-bit Timer/Counter3 and the Output Compare Unit of the 16-bit Timer/Counter4. For more details about these Timer/Counters see 16-bit Timer/Counter. When the modulator is enabled, the two output compare channels are modulated together as shown in the block diagram (as the following figure). Figure 21-1 Output Compare Modulator, Block Diagram Timer/Counter 3 OC3B Pin Timer/Counter 4 OC3B / OC4B / PD2 OC4B Related Links TC - 16-bit Timer/Counter with PWM on page 160 21.2. Description The Output Compare unit 3B and Output Compare unit 4B shares the PD2 port pin for output. The outputs of the Output Compare units (OC3B and OC4B) overrides the normal PORTD2 Register when one of them is enabled (that is, when COMnx1:0 is not equal to zero). When both OC3B and OC4B are enabled at the same time, the modulator is automatically enabled. The functional equivalent schematic of the modulator is shown on the figure below. The schematic includes part of the Timer/Counter units and the port D pin 2 output driver circuit. When the modulator is enabled the type of modulation (logical AND or OR) can be selected by the PORTB7 Register. Note: The DDRD2 controls the direction of the port independent of the COMnx1:0 bit setting. Figure 21-2 Output Compare Modulator, Schematic COM3B1 COM3B0 Vcc COM1C1 COM1C0 ( From Waveform Generator ) Modulator 0 D 1 Q 1 OC3B Pin 0 ( From Waveform Generator ) D Q OC4B D Q D PORTD2 Q DDRD2 DATABUS Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 226 21.2.1. Timing Example The figure below illustrates the modulator in action. In this example the Timer/Counter3 is set to operate in fast PWM mode (non-inverted) and Timer/Counter4 uses CTC waveform mode with toggle Compare Output mode (COMx[1:0] = 0x1). Figure 21-3 Output Compare Modulator, Timing Diagram clk I/O OC3B (FPWM Mode) OC4B (CTC Mode) PD2 (PORTD2 = 0) PD2 (PORTD2 = 1) (Period) 1 2 3 In this example, Timer/Counter4 provides the carrier, while the modulating signal is generated by the Output Compare unit B of the Timer/Counter3. The resolution of the PWM signal (OC3B) is reduced by the modulation. The reduction factor is equal to the number of system clock cycles of one period of the carrier (OC4B). In this example the resolution is reduced by a factor of two. The reason for the reduction is illustrated in the above figure at the second and third period of the PD2 output when PORTD2 equals zero. The period 2 high time is one cycle longer than the period 3 high time, but the result on the PD2 output is equal in both periods. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 227 22. SPI – Serial Peripheral Interface 22.1. Features • • • • • • • • • 22.2. Two SPIs are available - SPI0 and SPI1 Full-duplex, Three-wire Synchronous Data Transfer Master or Slave Operation LSB First or MSB First Data Transfer Seven Programmable Bit Rates End of Transmission Interrupt Flag Write Collision Flag Protection Wake-up from Idle Mode Double Speed (CK/2) Master SPI Mode Overview The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) allows high-speed synchronous data transfer between the device and peripheral units, or between several AVR devices. The USART can also be used in Master SPI mode. To enable the SPI module Power Reduction PRSPIn bit in the Power Reduction Register (PRSPIn.PRRn) must be written to '0'. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 228 Figure 22-1 SPI Block Diagram SPI2X SPI2X DIVIDER /2/4/8/16/32/64/128 Note: Refer to the pinout description and the IO Port description for SPI pin placement. The interconnection between Master and Slave CPUs with SPI is shown in the figure below. The system consists of two shift registers, and a Master Clock generator. The SPI Master initiates the communication cycle when pulling low the Slave Select SS pin of the desired Slave. Master and Slave prepare the data to be sent in their respective shift Registers, and the Master generates the required clock pulses on the SCK line to interchange data. Data is always shifted from Master to Slave on the Master Out – Slave In, MOSI, line, and from Slave to Master on the Master In – Slave Out, MISO, line. After each data packet, the Master will synchronize the Slave by pulling high the Slave Select, SS, line. When configured as a Master, the SPI interface has no automatic control of the SS line. This must be handled by user software before communication can start. When this is done, writing a byte to the SPI Data Register starts the SPI clock generator, and the hardware shifts the eight bits into the Slave. After shifting one byte, the SPI clock generator stops, setting the end of Transmission Flag (SPIF). If the SPI Interrupt Enable bit (SPIE) in the SPCR Register is set, an interrupt is requested. The Master may continue to shift the next byte by writing it into SPDR, or signal the end of packet by pulling high the Slave Select, SS line. The last incoming byte will be kept in the Buffer Register for later use. When configured as a Slave, the SPI interface will remain sleeping with MISO tri-stated as long as the SS pin is driven high. In this state, software may update the contents of the SPI Data Register, SPDR, but the data will not be shifted out by incoming clock pulses on the SCK pin until the SS pin is driven low. As one byte has been completely shifted, the end of Transmission Flag, SPIF is set. If the SPI Interrupt Enable bit, SPIE, in the SPCR Register is set, an interrupt is requested. The Slave may continue to place new Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 229 data to be sent into SPDR before reading the incoming data. The last incoming byte will be kept in the Buffer Register for later use. Figure 22-2 SPI Master-slave Interconnection SHIFT ENABLE The system is single buffered in the transmit direction and double buffered in the receive direction. This means that bytes to be transmitted cannot be written to the SPI Data Register before the entire shift cycle is completed. When receiving data, however, a received character must be read from the SPI Data Register before the next character has been completely shifted in. Otherwise, the first byte is lost. In SPI Slave mode, the control logic will sample the incoming signal of the SCK pin. To ensure correct sampling of the clock signal, the minimum low and high periods should be longer than two CPU clock cycles. When the SPI is enabled, the data direction of the MOSI, MISO, SCK, and SS pins is overridden according to the table below. For more details on automatic port overrides, refer to the IO Port description. Table 22-1 SPI Pin Overrides Pin Direction, Master SPI Direction, Slave SPI MOSI User Defined Input MISO Input User Defined SCK User Defined Input SS User Defined Input Note: 1. See the IO Port description for how to define the SPI pin directions. The following code examples show how to initialize the SPI as a Master and how to perform a simple transmission. DDR_SPI in the examples must be replaced by the actual Data Direction Register controlling the SPI pins. DD_MOSI, DD_MISO and DD_SCK must be replaced by the actual data direction bits for these pins. E.g. if MOSI is placed on pin PB5, replace DD_MOSI with DDB5 and DDR_SPI with DDRB. Assembly Code Example SPI_MasterInit: ; Set MOSI and SCK output, all others input ldi r17,(1<<DD_MOSI)|(1<<DD_SCK) out DDR_SPI,r17 ; Enable SPI, Master, set clock rate fck/16 ldi r17,(1<<SPE)|(1<<MSTR)|(1<<SPR0) out SPCR,r17 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 230 ret SPI_MasterTransmit: ; Start transmission of data (r16) out SPDR,r16 Wait_Transmit: ; Wait for transmission complete in r16, SPSR sbrs r16, SPIF rjmp Wait_Transmit ret C Code Example void SPI_MasterInit(void) { /* Set MOSI and SCK output, all others input */ DDR_SPI = (1<<DD_MOSI)|(1<<DD_SCK); /* Enable SPI, Master, set clock rate fck/16 */ SPCR = (1<<SPE)|(1<<MSTR)|(1<<SPR0); } void SPI_MasterTransmit(char cData) { /* Start transmission */ SPDR = cData; /* Wait for transmission complete */ while(!(SPSR & (1<<SPIF))) ; } The following code examples show how to initialize the SPI as a Slave and how to perform a simple reception. Assembly Code Example SPI_SlaveInit: ; Set MISO output, all others input ldi r17,(1<<DD_MISO) out DDR_SPI,r17 ; Enable SPI ldi r17,(1<<SPE) out SPCR,r17 ret SPI_SlaveReceive: ; Wait for reception complete in r16, SPSR sbrs r16, SPIF rjmp SPI_SlaveReceive ; Read received data and return in r16,SPDR ret C Code Example void SPI_SlaveInit(void) { /* Set MISO output, all others input */ DDR_SPI = (1<<DD_MISO); /* Enable SPI */ Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 231 SPCR = (1<<SPE); } char SPI_SlaveReceive(void) { /* Wait for reception complete */ while(!(SPSR & (1<<SPIF))) ; /* Return Data Register */ return SPDR; } Related Links Pin Descriptions on page 13 USARTSPI - USART in SPI Mode on page 274 PM - Power Management and Sleep Modes on page 58 I/O-Ports on page 99 About Code Examples on page 17 22.3. SS Pin Functionality 22.3.1. Slave Mode When the SPI is configured as a Slave, the Slave Select (SS) pin is always input. When SS is held low, the SPI is activated, and MISO becomes an output if configured so by the user. All other pins are inputs. When SS is driven high, all pins are inputs, and the SPI is passive, which means that it will not receive incoming data. The SPI logic will be reset once the SS pin is driven high. The SS pin is useful for packet/byte synchronization to keep the slave bit counter synchronous with the master clock generator. When the SS pin is driven high, the SPI slave will immediately reset the send and receive logic, and drop any partially received data in the Shift Register. 22.3.2. Master Mode When the SPI is configured as a Master (MSTR in SPCR is set), the user can determine the direction of the SS pin. If SS is configured as an output, the pin is a general output pin which does not affect the SPI system. Typically, the pin will be driving the SS pin of the SPI Slave. If SS is configured as an input, it must be held high to ensure Master SPI operation. If the SS pin is driven low by peripheral circuitry when the SPI is configured as a Master with the SS pin defined as an input, the SPI system interprets this as another master selecting the SPI as a slave and starting to send data to it. To avoid bus contention, the SPI system takes the following actions: 1. 2. The MSTR bit in SPCR is cleared and the SPI system becomes a Slave. As a result of the SPI becoming a Slave, the MOSI and SCK pins become inputs. The SPIF Flag in SPSR is set, and if the SPI interrupt is enabled, and the I-bit in SREG is set, the interrupt routine will be executed. Thus, when interrupt-driven SPI transmission is used in Master mode, and there exists a possibility that SS is driven low, the interrupt should always check that the MSTR bit is still set. If the MSTR bit has been cleared by a slave select, it must be set by the user to re-enable SPI Master mode. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 232 22.4. Data Modes There are four combinations of SCK phase and polarity with respect to serial data, which are determined by control bits CPHA and CPOL. Data bits are shifted out and latched in on opposite edges of the SCK signal, ensuring sufficient time for data signals to stabilize. The following table, summarizes SPCR.CPOL and SPCR.CPHA settings. Table 22-2 SPI Modes SPI Mode Conditions Leading Edge Trailing Edge 0 CPOL=0, CPHA=0 Sample (Rising) Setup (Falling) 1 CPOL=0, CPHA=1 Setup (Rising) Sample (Falling) 2 CPOL=1, CPHA=0 Sample (Falling) Setup (Rising) 3 CPOL=1, CPHA=1 Setup (Falling) Sample (Rising) The SPI data transfer formats are shown in the following figure. Figure 22-3 SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 0 SCK (CPOL = 0) mode 0 SCK (CPOL = 1) mode 2 SAMPLE I MOSI/MISO CHANGE 0 MOSI PIN CHANGE 0 MISO PIN SS MSB first (DORD = 0) LSB first (DORD = 1) MSB LSB Bit 6 Bit 1 Bit 5 Bit 2 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 2 Bit 5 Bit 1 Bit 6 LSB MSB Figure 22-4 SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 1 SCK (CPOL = 0) mode 1 SCK (CPOL = 1) mode 3 SAMPLE I MOSI/MISO CHANGE 0 MOSI PIN CHANGE 0 MISO PIN SS MSB first (DORD = 0) LSB first (DORD = 1) 22.5. MSB LSB Bit 6 Bit 1 Bit 5 Bit 2 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 2 Bit 5 Bit 1 Bit 6 LSB MSB Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 233 22.5.1. SPI Control Register 0 When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: SPCR0 Offset: 0x4C Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x2C Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SPIE0 SPE0 DORD0 MSTR0 CPOL0 CPHA0 SPR01 SPR00 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – SPIE0: SPI0 Interrupt Enable This bit causes the SPI interrupt to be executed if SPIF bit in the SPSR Register is set and if the Global Interrupt Enable bit in SREG is set. Bit 6 – SPE0: SPI0 Enable When the SPE bit is written to one, the SPI is enabled. This bit must be set to enable any SPI operations. Bit 5 – DORD0: Data0 Order When the DORD bit is written to one, the LSB of the data word is transmitted first. When the DORD bit is written to zero, the MSB of the data word is transmitted first. Bit 4 – MSTR0: Master/Slave0 Select This bit selects Master SPI mode when written to one, and Slave SPI mode when written logic zero. If SS is configured as an input and is driven low while MSTR is set, MSTR will be cleared, and SPIF in SPSR will become set. The user will then have to set MSTR to re-enable SPI Master mode. Bit 3 – CPOL0: Clock0 Polarity When this bit is written to one, SCK is high when idle. When CPOL is written to zero, SCK is low when idle. Refer to Figure 22-3 SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 0 on page 233 and Figure 22-4 SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 1 on page 233 for an example. The CPOL functionality is summarized below: Table 22-3 CPOL0 Functionality CPOL0 Leading Edge Trailing Edge 0 Rising Falling 1 Falling Rising Bit 2 – CPHA0: Clock0 Phase The settings of the Clock Phase bit (CPHA) determine if data is sampled on the leading (first) or trailing (last) edge of SCK. Refer to Figure 22-3 SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 0 on page 233 and Figure 22-4 SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 1 on page 233 for an example. The CPHA functionality is summarized below: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 234 Table 22-4 CPHA0 Functionality CPHA0 Leading Edge Trailing Edge 0 Sample Setup 1 Setup Sample Bits 1:0 – SPR0n: SPI0 Clock Rate Select n [n = 1:0] These two bits control the SCK rate of the device configured as a Master. SPR1 and SPR0 have no effect on the Slave. The relationship between SCK and the Oscillator Clock frequency fosc is shown in the table below. Table 22-5 Relationship between SCK and Oscillator Frequency SPI2X SPR01 SPR00 SCK Frequency 0 0 0 fosc/4 0 0 1 fosc/16 0 1 0 fosc/64 0 1 1 fosc/128 1 0 0 fosc/2 1 0 1 fosc/8 1 1 0 fosc/32 1 1 1 fosc/64 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 235 22.5.2. SPI Control Register 1 Name: SPCR1 Offset: 0xAC Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SPIE1 SPE1 DORD1 MSTR1 CPOL1 CPHA1 SPR11 SPR10 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – SPIE1: SPI1 Interrupt Enable This bit causes the SPI interrupt to be executed if SPIF bit in the SPSR Register is set and if the Global Interrupt Enable bit in SREG is set. Bit 6 – SPE1: SPI1 Enable When the SPE bit is written to one, the SPI is enabled. This bit must be set to enable any SPI operations. Bit 5 – DORD1: Data1 Order When the DORD bit is written to one, the LSB of the data word is transmitted first. When the DORD bit is written to zero, the MSB of the data word is transmitted first. Bit 4 – MSTR1: Master/Slave1 Select This bit selects Master SPI mode when written to one, and Slave SPI mode when written logic zero. If SS is configured as an input and is driven low while MSTR is set, MSTR will be cleared, and SPIF in SPSR will become set. The user will then have to set MSTR to re-enable SPI Master mode. Bit 3 – CPOL1: Clock1 Polarity When this bit is written to one, SCK is high when idle. When CPOL is written to zero, SCK is low when idle. Refer to Figure 22-3 SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 0 on page 233 and Figure 22-4 SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 1 on page 233 for an example. The CPOL functionality is summarized below: Table 22-6 CPOL Functionality CPOL Leading Edge Trailing Edge 0 Rising Falling 1 Falling Rising Bit 2 – CPHA1: Clock1 Phase The settings of the Clock Phase bit (CPHA) determine if data is sampled on the leading (first) or trailing (last) edge of SCK. Refer to Figure 22-3 SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 0 on page 233 and Figure 22-4 SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 1 on page 233 for an example. The CPHA functionality is summarized below: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 236 Table 22-7 CPHA1 Functionality CPHA1 Leading Edge Trailing Edge 0 Sample Setup 1 Setup Sample Bits 1:0 – SPR1n: SPI1 Clock Rate Select n [n = 1:0] These two bits control the SCK rate of the device configured as a Master. SPR1 and SPR0 have no effect on the Slave. The relationship between SCK and the Oscillator Clock frequency fosc is shown in the table below. Table 22-8 Relationship between SCK and Oscillator Frequency SPI2X SPR11 SPR10 SCK Frequency 0 0 0 fosc/4 0 0 1 fosc/16 0 1 0 fosc/64 0 1 1 fosc/128 1 0 0 fosc/2 1 0 1 fosc/8 1 1 0 fosc/32 1 1 1 fosc/64 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 237 22.5.3. SPI Status Register 0 When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: SPSR0 Offset: 0x4D Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x2D Bit 7 6 SPIF0 WCOL0 5 4 3 2 1 SPI2X0 0 Access R R R/W Reset 0 0 0 Bit 7 – SPIF0: SPI Interrupt Flag When a serial transfer is complete, the SPIF Flag is set. An interrupt is generated if SPIE in SPCR is set and global interrupts are enabled. If SS is an input and is driven low when the SPI is in Master mode, this will also set the SPIF Flag. SPIF is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, the SPIF bit is cleared by first reading the SPI Status Register with SPIF set, then accessing the SPI Data Register (SPDR). Bit 6 – WCOL0: Write Collision Flag The WCOL bit is set if the SPI Data Register (SPDR) is written during a data transfer. The WCOL bit (and the SPIF bit) are cleared by first reading the SPI Status Register with WCOL set, and then accessing the SPI Data Register. Bit 0 – SPI2X0: Double SPI Speed Bit When this bit is written logic one the SPI speed (SCK Frequency) will be doubled when the SPI is in Master mode (refer to Table 22-5 Relationship between SCK and Oscillator Frequency on page 235). This means that the minimum SCK period will be two CPU clock periods. When the SPI is configured as Slave, the SPI is only guaranteed to work at fosc/4 or lower. The SPI interface is also used for program memory and EEPROM downloading or uploading. See Serial Downloading for serial programming and verification. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 238 22.5.4. SPI Status Register 1 Name: SPSR1 Offset: 0xAD Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 SPIF1 WCOL1 5 4 3 2 1 SPI2X1 0 Access R R R/W Reset 0 0 0 Bit 7 – SPIF1: SPI Interrupt Flag 1 When a serial transfer is complete, the SPIF Flag is set. An interrupt is generated if SPIE in SPCR is set and global interrupts are enabled. If SS is an input and is driven low when the SPI is in Master mode, this will also set the SPIF Flag. SPIF is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, the SPIF bit is cleared by first reading the SPI Status Register with SPIF set, then accessing the SPI Data Register (SPDR). Bit 6 – WCOL1: Write Collision Flag 1 The WCOL bit is set if the SPI Data Register (SPDR) is written during a data transfer. The WCOL bit (and the SPIF bit) are cleared by first reading the SPI Status Register with WCOL set, and then accessing the SPI Data Register. Bit 0 – SPI2X1: Double SPI Speed Bit 1 When this bit is written logic one the SPI speed (SCK Frequency) will be doubled when the SPI is in Master mode (refer to Table 22-5 Relationship between SCK and Oscillator Frequency on page 235). This means that the minimum SCK period will be two CPU clock periods. When the SPI is configured as Slave, the SPI is only guaranteed to work at fosc/4 or lower. The SPI interface is also used for program memory and EEPROM downloading or uploading. See Serial Downloading for serial programming and verification. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 239 22.5.5. SPI Data Register 0 When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: SPDR0 Offset: 0x4E Reset: 0xXX Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x2E Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SPID[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W x x x x x x x x Bits 7:0 – SPID[7:0]: SPI Data The SPI Data Register is a read/write register used for data transfer between the Register File and the SPI Shift Register. Writing to the register initiates data transmission. Reading the register causes the Shift Register Receive buffer to be read. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 240 22.5.6. SPI Data Register 1 Name: SPDR1 Offset: 0xAE Reset: 0xXX Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SPID1[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W x x x x x x x x Bits 7:0 – SPID1[7:0]: SPI Data 1 The SPI Data Register is a read/write register used for data transfer between the Register File and the SPI Shift Register. Writing to the register initiates data transmission. Reading the register causes the Shift Register Receive buffer to be read. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 241 23. USART - Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver 23.1. Features • • • • • • • • • • • • • • 23.2. Three USART instances USART0, USART1, USART2 Full Duplex Operation (Independent Serial Receive and Transmit Registers) Asynchronous or Synchronous Operation Master or Slave Clocked Synchronous Operation High Resolution Baud Rate Generator Supports Serial Frames with 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 data bits and 1 or 2 stop bits Odd or Even Parity Generation and Parity Check Supported by Hardware Data OverRun Detection Framing Error Detection Noise Filtering Includes False Start Bit Detection and Digital Low Pass Filter Three Separate Interrupts on TX Complete, TX Data Register Empty and RX Complete Multi-processor Communication Mode Double Speed Asynchronous Communication Mode Start Frame Detection Overview The Universal Synchronous and Asynchronous serial Receiver and Transmitter (USART) is a highly flexible serial communication device. The USART can also be used in Master SPI mode. The Power Reduction USART bit in the Power Reduction Register (PRR.PRUSARTn) must be written to '0' in order to enable USARTn. USART 0 and 1 are in PRR, and USART 2 is present in PRR2. In the block diagram of the USART Transmitter below, the CPU accessible I/O Registers and I/O pins are shown in bold. The dashed boxes in the block diagram separate the three main parts of the USART (listed from the top): Clock Generator, Transmitter, and Receiver. Control Registers are shared by all units. The Clock Generation logic consists of synchronization logic for external clock input used by synchronous slave operation, and the baud rate generator. The XCKn (Transfer Clock) pin is only used by synchronous transfer mode. The Transmitter consists of a single write buffer, a serial Shift Register, Parity Generator, and Control logic for handling different serial frame formats. The write buffer allows a continuous transfer of data without any delay between frames. The Receiver is the most complex part of the USART module due to its clock and data recovery units. The recovery units are used for asynchronous data reception. In addition to the recovery units, the Receiver includes a Parity Checker, Control logic, a Shift Register, and a two level receive buffer (UDRn). The Receiver supports the same frame formats as the Transmitter, and can detect Frame Error, Data OverRun, and Parity Errors. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 242 Figure 23-1 USART Block Diagram Clock Generator UBRRn [H:L] OSC BAUD RATE GENERATOR SYNC LOGIC PIN CONTROL XCKn Transmitter TX CONTROL DATA BUS UDRn(Transmit) PARITY GENERATOR PIN CONTROL TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER TxDn Receiver CLOCK RECOVERY RX CONTROL RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER DATA RECOVERY PIN CONTROL UDRn (Receive) PARITY CHECKER UCSRnA UCSRnB RxDn UCSRnC Note: Refer to the Pin Configurations and the I/O-Ports description for USART pin placement. Related Links USARTSPI - USART in SPI Mode on page 274 I/O-Ports on page 99 Pin Configurations on page 13 23.3. Clock Generation The Clock Generation logic generates the base clock for the Transmitter and Receiver. The USART supports four modes of clock operation: Normal asynchronous, Double Speed asynchronous, Master synchronous and Slave synchronous mode. The USART Mode Select bit 0 in the USART Control and Status Register n C (UCSRnC.UMSELn0) selects between asynchronous and synchronous operation. Double Speed (asynchronous mode only) is controlled by the U2Xn found in the UCSRnA Register. When using synchronous mode (UMSELn0=1), the Data Direction Register for the XCKn pin (DDR_XCKn) controls whether the clock source is internal (Master mode) or external (Slave mode). The XCKn pin is only active when using synchronous mode. Below is a block diagram of the clock generation logic. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 243 Figure 23-2 Clock Generation Logic, Block Diagram UBRRn U2Xn fosc Prescaling Down-Counter UBRRn+1 /2 /4 /2 0 1 0 OSC DDR_XCKn xcki XCKn Pin Sync Register Edge Detector 0 xcko DDR_XCKn UMSELn 1 UCPOLn txclk 1 1 0 rxclk Signal description: 23.3.1. • txclk: Transmitter clock (internal signal). • • • • rxclk: Receiver base clock (internal signal). xcki: Input from XCKn pin (internal signal). Used for synchronous slave operation. xcko: Clock output to XCKn pin (internal signal). Used for synchronous master operation. fosc: System clock frequency. Internal Clock Generation – The Baud Rate Generator Internal clock generation is used for the asynchronous and the synchronous master modes of operation. The description in this section refers to the Clock Generation Logic block diagram in the previous section.. The USART Baud Rate Register (UBRRn) and the down-counter connected to it function as a programmable prescaler or baud rate generator. The down-counter, running at system clock (fosc), is loaded with the UBRRn value each time the counter has counted down to zero or when the UBRRnL Register is written. A clock is generated each time the counter reaches zero. This clock is the baud rate generator clock output (= fosc/(UBRRn+1)). The Transmitter divides the baud rate generator clock output by 2, 8, or 16 depending on mode. The baud rate generator output is used directly by the Receiver’s clock and data recovery units. However, the recovery units use a state machine that uses 2, 8, or 16 states depending on mode set by the state of the UMSEL, U2X and DDR_XCK bits. The table below contains equations for calculating the baud rate (in bits per second) and for calculating the UBRRn value for each mode of operation using an internally generated clock source. Table 23-1 Equations for Calculating Baud Rate Register Setting Operating Mode Asynchronous Normal mode (U2X = 0) Asynchronous Double Speed mode (U2X = 1) Synchronous Master mode Equation for Calculating Baud Rate(1) BAUD = BAUD = BAUD = Equation for Calculating UBRRn Value �OSC 16 ����� + 1 ����� = �OSC 2 ����� + 1 ����� = �OSC 8 ����� + 1 ����� = �OSC + −1 16BAUD �OSC + −1 8BAUD �OSC + −1 2BAUD Note: 1. The baud rate is defined to be the transfer rate in bits per second (bps) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 244 BAUD Baud rate (in bits per second, bps) fOSC System oscillator clock frequency UBRRn Contents of the UBRRnH and UBRRnL Registers, (0-4095). Some examples of UBRRn values for some system clock frequencies are found in Examples of Baud Rate Settings. 23.3.2. Double Speed Operation (U2Xn) The transfer rate can be doubled by setting the U2Xn bit in UCSRnA. Setting this bit only has effect for the asynchronous operation. Set this bit to zero when using synchronous operation. Setting this bit will reduce the divisor of the baud rate divider from 16 to 8, effectively doubling the transfer rate for asynchronous communication. However, in this case , the Receiver will only use half the number of samples (reduced from 16 to 8) for data sampling and clock recovery, and therefore a more accurate baud rate setting and system clock are required when this mode is used. For the Transmitter, there are no downsides. 23.3.3. External Clock External clocking is used by the synchronous slave modes of operation. The description in this section refers to the Clock Generation Logic block diagram in the previous section. External clock input from the XCKn pin is sampled by a synchronization register to minimize the chance of meta-stability. The output from the synchronization register must then pass through an edge detector before it can be used by the Transmitter and Receiver. This process introduces a two CPU clock period delay and therefore the maximum external XCKn clock frequency is limited by the following equation: �XCKn < �OSC 4 The value of fosc depends on the stability of the system clock source. It is therefore recommended to add some margin to avoid possible loss of data due to frequency variations. 23.3.4. Synchronous Clock Operation When synchronous mode is used (UMSELn = 1), the XCKn pin will be used as either clock input (Slave) or clock output (Master). The dependency between the clock edges and data sampling or data change is the same. The basic principle is that data input (on RxDn) is sampled at the opposite XCKn clock edge of the edge the data output (TxDn) is changed. Figure 23-3 Synchronous Mode XCKn Timing UCPOL = 1 XCKn RxDn / TxDn Sample UCPOL = 0 XCKn RxDn / TxDn Sample The UCPOLn bit UCRSC selects which XCKn clock edge is used for data sampling and which is used for data change. As the above timing diagram shows, when UCPOLn is zero, the data will be changed at Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 245 rising XCKn edge and sampled at falling XCKn edge. If UCPOLn is set, the data will be changed at falling XCKn edge and sampled at rising XCKn edge. 23.4. Frame Formats A serial frame is defined to be one character of data bits with synchronization bits (start and stop bits), and optionally a parity bit for error checking. The USART accepts all 30 combinations of the following as valid frame formats: • • • • 1 start bit 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 data bits no, even or odd parity bit 1 or 2 stop bits A frame starts with the start bit, followed by the data bits (from five up to nine data bits in total): first the least significant data bit, then the next data bits ending with the most significant bit. If enabled, the parity bit is inserted after the data bits, before the one or two stop bits. When a complete frame is transmitted, it can be directly followed by a new frame, or the communication line can be set to an idle (high) state. the figure below illustrates the possible combinations of the frame formats. Bits inside brackets are optional. Figure 23-4 Frame Formats FRAME (IDLE) St 0 1 2 3 4 [5] [6] [7] [8] [P] Sp (St / IDLE) St Start bit, always low. (n) Data bits (0 to 8). P Parity bit. Can be odd or even. Sp Stop bit, always high. IDLE No transfers on the communication line (RxDn or TxDn). An IDLE line must be high. The frame format used by the USART is set by: • Character Size bits (UCSRnC.UCSZn[2:0]) select the number of data bits in the frame. • Parity Mode bits (UCSRnC.UPMn[1:0]) enable and set the type of parity bit. • Stop Bit Select bit (UCSRnC.USBSn) select the number of stop bits. The Receiver ignores the second stop bit. The Receiver and Transmitter use the same setting. Note that changing the setting of any of these bits will corrupt all ongoing communication for both the Receiver and Transmitter. An FE (Frame Error) will only be detected in cases where the first stop bit is zero. 23.4.1. Parity Bit Calculation The parity bit is calculated by doing an exclusive-or of all the data bits. If odd parity is used, the result of the exclusive or is inverted. The relation between the parity bit and data bits is as follows: �even = �� + Peven − 1 ⊕ … ⊕ �3 ⊕ �2 ⊕ �1 ⊕ �0 ⊕ 0�odd Parity bit using even parity = �� + − 1 ⊕ … ⊕ �3 ⊕ � 2 ⊕ �1 ⊕ �0 ⊕ 1 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 246 Podd dn Parity bit using odd parity Data bit n of the character If used, the parity bit is located between the last data bit and first stop bit of a serial frame. 23.5. USART Initialization The USART has to be initialized before any communication can take place. The initialization process normally consists of setting the baud rate, setting frame format and enabling the Transmitter or the Receiver depending on the usage. For interrupt driven USART operation, the Global Interrupt Flag should be cleared (and interrupts globally disabled) when doing the initialization. Before doing a re-initialization with changed baud rate or frame format, be sure that there are no ongoing transmissions during the period the registers are changed. The TXC Flag (UCSRnA.TXC) can be used to check that the Transmitter has completed all transfers, and the RXC Flag can be used to check that there are no unread data in the receive buffer. The UCSRnA.TXC must be cleared before each transmission (before UDRn is written) if it is used for this purpose. The following simple USART initialization code examples show one assembly and one C function that are equal in functionality. The examples assume asynchronous operation using polling (no interrupts enabled) and a fixed frame format. The baud rate is given as a function parameter. For the assembly code, the baud rate parameter is assumed to be stored in the r17, r16 Registers. Assembly Code Example USART_Init: ; Set baud rate to UBRR0 out UBRR0H, r17 out UBRR0L, r16 ; Enable receiver and transmitter ldi r16, (1<<RXEN0)|(1<<TXEN0) out UCSR0B,r16 ; Set frame format: 8data, 2stop bit ldi r16, (1<<USBS0)|(3<<UCSZ00) out UCSR0C,r16 ret C Code Example #define FOSC 1843200 // Clock Speed #define BAUD 9600 #define MYUBRR FOSC/16/BAUD-1 void main( void ) { ... USART_Init(MYUBRR) ... } void USART_Init( unsigned int ubrr) { /*Set baud rate */ UBRR0H = (unsigned char)(ubrr>>8); UBRR0L = (unsigned char)ubrr; Enable receiver and transmitter */ UCSR0B = (1<<RXEN0)|(1<<TXEN0); /* Set frame format: 8data, 2stop bit */ Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 247 } UCSR0C = (1<<USBS0)|(3<<UCSZ00); More advanced initialization routines can be written to include frame format as parameters, disable interrupts, and so on. However, many applications use a fixed setting of the baud and control registers, and for these types of applications the initialization code can be placed directly in the main routine, or be combined with initialization code for other I/O modules. Related Links About Code Examples on page 17 23.6. Data Transmission – The USART Transmitter The USART Transmitter is enabled by setting the Transmit Enable (TXEN) bit in the UCSRnB Register. When the Transmitter is enabled, the normal port operation of the TxDn pin is overridden by the USART and given the function as the Transmitter’s serial output. The baud rate, mode of operation and frame format must be set up once before doing any transmissions. If synchronous operation is used, the clock on the XCKn pin will be overridden and used as transmission clock. 23.6.1. Sending Frames with 5 to 8 Data Bits A data transmission is initiated by loading the transmit buffer with the data to be transmitted. The CPU can load the transmit buffer by writing to the UDRn I/O location. The buffered data in the transmit buffer will be moved to the Shift Register when the Shift Register is ready to send a new frame. The Shift Register is loaded with new data if it is in idle state (no ongoing transmission) or immediately after the last stop bit of the previous frame is transmitted. When the Shift Register is loaded with new data, it will transfer one complete frame at the rate given by the Baud Register, U2X bit or by XCKn depending on mode of operation. The following code examples show a simple USART transmit function based on polling of the Data Register Empty (UDRE) Flag. When using frames with less than eight bits, the most significant bits written to the UDR0 are ignored. The USART 0 has to be initialized before the function can be used. For the assembly code, the data to be sent is assumed to be stored in Register R17. Assembly Code Example USART_Transmit: ; Wait for empty transmit buffer in r17, UCSR0A sbrs r17, UDRE rjmp USART_Transmit ; Put data (r16) into buffer, sends the data out UDR0,r16 ret C Code Example void USART_Transmit( unsigned char data ) { /* Wait for empty transmit buffer */ while ( !( UCSR0A & (1<<UDRE)) ) ; /* Put data into buffer, sends the data */ Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 248 } UDR0 = data; The function simply waits for the transmit buffer to be empty by checking the UDRE Flag, before loading it with new data to be transmitted. If the Data Register Empty interrupt is utilized, the interrupt routine writes the data into the buffer. Related Links About Code Examples on page 17 23.6.2. Sending Frames with 9 Data Bit If 9-bit characters are used (UCSZn = 7), the ninth bit must be written to the TXB8 bit in UCSRnB before the low byte of the character is written to UDRn. The ninth bit can be used for indicating an address frame when using multi processor communication mode or for other protocol handling as for example synchronization. The following code examples show a transmit function that handles 9-bit characters. For the assembly code, the data to be sent is assumed to be stored in registers R17:R16. Assembly Code Example USART_Transmit: ; Wait for empty transmit buffer in r18, UCSR0A sbrs r18, UDRE rjmp USART_Transmit ; Copy 9th bit from r17 to TXB8 cbi UCSR0B,TXB8 sbrc r17,0 sbi UCSR0B,TXB8 ; Put LSB data (r16) into buffer, sends the data out UDR0,r16 ret C Code Example void USART_Transmit( unsigned int data ) { /* Wait for empty transmit buffer */ while ( !( UCSR0A & (1<<UDRE))) ) ; /* Copy 9th bit to TXB8 */ UCSR0B &= ~(1<<TXB8); if ( data & 0x0100 ) UCSR0B |= (1<<TXB8); /* Put data into buffer, sends the data */ UDR0 = data; } Note: These transmit functions are written to be general functions. They can be optimized if the contents of the UCSRnB is static. For example, only the TXB8 bit of the UCSRnB Register is used after initialization. Related Links About Code Examples on page 17 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 249 23.6.3. Transmitter Flags and Interrupts The USART Transmitter has two flags that indicate its state: USART Data Register Empty (UDREn) and Transmit Complete (TXCn). Both flags can be used for generating interrupts. The Data Register Empty (UDREn) Flag indicates whether the transmit buffer is ready to receive new data. This bit is set when the transmit buffer is empty, and cleared when the transmit buffer contains data to be transmitted that has not yet been moved into the Shift Register. For compatibility with future devices, always write this bit to zero when writing the UCSRnA Register. When the Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable (UDRIEn) bit in UCSRnB is written to '1', the USART Data Register Empty Interrupt will be executed as long as UDREn is set (provided that global interrupts are enabled). UDREn is cleared by writing UDRn. When interrupt-driven data transmission is used, the Data Register Empty interrupt routine must either write new data to UDRn in order to clear UDREn or disable the Data Register Empty interrupt - otherwise, a new interrupt will occur once the interrupt routine terminates. The Transmit Complete (TXCn) Flag bit is set when the entire frame in the Transmit Shift Register has been shifted out and there are no new data currently present in the transmit buffer. The TXCn Flag bit is either automatically cleared when a transmit complete interrupt is executed, or it can be cleared by writing a '1' to its bit location. The TXCn Flag is useful in half-duplex communication interfaces (like the RS-485 standard), where a transmitting application must enter receive mode and free the communication bus immediately after completing the transmission. When the Transmit Compete Interrupt Enable (TXCIEn) bit in UCSRnB is written to '1', the USART Transmit Complete Interrupt will be executed when the TXCn Flag becomes set (provided that global interrupts are enabled). When the transmit complete interrupt is used, the interrupt handling routine does not have to clear the TXCn Flag, this is done automatically when the interrupt is executed. 23.6.4. Parity Generator The Parity Generator calculates the parity bit for the serial frame data. When parity bit is enabled (UPMn1 = 1), the transmitter control logic inserts the parity bit between the last data bit and the first stop bit of the frame that is sent. 23.6.5. Disabling the Transmitter When writing the TX Enable bit in the USART Control and Status Register n B (UCSRnB.TXENn) to zero, the disabling of the Transmitter will not become effective until ongoing and pending transmissions are completed, i.e., when the Transmit Shift Register and Transmit Buffer Register do not contain data to be transmitted. When disabled, the Transmitter will no longer override the TxDn pin. 23.7. Data Reception – The USART Receiver The USART Receiver is enabled by writing the Receive Enable (RXEN) bit in the UCSRnB Register to '1'. When the Receiver is enabled, the normal pin operation of the RxDn pin is overridden by the USART and given the function as the Receiver’s serial input. The baud rate, mode of operation and frame format must be set up once before any serial reception can be done. If synchronous operation is used, the clock on the XCKn pin will be used as transfer clock. 23.7.1. Receiving Frames with 5 to 8 Data Bits The Receiver starts data reception when it detects a valid start bit. Each bit that follows the start bit will be sampled at the baud rate or XCKn clock, and shifted into the Receive Shift Register until the first stop bit of a frame is received. A second stop bit will be ignored by the Receiver. When the first stop bit is received, i.e., a complete serial frame is present in the Receive Shift Register, the contents of the Shift Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 250 Register will be moved into the receive buffer. The receive buffer can then be read by reading the UDRn I/O location. The following code example shows a simple USART receive function based on polling of the Receive Complete (RXC) Flag. When using frames with less than eight bits the most significant bits of the data read from the UDR0 will be masked to zero. The USART 0 has to be initialized before the function can be used. For the assembly code, the received data will be stored in R16 after the code completes. Assembly Code Example USART_Receive: ; Wait for data to be received in r17, UCSR0A sbrs r17, RXC rjmp USART_Receive ; Get and return received data from buffer in r16, UDR0 ret C Code Example unsigned char USART_Receive( void ) { /* Wait for data to be received */ while ( !(UCSR0A & (1<<RXC)) ) ; /* Get and return received data from buffer */ return UDR0; } For I/O Registers located in extended I/O map, “IN”, “OUT”, “SBIS”, “SBIC”, “CBI”, and “SBI” instructions must be replaced with instructions that allow access to extended I/O. Typically “LDS” and “STS” combined with “SBRS”, “SBRC”, “SBR”, and “CBR”. The function simply waits for data to be present in the receive buffer by checking the RXC Flag, before reading the buffer and returning the value. Related Links About Code Examples on page 17 23.7.2. Receiving Frames with 9 Data Bits If 9-bit characters are used (UCSZn=7) the ninth bit must be read from the RXB8 bit in UCSRnB before reading the low bits from the UDRn. This rule applies to the FE, DOR and UPE Status Flags as well. Read status from UCSRnA, then data from UDRn. Reading the UDRn I/O location will change the state of the receive buffer FIFO and consequently the TXB8, FE, DOR and UPE bits, which all are stored in the FIFO, will change. The following code example shows a simple receive function for USART0 that handles both nine bit characters and the status bits. For the assembly code, the received data will be stored in R17:R16 after the code completes. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 251 Assembly Code Example USART_Receive: ; Wait for data to be received in r16, UCSR0A sbrs r16, RXC rjmp USART_Receive ; Get status and 9th bit, then data from buffer in r18, UCSR0A in r17, UCSR0B in r16, UDR0 ; If error, return -1 andi r18,(1<<FE)|(1<<DOR)|(1<<UPE) breq USART_ReceiveNoError ldi r17, HIGH(-1) ldi r16, LOW(-1) USART_ReceiveNoError: ; Filter the 9th bit, then return lsr r17 andi r17, 0x01 ret C Code Example unsigned int USART_Receive( void ) { unsigned char status, resh, resl; /* Wait for data to be received */ while ( !(UCSR0A & (1<<RXC)) ) ; /* Get status and 9th bit, then data */ /* from buffer */ status = UCSR0A; resh = UCSR0B; resl = UDR0; /* If error, return -1 */ if ( status & (1<<FE)|(1<<DOR)|(1<<UPE) ) return -1; /* Filter the 9th bit, then return */ resh = (resh >> 1) & 0x01; return ((resh << 8) | resl); } The receive function example reads all the I/O Registers into the Register File before any computation is done. This gives an optimal receive buffer utilization since the buffer location read will be free to accept new data as early as possible. Related Links About Code Examples on page 17 23.7.3. Receive Compete Flag and Interrupt The USART Receiver has one flag that indicates the Receiver state. The Receive Complete (RXC) Flag indicates if there are unread data present in the receive buffer. This flag is one when unread data exist in the receive buffer, and zero when the receive buffer is empty (i.e., does not contain any unread data). If the Receiver is disabled (RXEN = 0), the receive buffer will be flushed and consequently the RXCn bit will become zero. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 252 When the Receive Complete Interrupt Enable (RXCIE) in UCSRnB is set, the USART Receive Complete interrupt will be executed as long as the RXC Flag is set (provided that global interrupts are enabled). When interrupt-driven data reception is used, the receive complete routine must read the received data from UDR in order to clear the RXC Flag, otherwise a new interrupt will occur once the interrupt routine terminates. 23.7.4. Receiver Error Flags The USART Receiver has three Error Flags: Frame Error (FE), Data OverRun (DOR) and Parity Error (UPE). All can be accessed by reading UCSRnA. Common for the Error Flags is that they are located in the receive buffer together with the frame for which they indicate the error status. Due to the buffering of the Error Flags, the UCSRnA must be read before the receive buffer (UDRn), since reading the UDRn I/O location changes the buffer read location. Another equality for the Error Flags is that they can not be altered by software doing a write to the flag location. However, all flags must be set to zero when the UCSRnA is written for upward compatibility of future USART implementations. None of the Error Flags can generate interrupts. The Frame Error (FE) Flag indicates the state of the first stop bit of the next readable frame stored in the receive buffer. The FE Flag is zero when the stop bit was correctly read as '1', and the FE Flag will be one when the stop bit was incorrect (zero). This flag can be used for detecting out-of-sync conditions, detecting break conditions and protocol handling. The FE Flag is not affected by the setting of the USBS bit in UCSRnC since the Receiver ignores all, except for the first, stop bits. For compatibility with future devices, always set this bit to zero when writing to UCSRnA. The Data OverRun (DOR) Flag indicates data loss due to a receiver buffer full condition. A Data OverRun occurs when the receive buffer is full (two characters), a new character is waiting in the Receive Shift Register, and a new start bit is detected. If the DOR Flag is set, one or more serial frames were lost between the last frame read from UDR, and the next frame read from UDR. For compatibility with future devices, always write this bit to zero when writing to UCSRnA. The DOR Flag is cleared when the frame received was successfully moved from the Shift Register to the receive buffer. The Parity Error (UPE) Flag indicates that the next frame in the receive buffer had a Parity Error when received. If Parity Check is not enabled the UPE bit will always read '0'. For compatibility with future devices, always set this bit to zero when writing to UCSRnA. For more details see Parity Bit Calculation and 'Parity Checker' below. 23.7.5. Parity Checker The Parity Checker is active when the high USART Parity Mode bit 1 in the USART Control and Status Register n C (UCSRnC.UPM[1]) is written to '1'. The type of Parity Check to be performed (odd or even) is selected by the UCSRnC.UPM[0] bit. When enabled, the Parity Checker calculates the parity of the data bits in incoming frames and compares the result with the parity bit from the serial frame. The result of the check is stored in the receive buffer together with the received data and stop bits. The USART Parity Error Flag in the USART Control and Status Register n A (UCSRnA.UPE) can then be read by software to check if the frame had a Parity Error. The UPEn bit is set if the next character that can be read from the receive buffer had a Parity Error when received and the Parity Checking was enabled at that point (UPM[1] = 1). This bit is valid until the receive buffer (UDRn) is read. 23.7.6. Disabling the Receiver In contrast to the Transmitter, disabling of the Receiver will be immediate. Data from ongoing receptions will therefore be lost. When disabled (i.e., UCSRnB.RXEN is written to zero) the Receiver will no longer override the normal function of the RxDn port pin. The Receiver buffer FIFO will be flushed when the Receiver is disabled. Remaining data in the buffer will be lost. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 253 23.7.7. Flushing the Receive Buffer The receiver buffer FIFO will be flushed when the Receiver is disabled, i.e., the buffer will be emptied of its contents. Unread data will be lost. If the buffer has to be flushed during normal operation, due to for instance an error condition, read the UDRn I/O location until the RXCn Flag is cleared. The following code shows how to flush the receive buffer of USART0. Assembly Code Example USART_Flush: in r16, UCSR0A sbrs r16, RXC ret in r16, UDR0 rjmp USART_Flush C Code Example void USART_Flush( void ) { unsigned char dummy; while ( UCSR0A & (1<<RXC) ) dummy = UDR0; } Related Links About Code Examples on page 17 23.8. Asynchronous Data Reception The USART includes a clock recovery and a data recovery unit for handling asynchronous data reception. The clock recovery logic is used for synchronizing the internally generated baud rate clock to the incoming asynchronous serial frames at the RxDn pin. The data recovery logic samples and low pass filters each incoming bit, thereby improving the noise immunity of the Receiver. The asynchronous reception operational range depends on the accuracy of the internal baud rate clock, the rate of the incoming frames, and the frame size in number of bits. 23.8.1. Asynchronous Clock Recovery The clock recovery logic synchronizes internal clock to the incoming serial frames. The figure below illustrates the sampling process of the start bit of an incoming frame. The sample rate is 16times the baud rate for Normal mode, and 8 times the baud rate for Double Speed mode. The horizontal arrows illustrate the synchronization variation due to the sampling process. Note the larger time variation when using the Double Speed mode (U2Xn=1) of operation. Samples denoted '0' are samples taken while the RxDn line is idle (i.e., no communication activity). Figure 23-5 Start Bit Sampling RxDn IDLE START BIT 0 Sample (U2X = 0) 0 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1 2 3 Sample (U2X = 1) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 254 When the clock recovery logic detects a high (idle) to low (start) transition on the RxDn line, the start bit detection sequence is initiated. Let sample 1 denote the first zero-sample as shown in the figure. The clock recovery logic then uses samples 8, 9, and 10 for Normal mode, and samples 4, 5, and 6 for Double Speed mode (indicated with sample numbers inside boxes on the figure), to decide if a valid start bit is received. If two or more of these three samples have logical high levels (the majority wins), the start bit is rejected as a noise spike and the Receiver starts looking for the next high to low-transition on RxDn. If however, a valid start bit is detected, the clock recovery logic is synchronized and the data recovery can begin. The synchronization process is repeated for each start bit. 23.8.2. Asynchronous Data Recovery When the receiver clock is synchronized to the start bit, the data recovery can begin. The data recovery unit uses a state machine that has 16 states for each bit in Normal mode and eight states for each bit in Double Speed mode. The figure below shows the sampling of the data bits and the parity bit. Each of the samples is given a number that is equal to the state of the recovery unit. Figure 23-6 Sampling of Data and Parity Bit RxDn BIT n Sample (U2X = 0) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1 Sample (U2X = 1) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 The decision of the logic level of the received bit is taken by doing a majority voting of the logic value to the three samples in the center of the received bit: If two or all three center samples (those marked by their sample number inside boxes) have high levels, the received bit is registered to be a logic '1'. If two or all three samples have low levels, the received bit is registered to be a logic '0'. This majority voting process acts as a low pass filter for the incoming signal on the RxDn pin. The recovery process is then repeated until a complete frame is received, including the first stop bit. The Receiver only uses the first stop bit of a frame. The following figure shows the sampling of the stop bit and the earliest possible beginning of the start bit of the next frame. Figure 23-7 Stop Bit Sampling and Next Start Bit Sampling RxD STOP 1 (A) (B) (C) Sample (U2X = 0) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 0/1 0/1 0/1 Sample (U2X = 1) 1 2 3 4 5 6 0/1 The same majority voting is done to the stop bit as done for the other bits in the frame. If the stop bit is registered to have a logic '0' value, the Frame Error (FEn) Flag will be set. A new high to low transition indicating the start bit of a new frame can come right after the last of the bits used for majority voting. For Normal Speed mode, the first low level sample can be taken at point marked (A) in the figure above. For Double Speed mode, the first low level must be delayed to (B). (C) marks a stop bit of full length. The early start bit detection influences the operational range of the Receiver. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 255 23.8.3. Asynchronous Operational Range The operational range of the Receiver is dependent on the mismatch between the received bit rate and the internally generated baud rate. If the Transmitter is sending frames at too fast or too slow bit rates, or the internally generated baud rate of the Receiver does not have a similar base frequency (see recommendations below), the Receiver will not be able to synchronize the frames to the start bit. The following equations can be used to calculate the ratio of the incoming data rate and internal receiver baud rate. �slow = • • • • • �+1 � � + − 1 + � ⋅ � + �� �fast = �+2 � � + 1 � + �� D Sum of character size and parity size (D = 5 to 10 bit) S Samples per bit. S = 16 for Normal Speed mode and S = 8 for Double Speed mode. SF First sample number used for majority voting. SF = 8 for normal speed and SF = 4 for Double Speed mode. SM Middle sample number used for majority voting. SM = 9 for normal speed and SM = 5 for Double Speed mode. Rslow is the ratio of the slowest incoming data rate that can be accepted in relation to the receiver baud rate. Rfast is the ratio of the fastest incoming data rate that can be accepted in relation to the receiver baud rate. The following tables list the maximum receiver baud rate error that can be tolerated. Note that Normal Speed mode has higher toleration of baud rate variations. Table 23-2 Recommended Maximum Receiver Baud Rate Error for Normal Speed Mode (U2Xn = 0) D # (Data+Parity Bit) Rslow [%] Rfast [%] Max. Total Error [%] Recommended Max. Receiver Error [%] 5 93.20 106.67 +6.67/-6.8 ±3.0 6 94.12 105.79 +5.79/-5.88 ±2.5 7 94.81 105.11 +5.11/-5.19 ±2.0 8 95.36 104.58 +4.58/-4.54 ±2.0 9 95.81 104.14 +4.14/-4.19 ±1.5 10 96.17 103.78 +3.78/-3.83 ±1.5 Table 23-3 Recommended Maximum Receiver Baud Rate Error for Double Speed Mode (U2Xn = 1) D # (Data+Parity Bit) Rslow [%] Rfast [%] Max Total Error [%] Recommended Max Receiver Error [%] 5 94.12 105.66 +5.66/-5.88 ±2.5 6 94.92 104.92 +4.92/-5.08 ±2.0 7 95.52 104,35 +4.35/-4.48 ±1.5 8 96.00 103.90 +3.90/-4.00 ±1.5 9 96.39 103.53 +3.53/-3.61 ±1.5 10 96.70 103.23 +3.23/-3.30 ±1.0 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 256 The recommendations of the maximum receiver baud rate error was made under the assumption that the Receiver and Transmitter equally divides the maximum total error. There are two possible sources for the receivers baud rate error. The Receiver’s system clock (EXTCLK) will always have some minor instability over the supply voltage range and the temperature range. When using a crystal to generate the system clock, this is rarely a problem, but for a resonator, the system clock may differ more than 2% depending of the resonator's tolerance. The second source for the error is more controllable. The baud rate generator can not always do an exact division of the system frequency to get the baud rate wanted. In this case an UBRRn value that gives an acceptable low error can be used if possible. 23.8.4. Start Frame Detection The USART start frame detector can wake up the MCU from Power-down and Standby sleep mode when it detects a start bit. When a high-to-low transition is detected on RxDn, the internal 8MHz oscillator is powered up and the USART clock is enabled. After start-up the rest of the data frame can be received, provided that the baud rate is slow enough in relation to the internal 8MHz oscillator start-up time. Start-up time of the internal 8MHz oscillator varies with supply voltage and temperature. The USART start frame detection works both in asynchronous and synchronous modes. It is enabled by writing the Start Frame Detection Enable bit (SFDEn). If the USART Start Interrupt Enable (RXSIE) bit is set, the USART Receive Start Interrupt is generated immediately when start is detected. When using the feature without start interrupt, the start detection logic activates the internal 8MHz oscillator and the USART clock while the frame is being received, only. Other clocks remain stopped until the Receive Complete Interrupt wakes up the MCU. The maximum baud rate in synchronous mode depends on the sleep mode the device is woken up from, as follows: • • Idle sleep mode: system clock frequency divided by four Standby or Power-down: 500kbps The maximum baud rate in asynchronous mode depends on the sleep mode the device is woken up from, as follows: • Idle sleep mode: the same as in active mode Table 23-4 Maximum Total Baudrate Error in Normal Speed Mode Baudrate Frame Size 5 6 7 8 9 10 0 - 28.8kbps +6.67 -5.88 +5.79 -5.08 +5.11 -4.48 +4.58 -4.00 +4.14 -3.61 +3.78 -3.30 38.4kbps +6.63 -5.88 +5.75 -5.08 +5.08 -4.48 +4.55 -4.00 +4.12 -3.61 +3.76 -3.30 57.6kbps +6.10 -5.88 +5.30 -5.08 +4.69 -4.48 +4.20 -4.00 +3.80 -3.61 +3.47 -3.30 76.8kbps +5.59 -5.88 +4.85 -5.08 +4.29 -4.48 +3.85 -4.00 +3.48 -3.61 +3.18 -3.30 115.2kbps +4.57 -5.88 +3.97 -5.08 +3.51 -4.48 +3.15 -4.00 +2.86 -3.61 +2.61 -3.30 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 257 Table 23-5 Maximum Total Baudrate Error in Double Speed Mode Baudrate Frame Size 5 6 7 8 9 10 0 - 57.6kbps +5.66 -4.00 +4.92 -3.45 +4.35 -3.03 +3.90 -2.70 +3.53 -2.44 +3.23 -2.22 76.8kbps +5.59 -4.00 +4.85 -3.45 +4.29 -3.03 +3.85 -2.70 +3.48 -2.44 +3.18 -2.22 115.2kbps +4.57 -4.00 +3.97 -3.45 +3.51 -3.03 +3.15 -2.70 +2.86 -2.44 +2.61 -2.22 23.9. Multi-Processor Communication Mode Setting the Multi-Processor Communication mode (MPCMn) bit in UCSRnA enables a filtering function of incoming frames received by the USART Receiver. Frames that do not contain address information will be ignored and not put into the receive buffer. This effectively reduces the number of incoming frames that has to be handled by the CPU, in a system with multiple MCUs that communicate via the same serial bus. The Transmitter is unaffected by the MPCMn setting, but has to be used differently when it is a part of a system utilizing the Multi-processor Communication mode. If the Receiver is set up to receive frames that contain 5 to 8 data bits, then the first stop bit indicates if the frame contains data or address information. If the Receiver is set up for frames with 9 data bits, then the ninth bit (RXB8) is used for identifying address and data frames. When the frame type bit (the first stop or the ninth bit) is '1', the frame contains an address. When the frame type bit is '0', the frame is a data frame. The Multi-Processor Communication mode enables several slave MCUs to receive data from a master MCU. This is done by first decoding an address frame to find out which MCU has been addressed. If a particular slave MCU has been addressed, it will receive the following data frames as normal, while the other slave MCUs will ignore the received frames until another address frame is received. 23.9.1. Using MPCMn For an MCU to act as a master MCU, it can use a 9-bit character frame format (UCSZn=7). The ninth bit (TXB8n) must be set when an address frame (TXB8n = 1) or cleared when a data frame (TXB = 0) is being transmitted. The slave MCUs must in this case be set to use a 9-bit character frame format. The following procedure should be used to exchange data in Multi-Processor Communication Mode: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. All Slave MCUs are in Multi-Processor Communication mode (MPCMn in UCSRnA is set). The Master MCU sends an address frame, and all slaves receive and read this frame. In the Slave MCUs, the RXCn Flag in UCSRnA will be set as normal. Each Slave MCU reads the UDRn Register and determines if it has been selected. If so, it clears the MPCMn bit in UCSRnA, otherwise it waits for the next address byte and keeps the MPCMn setting. The addressed MCU will receive all data frames until a new address frame is received. The other Slave MCUs, which still have the MPCMn bit set, will ignore the data frames. When the last data frame is received by the addressed MCU, the addressed MCU sets the MPCMn bit and waits for a new address frame from master. The process then repeats from step 2. Using any of the 5- to 8-bit character frame formats is possible, but impractical since the Receiver must change between using n and n+1 character frame formats. This makes full-duplex operation difficult since Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 258 the Transmitter and Receiver uses the same character size setting. If 5- to 8-bit character frames are used, the Transmitter must be set to use two stop bit (USBSn = 1) since the first stop bit is used for indicating the frame type. Do not use Read-Modify-Write instructions (SBI and CBI) to set or clear the MPCMn bit. The MPCMn bit shares the same I/O location as the TXCn Flag and this might accidentally be cleared when using SBI or CBI instructions. 23.10. Examples of Baud Rate Setting For standard crystal and resonator frequencies, the most commonly used baud rates for asynchronous operation can be generated by using the UBRRn settings as listed in the table below. UBRRn values which yield an actual baud rate differing less than 0.5% from the target baud rate, are bold in the table. Higher error ratings are acceptable, but the Receiver will have less noise resistance when the error ratings are high, especially for large serial frames (see also section Asynchronous Operational Range). The error values are calculated using the following equation: Table 23-6 Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies Baud Rate [bps] fosc = 1.0000MHz fosc = 1.8432MHz fosc = 2.0000MHz U2X = 0 U2X = 1 U2X = 0 U2X = 1 UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error 2400 25 0.2% 51 0.2% 47 0.0% 95 0.0% 51 0.2% 103 0.2% 4800 12 0.2% 25 0.2% 23 0.0% 47 0.0% 25 0.2% 51 0.2% 9600 6 -7.0% 12 0.2% 11 0.0% 23 0.0% 12 0.2% 25 0.2% 14.4k 3 8.5% 8 -3.5% 7 0.0% 15 0.0% 8 -3.5% 16 2.1% 19.2k 2 8.5% 6 -7.0% 5 0.0% 11 0.0% 6 -7.0% 12 0.2% 28.8k 1 8.5% 3 8.5% 3 0.0% 7 0.0% 3 8.5% 8 -3.5% 38.4k 1 -18.6% 2 8.5% 2 0.0% 5 0.0% 2 8.5% 6 -7.0% 57.6k 0 8.5% 1 8.5% 1 0.0% 3 0.0% 1 8.5% 3 8.5% 76.8k – – 1 -18.6% 1 -25.0% 2 0.0% 1 -18.6% 2 8.5% 115.2k – – 0 8.5% 0 0.0% 1 0.0% 0 8.5% 1 8.5% 230.4k – – – – – – 0 0.0% – – – – 250k – – – – – – – – – – 0 0.0% Max.(1) 62.5kbps 125kbps 115.2kbps U2X = 0 230.4kbps 125kbps U2X = 1 250kbps Note: 1. UBRRn = 0, Error = 0.0% Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 259 Table 23-7 Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies (Continued) Baud Rate [bps] fosc = 3.6864MHz fosc = 4.0000MHz fosc = 7.3728MHz U2X = 0 U2X = 1 U2X = 0 U2X = 1 U2X = 0 U2X = 1 UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error 2400 95 0.0% 191 0.0% 103 0.2% 207 0.2% 191 0.0% 383 0.0% 4800 47 0.0% 95 0.0% 51 0.2% 103 0.2% 95 0.0% 191 0.0% 9600 23 0.0% 47 0.0% 25 0.2% 51 0.2% 47 0.0% 95 0.0% 14.4k 15 0.0% 31 0.0% 16 2.1% 34 -0.8% 31 0.0% 63 0.0% 19.2k 11 0.0% 23 0.0% 12 0.2% 25 0.2% 23 0.0% 47 0.0% 28.8k 7 0.0% 15 0.0% 8 -3.5% 16 2.1% 15 0.0% 31 0.0% 38.4k 5 0.0% 11 0.0% 6 -7.0% 12 0.2% 11 0.0% 23 0.0% 57.6k 3 0.0% 7 0.0% 3 8.5% 8 -3.5% 7 0.0% 15 0.0% 76.8k 2 0.0% 5 0.0% 2 8.5% 6 -7.0% 5 0.0% 11 0.0% 115.2k 1 0.0% 3 0.0% 1 8.5% 3 8.5% 3 0.0% 7 0.0% 230.4k 0 0.0% 1 0.0% 0 8.5% 1 8.5% 1 0.0% 3 0.0% 250k 0 -7.8% 1 -7.8% 0 0.0% 1 0.0% 1 -7.8% 3 -7.8% 0.5M – – 0 -7.8% – – 0 0.0% 0 -7.8% 1 -7.8% 1M – – – – – – – – – -7.8% Max.(1) 230.4kbps 460.8kbps – 250kbps 0.5Mbps 460.8kbps 0 921.6kbps (1) UBRRn = 0, Error = 0.0% Table 23-8 Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies (Continued) Baud Rate [bps] fosc = 8.0000MHz fosc = 11.0592MHz fosc = 14.7456MHz U2X = 0 U2X = 1 U2X = 0 U2X = 1 U2X = 0 U2X = 1 UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error 2400 207 0.2% 416 -0.1% 287 0.0% 575 0.0% 383 0.0% 767 0.0% 4800 103 0.2% 207 0.2% 143 0.0% 287 0.0% 191 0.0% 383 0.0% 9600 51 0.2% 103 0.2% 71 0.0% 143 0.0% 95 0.0% 191 0.0% 14.4k 34 -0.8% 68 0.6% 47 0.0% 95 0.0% 63 0.0% 127 0.0% 19.2k 25 0.2% 51 0.2% 35 0.0% 71 0.0% 47 0.0% 95 0.0% 28.8k 16 2.1% 34 -0.8% 23 0.0% 47 0.0% 31 0.0% 63 0.0% 38.4k 12 0.2% 25 0.2% 17 0.0% 35 0.0% 23 0.0% 47 0.0% 57.6k 8 -3.5% 16 2.1% 11 0.0% 23 0.0% 15 0.0% 31 0.0% 76.8k 6 -7.0% 12 0.2% 8 0.0% 17 0.0% 11 0.0% 23 0.0% Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 260 Baud Rate [bps] fosc = 8.0000MHz fosc = 11.0592MHz fosc = 14.7456MHz U2X = 0 U2X = 1 U2X = 0 U2X = 1 U2X = 0 U2X = 1 UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error 115.2k 3 8.5% 8 -3.5% 5 0.0% 11 0.0% 7 0.0% 15 0.0% 230.4k 1 8.5% 3 8.5% 2 0.0% 5 0.0% 3 0.0% 7 0.0% 250k 1 0.0% 3 0.0% 2 -7.8% 5 -7.8% 3 -7.8% 6 5.3% 0.5M 0 0.0% 1 0.0% – – 2 -7.8% 1 -7.8% 3 -7.8% 1M – – 0 0.0% – – – – -7.8% 1 -7.8% Max.(1) 0.5Mbps 1Mbps 691.2kbps 1.3824Mbps 0 921.6kbps 1.8432Mbps (1) UBRRn = 0, Error = 0.0% Table 23-9 Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies (Continued) Baud Rate [bps] fosc = 16.0000MHz fosc = 18.4320MHz fosc = 20.0000MHz U2X = 0 U2X = 1 U2X = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2X = 0 U2X = 1 UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error UBRRn Error 2400 416 -0.1% 832 0.0% 479 0.0% 959 0.0% 520 0.0% 1041 0.0% 4800 207 0.2% 416 -0.1% 239 0.0% 479 0.0% 259 0.2% 520 0.0% 9600 103 0.2% 207 0.2% 0.0% 239 0.0% 129 0.2% 259 0.2% 14.4k 68 0.6% 138 -0.1% 79 0.0% 159 0.0% 86 -0.2% 173 -0.2% 19.2k 51 0.2% 103 0.2% 59 0.0% 119 0.0% 64 0.2% 129 0.2% 28.8k 34 -0.8% 68 0.6% 39 0.0% 79 0.0% 42 0.9% 86 -0.2% 38.4k 25 0.2% 51 0.2% 29 0.0% 59 0.0% 32 -1.4% 64 0.2% 57.6k 16 2.1% 34 -0.8% 19 0.0% 39 0.0% 21 -1.4% 42 0.9% 76.8k 12 0.2% 25 0.2% 14 0.0% 29 0.0% 15 1.7% 32 -1.4% 115.2k 8 -3.5% 16 2.1% 9 0.0% 19 0.0% 10 -1.4% 21 -1.4% 230.4k 3 8.5% 8 -3.5% 4 0.0% 9 0.0% 4 8.5% 10 -1.4% 250k 3 0.0% 7 0.0% 4 -7.8% 8 2.4% 4 0.0% 9 0.0% 0.5M 1 0.0% 3 0.0% – – 4 -7.8% – – 4 0.0% 1M 0 0.0% 1 0.0% – – – – – – – Max.(1) 1Mbps 2Mbps 119 1.152Mbps 2.304Mbps – 1.25Mbps 2.5Mbps (1) UBRRn = 0, Error = 0.0% Related Links Asynchronous Operational Range on page 256 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 261 23.11. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 262 23.11.1. USART I/O Data Register n The USART Transmit Data Buffer Register and USART Receive Data Buffer Registers share the same I/O address referred to as USART Data Register or UDRn. The Transmit Data Buffer Register (TXB) will be the destination for data written to the UDR1 Register location. Reading the UDRn Register location will return the contents of the Receive Data Buffer Register (RXB). For 5-, 6-, or 7-bit characters the upper unused bits will be ignored by the Transmitter and set to zero by the Receiver. The transmit buffer can only be written when the UDRE Flag in the UCSRnA Register is set. Data written to UDRn when the UCSRnA.UDRE Flag is not set, will be ignored by the USART Transmitter n. When data is written to the transmit buffer, and the Transmitter is enabled, the Transmitter will load the data into the Transmit Shift Register when the Shift Register is empty. Then the data will be serially transmitted on the TxDn pin. The receive buffer consists of a two level FIFO. The FIFO will change its state whenever the receive buffer is accessed. Due to this behavior of the receive buffer, do not use Read-Modify-Write instructions (SBI and CBI) on this location. Be careful when using bit test instructions (SBIC and SBIS), since these also will change the state of the FIFO. Name: UDRn Offset: 0xC6 + n*0x08 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TXB / RXB[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – TXB / RXB[7:0]: USART Transmit / Receive Data Buffer Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 263 23.11.2. USARTn Control and Status Register A Name: UCSR0A, UCSR1A, UCSR2A Offset: 0xC0 + n*0x08 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x20 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RXC TXC UDRE FE DOR UPE U2X MPCM Access R R/W R R R R R/W R/W Reset 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – RXC: USART Receive Complete This flag bit is set when there are unread data in the receive buffer and cleared when the receive buffer is empty (i.e., does not contain any unread data). If the Receiver is disabled, the receive buffer will be flushed and consequently the RXC bit will become zero. The RXC Flag can be used to generate a Receive Complete interrupt (see description of the RXCIE bit). Bit 6 – TXC: USART Transmit Complete This flag bit is set when the entire frame in the Transmit Shift Register has been shifted out and there are no new data currently present in the transmit buffer (UDRn). The TXC Flag bit is automatically cleared when a transmit complete interrupt is executed, or it can be cleared by writing a one to its bit location. The TXC Flag can generate a Transmit Complete interrupt (see description of the TXCIE bit). Bit 5 – UDRE: USART Data Register Empty The UDRE Flag indicates if the transmit buffer (UDRn) is ready to receive new data. If UDRE is one, the buffer is empty, and therefore ready to be written. The UDRE Flag can generate a Data Register Empty interrupt (see description of the UDRIE bit). UDRE is set after a reset to indicate that the Transmitter is ready. Bit 4 – FE: Frame Error This bit is set if the next character in the receive buffer had a Frame Error when received. I.e., when the first stop bit of the next character in the receive buffer is zero. This bit is valid until the receive buffer (UDRn) is read. The FEn bit is zero when the stop bit of received data is one. Always set this bit to zero when writing to UCSRnA. This bit is reserved in Master SPI Mode (MSPIM). Bit 3 – DOR: Data OverRun This bit is set if a Data OverRun condition is detected. A Data OverRun occurs when the receive buffer is full (two characters), it is a new character waiting in the Receive Shift Register, and a new start bit is detected. This bit is valid until the receive buffer (UDRn) is read. Always set this bit to zero when writing to UCSRnA. This bit is reserved in Master SPI Mode (MSPIM). Bit 2 – UPE: USART Parity Error This bit is set if the next character in the receive buffer had a Parity Error when received and the Parity Checking was enabled at that point (UCSRnC.UPM1 = 1). This bit is valid until the receive buffer (UDRn) is read. Always set this bit to zero when writing to UCSRnA. This bit is reserved in Master SPI Mode (MSPIM). Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 264 Bit 1 – U2X: Double the USART Transmission Speed This bit only has effect for the asynchronous operation. Write this bit to zero when using synchronous operation. Writing this bit to one will reduce the divisor of the baud rate divider from 16 to 8 effectively doubling the transfer rate for asynchronous communication. This bit is reserved in Master SPI Mode (MSPIM). Bit 0 – MPCM: Multi-processor Communication Mode This bit enables the Multi-processor Communication mode. When the MPCM bit is written to one, all the incoming frames received by the USART Receiver n that do not contain address information will be ignored. The Transmitter is unaffected by the MPCM setting. Refer to Multi-Processor Communication Mode on page 258 for details. This bit is reserved in Master SPI Mode (MSPIM). Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 265 23.11.3. USART Control and Status Register n B Name: UCSR0B, UCSR1B, UCSR2B Offset: 0xC1 + n*0x08 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RXCIE TXCIE UDRIE RXEN TXEN UCSZ2 RXB8 TXB8 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – RXCIE: RX Complete Interrupt Enable Writing this bit to one enables interrupt on the UCSRnA.RXC Flag. A USART Receive Complete interrupt will be generated only if the RXCIE bit is written to one, the Global Interrupt Flag in SREG is written to one and the RXC bit in UCSRnA is set. Bit 6 – TXCIE: TX Complete Interrupt Enable Writing this bit to one enables interrupt on the TXC Flag. A USART Transmit Complete interrupt will be generated only if the TXCIE bit is written to one, the Global Interrupt Flag in SREG is written to one and the TXC bit in UCSRnA is set. Bit 5 – UDRIE: USART Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable Writing this bit to one enables interrupt on the UDRE Flag. A Data Register Empty interrupt will be generated only if the UDRIE bit is written to one, the Global Interrupt Flag in SREG is written to one and the UDRE bit in UCSRnA is set. Bit 4 – RXEN: Receiver Enable Writing this bit to one enables the USART Receiver. The Receiver will override normal port operation for the RxDn pin when enabled. Disabling the Receiver will flush the receive buffer invalidating the FE, DOR, and UPE Flags. Bit 3 – TXEN: Transmitter Enable Writing this bit to one enables the USART Transmitter. The Transmitter will override normal port operation for the TxDn pin when enabled. The disabling of the Transmitter (writing TXEN to zero) will not become effective until ongoing and pending transmissions are completed, i.e., when the Transmit Shift Register and Transmit Buffer Register do not contain data to be transmitted. When disabled, the Transmitter will no longer override the TxDn port. Bit 2 – UCSZ2: Character Size The UCSZ2 bits combined with the UCSZ[1:0] bit in UCSRnC sets the number of data bits (Character Size) in a frame the Receiver and Transmitter use. This bit is reserved in Master SPI Mode (MSPIM). Bit 1 – RXB8: Receive Data Bit 8 RXB8 is the ninth data bit of the received character when operating with serial frames with nine data bits. Must be read before reading the low bits from UDRn. This bit is reserved in Master SPI Mode (MSPIM). Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 266 Bit 0 – TXB8: Transmit Data Bit 8 TXB8 is the ninth data bit in the character to be transmitted when operating with serial frames with nine data bits. Must be written before writing the low bits to UDRn. This bit is reserved in Master SPI Mode (MSPIM). Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 267 23.11.4. USART Control and Status Register n C Name: UCSR0C, UCSR1C, UCSR2C Offset: 0xC2 + n*0x08 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x06 Property: Bit 7 6 5 UMSEL[1:0] Access Reset 4 UPM[1:0] 3 2 1 0 USBS UCSZ1 / UCSZ0 / UCPOL UDORD UCPHA R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 Bits 7:6 – UMSEL[1:0]: USART Mode Select These bits select the mode of operation of the USARTn Table 23-10 USART Mode Selection UMSEL[1:0] Mode 00 Asynchronous USART 01 Synchronous USART 10 Reserved 11 Master SPI (MSPIM)(1) Note: 1. The UDORD, UCPHA, and UCPOL can be set in the same write operation where the MSPIM is enabled. Bits 5:4 – UPM[1:0]: USART Parity Mode These bits enable and set type of parity generation and check. If enabled, the Transmitter will automatically generate and send the parity of the transmitted data bits within each frame. The Receiver will generate a parity value for the incoming data and compare it to the UPM setting. If a mismatch is detected, the UPE Flag in UCSRnA will be set. Table 23-11 USART Mode Selection UPM[1:0] ParityMode 00 Disabled 01 Reserved 10 Enabled, Even Parity 11 Enabled, Odd Parity These bits are reserved in Master SPI Mode (MSPIM). Bit 3 – USBS: USART Stop Bit Select This bit selects the number of stop bits to be inserted by the Transmitter n. The Receiver ignores this setting. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 268 Table 23-12 Stop Bit Settings USBS Stop Bit(s) 0 1-bit 1 2-bit This bit is reserved in Master SPI Mode (MSPIM). Bit 2 – UCSZ1 / UDORD: USART Character Size / Data Order UCSZ1[1:0]: USART Modes: The UCSZ1[1:0] bits combined with the UCSZ12 bit in UCSR1B sets the number of data bits (Character Size) in a frame the Receiver and Transmitter use. Table 23-13 Character Size Settings UCSZ1[2:0] Character Size 000 5-bit 001 6-bit 010 7-bit 011 8-bit 100 Reserved 101 Reserved 110 Reserved 111 9-bit UDORD0: Master SPI Mode: When set to one the LSB of the data word is transmitted first. When set to zero the MSB of the data word is transmitted first. Refer to the USART in SPI Mode - Frame Formats for details. Bit 1 – UCSZ0 / UCPHA: USART Character Size / Clock Phase UCSZ0: USART Modes: Refer to UCSZ1. UCPHA: Master SPI Mode: The UCPHA bit setting determine if data is sampled on the leasing edge (first) or tailing (last) edge of XCK. Refer to the SPI Data Modes and Timing for details. Bit 0 – UCPOL: Clock Polarity USART n Modes: This bit is used for synchronous mode only. Write this bit to zero when asynchronous mode is used. The UCPOL bit sets the relationship between data output change and data input sample, and the synchronous clock (XCKn). Table 23-14 USART Clock Polarity Settings UCPOL Transmitted Data Changed (Output of TxDn Pin) Received Data Sampled (Input on RxDn Pin) 0 Rising XCKn Edge Falling XCKn Edge 1 Falling XCKn Edge Rising XCKn Edge Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 269 Master SPI Mode: The UCPOL bit sets the polarity of the XCKn clock. The combination of the UCPOL and UCPHA bit settings determine the timing of the data transfer. Refer to the SPI Data Modes and Timing for details. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 270 23.11.5. USART Control and Status Register n D This register is not used in Master SPI Mode (UCSRnC.UMSEL[1:0] = 11) Name: UCSR0D, UCSR1D, UCSR2D Offset: 0xC3 + n*0x08 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 RXIE RXS SFDE R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 – RXIE: USART RX Start Interrupt Enable Writing this bit to one enables the interrupt on the RXS flag. In sleep modes this bit enables start frame detector that can wake up the MCU when a start condition is detected on the RxD line. The USART RX Start Interrupt is generated only, if the RXSIE bit, the Global Interrupt flag, and RXS are set. Bit 6 – RXS: USART RX Start The RXS flag is set when a start condition is detected on the RxD line. If the RXSIE bit and the Global Interrupt Enable flag are set, an RX Start Interrupt will be generated when the flag is set. The flag can only be cleared by writing a logical one on the RXS bit location. If the start frame detector is enabled (RXSIE = 1) and the Global Interrupt Enable flag is set, the RX Start Interrupt will wake up the MCU from all sleep modes. Bit 5 – SFDE: Start Frame Detection Enable Writing this bit to one enables the USART Start Frame Detection mode. The start frame detector is able to wake up the MCU from sleep mode when a start condition, i.e. a high (IDLE) to low (START) transition, is detected on the RxD line. Table 23-15 USART Start Frame Detection Modes SFDE RXSIE RXCIE Description 0 X X Start frame detector disabled 1 0 0 Reserved 1 0 1 Start frame detector enabled. RXC flag wakes up MCU from all sleep modes 1 1 0 Start frame detector enabled. RXS flag wakes up MCU from all sleep modes 1 1 1 Start frame detector enabled. Both RXC and RXS wake up the MCU from all sleep modes Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 271 23.11.6. USART Baud Rate n Register Low Name: UBBR0L, UBBR1L, UBBR2L Offset: 0xC4 + n*0x08 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 UBBR[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – UBBR[7:0]: USART Baud Rate [7:0] This is a 12-bit register which contains the USART baud rate. The UBBRnH contains the four most significant bits and the UBBRnL contains the eight least significant bits of the USART n baud rate. Ongoing transmissions by the Transmitter and Receiver will be corrupted if the baud rate is changed. Writing UBRRnL will trigger an immediate update of the baud rate prescaler. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 272 23.11.7. USART Baud Rate n Register High Name: UBBR0H, UBBR1H, UBBR2H Offset: 0xC5 + n*0x08 [n=0..2] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 UBBR[3:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 Bits 3:0 – UBBR[3:0]: USART Baud Rate [11:8] Refer to UBBR0L, UBBR1L, UBBR2L on page 272. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 273 24. USARTSPI - USART in SPI Mode 24.1. Features • • • • • • • • 24.2. Full Duplex, Three-wire Synchronous Data Transfer Master Operation Supports all four SPI Modes of Operation (Mode 0, 1, 2, and 3) LSB First or MSB First Data Transfer (Configurable Data Order) Queued Operation (Double Buffered) High Resolution Baud Rate Generator High Speed Operation (fXCKmax = fCK/2) Flexible Interrupt Generation Overview The Universal Synchronous and Asynchronous serial Receiver and Transmitter (USART) can be set to a master SPI compliant mode of operation. Setting both UMSELn1:0 bits to one enables the USART in MSPIM logic. In this mode of operation the SPI master control logic takes direct control over the USART resources. These resources include the transmitter and receiver shift register and buffers, and the baud rate generator. The parity generator and checker, the data and clock recovery logic, and the RX and TX control logic is disabled. The USART RX and TX control logic is replaced by a common SPI transfer control logic. However, the pin control logic and interrupt generation logic is identical in both modes of operation. The I/O register locations are the same in both modes. However, some of the functionality of the control registers changes when using MSPIM. 24.3. Clock Generation The Clock Generation logic generates the base clock for the Transmitter and Receiver. For USART MSPIM mode of operation only internal clock generation (i.e. master operation) is supported. The Data Direction Register for the XCKn pin (DDR_XCKn) must therefore be set to one (i.e. as output) for the USART in MSPIM to operate correctly. Preferably the DDR_XCKn should be set up before the USART in MSPIM is enabled (i.e. TXENn and RXENn bit set to one). The internal clock generation used in MSPIM mode is identical to the USART synchronous master mode. The table below contains the equations for calculating the baud rate or UBRRn setting for Synchronous Master Mode. Table 24-1 Equations for Calculating Baud Rate Register Setting Operating Mode Synchronous Master mode Equation for Calculating Baud Rate(1) BAUD = �OSC 2 ����� + 1 Equation for Calculating UBRRn Value ����� = �OSC + −1 2BAUD Note: 1. The baud rate is defined to be the transfer rate in bit per second (bps) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 274 24.4. BAUD Baud rate (in bits per second, bps) fOSC System Oscillator clock frequency UBRRn Contents of the UBRRnH and UBRRnL Registers, (0-4095) SPI Data Modes and Timing There are four combinations of XCKn (SCK) phase and polarity with respect to serial data, which are determined by control bits UCPHAn and UCPOLn. The data transfer timing diagrams are shown in the following figure. Data bits are shifted out and latched in on opposite edges of the XCKn signal, ensuring sufficient time for data signals to stabilize. The UCPOLn and UCPHAn functionality is summarized in the following table. Note that changing the setting of any of these bits will corrupt all ongoing communication for both the Receiver and Transmitter. Table 24-2 UCPOLn and UCPHAn Functionality UCPOLn UCPHAn SPI Mode Leading Edge Trailing Edge 0 0 0 Sample (Rising) Setup (Falling) 0 1 1 Setup (Rising) Sample (Falling) 1 0 2 Sample (Falling) Setup (Rising) 1 1 3 Setup (Falling) Sample (Rising) UCPHA=0 UCPHA=1 Figure 24-1 UCPHAn and UCPOLn data transfer timing diagrams. UCPOL=0 24.5. XCK XCK Data setup (TXD) Data setup (TXD) Data sample (RXD) Data sample (RXD) XCK XCK Data setup (TXD) Data setup (TXD) Data sample (RXD) Data sample (RXD) UCPOL=1 Frame Formats A serial frame for the MSPIM is defined to be one character of eight data bits. The USART in MSPIM mode has two valid frame formats: • • 8-bit data with MSB first 8-bit data with LSB first A frame starts with the least or most significant data bit. Then the next data bits, up to a total of eight, are succeeding, ending with the most or least significant bit accordingly. When a complete frame is transmitted, a new frame can directly follow it, or the communication line can be set to an idle (high) state. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 275 The UDORDn bit in UCSRnC sets the frame format used by the USART in MSPIM mode. The Receiver and Transmitter use the same setting. Note that changing the setting of any of these bits will corrupt all ongoing communication for both the Receiver and Transmitter. 16-bit data transfer can be achieved by writing two data bytes to UDRn. A UART transmit complete interrupt will then signal that the 16-bit value has been shifted out. 24.5.1. USART MSPIM Initialization The USART in MSPIM mode has to be initialized before any communication can take place. The initialization process normally consists of setting the baud rate, setting master mode of operation (by setting DDR_XCKn to one), setting frame format and enabling the Transmitter and the Receiver. Only the transmitter can operate independently. For interrupt driven USART operation, the Global Interrupt Flag should be cleared (and thus interrupts globally disabled) when doing the initialization. Note: To ensure immediate initialization of the XCKn output the baud-rate register (UBRRn) must be zero at the time the transmitter is enabled. Contrary to the normal mode USART operation the UBRRn must then be written to the desired value after the transmitter is enabled, but before the first transmission is started. Setting UBRRn to zero before enabling the transmitter is not necessary if the initialization is done immediately after a reset since UBRRn is reset to zero. Before doing a re-initialization with changed baud rate, data mode, or frame format, be sure that there is no ongoing transmissions during the period the registers are changed. The TXCn Flag can be used to check that the Transmitter has completed all transfers, and the RXCn Flag can be used to check that there are no unread data in the receive buffer. Note that the TXCn Flag must be cleared before each transmission (before UDRn is written) if it is used for this purpose. The following simple USART initialization code examples show one assembly and one C function that are equal in functionality. The examples assume polling (no interrupts enabled). The baud rate is given as a function parameter. For the assembly code, the baud rate parameter is assumed to be stored in the r17:r16 registers. Assembly Code Example clr r18 out UBRRnH,r18 out UBRRnL,r18 ; Setting the XCKn port pin as output, enables master mode. sbi XCKn_DDR, XCKn ; Set MSPI mode of operation and SPI data mode 0. ldi r18, (1<<UMSELn1)|(1<<UMSELn0)|(0<<UCPHAn)|(0<<UCPOLn) out UCSRnC,r18 ; Enable receiver and transmitter. ldi r18, (1<<RXENn)|(1<<TXENn) out UCSRnB,r18 ; Set baud rate. ; IMPORTANT: The Baud Rate must be set after the transmitter is enabled! out UBRRnH, r17 out UBRRnL, r18 ret C Code Example { UBRRn = 0; Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 276 /* Setting the XCKn port pin as output, enables master mode. */ XCKn_DDR |= (1<<XCKn); /* Set MSPI mode of operation and SPI data mode 0. */ UCSRnC = (1<<UMSELn1)|(1<<UMSELn0)|(0<<UCPHAn)|(0<<UCPOLn); /* Enable receiver and transmitter. */ UCSRnB = (1<<RXENn)|(1<<TXENn); /* Set baud rate. */ /* IMPORTANT: The Baud Rate must be set after the transmitter is enabled */ UBRRn = baud; } Related Links About Code Examples on page 17 24.6. Data Transfer Using the USART in MSPI mode requires the Transmitter to be enabled, i.e. the TXENn bit in the UCSRnB register is set to one. When the Transmitter is enabled, the normal port operation of the TxDn pin is overridden and given the function as the Transmitter's serial output. Enabling the receiver is optional and is done by setting the RXENn bit in the UCSRnB register to one. When the receiver is enabled, the normal pin operation of the RxDn pin is overridden and given the function as the Receiver's serial input. The XCKn will in both cases be used as the transfer clock. After initialization the USART is ready for doing data transfers. A data transfer is initiated by writing to the UDRn I/O location. This is the case for both sending and receiving data since the transmitter controls the transfer clock. The data written to UDRn is moved from the transmit buffer to the shift register when the shift register is ready to send a new frame. Note: To keep the input buffer in sync with the number of data bytes transmitted, the UDRn register must be read once for each byte transmitted. The input buffer operation is identical to normal USART mode, i.e. if an overflow occurs the character last received will be lost, not the first data in the buffer. This means that if four bytes are transferred, byte 1 first, then byte 2, 3, and 4, and the UDRn is not read before all transfers are completed, then byte 3 to be received will be lost, and not byte 1. The following code examples show a simple USART in MSPIM mode transfer function based on polling of the Data Register Empty (UDREn) Flag and the Receive Complete (RXCn) Flag. The USART has to be initialized before the function can be used. For the assembly code, the data to be sent is assumed to be stored in Register R16 and the data received will be available in the same register (R16) after the function returns. The function simply waits for the transmit buffer to be empty by checking the UDREn Flag, before loading it with new data to be transmitted. The function then waits for data to be present in the receive buffer by checking the RXCn Flag, before reading the buffer and returning the value. Assembly Code Example USART_MSPIM_Transfer: ; Wait for empty transmit buffer in r16, UCSRnA sbrs r16, UDREn rjmp USART_MSPIM_Transfer ; Put data (r16) into buffer, sends the data out UDRn,r16 ; Wait for data to be received Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 277 USART_MSPIM_Wait_RXCn: in r16, UCSRnA sbrs r16, RXCn rjmp USART_MSPIM_Wait_RXCn ; Get and return received data from buffer in r16, UDRn ret C Code Example { /* Wait for empty transmit buffer */ while ( !( UCSRnA & (1<<UDREn)) ); /* Put data into buffer, sends the data */ UDRn = data; /* Wait for data to be received */ while ( !(UCSRnA & (1<<RXCn)) ); /* Get and return received data from buffer */ return UDRn; } Related Links About Code Examples on page 17 24.6.1. Transmitter and Receiver Flags and Interrupts The RXCn, TXCn, and UDREn flags and corresponding interrupts in USART in MSPIM mode are identical in function to the normal USART operation. However, the receiver error status flags (FE, DOR, and PE) are not in use and is always read as zero. 24.6.2. Disabling the Transmitter or Receiver The disabling of the transmitter or receiver in USART in MSPIM mode is identical in function to the normal USART operation. 24.7. AVR USART MSPIM vs. AVR SPI The USART in MSPIM mode is fully compatible with the AVR SPI regarding: • • • • Master mode timing diagram The UCPOLn bit functionality is identical to the SPI CPOL bit The UCPHAn bit functionality is identical to the SPI CPHA bit The UDORDn bit functionality is identical to the SPI DORD bit However, since the USART in MSPIM mode reuses the USART resources, the use of the USART in MSPIM mode is somewhat different compared to the SPI. In addition to differences of the control register bits, and that only master operation is supported by the USART in MSPIM mode, the following features differ between the two modules: • • • • The USART in MSPIM mode includes (double) buffering of the transmitter. The SPI has no buffer The USART in MSPIM mode receiver includes an additional buffer level The SPI WCOL (Write Collision) bit is not included in USART in MSPIM mode The SPI double speed mode (SPI2X) bit is not included. However, the same effect is achieved by setting UBRRn accordingly Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 278 • • Interrupt timing is not compatible Pin control differs due to the master only operation of the USART in MSPIM mode A comparison of the USART in MSPIM mode and the SPI pins is shown in the table below. Table 24-3 Comparison of USART in MSPIM mode and SPI pins 24.8. USART_MSPIM SPI Comments TxDn MOSI Master Out only RxDn MISO Master In only XCKn SCK (Functionally identical) (N/A) SS Not supported by USART in MSPIM Register Description Refer to the USART Register Description. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 279 25. TWI - 2-wire Serial Interface 25.1. Features • • • • • • • • • • • • 25.2. Two TWI instances TWI0 and TWI1 Simple, yet Powerful and Flexible Communication Interface, only two Bus Lines Needed Both Master and Slave Operation Supported Device can Operate as Transmitter or Receiver 7-bit Address Space Allows up to 128 Different Slave Addresses Multi-master Arbitration Support Up to 400kHz Data Transfer Speed Slew-rate Limited Output Drivers Noise Suppression Circuitry Rejects Spikes on Bus Lines Fully Programmable Slave Address with General Call Support Address Recognition Causes Wake-up When AVR is in Sleep Mode Compatible with Philips’ I2C protocol Two-Wire Serial Interface Bus Definition The Two-Wire Serial Interface (TWI) is ideally suited for typical microcontroller applications. The TWI protocol allows the systems designer to interconnect up to 128 different devices using only two bidirectional bus lines: one for clock (SCL) and one for data (SDA). The only external hardware needed to implement the bus is a single pull-up resistor for each of the TWI bus lines. All devices connected to the bus have individual addresses, and mechanisms for resolving bus contention are inherent in the TWI protocol. Figure 25-1 TWI Bus Interconnection VCC Device 1 Device 2 Device 3 ........ Device n R1 R2 SD A SCL 25.2.1. TWI Terminology The following definitions are frequently encountered in this section. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 280 Table 25-1 TWI Terminology Term Description Master The device that initiates and terminates a transmission. The Master also generates the SCL clock. Slave The device addressed by a Master. Transmitter The device placing data on the bus. Receiver The device reading data from the bus. The Power Reduction TWI bit in the Power Reduction Register (PRRn.PRTWI) must be written to '0' to enable the two-wire Serial Interface. TWI0 is in PRR, and TWI1 is in PRR2. Related Links Power Management and Sleep Modes on page 58 25.2.2. Electrical Interconnection As depicted in the TWI Bus Definition, both bus lines are connected to the positive supply voltage through pull-up resistors. The bus drivers of all TWI-compliant devices are open-drain or open-collector. This implements a wired-AND function which is essential to the operation of the interface. A low level on a TWI bus line is generated when one or more TWI devices output a zero. A high level is output when all TWI devices tri-state their outputs, allowing the pull-up resistors to pull the line high. Note that all AVR devices connected to the TWI bus must be powered in order to allow any bus operation. The number of devices that can be connected to the bus is only limited by the bus capacitance limit of 400pF and the 7-bit slave address space. Two different sets of specifications are presented there, one relevant for bus speeds below 100kHz, and one valid for bus speeds up to 400kHz. 25.3. Data Transfer and Frame Format 25.3.1. Transferring Bits Each data bit transferred on the TWI bus is accompanied by a pulse on the clock line. The level of the data line must be stable when the clock line is high. The only exception to this rule is for generating start and stop conditions. Figure 25-2 Data Validity SDA SCL Data Stable Data Stable Data Change 25.3.2. START and STOP Conditions The Master initiates and terminates a data transmission. The transmission is initiated when the Master issues a START condition on the bus, and it is terminated when the Master issues a STOP condition. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 281 Between a START and a STOP condition, the bus is considered busy, and no other master should try to seize control of the bus. A special case occurs when a new START condition is issued between a START and STOP condition. This is referred to as a REPEATED START condition, and is used when the Master wishes to initiate a new transfer without relinquishing control of the bus. After a REPEATED START, the bus is considered busy until the next STOP. This is identical to the START behavior, and therefore START is used to describe both START and REPEATED START for the remainder of this datasheet, unless otherwise noted. As depicted below, START and STOP conditions are signalled by changing the level of the SDA line when the SCL line is high. Figure 25-3 START, REPEATED START and STOP conditions SDA SCL START 25.3.3. STOP START REPEATED START STOP Address Packet Format All address packets transmitted on the TWI bus are 9 bits long, consisting of 7 address bits, one READ/ WRITE control bit and an acknowledge bit. If the READ/WRITE bit is set, a read operation is to be performed, otherwise a write operation should be performed. When a Slave recognizes that it is being addressed, it should acknowledge by pulling SDA low in the ninth SCL (ACK) cycle. If the addressed Slave is busy, or for some other reason can not service the Master’s request, the SDA line should be left high in the ACK clock cycle. The Master can then transmit a STOP condition, or a REPEATED START condition to initiate a new transmission. An address packet consisting of a slave address and a READ or a WRITE bit is called SLA+R or SLA+W, respectively. The MSB of the address byte is transmitted first. Slave addresses can freely be allocated by the designer, but the address '0000 000' is reserved for a general call. When a general call is issued, all slaves should respond by pulling the SDA line low in the ACK cycle. A general call is used when a Master wishes to transmit the same message to several slaves in the system. When the general call address followed by a Write bit is transmitted on the bus, all slaves set up to acknowledge the general call will pull the SDA line low in the ACK cycle. The following data packets will then be received by all the slaves that acknowledged the general call. Note that transmitting the general call address followed by a Read bit is meaningless, as this would cause contention if several slaves started transmitting different data. All addresses of the format '1111 xxx' should be reserved for future purposes. Figure 25-4 Address Packet Format Addr MSB Addr LSB R/W ACK 7 8 9 SD A SCL 1 2 START Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 282 25.3.4. Data Packet Format All data packets transmitted on the TWI bus are nine bits long, consisting of one data byte and an acknowledge bit. During a data transfer, the Master generates the clock and the START and STOP conditions, while the Receiver is responsible for acknowledging the reception. An Acknowledge (ACK) is signalled by the Receiver pulling the SDA line low during the ninth SCL cycle. If the Receiver leaves the SDA line high, a NACK is signalled. When the Receiver has received the last byte, or for some reason cannot receive any more bytes, it should inform the Transmitter by sending a NACK after the final byte. The MSB of the data byte is transmitted first. Figure 25-5 Data Packet Format Data MSB Data LSB ACK 8 9 Aggregate SD A SDA from Transmitter SDA from Receiv er SCL from Master 1 2 7 SLA+R/W 25.3.5. ST OP, REPEA TED START or Ne xt Data Byte Data Byte Combining Address and Data Packets into a Transmission A transmission basically consists of a START condition, a SLA+R/W, one or more data packets and a STOP condition. An empty message, consisting of a START followed by a STOP condition, is illegal. Note that the "Wired-ANDing" of the SCL line can be used to implement handshaking between the Master and the Slave. The Slave can extend the SCL low period by pulling the SCL line low. This is useful if the clock speed set up by the Master is too fast for the Slave, or the Slave needs extra time for processing between the data transmissions. The Slave extending the SCL low period will not affect the SCL high period, which is determined by the Master. As a consequence, the Slave can reduce the TWI data transfer speed by prolonging the SCL duty cycle. The following figure depicts a typical data transmission. Note that several data bytes can be transmitted between the SLA+R/W and the STOP condition, depending on the software protocol implemented by the application software. Figure 25-6 Typical Data Transmission Addr MSB Addr LSB R/W ACK Data MSB 7 8 9 1 Data LSB ACK 8 9 SD A SCL 1 START 2 SLA+R/W 2 7 Data Byte Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 ST OP 283 25.4. Multi-master Bus Systems, Arbitration and Synchronization The TWI protocol allows bus systems with several masters. Special concerns have been taken in order to ensure that transmissions will proceed as normal, even if two or more masters initiate a transmission at the same time. Two problems arise in multi-master systems: • • An algorithm must be implemented allowing only one of the masters to complete the transmission. All other masters should cease transmission when they discover that they have lost the selection process. This selection process is called arbitration. When a contending master discovers that it has lost the arbitration process, it should immediately switch to Slave mode to check whether it is being addressed by the winning master. The fact that multiple masters have started transmission at the same time should not be detectable to the slaves, i.e. the data being transferred on the bus must not be corrupted. Different masters may use different SCL frequencies. A scheme must be devised to synchronize the serial clocks from all masters, in order to let the transmission proceed in a lockstep fashion. This will facilitate the arbitration process. The wired-ANDing of the bus lines is used to solve both these problems. The serial clocks from all masters will be wired-ANDed, yielding a combined clock with a high period equal to the one from the Master with the shortest high period. The low period of the combined clock is equal to the low period of the Master with the longest low period. Note that all masters listen to the SCL line, effectively starting to count their SCL high and low time-out periods when the combined SCL line goes high or low, respectively. Figure 25-7 SCL Synchronization Between Multiple Masters TAlow TAhigh SCL from Master A TBlow TBhigh SCL from Master B SCL Bus Line Masters Start Counting Low Period Masters Start Counting High Period Arbitration is carried out by all masters continuously monitoring the SDA line after outputting data. If the value read from the SDA line does not match the value the Master had output, it has lost the arbitration. Note that a Master can only lose arbitration when it outputs a high SDA value while another Master outputs a low value. The losing Master should immediately go to Slave mode, checking if it is being addressed by the winning Master. The SDA line should be left high, but losing masters are allowed to generate a clock signal until the end of the current data or address packet. Arbitration will continue until only one Master remains, and this may take many bits. If several masters are trying to address the same Slave, arbitration will continue into the data packet. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 284 Figure 25-8 Arbitration Between Two Masters START SD A from Master A Master A Loses Arbitration, SD AA SDA SD A from Master B SD A Line Synchroniz ed SCL Line Note that arbitration is not allowed between: • A REPEATED START condition and a data bit • • A STOP condition and a data bit A REPEATED START and a STOP condition It is the user software’s responsibility to ensure that these illegal arbitration conditions never occur. This implies that in multi-master systems, all data transfers must use the same composition of SLA+R/W and data packets. In other words; All transmissions must contain the same number of data packets, otherwise the result of the arbitration is undefined. 25.5. Overview of the TWI Module The TWI module is comprised of several submodules, as shown in the following figure. The registers drawn in a thick line are accessible through the AVR data bus. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 285 Figure 25-9 Overview of the TWI Module Sle w-rate Control SD A Spik e Filter Sle w-rate Control Spik e Filter Bus Interf ace Unit START / ST OP Control Spik e Suppression Arbitration detection Address/Data Shift Register (TWDR) Bit Rate Gener ator Prescaler Address Match Unit Address Register (TWAR) Address Compar ator 25.5.1. Bit Rate Register (TWBR) Ack Control Unit Status Register (TWSR) Control Register (TWCR) State Machine and Status control TWI Unit SCL SCL and SDA Pins These pins interface the AVR TWI with the rest of the MCU system. The output drivers contain a slewrate limiter in order to conform to the TWI specification. The input stages contain a spike suppression unit removing spikes shorter than 50ns. Note that the internal pull-ups in the AVR pads can be enabled by setting the PORT bits corresponding to the SCL and SDA pins, as explained in the I/O Port section. The internal pull-ups can in some systems eliminate the need for external ones. 25.5.2. Bit Rate Generator Unit This unit controls the period of SCL when operating in a Master mode. The SCL period is controlled by settings in the TWI Bit Rate Register (TWBR) and the Prescaler bits in the TWI Status Register (TWSR). Slave operation does not depend on Bit Rate or Prescaler settings, but the CPU clock frequency in the Slave must be at least 16 times higher than the SCL frequency. Note that slaves may prolong the SCL low period, thereby reducing the average TWI bus clock period. The SCL frequency is generated according to the following equation: SCL frequency = • • CPU Clock frequency 16 + 2(TWBR) ⋅ PrescalerValue TWBR = Value of the TWI Bit Rate Register PrescalerValue = Value of the prescaler, see description of the TWI Prescaler bit in the TWSR Status Register description (TWSR.TWPS) Note: Pull-up resistor values should be selected according to the SCL frequency and the capacitive bus line load. See the Two-Wire Serial Interface Characteristics for a suitable value of the pull-up resistor. Related Links Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 286 Two-wire Serial Interface Characteristics on page 435 25.5.3. Bus Interface Unit This unit contains the Data and Address Shift Register (TWDR), a START/STOP Controller and Arbitration detection hardware. The TWDR contains the address or data bytes to be transmitted, or the address or data bytes received. In addition to the 8-bit TWDR, the Bus Interface Unit also contains a register containing the (N)ACK bit to be transmitted or received. This (N)ACK Register is not directly accessible by the application software. However, when receiving, it can be set or cleared by manipulating the TWI Control Register (TWCR). When in Transmitter mode, the value of the received (N)ACK bit can be determined by the value in the TWSR. The START/STOP Controller is responsible for generation and detection of START, REPEATED START, and STOP conditions. The START/STOP controller is able to detect START and STOP conditions even when the AVR MCU is in one of the sleep modes, enabling the MCU to wake up if addressed by a Master. If the TWI has initiated a transmission as Master, the Arbitration Detection hardware continuously monitors the transmission trying to determine if arbitration is in process. If the TWI has lost an arbitration, the Control Unit is informed. Correct action can then be taken and appropriate status codes generated. 25.5.4. Address Match Unit The Address Match unit checks if received address bytes match the seven-bit address in the TWI Address Register (TWAR). If the TWI General Call Recognition Enable bit (TWAR.TWGCE) is written to '1', all incoming address bits will also be compared against the General Call address. Upon an address match, the Control Unit is informed, allowing correct action to be taken. The TWI may or may not acknowledge its address, depending on settings in the TWI Control Register (TWCR). The Address Match unit is able to compare addresses even when the AVR MCU is in sleep mode, enabling the MCU to wake up if addressed by a Master. 25.5.5. Control Unit The Control unit monitors the TWI bus and generates responses corresponding to settings in the TWI Control Register (TWCR). When an event requiring the attention of the application occurs on the TWI bus, the TWI Interrupt Flag (TWINT) is asserted. In the next clock cycle, the TWI Status Register (TWSR) is updated with a status code identifying the event. The TWSR only contains relevant status information when the TWI Interrupt Flag is asserted. At all other times, the TWSR contains a special status code indicating that no relevant status information is available. As long as the TWINT Flag is set, the SCL line is held low. This allows the application software to complete its tasks before allowing the TWI transmission to continue. The TWINT Flag is set in the following situations: • • • • • • • • After the TWI has transmitted a START/REPEATED START condition After the TWI has transmitted SLA+R/W After the TWI has transmitted an address byte After the TWI has lost arbitration After the TWI has been addressed by own slave address or general call After the TWI has received a data byte After a STOP or REPEATED START has been received while still addressed as a Slave When a bus error has occurred due to an illegal START or STOP condition Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 287 Using the TWI The AVR TWI is byte-oriented and interrupt based. Interrupts are issued after all bus events, like reception of a byte or transmission of a START condition. Because the TWI is interrupt-based, the application software is free to carry on other operations during a TWI byte transfer. Note that the TWI Interrupt Enable (TWIE) bit in TWCRn together with the Global Interrupt Enable bit in SREG allow the application to decide whether or not assertion of the TWINT Flag should generate an interrupt request. If the TWIE bit is cleared, the application must poll the TWINT Flag in order to detect actions on the TWI bus. When the TWINT Flag is asserted, the TWI has finished an operation and awaits application response. In this case, the TWI Status Register (TWSRn) contains a value indicating the current state of the TWI bus. The application software can then decide how the TWI should behave in the next TWI bus cycle by manipulating the TWCRn and TWDRn Registers. The following figure illustrates a simple example of how the application can interface to the TWI hardware. In this example, a Master wishes to transmit a single data byte to a Slave. A more detailed explanation follows later in this section. Simple code examples are presented in the table below. Application Action Figure 25-10 Interfacing the Application to the TWI in a Typical Transmission 1. Application writes to TWCRto initiate transmission of START TWI bus TWI Hardware Action 25.6. 1. 2. 3. 3. Check TWSR to see if START was sent. Application loads SLA+W into TWDR, and loads appropriate control signals into TWCR, making sure that TWINT is written to one, and TWSTA is written to zero. START 2.TWINT set. Status code indicates START condition sent SLA+W 5. Check TWSRto see if SLA+W was sent and ACK received. Application loads data into TWDR, and loads appropriate control signals into TWCR, making sure that TWINT is written to one A 4.TWINT set. Status code indicates SLA+W sent, ACK received Data 7. Check TWSRto see if data was sent and ACK received. Application loads appropriate control signals to send STOP into TWCR, making sure that TWINT is written to one A 6.TWINT set. Status code indicates data sent, ACK received STOP Indicates TWINT set The first step in a TWI transmission is to transmit a START condition. This is done by writing a specific value into TWCRn, instructing the TWI n hardware to transmit a START condition. Which value to write is described later on. However, it is important that the TWINT bit is set in the value written. Writing a one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI n will not start any operation as long as the TWINT bit in TWCRn is set. Immediately after the application has cleared TWINT, the TWI n will initiate transmission of the START condition. When the START condition has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag in TWCRn is set, and TWSRn is updated with a status code indicating that the START condition has successfully been sent. The application software should now examine the value of TWSRn, to make sure that the START condition was successfully transmitted. If TWSRn indicates otherwise, the application software might take some special action, like calling an error routine. Assuming that the status code is as expected, the application must load SLA+W into TWDR. Remember that TWDRn is used both for address and data. After TWDRn has been loaded with the desired SLA+W, a specific value must be written to TWCRn, instructing the TWI n hardware to transmit the SLA+W present in TWDRn. Which value to write is described later on. However, it is important that the TWINT bit is set in the value written. Writing a one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI will not start any operation as long Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 288 4. 5. 6. 7. as the TWINT bit in TWCRn is set. Immediately after the application has cleared TWINT, the TWI will initiate transmission of the address packet. When the address packet has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag in TWCRn is set, and TWSRn is updated with a status code indicating that the address packet has successfully been sent. The status code will also reflect whether a Slave acknowledged the packet or not. The application software should now examine the value of TWSRn, to make sure that the address packet was successfully transmitted, and that the value of the ACK bit was as expected. If TWSRn indicates otherwise, the application software might take some special action, like calling an error routine. Assuming that the status code is as expected, the application must load a data packet into TWDRn. Subsequently, a specific value must be written to TWCRn, instructing the TWI n hardware to transmit the data packet present in TWDRn. Which value to write is described later on. However, it is important that the TWINT bit is set in the value written. Writing a one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI n will not start any operation as long as the TWINT bit in TWCRn is set. Immediately after the application has cleared TWINT, the TWI will initiate transmission of the data packet. When the data packet has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag in TWCRn is set, and TWSRn is updated with a status code indicating that the data packet has successfully been sent. The status code will also reflect whether a Slave acknowledged the packet or not. The application software should now examine the value of TWSRn, to make sure that the data packet was successfully transmitted, and that the value of the ACK bit was as expected. If TWSR indicates otherwise, the application software might take some special action, like calling an error routine. Assuming that the status code is as expected, the application must write a specific value to TWCRn, instructing the TWI n hardware to transmit a STOP condition. Which value to write is described later on. However, it is important that the TWINT bit is set in the value written. Writing a one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI n will not start any operation as long as the TWINT bit in TWCRn is set. Immediately after the application has cleared TWINT, the TWI will initiate transmission of the STOP condition. Note that TWINT is not set after a STOP condition has been sent. Even though this example is simple, it shows the principles involved in all TWI transmissions. These can be summarized as follows: • • • When the TWI has finished an operation and expects application response, the TWINT Flag is set. The SCL line is pulled low until TWINT is cleared. When the TWINT Flag is set, the user must update all TWI n Registers with the value relevant for the next TWI n bus cycle. As an example, TWDRn must be loaded with the value to be transmitted in the next bus cycle. After all TWI n Register updates and other pending application software tasks have been completed, TWCRn is written. When writing TWCRn, the TWINT bit should be set. Writing a one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI n will then commence executing whatever operation was specified by the TWCRn setting. The following table lists assembly and C implementation examples for TWI0. Note that the code below assumes that several definitions have been made, e.g. by using include-files. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 289 Table 25-2 Assembly and C Code Example Assembly Code Example 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 C Example Comments Send START condition ldi r16, (1<<TWINT)| (1<<TWSTA)|(1<<TWEN) out TWCR0, r16 TWCR0 = (1<<TWINT)| (1<<TWSTA)|(1<<TWEN) wait1: in r16,TWCR0 sbrs r16,TWINT rjmp wait1 while (!(TWCR0 & (1<<TWINT))); Wait for TWINT Flag set. This indicates that the START condition has been transmitted. in r16,TWSR0 andi r16, 0xF8 cpi r16, START brne ERROR if ((TWSR0 & 0xF8) != START) ERROR(); Check value of TWI Status Register. Mask prescaler bits. If status different from START go to ERROR. ldi r16, SLA_W out TWDR0, r16 ldi r16, (1<<TWINT) | (1<<TWEN) out TWCR0, r16 TWDR0 = SLA_W; TWCR0 = (1<<TWINT) | (1<<TWEN); Load SLA_W into TWDR Register. Clear TWINT bit in TWCR to start transmission of address. wait2: in r16,TWCR0 sbrs r16,TWINT rjmp wait2 while (!(TWCR0 & (1<<TWINT))); Wait for TWINT Flag set. This indicates that the SLA+W has been transmitted, and ACK/ NACK has been received. in r16,TWSR0 andi r16, 0xF8 cpi r16, MT_SLA_ACK brne ERROR if ((TWSR0 & 0xF8) != MT_SLA_ACK) ERROR(); Check value of TWI Status Register. Mask prescaler bits. If status different from MT_SLA_ACK go to ERROR. ldi r16, DATA out TWDR0, r16 ldi r16, (1<<TWINT) | (1<<TWEN) out TWCR, r16 TWDR0 = DATA; TWCR0 = (1<<TWINT) | (1<<TWEN); wait3: in r16,TWCR0 sbrs r16,TWINT rjmp wait3 while (!(TWCR0 & (1<<TWINT))); Wait for TWINT Flag set. This indicates that the DATA has been transmitted, and ACK/ NACK has been received. in r16,TWSR0 andi r16, 0xF8 cpi r16, MT_DATA_ACK brne ERROR if ((TWSR0 & 0xF8) != MT_DATA_ACK) ERROR(); Check value of TWI Status Register. Mask prescaler bits. If status different from MT_DATA_ACK go to ERROR. ldi r16, (1<<TWINT)| (1<<TWEN)| (1<<TWSTO) out TWCR0, r16 TWCR0 = (1<<TWINT)| (1<<TWEN)|(1<<TWSTO); Load DATA into TWDR Register. Clear TWINT bit in TWCR to start transmission of data. Transmit STOP condition. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 290 25.7. Transmission Modes The TWI can operate in one of four major modes: • Master Transmitter (MT) • Master Receiver (MR) • Slave Transmitter (ST) • Slave Receiver (SR) Several of these modes can be used in the same application. As an example, the TWI can use MT mode to write data into a TWI EEPROM, MR mode to read the data back from the EEPROM. If other masters are present in the system, some of these might transmit data to the TWI, and then SR mode would be used. It is the application software that decides which modes are legal. The following sections describe each of these modes. Possible status codes are described along with figures detailing data transmission in each of the modes. These figures use the following abbreviations: S START condition Rs REPEATED START condition R Read bit (high level at SDA) W Write bit (low level at SDA) A Acknowledge bit (low level at SDA) A Not acknowledge bit (high level at SDA) Data 8-bit data byte P STOP condition SLA Slave Address Circles are used to indicate that the TWINT Flag is set. The numbers in the circles show the status code held in TWSRn, with the prescaler bits masked to zero. At these points, actions must be taken by the application to continue or complete the TWI transfer. The TWI transfer is suspended until the TWINT Flag is cleared by software. When the TWINT Flag is set, the status code in TWSRn is used to determine the appropriate software action. For each status code, the required software action and details of the following serial transfer are given below in the Status Code table for each mode. Note that the prescaler bits are masked to zero in these tables. 25.7.1. Master Transmitter Mode In the Master Transmitter (MT) mode, a number of data bytes are transmitted to a Slave Receiver, see figure below. In order to enter a Master mode, a START condition must be transmitted. The format of the following address packet determines whether MT or Master Receiver (MR) mode is to be entered: If SLA +W is transmitted, MT mode is entered, if SLA+R is transmitted, MR mode is entered. All the status codes mentioned in this section assume that the prescaler bits are zero or are masked to zero. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 291 Figure 25-11 Data Transfer in Master Transmitter Mode VCC Device 1 Device 2 MASTER TRANSMITTER SLAVE RECEIVER Device 3 ........ Device n R1 R2 SD A SCL A START condition is sent by writing a value to the TWI Control Register n (TWCRn) of the type TWCRn=1x10x10x: • • • The TWI Enable bit (TWCRn.TWEN) must be written to '1' to enable the 2-wire Serial Interface The TWI Start Condition bit (TWCRn.TWSTA) must be written to '1' to transmit a START condition The TWI Interrupt Flag (TWCRn.TWINT) must be written to '1' to clear the flag. The TWI n will then test the 2-wire Serial Bus and generate a START condition as soon as the bus becomes free. After a START condition has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag is set by hardware, and the status code in TWSRn will be 0x08 (see Status Code table below). In order to enter MT mode, SLA +W must be transmitted. This is done by writing SLA+W to the TWI Data Register (TWDRn). Thereafter, the TWCRn.TWINT Flag should be cleared (by writing a '1' to it) to continue the transfer. This is accomplished by writing a value to TWRC of the type TWCR=1x00x10x. When SLA+W have been transmitted and an acknowledgment bit has been received, TWINT is set again and a number of status codes in TWSR are possible. Possible status codes in Master mode are 0x18, 0x20, or 0x38. The appropriate action to be taken for each of these status codes is detailed in the Status Code table below. When SLA+W has been successfully transmitted, a data packet should be transmitted. This is done by writing the data byte to TWDR. TWDR must only be written when TWINT is high. If not, the access will be discarded, and the Write Collision bit (TWWC) will be set in the TWCRn Register. After updating TWDRn, the TWINT bit should be cleared (by writing '1' to it) to continue the transfer. This is accomplished by writing again a value to TWCRn of the type TWCRn=1x00x10x. This scheme is repeated until the last byte has been sent and the transfer is ended, either by generating a STOP condition or a by a repeated START condition. A repeated START condition is accomplished by writing a regular START value TWCRn=1x10x10x. A STOP condition is generated by writing a value of the type TWCRn=1x01x10x. After a repeated START condition (status code 0x10), the 2-wire Serial Interface can access the same Slave again, or a new Slave without transmitting a STOP condition. Repeated START enables the Master to switch between Slaves, Master Transmitter mode and Master Receiver mode without losing control of the bus. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 292 Table 25-3 Status Codes for Master Transmitter Mode Status Code (TWSR) Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus and 2-wire Serial Interface Hardware Application Software Response 0x08 A START condition has been transmitted Load SLA+W 0x10 Prescaler Bits are 0 0x18 0x20 0x28 To/from TWDR Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware To TWCRn STA STO TWINT TWEA 0 0 1 X SLA+W will be transmitted; ACK or NOT ACK will be received A repeated START condition has been transmitted Load SLA+W or 0 0 1 X SLA+W will be transmitted; ACK or NOT ACK will be received Load SLA+R 0 0 1 X SLA+R will be transmitted; Logic will switch to Master Receiver mode SLA+W has been transmitted; ACK has been received Load data byte or 0 0 1 X Data byte will be transmitted and ACK or NOT ACK will be received No TWDR action or 1 0 1 X Repeated START will be transmitted No TWDR action or 0 1 1 X STOP condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset No TWDR action 1 1 1 X STOP condition followed by a START condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset Load data byte or 0 0 1 X Data byte will be transmitted and ACK or NOT ACK will be received No TWDR action or 1 0 1 X Repeated START will be transmitted No TWDR action or 0 1 1 X STOP condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset No TWDR action 1 1 1 X STOP condition followed by a START condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset Load data byte or 0 0 1 X Data byte will be transmitted and ACK or NOT ACK will be received No TWDR action or 1 0 1 X Repeated START will be transmitted No TWDR action or 1 0 1 X STOP condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset No TWDR action 1 1 1 X STOP condition followed by a START condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset SLA+W has been transmitted; NOT ACK has been received Data byte has been transmitted; ACK has been received Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 293 Status Code (TWSR) Prescaler Bits are 0 0x30 0x38 Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus and 2-wire Serial Interface Hardware Application Software Response Data byte has been transmitted; NOT ACK has been received Arbitration lost in SLA +W or data bytes To/from TWDR Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware To TWCRn STA STO TWINT TWEA Load data byte or 0 0 1 X Data byte will be transmitted and ACK or NOT ACK will be received No TWDR action or 1 0 1 X Repeated START will be transmitted No TWDR action or 0 1 1 X STOP condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset No TWDR action 1 1 1 X STOP condition followed by a START condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset No TWDR action or 0 0 1 X 2-wire Serial Bus will be released and not addressed Slave mode entered No TWDR action 1 0 1 X A START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 294 Figure 25-12 Formats and States in the Master Transmitter Mode MT Successfull transmission to a sla ve receiv er S SLA $08 W A DATA $18 A P $28 Next transfer star ted with a repeated star t condition RS SLA W $10 Not acknowledge received after the slave address A R P $20 MR Not acknowledge receiv ed after a data byte A P $30 Arbitration lost in sla ve address or data b yte A or A Other master contin ues A or A $38 Arbitration lost and addressed as sla ve A $68 From master to sla ve From sla ve to master 25.7.2. Other master contin ues $38 Other master contin ues $78 DATA To corresponding states in sla ve mode $B0 A n Any number of data b ytes and their associated ac kno wledge bits This number (contained in TWSR) corresponds to a defined state of the 2-Wire Ser ial Bus . The prescaler bits are z ero or mask ed to z ero Master Receiver Mode In the Master Receiver (MR) mode, a number of data bytes are received from a Slave Transmitter (see next figure). In order to enter a Master mode, a START condition must be transmitted. The format of the following address packet determines whether Master Transmitter (MT) or MR mode is to be entered. If SLA+W is transmitted, MT mode is entered, if SLA+R is transmitted, MR mode is entered. All the status codes mentioned in this section assume that the prescaler bits are zero or are masked to zero. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 295 Figure 25-13 Data Transfer in Master Receiver Mode VCC Device 1 Device 2 MASTER RECEIVER SLAVE TRANSMITTER Device 3 ........ Device n R1 R2 SD A SCL A START condition is sent by writing to the TWI Control register (TWCRn) a value of the type TWCRn=1x10x10x: • TWCRn.TWEN must be written to '1' to enable the 2-wire Serial Interface • TWCRn.TWSTA must be written to '1' to transmit a START condition • TWCRn.TWINT must be cleared by writing a '1' to it. The TWI will then test the 2-wire Serial Bus and generate a START condition as soon as the bus becomes free. After a START condition has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag is set by hardware, and the status code in TWSRn will be 0x08 (see Status Code table below). In order to enter MR mode, SLA +R must be transmitted. This is done by writing SLA+R to TWDR. Thereafter, the TWINT flag should be cleared (by writing '1' to it) to continue the transfer. This is accomplished by writing the a value to TWCRn of the type TWCRn=1x00x10x. When SLA+R have been transmitted and an acknowledgment bit has been received, TWINT is set again and a number of status codes in TWSRn are possible. Possible status codes in Master mode are 0x38, 0x40, or 0x48. The appropriate action to be taken for each of these status codes is detailed in the table below. Received data can be read from the TWDR Register when the TWINT Flag is set high by hardware. This scheme is repeated until the last byte has been received. After the last byte has been received, the MR should inform the ST by sending a NACK after the last received data byte. The transfer is ended by generating a STOP condition or a repeated START condition. A repeated START condition is sent by writing to the TWI Control register (TWCRn) a value of the type TWCRn=1x10x10x again. A STOP condition is generated by writing TWCRn=1xx01x10x: After a repeated START condition (status code 0x10) the 2-wire Serial Interface can access the same Slave again, or a new Slave without transmitting a STOP condition. Repeated START enables the Master to switch between Slaves, Master Transmitter mode and Master Receiver mode without losing control over the bus. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 296 Table 25-4 Status codes for Master Receiver Mode Status Code (TWSRn) Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus and 2-wire Serial Interface Hardware Application Software Response 0x08 A START condition has been transmitted 0x10 A repeated START condition has been transmitted Prescaler Bits are 0 To/from TWD Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware To TWCRn STA STO TWINT TWEA Load SLA+R 0 0 1 X SLA+R will be transmitted ACK or NOT ACK will be received Load SLA+R or Load SLA+W 0 0 0 0 1 1 X X SLA+R will be transmitted ACK or NOT ACK will be received SLA+W will be transmitted Logic will switch to Master Transmitter mode 0x38 Arbitration lost in SLA+R No TWDR or NOT ACK bit action or No TWDR action 0 1 0 0 1 1 X X 2-wire Serial Bus will be released and not addressed Slave mode will be entered A START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free 0x40 0x48 SLA+R has been transmitted; ACK has been received SLA+R has been transmitted; NOT ACK has been received No TWDR action or No TWDR action 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 No TWDR action or No TWDR action or 1 0 0 1 1 1 X X 1 1 1 X Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned Data byte has been received; ACK has been returned Read data byte or Read data byte Repeated START will be transmitted STOP condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset STOP condition followed by a START condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset No TWDR action 0x50 Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be returned 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be returned Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned 0x58 Data byte has been received; NOT ACK has been returned Read data byte or Read data byte or Read data byte 1 0 0 1 1 1 X X 1 1 1 X Repeated START will be transmitted STOP condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset STOP condition followed by a START condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 297 Figure 25-14 Formats and States in the Master Receiver Mode MR Successfull reception from a sla v e receiv er S SLA $08 R A DATA $40 A DATA $50 A P $58 Next transf er star ted with a repeated star t condition RS SLA R $10 Not ac kno wledge received after the slave address A W P $48 Arbitration lost in sla ve address or data b yte MT A or A Other master contin ues $38 Arbitration lost and addressed as sla ve A $68 From master to sla ve From slave to master 25.7.3. Other master contin ues A $38 Other master contin ues $78 DATA To corresponding states in sla ve mode $B0 A n Any number of data b ytes and their associated ac kno wledge bits This number (contained in TWSR) corresponds to a defined state of the 2-Wire Ser ial Bus . The prescaler bits are z ero or mask ed to z ero Slave Transmitter Mode In the Slave Transmitter (ST) mode, a number of data bytes are transmitted to a Master Receiver, as in the figure below. All the status codes mentioned in this section assume that the prescaler bits are zero or are masked to zero. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 298 Figure 25-15 Data Transfer in Slave Transmitter Mode VCC Device 1 Device 2 SLAVE TRANSMITTER MASTER RECEIVER Device 3 ........ Device n R1 R2 SD A SCL To initiate the SR mode, the TWI (Slave) Address Register (TWARn) and the TWI Control Register (TWCRn) must be initialized as follows: The upper seven bits of TWARn are the address to which the 2-wire Serial Interface will respond when addressed by a Master (TWARn.TWA[6:0]). If the LSB of TWARn is written to TWARn.TWGCI=1, the TWI will respond to the general call address (0x00), otherwise it will ignore the general call address. TWCRn must hold a value of the type TWCRn=0100010x - TWEN must be written to one to enable the TWI. The TWEA bit must be written to one to enable the acknowledgment of the device’s own slave address or the general call address. TWSTA and TWSTO must be written to zero. When TWARn and TWCRn have been initialized, the TWI waits until it is addressed by its own slave address (or the general call address if enabled) followed by the data direction bit. If the direction bit is “1” (read), the TWI will operate in ST mode, otherwise SR mode is entered. After its own slave address and the write bit have been received, the TWINT Flag is set and a valid status code can be read from TWSRb. The status code is used to determine the appropriate sofTWARne action. The appropriate action to be taken for each status code is detailed in the table below. The ST mode may also be entered if arbitration is lost while the TWI is in the Master mode (see state 0xB0). If the TWCRn.TWEA bit is written to zero during a transfer, the TWI will transmit the last byte of the transfer. State 0xC0 or state 0xC8 will be entered, depending on whether the Master Receiver transmits a NACK or ACK after the final byte. The TWI is switched to the not addressed Slave mode, and will ignore the Master if it continues the transfer. Thus the Master Receiver receives all '1' as serial data. State 0xC8 is entered if the Master demands additional data bytes (by transmitting ACK), even though the Slave has transmitted the last byte (TWEA zero and expecting NACK from the Master). While TWCRn.TWEA is zero, the TWI does not respond to its own slave address. However, the 2-wire Serial Bus is still monitored and address recognition may resume at any time by setting TWEA. This implies that the TWEA bit may be used to temporarily isolate the TWI from the 2-wire Serial Bus. In all sleep modes other than Idle mode, the clock system to the TWI is turned off. If the TWEA bit is set, the interface can still acknowledge its own slave address or the general call address by using the 2-wire Serial Bus clock as a clock source. The part will then wake up from sleep and the TWI will hold the SCL clock will low during the wake up and until the TWINT Flag is cleared (by writing '1' to it). Further data transmission will be carried out as normal, with the AVR clocks running as normal. Observe that if the AVR is set up with a long start-up time, the SCL line may be held low for a long time, blocking other data transmissions. Note: The 2-wire Serial Interface Data Register (TWDRn) does not reflect the last byte present on the bus when waking up from these Sleep modes. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 299 Table 25-5 Status Codes for Slave Transmitter Mode Status Code (TWSRb) Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus and 2-wire Serial Interface Hardware Application SofTWARne Response To/from TWDRn To TWCRn STA STO TWINT TWEA 0xA8 Own SLA+R has been received; ACK has been returned Load data byte or Load data byte X X 0 0 1 1 0 1 Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should be received Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be received 0xB0 Arbitration lost in SLA +R/W as Master; own SLA+R has been received; ACK has been returned Load data byte or Load data byte X X 0 0 1 1 0 1 Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should be received Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be received 0xB8 Data byte in TWDRn has been transmitted; ACK has been Load data byte or Load data byte X X 0 0 1 1 0 1 Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should be received Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be received Prescaler Bits are 0 Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware received Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 300 Status Code (TWSRb) Prescaler Bits are 0 0xC0 Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus and 2-wire Serial Interface Hardware Application SofTWARne Response Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware To/from TWDRn To TWCRn STA STO TWINT TWEA Data byte in TWDRn has been transmitted; NOT ACK has been No TWDRn action or No TWDRn action or 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 received No TWDRn action or 1 0 1 1 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; no recognition of own SLA or GCA Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; own SLA will be recognized; No TWDRn action GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1” Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; no recognition of own SLA or GCA; a START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; own SLA will be recognized; GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”; a START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free 0xC8 Last data byte in TWDRn has been transmitted (TWEA = “0”); ACK has been received No TWDRn action or No TWDRn action or No TWDRn action or No TWDRn action 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; no recognition of own SLA or GCA Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; own SLA will be recognized; GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1” Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; no recognition of own SLA or GCA; a START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; own SLA will be recognized; GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”; a START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 301 Figure 25-16 Formats and States in the Slave Transmitter Mode Reception of the o wn sla ve address and one or more data b ytes S SLA R A DATA A $A8 Arbitration lost as master and addressed as sla ve DATA $B8 A P or S $C0 A $B0 Last data b yte tr ansmitted. Switched to not addressed slave (TWEA = '0') A All 1's P or S $C8 From master to sla ve DATA From slave to master 25.7.4. A n Any number of data b ytes and their associated ac kno wledge bits This number (contained in TWSR) corresponds to a defined state of the 2-Wire Ser ial Bus . The prescaler bits are z ero or mask ed to z ero Slave Receiver Mode In the Slave Receiver (SR) mode, a number of data bytes are received from a Master Transmitter (see figure below). All the status codes mentioned in this section assume that the prescaler bits are zero or are masked to zero. Figure 25-17 Data transfer in Slave Receiver mode VCC Device 1 Device 2 SLAVE RECEIVER MASTER TRANSMITTER Device 3 ........ Device n R1 R2 SD A SCL To initiate the SR mode, the TWI (Slave) Address Register n (TWARn) and the TWI Control Register n (TWCRn) must be initialized as follows: The upper seven bits of TWARn are the address to which the 2-wire Serial Interface will respond when addressed by a Master (TWARn.TWA[6:0]). If the LSB of TWARn is written to TWARn.TWGCI=1, the TWI n will respond to the general call address (0x00), otherwise it will ignore the general call address. TWCRn must hold a value of the type TWCRn=0100010x - TWCRn.TWEN must be written to '1' to enable the TWI. TWCRn.TWEA bit must be written to '1' to enable the acknowledgment of the device’s own slave address or the general call address. TWCRn.TWSTA and TWSTO must be written to zero. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 302 When TWARn and TWCRn have been initialized, the TWI waits until it is addressed by its own slave address (or the general call address, if enabled) followed by the data direction bit. If the direction bit is '0' (write), the TWI will operate in SR mode, otherwise ST mode is entered. After its own slave address and the write bit have been received, the TWINT Flag is set and a valid status code can be read from TWSR. The status code is used to determine the appropriate software action, as detailed in the table below. The SR mode may also be entered if arbitration is lost while the TWI is in the Master mode (see states 0x68 and 0x78). If the TWCRn.TWEA bit is reset during a transfer, the TWI will return a "Not Acknowledge" ('1') to SDA after the next received data byte. This can be used to indicate that the Slave is not able to receive any more bytes. While TWEA is zero, the TWI does not acknowledge its own slave address. However, the 2wire Serial Bus is still monitored and address recognition may resume at any time by setting TWEA. This implies that the TWEA bit may be used to temporarily isolate the TWI from the 2-wire Serial Bus. In all sleep modes other than Idle mode, the clock system to the TWI is turned off. If the TWEA bit is set, the interface can still acknowledge its own slave address or the general call address by using the 2-wire Serial Bus clock as a clock source. The part will then wake up from sleep and the TWI will hold the SCL clock low during the wake up and until the TWINT Flag is cleared (by writing '1' to it). Further data reception will be carried out as normal, with the AVR clocks running as normal. Observe that if the AVR is set up with a long start-up time, the SCL line may be held low for a long time, blocking other data transmissions. Note: The 2-wire Serial Interface Data Register (TWDRn) does not reflect the last byte present on the bus when waking up from these Sleep modes. Table 25-6 Status Codes for Slave Receiver Mode Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus and 2-wire Serial Interface Hardware Application SofTWARne Response To/from TWDRn To TWCRn STA STO TWINT TWEA 0x60 Own SLA+W has been received; ACK has been returned No TWDRn action or No TWDRn action X X 0 0 1 1 0 1 Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be returned Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned 0x68 Arbitration lost in SLA +R/W as Master; own SLA +W has been received; ACK has been returned No TWDRn action or No TWDRn action X X 0 0 1 1 0 1 Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be returned Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned 0x70 General call address has been received; ACK has been returned No TWDRn action or No TWDRn action X X 0 0 1 1 0 1 Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be returned Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned 0x78 Arbitration lost in SLA +R/W as Master; General call address has been received; ACK has been returned No TWDRn action or No TWDRn action X X 0 0 1 1 0 1 Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be returned Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned Status Code (TWSR) Prescaler Bits are 0 Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 303 Status Code (TWSR) Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus and 2-wire Serial Interface Hardware Application SofTWARne Response To/from TWDRn To TWCRn STA STO TWINT TWEA 0x80 Previously addressed with own SLA+W; data has been received; ACK has been returned Read data byte or Read data byte X X 0 0 1 1 0 1 Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be returned Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned 0x88 Previously addressed with own SLA+W; data has been received; NOT ACK has been returned Read data byte or Read data byte or 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; no recognition of own SLA or GCA 1 0 1 1 Prescaler Bits are 0 Read data byte or Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; own SLA will be recognized; Read data byte GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1” Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; no recognition of own SLA or GCA; a START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; own SLA will be recognized; GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”; a START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free 0x90 Previously addressed with general call; data has been received; ACK has been returned Read data byte or Read data byte X X 0 0 1 1 0 1 Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be returned Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 304 Status Code (TWSR) Prescaler Bits are 0 0x98 Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus and 2-wire Serial Interface Hardware Application SofTWARne Response To/from TWDRn To TWCRn STA STO TWINT TWEA Previously addressed with general call; data has been Read data byte or Read data byte or 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 received; NOT ACK has been returned Read data byte or Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; no recognition of own SLA or GCA Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; own SLA will be recognized; Read data byte GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1” Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; no recognition of own SLA or GCA; a START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; own SLA will be recognized; GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”; a START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free 0xA0 A STOP condition or No action repeated START condition has been received while still addressed as Slave 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; no recognition of own SLA or GCA Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; own SLA will be recognized; GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1” Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; no recognition of own SLA or GCA; a START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free Switched to the not addressed Slave mode; own SLA will be recognized; GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”; a START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 305 Figure 25-18 Formats and States in the Slave Receiver Mode Reception of the o wn sla ve address and one or more data b ytes. All are acknowledged S SLA W A DATA $60 A DATA $80 Last data b yte receiv ed is not ac kno wledged A P or S $80 $A0 A P or S $88 Arbitration lost as master and addressed as sla ve A $68 Reception of the gener al call address and one or more data bytes General Call A DATA $70 A DATA $90 Last data b yte receiv ed is not ac knowledged A P or S $90 $A0 A P or S $98 Arbitration lost as master and addressed as sla ve b y gener al call A $78 From master to sla ve From sla ve to master 25.7.5. DATA A n Any number of data b ytes and their associated ac kno wledge bits This n umber (contained in TWSR) corresponds to a defined state of the 2-Wire Ser ial Bus . The prescaler bits are z ero or mask ed to z ero Miscellaneous States There are two status codes that do not correspond to a defined TWI state, see the table in this section. Status 0xF8 indicates that no relevant information is available because the TWINT Flag is not set. This occurs between other states, and when the TWI is not involved in a serial transfer. Status 0x00 indicates that a bus error has occurred during a 2-wire Serial Bus transfer. A bus error occurs when a START or STOP condition occurs at an illegal position in the format frame. Examples of such illegal positions are during the serial transfer of an address byte, a data byte, or an acknowledge bit. When a bus error occurs, TWINT is set. To recover from a bus error, the TWSTO Flag must set and TWINT must be cleared by writing a logic one to it. This causes the TWI to enter the not addressed Slave mode and to clear the TWSTO Flag (no other bits in TWCRn are affected). The SDA and SCL lines are released, and no STOP condition is transmitted. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 306 Table 25-7 Miscellaneous States Status Code (TWSR) Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus and 2-wire Serial Interface Hardware Application Software Response To/from TWDRn To TWCRn 0xF8 No relevant state information available; TWINT = “0” No TWDRn action No TWCRn action 0x00 Bus error due to an illegal START or STOP condition No TWDRn action 0 Prescaler Bits are 0 25.7.6. STA STO 1 Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware TWINT 1 TWEA Wait or proceed current transfer X Only the internal hardware is affected, no STOP condition is sent on the bus. In all cases, the bus is released and TWSTO is cleared. Combining Several TWI Modes In some cases, several TWI modes must be combined in order to complete the desired action. Consider for example reading data from a serial EEPROM. Typically, such a transfer involves the following steps: 1. 2. 3. 4. The transfer must be initiated. The EEPROM must be instructed what location should be read. The reading must be performed. The transfer must be finished. Note that data is transmitted both from Master to Slave and vice versa. The Master must instruct the Slave what location it wants to read, requiring the use of the MT mode. Subsequently, data must be read from the Slave, implying the use of the MR mode. Thus, the transfer direction must be changed. The Master must keep control of the bus during all these steps, and the steps should be carried out as an atomical operation. If this principle is violated in a multi master system, another Master can alter the data pointer in the EEPROM between steps 2 and 3, and the Master will read the wrong data location. Such a change in transfer direction is accomplished by transmitting a REPEATED START between the transmission of the address byte and reception of the data. After a REPEATED START, the Master keeps ownership of the bus. The flow in this transfer is depicted in the following figure: Figure 25-19 Combining Several TWI Modes to Access a Serial EEPROM Master Transmitter S SLA+W A ADDRESS A S = ST ART Transmitted from master to sla 25.8. Rs SLA+R Master Receiv er A Rs = REPEA TED ST ART ve DATA A P P = ST OP Transmitted from sla ve to master Multi-master Systems and Arbitration If multiple masters are connected to the same bus, transmissions may be initiated simultaneously by one or more of them. The TWI standard ensures that such situations are handled in such a way that one of the masters will be allowed to proceed with the transfer, and that no data will be lost in the process. An example of an arbitration situation is depicted below, where two masters are trying to transmit data to a Slave Receiver. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 307 Figure 25-20 An Arbitration Example VCC Device 1 Device 2 Device 3 MASTER TRANSMITTER MASTER TRANSMITTER SLAVE RECEIVER ........ Device n R1 R2 SD A SCL Several different scenarios may arise during arbitration, as described below: • • • Two or more masters are performing identical communication with the same Slave. In this case, neither the Slave nor any of the masters will know about the bus contention. Two or more masters are accessing the same Slave with different data or direction bit. In this case, arbitration will occur, either in the READ/WRITE bit or in the data bits. The masters trying to output a '1' on SDA while another Master outputs a zero will lose the arbitration. Losing masters will switch to not addressed Slave mode or wait until the bus is free and transmit a new START condition, depending on application software action. Two or more masters are accessing different slaves. In this case, arbitration will occur in the SLA bits. Masters trying to output a '1' on SDA while another Master outputs a zero will lose the arbitration. Masters losing arbitration in SLA will switch to Slave mode to check if they are being addressed by the winning Master. If addressed, they will switch to SR or ST mode, depending on the value of the READ/WRITE bit. If they are not being addressed, they will switch to not addressed Slave mode or wait until the bus is free and transmit a new START condition, depending on application software action. This is summarized in the next figure. Possible status values are given in circles. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 308 Figure 25-21 Possible Status Codes Caused by Arbitration START SLA Data Arbitration lost in SLA Own Address / General Call received No STOP Arbitration lost in Data 38 TWI bus will be released and not addressed slave mode will be entered A START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free Yes Direction Write 68/78 Read B0 25.9. Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be returned Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should be received Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be received Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 309 25.9.1. TWI n Bit Rate Register Name: TWBRn Offset: 0xB8 + n*0x20 [n=0..1] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TWBR7 TWBR6 TWBR5 TWBR4 TWBR3 TWBR2 TWBR1 TWBR0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – TWBRn: TWI Bit Rate Registerremoved: [n = 7:0] TWBR selects the division factor for the bit rate generator. The bit rate generator is a frequency divider which generates the SCL clock frequency in the Master modes. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 310 25.9.2. TWI Status Register n Name: TWSRn Offset: 0xB9 + n*0x20 [n=0..1] Reset: 0xF8 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 1 0 TWS7 TWS6 TWS5 TWS4 TWS3 2 TWPS1 TWPS0 Access R R R R R R/W R/W Reset 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 Bit 7 – TWS7: TWI Status Bit 7 The TWS[7:3] reflect the status of the TWI logic and the 2-wire Serial Bus. The different status codes are described in Transmission Modes on page 291. Note that the value read from TWSR contains both the 5bit status value and the 2-bit prescaler value. The application designer should mask the prescaler bits to zero when checking the Status bits. This makes status checking independent of prescaler setting. This approach is used in this datasheet, unless otherwise noted. Bit 6 – TWS6: TWI Status Bit 6 Bit 5 – TWS5: TWI Status Bit 5 Bit 4 – TWS4: TWI Status Bit 4 Bit 3 – TWS3: TWI Status Bit 3 Bits 1:0 – TWPSn: TWI Prescaler [n = 1:0] These bits can be read and written, and control the bit rate prescaler. Table 25-8 TWI Bit Rate Prescaler TWPS[1:0] Prescaler Value 00 1 01 4 10 16 11 64 To calculate bit rates, refer to Bit Rate Generator Unit on page 286. The value of TWPS[1:0] is used in the equation. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 311 25.9.3. TWI (Slave) Address Register n The TWARn should be loaded with the 7-bit Slave address (in the seven most significant bits of TWARn) to which the TWI n will respond when programmed as a Slave Transmitter or Receiver, and not needed in the Master modes. In multi master systems, TWARn must be set in masters which can be addressed as Slaves by other Masters. The LSB of TWARn is used to enable recognition of the general call address (0x00). There is an associated address comparator that looks for the slave address (or general call address if enabled) in the received serial address. If a match is found, an interrupt request is generated. Name: TWARn Offset: 0xBA + n*0x20 [n=0..1] Reset: 0x02 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 TWA[6:0] Access Reset 0 TWGCE R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 Bits 7:1 – TWA[6:0]: TWI (Slave) Address These seven bits constitute the slave address of the TWI n unit. Bit 0 – TWGCE: TWI General Call Recognition Enable Bit If set, this bit enables the recognition of a General Call given over the 2-wire Serial Bus n. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 312 25.9.4. TWI Data Register n In Transmit mode, TWDRn contains the next byte to be transmitted. In Receive mode, the TWDRn contains the last byte received. It is writable while the TWI n is not in the process of shifting a byte. This occurs when the TWI Interrupt Flag in the TWI Control Register n (TWCRn.TWINT) is set by hardware. Note that the Data Register cannot be initialized by the user before the first interrupt occurs. The data in TWDRn remains stable as long as TWCRn.TWINT is set. While data is shifted out, data on the bus is simultaneously shifted in. TWDRn always contains the last byte present on the bus, except after a wake up from a sleep mode by the TWI n interrupt. In this case, the contents of TWDRn is undefined. In the case of a lost bus arbitration, no data is lost in the transition from Master to Slave. Handling of the ACK bit is controlled automatically by the TWI logic, the CPU cannot access the ACK bit directly. Name: TWDRn Offset: 0xBB + n*0x20 [n=0..1] Reset: 0x01 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TWD[7:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 Bits 7:0 – TWD[7:0]: TWI Data These eight bits constitute the next data byte to be transmitted, or the latest data byte received on the 2wire Serial Bus. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 313 25.9.5. TWI Control Register n The TWCRn is used to control the operation of the TWI n. It is used to enable the TWI n, to initiate a Master access by applying a START condition to the bus, to generate a Receiver acknowledge, to generate a stop condition, and to control halting of the bus while the data to be written to the bus are written to the TWDRn. It also indicates a write collision if data is attempted written to TWDRn while the register is inaccessible. Name: TWCRn Offset: 0xBC + n*0x20 [n=0..1] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 TWINT TWEA TWSTA TWSTO TWWC TWEN 1 TWIE 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – TWINT: TWI Interrupt Flag This bit is set by hardware when the TWI n has finished its current job and expects application software response. If the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG.I) and the TWI Interrupt Enable bit in the TWI Control Register n (TWCRn.TWIE) are set, the MCU will jump to the TWI Interrupt Vector. While the TWINT Flag is set, the SCL low period is stretched. The TWINT Flag must be cleared by software by writing a logic one to it. Note that this flag is not automatically cleared by hardware when executing the interrupt routine. Also note that clearing this flag starts the operation of the TWI n, so all accesses to the TWI Address Register (TWARn), TWI Status Register (TWSRn), and TWI Data Register (TWDRn) must be complete before clearing this flag. Bit 6 – TWEA: TWI Enable Acknowledge This bit controls the generation of the acknowledge pulse. If the TWEA bit is written to one, the ACK pulse is generated on the TWI n bus if the following conditions are met: 1. 2. 3. The device’s own slave address has been received. A general call has been received, while the TWGCE bit in the TWARn is set. A data byte has been received in Master Receiver or Slave Receiver mode. By writing the TWEA bit to zero, the device can be virtually disconnected from the 2-wire Serial Bus temporarily. Address recognition can then be resumed by writing the TWEA bit to one again. Bit 5 – TWSTA: TWI START Condition The application writes the TWSTA bit to one when it desires TWI n to become a Master on the 2-wire Serial Bus. The TWI n hardware checks if the bus is available, and generates a START condition on the bus if it is free. However, if the bus is not free, the TWI n waits until a STOP condition is detected, and then generates a new START condition to claim the bus Master status. TWSTA must be cleared by software when the START condition has been transmitted. Bit 4 – TWSTO: TWI STOP Condition Writing the TWSTO bit to one in Master mode will generate a STOP condition on the 2-wire Serial Bus TWI n. When the STOP condition is executed on the bus, the TWSTO bit is cleared automatically. In Slave mode, setting the TWSTO bit can be used to recover from an error condition. This will not generate Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 314 a STOP condition, but the TWI n returns to a well-defined unaddressed Slave mode and releases the SCL and SDA lines to a high impedance state. Bit 3 – TWWC: TWI Write Collision Flag The TWWC bit is set when attempting to write to the TWI n Data Register (TWDRn) when TWCRn.TWINT is low. This flag is cleared by writing the TWDRn register when TWINT is high. Bit 2 – TWEN: TWI Enable The TWEN bit enables TWI n operation and activates the TWI n interface. When TWEN is written to one, the TWI n takes control over the I/O pins connected to the SCL and SDA pins, enabling the slew-rate limiters and spike filters. If this bit is written to zero, the TWI n is switched off and all transmissions of TWI n are terminated, regardless of any ongoing operation. Bit 0 – TWIE: TWI Interrupt Enable When this bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG.I) is set, the TWI n interrupt request will be activated for as long as the TWCRn.TWINT Flag is high. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 315 25.9.6. TWI (Slave) Address Mask Register n Name: TWAMRn Offset: 0xBD + n*0x20 [n=0..1] Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TWAM[6:0] Access Reset R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:1 – TWAM[6:0]: TWI (Slave) Address The TWAMRn can be loaded with a 7-bit Slave Address mask. Each of the bits in TWAMRn can mask (disable) the corresponding address bits in the TWI Address Register n (TWARn). If the mask bit is set to one then the address match logic ignores the compare between the incoming address bit and the corresponding bit in TWARn. Figure 25-22 Address Match Logic, Example For TWI0 TWAR0 Address Match Address Bit 0 TWAMR0 Address Bit Comparator 0 Address Bit Comparator 6:1 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 316 26. AC - Analog Comparator 26.1. Overview The Analog Comparator compares the input values on the positive pin AIN0 and negative pin AIN1. When the voltage on the positive pin AIN0 is higher than the voltage on the negative pin AIN1, the Analog Comparator output, ACO, is set. The comparator’s output can be set to trigger the Timer/Counter1 Input Capture function. In addition, the comparator can trigger a separate interrupt, exclusive to the Analog Comparator. The user can select Interrupt triggering on comparator output rise, fall or toggle. A block diagram of the comparator and its surrounding logic is shown below. The Power Reduction ADC bit in the Power Reduction Register (PRR.PRADC) must be written to '0' in order to be able to use the ADC input MUX. Figure 26-1 Analog Comparator Block Diagram BANDGAP REFERENCE ACBG ACME ADEN ADC MULTIPLEXER OUTPUT (1) PE0 (ACO) ACOE Note: Refer to the Pin Configuration and the I/O Ports description for Analog Comparator pin placement Related Links I/O-Ports on page 99 PRR0 on page 67 Pin Configurations on page 13 Power Management and Sleep Modes on page 58 Minimizing Power Consumption on page 61 26.2. Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input It is possible to select any of the ADC[7..0] pins to replace the negative input to the Analog Comparator. The ADC multiplexer is used to select this input, and consequently, the ADC must be switched off to utilize this feature. If the Analog Comparator Multiplexer Enable bit in the ADC Control and Status Register B (ADCSRB.ACME) is '1' and the ADC is switched off (ADCSRA.ADEN=0), the three least significant Analog Channel Selection bits in the ADC Multiplexer Selection register (ADMUX.MUX[2..0]) select the input pin to replace the negative input to the Analog Comparator, as shown in the table below. When ADCSRB.ACME=0 or ADCSRA.ADEN=1, AIN1 is applied to the negative input of the Analog Comparator. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 317 Table 26-1 Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input 26.3. ACME ADEN MUX[2..0] Analog Comparator Negative Input 0 x xxx AIN1 1 1 xxx AIN1 1 0 000 ADC0 1 0 001 ADC1 1 0 010 ADC2 1 0 011 ADC3 1 0 100 ADC4 1 0 101 ADC5 1 0 110 ADC6 1 0 111 ADC7 Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 318 26.3.1. Analog Comparator Control and Status Register B The Store Program Memory Control and Status Register contains the control bits needed to control the Boot Loader operations. When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: ACSRB Offset: 0x4F Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x2F Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ACOE Access R/W Reset 0 Bit 0 – ACOE: Analog Comparator Output Enable When this bit is set, the analog comparator output is connected to the ACO pin. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 319 26.3.2. Analog Comparator Control and Status Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: ACSR Offset: 0x50 Reset: N/A Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x30 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ACD ACBG ACO ACI ACIE ACIC ACIS1 ACIS0 R/W R/W R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 a 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – ACD: Analog Comparator Disable When this bit is written logic one, the power to the Analog Comparator is switched off. This bit can be set at any time to turn off the Analog Comparator. This will reduce power consumption in Active and Idle mode. When changing the ACD bit, the Analog Comparator Interrupt must be disabled by clearing the ACIE bit in ACSR. Otherwise an interrupt can occur when the bit is changed. Bit 6 – ACBG: Analog Comparator Bandgap Select When this bit is set, a fixed bandgap reference voltage replaces the positive input to the Analog Comparator. When this bit is cleared, AIN0 is applied to the positive input of the Analog Comparator. When the bandgap reference is used as input to the Analog Comparator, it will take a certain time for the voltage to stabilize. If not stabilized, the first conversion may give a wrong value. Bit 5 – ACO: Analog Comparator Output The output of the Analog Comparator is synchronized and then directly connected to ACO. The synchronization introduces a delay of 1 - 2 clock cycles. Bit 4 – ACI: Analog Comparator Interrupt Flag This bit is set by hardware when a comparator output event triggers the interrupt mode defined by ACIS1 and ACIS0. The Analog Comparator interrupt routine is executed if the ACIE bit is set and the I-bit in SREG is set. ACI is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, ACI is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag. Bit 3 – ACIE: Analog Comparator Interrupt Enable When the ACIE bit is written logic one and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the Analog Comparator interrupt is activated. When written logic zero, the interrupt is disabled. Bit 2 – ACIC: Analog Comparator Input Capture Enable When written logic one, this bit enables the input capture function in Timer/Counter1 to be triggered by the Analog Comparator. The comparator output is in this case directly connected to the input capture front-end logic, making the comparator utilize the noise canceler and edge select features of the Timer/ Counter1 Input Capture interrupt. When written logic zero, no connection between the Analog Comparator and the input capture function exists. To make the comparator trigger the Timer/Counter1 Input Capture interrupt, the ICIE1 bit in the Timer Interrupt Mask Register (TIMSK1) must be set. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 320 Bits 1:0 – ACISn: Analog Comparator Interrupt Mode Select [n = 1:0] These bits determine which comparator events that trigger the Analog Comparator interrupt. Table 26-2 ACIS[1:0] Settings ACIS1 ACIS0 Interrupt Mode 0 0 Comparator Interrupt on Output Toggle. 0 1 Reserved 1 0 Comparator Interrupt on Falling Output Edge. 1 1 Comparator Interrupt on Rising Output Edge. When changing the ACIS1/ACIS0 bits, the Analog Comparator Interrupt must be disabled by clearing its Interrupt Enable bit in the ACSR Register. Otherwise an interrupt can occur when the bits are changed. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 321 26.3.3. Digital Input Disable Register 1 Name: DIDR1 Offset: 0x7F Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 5 Access Reset 4 3 2 1 0 AIN1D AIN0D R/W R/W 0 0 Bit 1 – AIN1D: AIN1 Digital Input Disable Bit 0 – AIN0D: AIN0 Digital Input Disable When this bit is written logic one, the digital input buffer on the AIN1/0 pin is disabled. The corresponding PIN Register bit will always read as zero when this bit is set. When an analog signal is applied to the AIN1/0 pin and the digital input from this pin is not needed, this bit should be written logic one to reduce power consumption in the digital input buffer. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 322 27. ADC - Analog to Digital Converter 27.1. Features • • • • • • • • • • • • • 27.2. 10-bit Resolution 0.5 LSB Integral Non-Linearity ±2 LSB Absolute Accuracy 13 - 260μs Conversion Time Up to 76.9kSPSs (Up to 15kSPS at Maximum Resolution) Six Multiplexed Single Ended Input Channels Two Additional Multiplexed Single Ended Input Channels (TQFP and VFQFN Package only) Optional Left Adjustment for ADC Result Readout 0 - VCC ADC Input Voltage Range Selectable 1.1V ADC Reference Voltage Free Running or Single Conversion Mode Interrupt on ADC Conversion Complete Sleep Mode Noise Canceler Overview The device features a 10-bit successive approximation ADC. The ADC is connected to an 8-channel Analog Multiplexer which allows eight single-ended voltage inputs constructed from the pins of Port A. The single-ended voltage inputs refer to 0V (GND). The ADC contains a Sample and Hold circuit which ensures that the input voltage to the ADC is held at a constant level during conversion. A block diagram of the ADC is shown below. The ADC has a separate analog supply voltage pin, AVCC. AVCC must not differ more than ±0.3V from VCC. See section ADC Noise Canceler on page 329 on how to connect this pin. The Power Reduction ADC bit in the Power Reduction Register (PRR.PRADC) must be written to '0' in order to be enable the ADC. The ADC converts an analog input voltage to a 10-bit digital value through successive approximation. The minimum value represents GND and the maximum value represents the voltage on the AREF pin minus 1 LSB. Optionally, AVCC or an internal 1.1V reference voltage may be connected to the AREF pin by writing to the REFSn bits in the ADMUX Register. The internal voltage reference must be decoupled by an external capacitor at the AREF pin to improve noise immunity. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 323 Figure 27-1 Analog to Digital Converter Block Schematic Operation ADC CONVERSION COMPLETE IRQ 15 0 ADC DATA REGISTER (ADCH/ADCL) ADC[9:0] ADPS1 ADPS0 ADPS2 ADIF ADFR ADEN ADSC ADC CTRL. & ST ATUS REGISTER (ADCSRA) MUX0 MUX2 MUX1 MUX3 ADLAR REFS0 REFS1 ADC MULTIPLEXER SELECT (ADMUX) ADIE ADIF 8-BIT DATA BUS MUX DECODER CHANNEL SELECTION PRESCALER AVCC CONVERSION LOGIC INTERNAL 1.1V REFERENCE SAMPLE & HOLD COMPARATOR AREF 10-BIT DAC + GND BANDGAP REFERENCE ADC7 ADC6 INPUT MUX ADC MULTIPLEXER OUTPUT ADC5 ADC4 ADC3 ADC2 ADC1 ADC0 The analog input channel is selected by writing to the MUX bits in the ADC Multiplexer Selection register ADMUX.MUX[3:0]. Any of the ADC input pins, as well as GND and a fixed bandgap voltage reference, can be selected as single ended inputs to the ADC. The ADC is enabled by writing a '1' to the ADC Enable bit in the ADC Control and Status Register A (ADCSRA.ADEN). Voltage reference and input channel selections will not take effect until ADEN is set. The ADC does not consume power when ADEN is cleared, so it is recommended to switch off the ADC before entering power saving sleep modes. If differential channels are selected, the differential gain stage amplifies the voltage difference between the selected input channel pair by the selected gain factor. This amplified value then becomes the analog input to the ADC. If single ended channels are used, the gain amplifier is bypassed altogether. The ADC generates a 10-bit result which is presented in the ADC Data Registers, ADCH and ADCL. By default, the result is presented right adjusted, but can optionally be presented left adjusted by setting the ADC Left Adjust Result bit ADMUX.ADLAR. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 324 If the result is left adjusted and no more than 8-bit precision is required, it is sufficient to read ADCH. Otherwise, ADCL must be read first, then ADCH, to ensure that the content of the Data Registers belongs to the same conversion: Once ADCL is read, ADC access to Data Registers is blocked. This means that if ADCL has been read, and a second conversion completes before ADCH is read, neither register is updated and the result from the second conversion is lost. When ADCH is read, ADC access to the ADCH and ADCL Registers is re-enabled. The ADC has its own interrupt which can be triggered when a conversion completes. When ADC access to the Data Registers is prohibited between reading of ADCH and ADCL, the interrupt will trigger even if the result is lost. Related Links Power Management and Sleep Modes on page 58 Power Reduction Register on page 61 27.3. Starting a Conversion A single conversion is started by writing a '0' to the Power Reduction ADC bit in the Power Reduction Register (PRR.PRADC), and writing a '1' to the ADC Start Conversion bit in the ADC Control and Status Register A (ADCSRA.ADSC). ADCS will stay high as long as the conversion is in progress, and will be cleared by hardware when the conversion is completed. If a different data channel is selected while a conversion is in progress, the ADC will finish the current conversion before performing the channel change. Alternatively, a conversion can be triggered automatically by various sources. Auto Triggering is enabled by setting the ADC Auto Trigger Enable bit (ADCSRA.ADATE). The trigger source is selected by setting the ADC Trigger Select bits in the ADC Control and Status Register B (ADCSRB.ADTS). See the description of the ADCSRB.ADTS for a list of available trigger sources. When a positive edge occurs on the selected trigger signal, the ADC prescaler is reset and a conversion is started. This provides a method of starting conversions at fixed intervals. If the trigger signal still is set when the conversion completes, a new conversion will not be started. If another positive edge occurs on the trigger signal during conversion, the edge will be ignored. Note that an interrupt flag will be set even if the specific interrupt is disabled or the Global Interrupt Enable bit in the AVR Status REgister (SREG.I) is cleared. A conversion can thus be triggered without causing an interrupt. However, the Interrupt Flag must be cleared in order to trigger a new conversion at the next interrupt event. Figure 27-2 ADC Auto Trigger Logic ADTS[2:0] PRESCALER START ADIF CLKADC ADATE SOURCE 1 . . . . SOURCE n CONVERSION LOGIC EDGE DETECTOR ADSC Using the ADC Interrupt Flag as a trigger source makes the ADC start a new conversion as soon as the ongoing conversion has finished. The ADC then operates in Free Running mode, constantly sampling and updating the ADC Data Register. The first conversion must be started by writing a '1' to ADCSRA.ADSC. In this mode the ADC will perform successive conversions independently of whether the ADC Interrupt Flag (ADIF) is cleared or not. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 325 If Auto Triggering is enabled, single conversions can be started by writing ADCSRA.ADSC to '1'. ADSC can also be used to determine if a conversion is in progress. The ADSC bit will be read as '1' during a conversion, independently of how the conversion was started. Prescaling and Conversion Timing Figure 27-3 ADC Prescaler ADEN START Reset CK/64 CK/128 CK/32 CK/8 CK/16 CK/4 7-BIT ADC PRESCALER CK CK/2 27.4. ADPS0 ADPS1 ADPS2 ADC CLOCK SOURCE By default, the successive approximation circuitry requires an input clock frequency between 50kHz and 200kHz to get maximum resolution. If a lower resolution than 10 bits is needed, the input clock frequency to the ADC can be higher than 200kHz to get a higher sample rate. The ADC module contains a prescaler, which generates an acceptable ADC clock frequency from any CPU frequency above 100kHz. The prescaling is selected by the ADC Prescaler Select bits in the ADC Control and Status Register A (ADCSRA.ADPS). The prescaler starts counting from the moment the ADC is switched on by writing the ADC Enable bit ADCSRA.ADEN to '1'. The prescaler keeps running for as long as ADEN=1, and is continuously reset when ADEN=0. When initiating a single ended conversion by writing a '1' to the ADC Start Conversion bit (ADCSRA.ADSC), the conversion starts at the following rising edge of the ADC clock cycle. A normal conversion takes 13 ADC clock cycles. The first conversion after the ADC is switched on (i.e., ADCSRA.ADEN is written to '1') takes 25 ADC clock cycles in order to initialize the analog circuitry. When the bandgap reference voltage is used as input to the ADC, it will take a certain time for the voltage to stabilize. If not stabilized, the first value read after the first conversion may be wrong. The actual sample-and-hold takes place 1.5 ADC clock cycles after the start of a normal conversion and 13.5 ADC clock cycles after the start of an first conversion. When a conversion is complete, the result is written to the ADC Data Registers (ADCL and ADCH), and the ADC Interrupt Flag (ADCSRA.ADIF) is set. In Single Conversion mode, ADCSRA.ADSC is cleared simultaneously. The software may then set ADCSRA.ADSC again, and a new conversion will be initiated on the first rising ADC clock edge. When Auto Triggering is used, the prescaler is reset when the trigger event occurs. This assures a fixed delay from the trigger event to the start of conversion. In this mode, the sample-and-hold takes place two ADC clock cycles after the rising edge on the trigger source signal. Three additional CPU clock cycles are used for synchronization logic. In Free Running mode, a new conversion will be started immediately after the conversion completes, while ADCRSA.ADSC remains high. See also the ADC Conversion Time table below. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 326 Figure 27-4 ADC Timing Diagram, First Conversion (Single Conversion Mode) Next Conversion First Conversion Cycle Number 1 12 2 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 1 2 3 ADC Clock ADEN ADSC ADIF Sign and MSB of Result ADCH LSB of Result ADCL MUX and REFS Update Conversion Complete Sample and Hold MUX and REFS Update Table 27-1 ADC Conversion Time Condition Sample & Hold (Cycles from Start of Conversion) Conversion Time (Cycles) First conversion 13.5 25 Normal conversions, single ended 1.5 13 Auto Triggered conversions 2 13.5 27.4.1. Differential Gain Channels When using differential gain channels, certain aspects of the conversion need to be taken into consideration. Note that the differential channels should not be used with an AREF < 2V. Differential conversions are synchronized to the internal clock CKADC2 equal to half the ADC clock. This synchronization is done automatically by the ADC interface in such a way that the sample-and-hold occurs at a specific phase of CKADC2. A conversion initiated by the user (that is, all single conversions, and the first free running conversion) when CKADC2 is low will take the same amount of time as a single ended conversion (13 ADC clock cycles from the next prescaled clock cycle). A conversion initiated by the user when CKADC2 is high will take 14 ADC clock cycles due to the synchronization mechanism. In Free Running mode, a new conversion is initiated immediately after the previous conversion completes, and since CKADC2 is high at this time, all automatically started (that is, all but the first) free running conversions will take 14 ADC clock cycles. The gain stage is optimized for a bandwidth of 4kHz at all gain settings. Higher frequencies may be subjected to non-linear amplification. An external low-pass filter should be used if the input signal contains higher frequency components than the gain stage bandwidth. Note that the ADC clock frequency is independent of the gain stage bandwidth limitation. For example, the ADC clock period may be 6 μs, allowing a channel to be sampled at 12kSPS, regardless of the bandwidth of this channel. If differential gain channels are used and conversions are started by Auto Triggering, the ADC must be switched off between conversions. When Auto Triggering is used, the ADC prescaler is reset before the conversion is started. Since the gain stage is dependent of a stable ADC clock prior to the conversion, this conversion will not be valid. By disabling and then re-enabling the ADC between each conversion (writing ADEN in ADCSRA to “0” then to “1”), only extended conversions are performed. The result from the extended conversions will be valid. See Prescaling and Conversion Timing section Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 327 27.5. Changing Channel or Reference Selection The Analog Channel Selection bits (MUX) and the Reference Selection bits (REFS) bits in the ADC Multiplexer Selection Register (ADCMUX.MUX[3:0] and ADCMUX.REFS[1:0]) are single buffered through a temporary register to which the CPU has random access. This ensures that the channels and reference selection only takes place at a safe point during the conversion. The channel and reference selection is continuously updated until a conversion is started. Once the conversion starts, the channel and reference selection is locked to ensure a sufficient sampling time for the ADC. Continuous updating resumes in the last ADC clock cycle before the conversion completes (indicated by ADCSRA.ADIF set). Note that the conversion starts on the following rising ADC clock edge after ADSC is written. The user is thus advised not to write new channel or reference selection values to ADMUX until one ADC clock cycle after the ADC Start Conversion bit (ADCRSA.ADSC) was written. If Auto Triggering is used, the exact time of the triggering event can be indeterministic. Special care must be taken when updating the ADMUX Register, in order to control which conversion will be affected by the new settings. If both the ADC Auto Trigger Enable and ADC Enable bits (ADCRSA.ADATE, ADCRSA.ADEN) are written to '1', an interrupt event can occur at any time. If the ADMUX Register is changed in this period, the user cannot tell if the next conversion is based on the old or the new settings. ADMUX can be safely updated in the following ways: 1. When ADATE or ADEN is cleared. 1.1. During conversion, minimum one ADC clock cycle after the trigger event. 1.2. After a conversion, before the Interrupt Flag used as trigger source is cleared. When updating ADMUX in one of these conditions, the new settings will affect the next ADC conversion. Special care should be taken when changing differential channels. Once a differential channel has been selected, the gain stage may take as much as 125 μs to stabilize to the new value. Thus conversions should not be started within the first 125 μs after selecting a new differential channel. Alternatively, conversion results obtained within this period should be discarded. The same settling time should be observed for the first differential conversion after changing ADC reference (by changing the REFS[1:0] bits in ADMUX). 27.5.1. ADC Input Channels When changing channel selections, the user should observe the following guidelines to ensure that the correct channel is selected: • In Single Conversion mode, always select the channel before starting the conversion. The channel selection may be changed one ADC clock cycle after writing one to ADSC. However, the simplest method is to wait for the conversion to complete before changing the channel selection. • In Free Running mode, always select the channel before starting the first conversion. The channel selection may be changed one ADC clock cycle after writing one to ADSC. However, the simplest method is to wait for the first conversion to complete, and then change the channel selection. Since the next conversion has already started automatically, the next result will reflect the previous channel selection. Subsequent conversions will reflect the new channel selection. The user is advised not to write new channel or reference selection values during Free Running mode. 27.5.2. ADC Voltage Reference The reference voltage for the ADC (VREF) indicates the conversion range for the ADC. Single ended channels that exceed VREF will result in codes close to 0x3FF. VREF can be selected as either AVCC, internal 1.1V reference, or external AREF pin. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 328 AVCC is connected to the ADC through a passive switch. The internal 1.1V reference is generated from the internal bandgap reference (VBG) through an internal amplifier. In either case, the external AREF pin is directly connected to the ADC, and the reference voltage can be made more immune to noise by connecting a capacitor between the AREF pin and ground. VREF can also be measured at the AREF pin with a high impedance voltmeter. Note that VREF is a high impedance source, and only a capacitive load should be connected in a system. If the user has a fixed voltage source connected to the AREF pin, the user may not use the other reference voltage options in the application, as they will be shorted to the external voltage. If no external voltage is applied to the AREF pin, the user may switch between AVCC and 1.1V as reference selection. The first ADC conversion result after switching reference voltage source may be inaccurate, and the user is advised to discard this result. If differential channels are used, the selected reference should not be closer to AVCC than indicated in ADC Characteristics of Electrical Characteristics chapter. 27.6. ADC Noise Canceler The ADC features a noise canceler that enables conversion during sleep mode to reduce noise induced from the CPU core and other I/O peripherals. The noise canceler can be used with ADC Noise Reduction and Idle mode. To make use of this feature, the following procedure should be used: 1. 2. 3. Make sure that the ADC is enabled and is not busy converting. Single Conversion mode must be selected and the ADC conversion complete interrupt must be enabled. Enter ADC Noise Reduction mode (or Idle mode). The ADC will start a conversion once the CPU has been halted. If no other interrupts occur before the ADC conversion completes, the ADC interrupt will wake up the CPU and execute the ADC Conversion Complete interrupt routine. If another interrupt wakes up the CPU before the ADC conversion is complete, that interrupt will be executed, and an ADC Conversion Complete interrupt request will be generated when the ADC conversion completes. The CPU will remain in active mode until a new sleep command is executed. Note: The ADC will not be automatically turned off when entering other sleep modes than Idle mode and ADC Noise Reduction mode. The user is advised to write zero to ADCRSA.ADEN before entering such sleep modes to avoid excessive power consumption. 27.6.1. Analog Input Circuitry The analog input circuitry for single ended channels is illustrated below. An analog source applied to ADCn is subjected to the pin capacitance and input leakage of that pin, regardless of whether that channel is selected as input for the ADC. When the channel is selected, the source must drive the S/H capacitor through the series resistance (combined resistance in the input path). The ADC is optimized for analog signals with an output impedance of approximately 10 kΩ or less. If such a source is used, the sampling time will be negligible. If a source with higher impedance is used, the sampling time will depend on how long time the source needs to charge the S/H capacitor, with can vary widely. The user is recommended to only use low impedance sources with slowly varying signals, since this minimizes the required charge transfer to the S/H capacitor. Signal components higher than the Nyquist frequency (fADC/2) should not be present for either kind of channels, to avoid distortion from unpredictable signal convolution. The user is advised to remove high frequency components with a low-pass filter before applying the signals as inputs to the ADC. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 329 Figure 27-5 Analog Input Circuitry IIH ADCn 1..100k Ω IIL CS/H= 14pF VCC/2 27.6.2. Analog Noise Canceling Techniques Digital circuitry inside and outside the device generates EMI which might affect the accuracy of analog measurements. If conversion accuracy is critical, the noise level can be reduced by applying the following techniques: 1. Keep analog signal paths as short as possible. Make sure analog tracks run over the analog ground plane, and keep them well away from high-speed switching digital tracks. 1.1. The AVCC pin on the device should be connected to the digital VCC supply voltage via an LC network as shown in the figure below. 1.2. Use the ADC noise canceler function to reduce induced noise from the CPU. 1.3. If any ADC [3:0] port pins are used as digital outputs, it is essential that these do not switch while a conversion is in progress. However, using the 2-wire Interface (ADC4 and ADC5) will only affect the conversion on ADC4 and ADC5 and not the other ADC channels. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 330 Analog Ground Plane PC2 (ADC2) PC3 (ADC3) PC4 (ADC4/SDA) PC5 (ADC5/SCL) VCC GND Figure 27-6 ADC Power Connections PC1 (ADC1) PC0 (ADC0) ADC7 AREF 10m H GND AVCC 100nF ADC6 PB5 27.6.3. ADC Accuracy Definitions An n-bit single-ended ADC converts a voltage linearly between GND and VREF in 2n steps (LSBs). The lowest code is read as 0, and the highest code is read as 2n-1. Several parameters describe the deviation from the ideal behavior: • Offset: The deviation of the first transition (0x000 to 0x001) compared to the ideal transition (at 0.5 LSB). Ideal value: 0 LSB. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 331 Figure 27-7 Offset Error Output Code Ideal ADC Actual ADC Offset Error • VREF Input Voltage Gain error: After adjusting for offset, the gain error is found as the deviation of the last transition (0x3FE to 0x3FF) compared to the ideal transition (at 1.5 LSB below maximum). Ideal value: 0 LSB. Figure 27-8 Gain Error Gain Error Output Code Ideal ADC Actual ADC VREF • Input Voltage Integral Non-linearity (INL): After adjusting for offset and gain error, the INL is the maximum deviation of an actual transition compared to an ideal transition for any code. Ideal value: 0 LSB. Figure 27-9 Integral Non-linearity (INL) Output Code INL Ideal ADC Actual ADC VREF Input Voltage Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 332 • Differential Non-linearity (DNL): The maximum deviation of the actual code width (the interval between two adjacent transitions) from the ideal code width (1 LSB). Ideal value: 0 LSB. Figure 27-10 Differential Non-linearity (DNL) Output Code 0x3FF 1 LSB DNL 0x000 0 • • 27.7. VREF Input Voltage Quantization Error: Due to the quantization of the input voltage into a finite number of codes, a range of input voltages (1 LSB wide) will code to the same value. Always ±0.5 LSB. Absolute accuracy: The maximum deviation of an actual (unadjusted) transition compared to an ideal transition for any code. This is the compound effect of offset, gain error, differential error, nonlinearity, and quantization error. Ideal value: ±0.5 LSB. ADC Conversion Result After the conversion is complete (ADCSRA.ADIF is set), the conversion result can be found in the ADC Result Registers (ADCL, ADCH). For single ended conversion, the result is ADC = �IN ⋅ 1024 �REF where VIN is the voltage on the selected input pin, and VREF the selected voltage reference (see also descriptions of ADMUX.REFSn and ADMUX.MUX). 0x000 represents analog ground, and 0x3FF represents the selected reference voltage minus one LSB. If differential channels are used, the result is ADC = ���� − ���� ⋅ ���� ⋅ 512 �REF where VPOS is the voltage on the positive input pin, VNEG the voltage on the negative input pin, GAIN the selected gain factor, and VREF the selected voltage reference. The result is presented in two’s complement form, from 0x200 (-512d) through 0x1FF (+511d). Note that if the user wants to perform a quick polarity check of the results, it is sufficient to read the MSB of the result (ADC9 in ADCH). If this bit is one, the result is negative, and if this bit is zero, the result is positive. The figure below shows the decoding of the differential input range. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 333 Figure 27-11 Differential Measurement Range Output Code 0x1FF 0x000 - VREF /GAIN 0x3FF 0 VREF /GAIN Diffe re ntia l Input Volta ge (Volts ) 0x200 The table below shows the resulting output codes if the differential input channel pair (ADCn - ADCm) is selected with a gain of GAIN and a reference voltage of VREF. Table 27-2 Correlation between Input Voltage and Output Codes VADCn Read code Corresponding Decimal Value VADCm + VREF/GAIN 0x1FF 511 VADCm + 0.999 VREF/GAIN 0x1FF 511 VADCm + 0.998 VREF/GAIN 0x1FE 510 ... ... ... VADCm + 0.001 VREF/GAIN 0x001 1 VADCm 0x000 0 VADCm - 0.001 VREF/GAIN 0x3FF -1 ... ... ... VADCm - 0.999 VREF/GAIN 0x201 -511 VADCm - VREF/GAIN 0x200 -512 ADMUX = 0xED (ADC3 - ADC2, 10× gain, 2.56V reference, left adjusted result) Voltage on ADC3 is 300 mV, voltage on ADC2 is 500 mV. ADCR = 512 × 10 × (300 - 500) / 2560 = -400 = 0x270 ADCL will thus read 0x00, and ADCH will read 0x9C. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 334 Writing zero to ADLAR right adjusts the result: ADCL = 0x70, ADCH = 0x02. 27.8. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 335 27.8.1. ADC Multiplexer Selection Register Name: ADMUX Offset: 0x7C Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 REFS1 REFS0 ADLAR MUX4 MUX3 MUX2 MUX1 MUX0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:6 – REFSn: Reference Selection [n = 1:0] These bits select the voltage reference for the ADC. If these bits are changed during a conversion, the change will not go in effect until this conversion is complete (ADIF in ADCSRA is set). The internal voltage reference options may not be used if an external reference voltage is being applied to the AREF pin. Table 27-3 ADC Voltage Reference Selection REFS[1:0] Voltage Reference Selection 00 AREF, Internal Vref turned off 01 AVCC with external capacitor at AREF pin 10 Internal 1.1V Voltage Reference with external capacitor at AREF pin 11 Internal 2.56V Voltage Reference with external capacitor at AREF pin Note: If differential channels are selected, only 2.56V should be used as Internal Voltage Reference. Bit 5 – ADLAR: ADC Left Adjust Result The ADLAR bit affects the presentation of the ADC conversion result in the ADC Data Register. Write one to ADLAR to left adjust the result. Otherwise, the result is right adjusted. Changing the ADLAR bit will affect the ADC Data Register immediately, regardless of any ongoing conversions. For a complete description of this bit, see ADCL on page 341 and ADCH on page 342. Bits 4:0 – MUXn: Analog Channel and Gain Selection Bits [n = 4:0] The value of these bits selects which combination of analog inputs are connected to the ADC. These bits also select the gain for the differential channels. If these bits are changed during a conversion, the change will not go in effect until this conversion is complete. (ADIF in ADCSRA on page 339 is set). Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 336 Table 27-4 Input Channel and Gain Selections MUX[4:0] Single Ended Input Positive Differential Input Negative Differential Input Gain 00000 ADC0 N/A 00001 ADC1 00010 ADC2 00011 ADC3 00100 ADC4 00101 ADC5 00110 ADC6 00111 ADC7 01000 N/A ADC0 ADC0 10x 01001 ADC1 ADC0 10x 01010 ADC0 ADC0 200x 01011 ADC1 ADC0 200x 01100 ADC2 ADC2 10x 01101 ADC3 ADC2 10x 01110 ADC2 ADC2 200x 01111 ADC3 ADC2 200x ADC0 ADC1 1x 10001 ADC1 ADC1 1x 10010 ADC2 ADC1 1x 10011 ADC3 ADC1 1x 10100 ADC4 ADC1 1x 10101 ADC5 ADC1 1x 10110 ADC6 ADC1 1x 11111 ADC7 ADC1 1x 11000 ADC0 ADC2 1x 11000 ADC1 ADC2 1x 11001 ADC2 ADC2 1x 11010 ADC3 ADC2 1x 11011 ADC4 ADC2 1x 11100 ADC5 ADC2 1x 10000 N/A Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 337 MUX[4:0] Single Ended Input Positive Differential Input 11110 1.1V (VBG) N/A 11111 0V (GND) Negative Differential Input Gain Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 338 27.8.2. ADC Control and Status Register A Name: ADCSRA Offset: 0x7A Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADEN ADSC ADATE ADIF ADIE ADPS2 ADPS1 ADPS0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – ADEN: ADC Enable Writing this bit to one enables the ADC. By writing it to zero, the ADC is turned off. Turning the ADC off while a conversion is in progress, will terminate this conversion. Bit 6 – ADSC: ADC Start Conversion In Single Conversion mode, write this bit to one to start each conversion. In Free Running mode, write this bit to one to start the first conversion. The first conversion after ADSC has been written after the ADC has been enabled, or if ADSC is written at the same time as the ADC is enabled, will take 25 ADC clock cycles instead of the normal 13. This first conversion performs initialization of the ADC. ADSC will read as one as long as a conversion is in progress. When the conversion is complete, it returns to zero. Writing zero to this bit has no effect. Bit 5 – ADATE: ADC Auto Trigger Enable When this bit is written to one, Auto Triggering of the ADC is enabled. The ADC will start a conversion on a positive edge of the selected trigger signal. The trigger source is selected by setting the ADC Trigger Select bits, ADTS in ADCSRB. Bit 4 – ADIF: ADC Interrupt Flag This bit is set when an ADC conversion completes and the Data Registers are updated. The ADC Conversion Complete Interrupt is executed if the ADIE bit and the I-bit in SREG are set. ADIF is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, ADIF is cleared by writing a logical one to the flag. Beware that if doing a Read-Modify-Write on ADCSRA, a pending interrupt can be disabled. This also applies if the SBI and CBI instructions are used. Bit 3 – ADIE: ADC Interrupt Enable When this bit is written to one and the I-bit in SREG is set, the ADC Conversion Complete Interrupt is activated. Bits 2:0 – ADPSn: ADC Prescaler Select [n = 2:0] These bits determine the division factor between the system clock frequency and the input clock to the ADC. Table 27-5 Input Channel Selection ADPS[2:0] Division Factor 000 2 001 2 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 339 ADPS[2:0] Division Factor 010 4 011 8 100 16 101 32 110 64 111 128 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 340 27.8.3. ADC Data Register Low (ADLAR=0) When an ADC conversion is complete, the result is found in these two registers. If differential channels are used, the result is presented in two’s complement form. When ADCL is read, the ADC Data Register is not updated until ADCH is read. Consequently, if the result is left adjusted and no more than 8-bit precision is required, it is sufficient to read ADCH. Otherwise, ADCL must be read first, then ADCH. The ADLAR bit and the MUXn bits in ADMUX affect the way the result is read from the registers. If ADLAR is set, the result is left adjusted. If ADLAR is cleared (default), the result is right adjusted. Name: ADCL Offset: 0x78 Reset: 0x00 Property: ADLAR = 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADC7 ADC6 ADC5 ADC4 ADC3 ADC2 ADC1 ADC0 Access R R R R R R R R Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bits 7:0 – ADCn: ADC Conversion Result [n = 7:0] These bits represent the result from the conversion. Refer to ADC Conversion Result on page 333 for details. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 341 27.8.4. ADC Data Register High (ADLAR=0) Name: ADCH Offset: 0x79 Reset: 0x00 Property: ADLAR = 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADC9 ADC8 Access R R Reset 0 0 Bit 1 – ADC9: ADC Conversion Result Refer to ADCL on page 341. Bit 0 – ADC8: ADC Conversion Result Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 342 27.8.5. ADC Data Register Low (ADLAR=1) Name: ADCL Offset: 0x78 Reset: 0x00 Property: ADLAR = 1 Bit 7 6 ADC1 ADC0 Access R R Reset 0 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 – ADC1: ADC Conversion Result Refer to ADCL on page 341. Bit 6 – ADC0: ADC Conversion Result Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 343 27.8.6. ADC Data Register High (ADLAR=1) Name: ADCH Offset: 0x79 Reset: 0x00 Property: ADLAR = 1 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADC9 ADC8 ADC7 ADC6 ADC5 ADC4 ADC3 ADC2 Access R R R R R R R R Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – ADC9: ADC Conversion Result 9 Refer to ADCL on page 341. Bit 6 – ADC8: ADC Conversion Result 8 Refer to ADCL on page 341. Bit 5 – ADC7: ADC Conversion Result 7 Refer to ADCL on page 341. Bit 4 – ADC6: ADC Conversion Result 6 Refer to ADCL on page 341. Bit 3 – ADC5: ADC Conversion Result 5 Refer to ADCL on page 341. Bit 2 – ADC4: ADC Conversion Result 4 Refer to ADCL on page 341. Bit 1 – ADC3: ADC Conversion Result 3 Refer to ADCL on page 341. Bit 0 – ADC2: ADC Conversion Result 2 Refer to ADCL on page 341. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 344 27.8.7. ADC Control and Status Register B Name: ADCSRB Offset: 0x7B Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit 7 6 Access 2 1 0 GPIOEN ADTS2 ADTS1 ADTS0 R/W R/W R/W R/W 1 0 0 0 Reset 5 4 3 Bit 6 – GPIOEN: GPIO operation enable To use AREF pin on PE4, ADC must be enabled and disable GPIO functionality by writing '0' to this bit. Setting a logic one to this bit will disable the AREF and enable the GPIO functionality. AREF is multiplexed with GPIO. Bit 6 – ACME: Analog Comparator Multiplexer Enable When this bit is written logic one and the ADC is switched off (ADEN in ADCSRA is zero), the ADC multiplexer selects the negative input to the Analog Comparator. When this bit is written logic zero, AIN1 is applied to the negative input of the Analog Comparator. For a detailed description of this bit, see Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input.. Bits 2:0 – ADTSn: ADC Auto Trigger Source [n = 2:0] If ADATE in ADCSRA is written to one, the value of these bits selects which source will trigger an ADC conversion. If ADATE is cleared, the ADTS[2:0] settings will have no effect. A conversion will be triggered by the rising edge of the selected Interrupt Flag. Note that switching from a trigger source that is cleared to a trigger source that is set, will generate a positive edge on the trigger signal. If ADEN in ADCSRA is set, this will start a conversion. Switching to Free Running mode (ADTS[2:0]=0) will not cause a trigger event, even if the ADC Interrupt Flag is set. Table 27-6 ADC Auto Trigger Source Selection ADTS[2:0] Trigger Source 000 Free Running mode 001 Analog Comparator 010 External Interrupt Request 0 011 Timer/Counter0 Compare Match A 100 Timer/Counter0 Overflow 101 Timer/Counter1 Compare Match B 110 Timer/Counter1 Overflow 111 Timer/Counter1 Capture Event Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 345 27.8.8. Digital Input Disable Register 0 When the respective bits are written to logic one, the digital input buffer on the corresponding ADC pin is disabled. The corresponding PIN Register bit will always read as zero when this bit is set. When an analog signal is applied to the ADC7...0 pin and the digital input from this pin is not needed, this bit should be written logic one to reduce power consumption in the digital input buffer. Name: DIDR0 Offset: 0x7E Reset: 0x00 Property: Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADC7D ADC6D ADC5D ADC4D ADC3D ADC2D ADC1D ADC0D R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – ADC7D: ADC7 Digital Input Disable Bit 6 – ADC6D: ADC6 Digital Input Disable Bit 5 – ADC5D: ADC5 Digital Input Disable Bit 4 – ADC4D: ADC4 Digital Input Disable Bit 3 – ADC3D: ADC3 Digital Input Disable Bit 2 – ADC2D: ADC2 Digital Input Disable Bit 1 – ADC1D: ADC1 Digital Input Disable Bit 0 – ADC0D: ADC0 Digital Input Disable Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 346 28. 28.1. PTC - Peripheral Touch Controller Overview The Peripheral Touch Controller (PTC) acquires signals in order to detect touch on capacitive sensors. The external capacitive touch sensor is typically formed on a PCB, and the sensor electrodes are connected to the analog front end of the PTC through the I/O pins in the device. The PTC supports both self- and mutual-capacitance sensors. In mutual-capacitance mode, sensing is done using capacitive touch matrices in various X-Y configurations, including indium tin oxide (ITO) sensor grids. The PTC requires one pin per X-line and one pin per Y-line. In self-capacitance mode, the PTC requires only one pin (Y-line) for each touch sensor. 28.2. Features • • • • • • • • • • • Low-power, high-sensitivity, environmentally robust capacitive touch buttons, sliders, wheels and proximity sensing Supports mutual capacitance and self-capacitance sensing – Mix-and-match mutual-and self-capacitance sensors. Refer Features Section of this device for information on the number of buttons supported. One pin per electrode – no external components Load compensating charge sensing – Parasitic capacitance compensation and adjustable gain for superior sensitivity Zero drift over the temperature and VDD range – Auto calibration and re-calibration of sensors Single-shot and free-running charge measurement Hardware noise filtering and noise signal de-synchronization for high conducted immunity Selectable channel change delay – Allows choosing the settling time on a new channel, as required Acquisition-start triggered by command or through auto-triggering feature Low CPU utilization through interrupt on acquisition-complete – 5% CPU utilization scanning 10 channels at 50ms scan rate Supported by the Atmel® QTouch® Composer development tool, which comprises QTouch Library project builder and QTouch analyzer Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 347 28.3. Block Diagram Figure 28-1 PTC Block Diagram Mutual-Capacitance Input Control Compensation Circuit Y0 RS Y1 Ym Acquisition Module IRQ - Gain control - ADC - Filtering 20 - 100K Result 10 CX0Y0 X0 X Line Driver X1 C XnYm Xn Figure 28-2 PTC Block Diagram Self-Capacitance Peripheral Touch Controller Compensation Circuit Input Control Y0 Y1 Rs Charge Integrator Cy0 Ym 20-100K IRQ Result 10 X-line Driver Cym 28.4. ADC System Signal Description Name Type Description X[n:0] Digital X-line (Output) Y[m:0] Analog Y-line (Input/Output) Note: The number of X and Y lines are device dependent. Refer to Configuration Summary for details. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 348 Refer to I/O Multiplexing and Considerations for details on the pin mapping for this peripheral. One signal can be mapped on several pins. Related Links I/O Multiplexing on page 15 28.5. Product Dependencies In order to use this Peripheral, configure the other components of the system as described in the following sections. 28.5.1. I/O Lines The I/O lines used for analog X-lines and Y-lines must be connected to external capacitive touch sensor electrodes. External components are not required for normal operation. However, to improve the EMC performance, a series resistor of 1kΩ or more can be used on X-lines and Y-lines. 28.5.1.1. Mutual-capacitance Sensor Arrangement A mutual-capacitance sensor is formed between two I/O lines - an X electrode for transmitting and Y electrode for receiving. The mutual capacitance between the X and Y electrode is measured by the Peripheral Touch Controller. Figure 28-3 Mutual Capacitance Sensor Arrangement Sensor Capacitance Cx,y MCU X0 X1 Xn Cx0,y0 Cx0,y1 Cx0,ym Cx1,y0 Cx1,y1 Cx1,ym Cxn,y0 Cxn,y1 Cxn,ym PTC PTC Module Module Y0 Y1 Ym 28.5.1.2. Self-capacitance Sensor Arrangement The self-capacitance sensor is connected to a single pin on the Peripheral Touch Controller through the Y electrode for receiving the signal. The sense electrode capacitance is measured by the Peripheral Touch Controller. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 349 Figure 28-4 Self-capacitance Sensor Arrangement MCU Sensor Capacitance Cy Y0 Cy0 Y1 Cy1 PTC Module Ym Cym For more information about designing the touch sensor, refer to Buttons, Sliders and Wheels Touch Sensor Design Guide on http://www.atmel.com. 28.6. Functional Description In order to access the PTC, the user must use the QTouch Composer tool to configure and link the QTouch Library firmware with the application code. QTouch Library can be used to implement buttons, sliders, wheels and proximity sensor in a variety of combinations on a single interface. Figure 28-5 QTouch Library Usage Compiler Custom Code Link Application Atmel QTouch Library For more information about QTouch Library, refer to the Atmel QTouch Library Peripheral Touch Controller User Guide. 28.7. QTouch Library ® ® The Atmel QTouch Library provides a simple to use solution to realize touch sensitive interfaces on ® most Atmel AVR microcontrollers. The QTouch Library includes support for the Atmel QTouch and Atmel ® QMatrix acquisition methods. Touch sensing can be added to any application by linking the appropriate Atmel QTouch Library for the AVR Microcontroller. This is done by using a simple set of APIs to define the touch channels and sensors, and then calling the touch sensing API’s to retrieve the channel information and determine the touch sensor states. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 350 The QTouch Library is FREE and downloadable from the Atmel website at the following location: http:// www.atmel.com/technologies/touch/. For implementation details and other information, refer to the Atmel QTouch Library User Guide - also available for download from the Atmel website. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 351 29. JTAG Interface and On-chip Debug System 29.1. Features • • • • • • 29.2. JTAG (IEEE std. 1149.1 Compliant) Interface Boundary-scan Capabilities According to the IEEE std. 1149.1 (JTAG) Standard Debugger Access to: – All Internal Peripheral Units – Internal and External RAM – The Internal Register File – Program Counter – EEPROM and Flash Memories Extensive On-chip Debug Support for Break Conditions, Including: – AVR Break Instruction – Break on Change of Program Memory Flow – Single Step Break – Program Memory Breakpoints on Single Address or Address Range – Data Memory Breakpoints on Single Address or Address Range Programming of Flash, EEPROM, Fuses, and Lock Bits through the JTAG Interface On-chip Debugging Supported by Atmel Studio Overview The AVR IEEE std. 1149.1 compliant JTAG interface can be used for: • • • Testing PCBs by using the JTAG Boundary-scan capability Programming the non-volatile memories, Fuses and Lock bits On-chip debugging A brief description is given in the following sections. Detailed descriptions for Programming via the JTAG interface, and using the Boundary-scan Chain can be found in the sections Programming Via the JTAG Interface and IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-scan on page 357, respectively. The On-chip Debug support is considered being private JTAG instructions, and distributed within ATMEL and to selected third party vendors only. Figure 29-1 Block Diagram on page 353 shows the JTAG interface and the On-chip Debug system. The TAP Controller is a state machine controlled by the TCK and TMS signals. The TAP Controller selects either the JTAG Instruction Register or one of several Data Registers as the scan chain (Shift Register) between the TDI – input and TDO – output. The Instruction Register holds JTAG instructions controlling the behavior of a Data Register. The ID-Register, Bypass Register, and the Boundary-scan Chain are the data registers used for boardlevel testing. The JTAG Programming Interface (actually consisting of several physical and virtual Data Registers) is used for serial programming via the JTAG interface. The Internal Scan Chain and Break Point Scan Chain are used for On-chip debugging only. Related Links Programming Via the JTAG Interface on page 414 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 352 TAP – Test Access Port The JTAG interface is accessed through four of the AVR’s pins. In JTAG terminology, these pins constitute the Test Access Port – TAP. These pins are: • • • • TMS: Test mode select. This pin is used for navigating through the TAP-controller state machine. TCK: Test clock. JTAG operation is synchronous to TCK. TDI: Test Data In. Serial input data to be shifted in to the Instruction Register or Data Register (Scan Chains). TDO: Test Data Out. Serial output data from Instruction Register or Data Register. The IEEE std. 1149.1 also specifies an optional TAP signal; TRST – Test ReSeT – which is not provided. When the JTAGEN fuse is unprogrammed, these four TAP pins are normal port pins and the TAP controller is in reset. When programmed and the JTD bit in MCUCSR is cleared, the TAP input signals are internally pulled high and the JTAG is enabled for Boundary-scan and programming. In this case, the TAP output pin (TDO) is left floating in states where the JTAG TAP controller is not shifting data, and must therefore be connected to a pull-up resistor or other hardware having pull-ups (for instance the TDI-input of the next device in the scan chain). The device is shipped with this fuse programmed. For the On-chip Debug system, in addition to the JTAG interface pins, the RESET pin is monitored by the debugger to be able to detect External Reset sources. The debugger can also pull the RESET pin low to reset the whole system, assuming only open collectors on the Reset line are used in the application. Figure 29-1 Block Diagram I/O P ORT 0 DEVICE BOUNDARY BOUNDARY S CAN CHAIN J TAG P ROGRAMMING INTERFACE INS TRUCTION REGIS TER ID REGIS TER M U X FLAS H MEMORY Addre s s Da ta BREAKP OINT UNIT BYP AS S REGIS TER AVR CP U INTERNAL S CAN CHAIN PC Ins truction FLOW CONTROL UNIT DIGITAL P ERIP HERAL UNITS BREAKP OINT S CAN CHAIN ADDRES S DECODER J TAG / AVR CORE COMMUNICATION INTERFACE OCD S TATUS AND CONTROL Ana log inputs TAP CONTROLLER Control & Clock line s TDI TDO TCK TMS ANALOG P ERIP HERIAL UNITS 29.3. I/O P ORT n Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 353 Figure 29-2 TAP Controller State Diagram 1 Te s t-Logic-Re s e t 0 0 Run-Te s t/Idle 1 S e le ct-DR S ca n 1 S e le ct-IR S ca n 0 0 1 1 Ca pture -DR Ca pture -IR 0 0 S hift-DR S hift-IR 0 1 Exit1-DR 0 P a us e -DR 0 0 P a us e -IR 1 1 0 Exit2-DR Exit2-IR 1 1 Upda te -DR 29.4. 1 Exit1-IR 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 Upda te -IR 0 1 0 TAP Controller The TAP controller is a 16-state finite state machine that controls the operation of the Boundary-scan circuitry, JTAG programming circuitry, or On-chip Debug system. The state transitions depicted in Figure 29-2 TAP Controller State Diagram on page 354 depend on the signal present on TMS (shown adjacent to each state transition) at the time of the rising edge at TCK. The initial state after a Power-on Reset is Test-Logic-Reset. As a definition in this document, the LSB is shifted in and out first for all Shift Registers. Assuming Run-Test/Idle is the present state, a typical scenario for using the JTAG interface is: • At the TMS input, apply the sequence 1, 1, 0, 0 at the rising edges of TCK to enter the Shift Instruction Register – Shift-IR state. While in this state, shift the 4 bits of the JTAG instructions into Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 354 • • • the JTAG instruction register from the TDI input at the rising edge of TCK. The TMS input must be held low during input of the 3 LSBs in order to remain in the Shift-IR state. The MSB of the instruction is shifted in when this state is left by setting TMS high. While the instruction is shifted in from the TDI pin, the captured IR-state 0x01 is shifted out on the TDO pin. The JTAG Instruction selects a particular Data Register as path between TDI and TDO and controls the circuitry surrounding the selected Data Register. Apply the TMS sequence 1, 1, 0 to re-enter the Run-Test/Idle state. The instruction is latched onto the parallel output from the Shift Register path in the Update-IR state. The Exit-IR, Pause-IR, and Exit2-IR states are only used for navigating the state machine. At the TMS input, apply the sequence 1, 0, 0 at the rising edges of TCK to enter the Shift Data Register – Shift-DR state. While in this state, upload the selected Data Register (selected by the present JTAG instruction in the JTAG Instruction Register) from the TDI input at the rising edge of TCK. In order to remain in the Shift-DR state, the TMS input must be held low during input of all bits except the MSB. The MSB of the data is shifted in when this state is left by setting TMS high. While the Data Register is shifted in from the TDI pin, the parallel inputs to the Data Register captured in the Capture-DR state is shifted out on the TDO pin. Apply the TMS sequence 1, 1, 0 to re-enter the Run-Test/Idle state. If the selected Data Register has a latched parallel-output, the latching takes place in the Update-DR state. The Exit-DR, PauseDR, and Exit2-DR states are only used for navigating the state machine. As shown in the state diagram, the Run-Test/Idle state need not be entered between selecting JTAG instruction and using Data Registers, and some JTAG instructions may select certain functions to be performed in the Run- Test/Idle, making it unsuitable as an Idle state. Note: 1. Independent of the initial state of the TAP Controller, the Test-Logic-Reset state can always be entered by holding TMS high for 5 TCK clock periods. For detailed information on the JTAG specification, refer to the literature listed in Bibliography on page 357. 29.5. Using the Boundary-scan Chain A complete description of the Boundary-scan capabilities are given in the section IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-scan on page 357. 29.6. Using the On-chip Debug System As shown in Figure 29-1 Block Diagram on page 353, the hardware support for On-chip Debugging consists mainly of: • • • A scan chain on the interface between the internal AVR CPU and the internal peripheral units Break point unit Communication interface between the CPU and JTAG system All read or modify/write operations needed for implementing the Debugger are done by applying AVR instructions via the internal AVR CPU Scan Chain. The CPU sends the result to an I/O memory mapped location which is part of the communication interface between the CPU and the JTAG system. The Break point Unit implements Break on Change of Program Flow, Single Step Break, two Program Memory Break points, and two combined break points. Together, the four break points can be configured as either: • 4 Single Program Memory break points Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 355 • • • • 3 Single Program Memory break points + 1 single Data Memory break point 2 Single Program Memory break points + 2 single Data Memory break points 2 Single Program Memory break points + 1 Program Memory break point with mask (“range break point”) 2 Single Program Memory break points + 1 Data Memory break point with mask (“range break point”) A debugger, like the Atmel Studio®, may however use one or more of these resources for its internal purpose, leaving less flexibility to the end-user. A list of the On-chip Debug specific JTAG instructions is given in On-chip Debug Specific JTAG Instructions on page 356. The JTAGEN fuse must be programmed to enable the JTAG Test Access Port. In addition, the OCDEN fuse must be programmed and no Lock bits must be set for the On-chip Debug system to work. As a security feature, the On-chip Debug system is disabled when any Lock bits are set. Otherwise, the Onchip Debug system would have provided a back-door into a secured device. The Atmel Studio enables the user to fully control execution of programs on an AVR device with On-chip Debug capability, AVR In-Circuit Emulator, or the built-in AVR Instruction Set Simulator. Atmel Studio supports source level execution of Assembly programs assembled with Atmel Corporation’s AVR Assembler and C programs compiled with third party vendors’ compilers. For a full description of the Atmel Studio, please refer to the Atmel Studio User Guide found in the Online Help in Atmel Studio. Only highlights are presented in this document. All necessary execution commands are available in Atmel Studio, both on source level and on disassembly level. The user can execute the program, single step through the code either by tracing into or stepping over functions, step out of functions, place the cursor on a statement and execute until the statement is reached, stop the execution, and reset the execution target. In addition, the user can have an unlimited number of code break points (using the BREAK instruction) and up to two data memory break points, alternatively combined as a mask (range) break point. 29.7. On-chip Debug Specific JTAG Instructions The On-chip debug support is considered being private JTAG instructions, and distributed within ATMEL and to selected third-party vendors only. Instruction opcodes are listed for reference. PRIVATE0; 0x8 Private JTAG instruction for accessing On-chip Debug system. PRIVATE1; 0x9 Private JTAG instruction for accessing On-chip Debug system. PRIVATE2; 0xA Private JTAG instruction for accessing On-chip Debug system. PRIVATE3; 0xB Private JTAG instruction for accessing On-chip Debug system. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 356 29.8. Using the JTAG Programming Capabilities Programming of AVR parts via JTAG is performed via the four-pin JTAG port, TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO. These are the only pins that need to be controlled/observed to perform JTAG programming (in addition to power pins). It is not required to apply 12V externally. The JTAGEN fuse must be programmed and the JTD bit in the MCUCSR Register must be cleared to enable the JTAG Test Access Port. The JTAG programming capability supports: • Flash programming and verifying • • • EEPROM programming and verifying Fuse programming and verifying Lock bit programming and verifying The Lock bit security is exactly as in Parallel Programming mode. If the Lock bits LB1 or LB2 are programmed, the OCDEN Fuse cannot be programmed unless first doing a chip erase. This is a security feature that ensures no back-door exists for reading out the content of a secured device. The details on programming through the JTAG interface and programming specific JTAG instructions are given in the section Programming Via the JTAG Interface. Related Links Programming Via the JTAG Interface on page 414 29.9. Bibliography For more information about general Boundary-scan, the following literature can be consulted: • • IEEE: IEEE Std 1149.1-1990. IEEE Standard Test Access Port and Boundary-scan Architecture, IEEE, 1993 Colin Maunder: The Board Designers Guide to Testable Logic Circuits, Addison-Wesley, 1992 29.10. IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-scan Related Links Reset Sources on page 70 29.10.1. Features • • • • • JTAG (IEEE std. 1149.1 Compliant) Interface Boundary-scan Capabilities According to the JTAG Standard Full Scan of all Port Functions as well as Analog Circuitry having Off-chip Connections Supports the Optional IDCODE Instruction Additional Public AVR_RESET Instruction to Reset the AVR Related Links Reset Sources on page 70 29.10.2. System Overview The Boundary-scan Chain has the capability of driving and observing the logic levels on the digital I/O pins, as well as the boundary between digital and analog logic for analog circuitry having off-chip connections. At system level, all ICs having JTAG capabilities are connected serially by the TDI/TDO signals to form a long Shift Register. An external controller sets up the devices to drive values at their Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 357 output pins, and observe the input values received from other devices. The controller compares the received data with the expected result. In this way, Boundary-scan provides a mechanism for testing interconnections and integrity of components on Printed Circuits Boards by using the four TAP signals only. The four IEEE 1149.1 defined mandatory JTAG instructions IDCODE, BYPASS, SAMPLE/PRELOAD, and EXTEST, as well as the AVR specific public JTAG instruction AVR_RESET can be used for testing the Printed Circuit Board. Initial scanning of the data register path will show the ID-code of the device, since IDCODE is the default JTAG instruction. It may be desirable to have the AVR device in reset during test mode. If not reset, inputs to the device may be determined by the scan operations, and the internal software may be in an undetermined state when exiting the test mode. Entering Reset, the outputs of any Port Pin will instantly enter the high impedance state, making the HIGHZ instruction redundant. If needed, the BYPASS instruction can be issued to make the shortest possible scan chain through the device. The device can be set in the Reset state either by pulling the external RESET pin low, or issuing the AVR_RESET instruction with appropriate setting of the Reset Data Register. The EXTEST instruction is used for sampling external pins and loading output pins with data. The data from the output latch will be driven out on the pins as soon as the EXTEST instruction is loaded into the JTAG IR-register. Therefore, the SAMPLE/PRELOAD should also be used for setting initial values to the scan ring, to avoid damaging the board when issuing the EXTEST instruction for the first time. SAMPLE/ PRELOAD can also be used for taking a snapshot of the external pins during normal operation of the part. The JTAGEN fuse must be programmed and the JTD bit in the I/O register MCUCSR must be cleared to enable the JTAG Test Access Port. When using the JTAG interface for Boundary-scan, using a JTAG TCK clock frequency higher than the internal chip frequency is possible. The chip clock is not required to run. Related Links Reset Sources on page 70 29.11. Data Registers The data registers relevant for Boundary-scan operations are: • • • • Bypass Register Device Identification Register Reset Register Boundary-scan Chain 29.11.1. Bypass Register The Bypass Register consists of a single Shift Register stage. When the Bypass Register is selected as path between TDI and TDO, the register is reset to 0 when leaving the Capture-DR controller state. The Bypass Register can be used to shorten the scan chain on a system when the other devices are to be tested. 29.11.2. Device Identification Register The figure below shows the structure of the Device Identification Register. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 358 Figure 29-3 The format of the Device Identification Register LSB MSB Bit 28 31 Device ID 27 12 11 Version Part Number 4 bits 16 bits 1 Manufacturer ID 11 bits 0 1 1-bit 29.11.2.1. Version Version is a 4-bit number identifying the revision of the component. The JTAG version number follows the revision of the device, and wraps around at revision P (0xF). Revision A and Q is 0x0, revision B and R is 0x1 and so on. 29.11.2.2. Part Number The part number is a 16-bit code identifying the component. The JTAG Part Number for ATmega324PB is listed in the table below. Table 29-1 AVR JTAG Part Number Part Number JTAG Part Number (Hex) ATmega324PB 0x9702 29.11.2.3. Manufacturer ID The Manufacturer ID is a 11-bit code identifying the manufacturer. The JTAG manufacturer ID for ATMEL is listed in the table below. Table 29-2 Manufacturer ID Manufacturer JTAG Manufacturer ID (Hex) ATMEL 0x01F 29.11.3. Reset Register The Reset Register is a Test Data Register used to reset the part. Since the AVR tri-states Port Pins when reset, the Reset Register can also replace the function of the unimplemented optional JTAG instruction HIGHZ. A high value in the Reset Register corresponds to pulling the External Reset low. The part is reset as long as there is a high value present in the Reset Register. Depending on the Fuse settings for the clock options, the part will remain reset for a Reset Time-Out Period (refer to Clock Sources) after releasing the Reset Register. The output from this Data Register is not latched, so the Reset will take place immediately, as shown in the figure below. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 359 Figure 29-4 Reset Register To TDO From Othe r Inte rna l a nd Exte rna l Re s e t S ource s From TDI D Q Inte rna l Re s e t ClockDR · AVR_RES ET 29.11.4. Boundary-scan Chain The Boundary-scan Chain has the capability of driving and observing the logic levels on the digital I/O pins, as well as the boundary between digital and analog logic for analog circuitry having off-chip connections. Refer to Boundary-scan Chain on page 361 for a complete description. 29.12. Boundry-scan Specific JTAG Instructions The Instruction Register is 4-bit wide, supporting up to 16 instructions. Listed below are the JTAG instructions useful for Boundary-scan operation. Note that the optional HIGHZ instruction is not implemented, but all outputs with tri-state capability can be set in high-impedant state by using the AVR_RESET instruction, since the initial state for all port pins is tri-state. As a definition in this data sheet, the LSB is shifted in and out first for all Shift Registers. The OPCODE for each instruction is shown behind the instruction name in hex format. The text describes which data register is selected as path between TDI and TDO for each instruction. 29.12.1. EXTEST; 0x0 Mandatory JTAG instruction for selecting the Boundary-scan Chain as Data Register for testing circuitry external to the AVR package. For port-pins, Pull-up Disable, Output Control, Output Data, and Input Data are all accessible in the scan chain. For Analog circuits having off-chip connections, the interface between the analog and the digital logic is in the scan chain. The contents of the latched outputs of the Boundary-scan chain is driven out as soon as the JTAG IR-register is loaded with the EXTEST instruction. The active states are: • • • Capture-DR: Data on the external pins are sampled into the Boundary-scan Chain. Shift-DR: The Internal Scan Chain is shifted by the TCK input. Update-DR: Data from the scan chain is applied to output pins. 29.12.2. IDCODE; 0x1 Optional JTAG instruction selecting the 32-bit ID Register as Data Register. The ID Register consists of a version number, a device number and the manufacturer code chosen by JEDEC. This is the default instruction after power-up. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 360 The active states are: • • Capture-DR: Data in the IDCODE Register is sampled into the Boundary-scan Chain. Shift-DR: The IDCODE scan chain is shifted by the TCK input. 29.12.3. SAMPLE_PRELOAD; 0x2 Mandatory JTAG instruction for pre-loading the output latches and taking a snap-shot of the input/output pins without affecting the system operation. However, the output latches are not connected to the pins. The Boundary-scan Chain is selected as Data Register. The active states are: • • • Capture-DR: Data on the external pins are sampled into the Boundary-scan Chain. Shift-DR: The Boundary-scan Chain is shifted by the TCK input. Update-DR: Data from the Boundary-scan Chain is applied to the output latches. However, the output latches are not connected to the pins. 29.12.4. AVR_RESET; 0xC The AVR specific public JTAG instruction for forcing the AVR device into the Reset mode or releasing the JTAG Reset source. The TAP controller is not reset by this instruction. The one bit Reset Register is selected as Data Register. Note that the Reset will be active as long as there is a logic 'one' in the Reset Chain. The output from this chain is not latched. The active states are: • Shift-DR: The Reset Register is shifted by the TCK input. 29.12.5. BYPASS; 0xF Mandatory JTAG instruction selecting the Bypass Register for Data Register. The active states are: • • Capture-DR: Loads a logic “0” into the Bypass Register. Shift-DR: The Bypass Register cell between TDI and TDO is shifted. 29.13. Boundary-scan Chain The Boundary-scan chain has the capability of driving and observing the logic levels on the digital I/O pins, as well as the boundary between digital and analog logic for analog circuitry having off-chip connections. 29.13.1. Scanning the Digital Port Pins The first figure below shows the Boundary-scan Cell for a bi-directional port pin with pull-up function. The cell consists of a standard Boundary-scan cell for the Pull-up Enable – PUExn – function, and a bidirectional pin cell that combines the three signals, Output Control – OCxn, Output Data – ODxn, and Input Data – IDxn, into only a two-stage Shift Register. The port and pin indexes are not used in the following description The Boundary-scan logic is not included in the figures in the Data Sheet. Figure 29-6 General Port Pin Schematic diagram on page 363 shows a simple digital Port Pin as described in the section I/O Ports. The Boundary-scan details from the first figure below replaces the dashed box in Figure 29-6 General Port Pin Schematic diagram on page 363. When no alternate port function is present, the Input Data – ID corresponds to the PINxn Register value (but ID has no synchronizer), Output Data corresponds to the PORT Register, Output Control Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 361 corresponds to the Data Direction – DD Register, and the Pull-up Enable – PUExn – corresponds to logic expression PUD · DDxn · PORTxn. Digital alternate port functions are connected outside the dotted box in Figure 29-6 General Port Pin Schematic diagram on page 363 to make the scan chain read the actual pin value. For Analog function, there is a direct connection from the external pin to the analog circuit, and a scan chain is inserted on the interface between the digital logic and the analog circuitry. Figure 29-5 Boundary-scan Cell for Bi-directional Port Pin with Pull-Up Function. S hiftDR To Ne xt Ce ll EXTES T P ullup Ena ble (P UE) Vcc 0 FF2 0 D 1 LD2 Q D 1 Q G Output Control (OC) FF1 0 D 1 LD1 Q D Q 0 1 G Output Da ta (OD) 0 1 FF0 0 D 1 LD0 Q D Q 0 1 P ort P in (P Xn) G Input Da ta (ID) From La s t Ce ll ClockDR Upda te DR Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 362 Figure 29-6 General Port Pin Schematic diagram S e e Bounda ry-S ca n de s cription for de ta ils ! P UExn P UD D Q DDxn Q CLR RES ET OCxn WDx D Q P xn ODxn PORTxn Q IDxn CLR RES ET WP x DATA BUS RDx RRx S LEEP S YNCHRONIZER D D Q RP x Q PINxn L Q Q CLK I/O P UD: P UExn: OCxn: ODxn: IDxn: S LEEP : P ULLUP DIS ABLE P ULLUP ENABLE for pin P xn OUTP UT CONTROL for pin P xn OUTP UT DATA to pin P xn INP UT DATA from pin P xn S LEEP CONTROL WDx: RDx: WP x: RRx: RP x: CLK I/O : WRITE DDRx READ DDRx WRITE P ORTx READ P ORTx REGIS TER READ P ORTx P IN I/O CLOCK Related Links I/O-Ports on page 99 29.13.2. Scanning the RESET Pin The RESET pin accepts 5V active low logic for standard Reset operation, and 12V active high logic for High Voltage Parallel programming. An observe-only cell as shown in the figure below is inserted both for the 5V Reset signal; RSTT, and the 12V Reset signal; RSTHV. Figure 29-7 Observe-only Cell To ne xt ce ll S hiftDR From s ys te m pin To s ys te m logic FF1 0 D 1 From pre vious ce ll Q ClockDR Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 363 29.13.3. Scanning the Clock Pins The AVR devices have many clock options selectable by fuses. These are: Internal RC Oscillator, External RC, External Clock, (High Frequency) Crystal Oscillator, Low-frequency Crystal Oscillator, and Ceramic Resonator. The figure below shows how each Oscillator with external connection is supported in the scan chain. The Enable signal is supported with a general boundary-scan cell, while the Oscillator/Clock output is attached to an observe-only cell. In addition to the main clock, the Timer Oscillator is scanned in the same way. The output from the internal RC Oscillator is not scanned, as this Oscillator does not have external connections. Figure 29-8 Boundary-scan Cells for Oscillators and Clock Options XTAL1/TOS C1 To Ne xt Ce ll S hiftDR 0 1 0 D 1 From P re vious Ce ll Q Os cilla tor EXTES T From Digita l Logic D XTAL2/TOS C2 ENABLE S hiftDR To S ys te m Logic OUTP UT FF1 Q 0 G ClockDR To ne xt ce ll D 1 Q Upda te DR From P re vious Ce ll ClockDR The following table summaries the scan registers for the external clock pin XTAL1, oscillators with XTAL1/ XTAL2 connections as well as 32kHz Timer Oscillator. Table 29-3 Scan Signals for the Oscillators(1)(2)(3) Enable signal Scanned Clock Line Clock Option Scanned Clock Line when not Used EXTCLKEN EXTCLK (XTAL1) External Clock 0 OSCON OSCCK External Crystal 0 External Ceramic Resonator RCOSCEN RCCK External RC 1 OSC32EN OSC32CK Low Freq. External Crystal 0 TOSKON TOSCK 32kHz Timer Oscillator 0 Note: 1. Do not enable more than one clock source as main clock at a time. 2. Scanning an Oscillator output gives unpredictable results as there is a frequency drift between the Internal Oscillator and the JTAG TCK clock. If possible, scanning an external clock is preferred. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 364 3. The clock configuration is programmed by fuses. As a fuse does not change run-time, the clock configuration is considered fixed for a given application. The user is advised to scan the same clock option as to be used in the final system. The enable signals are supported in the scan chain because the system logic can disable clock options in sleep modes, thereby disconnecting the Oscillator pins from the scan path if not provided. The INTCAP fuses are not supported in the scanchain, so the boundary scan chain can not make a XTAL Oscillator requiring internal capacitors to run unless the fuse is correctly programmed. 29.13.4. Scanning the Analog Comparator The relevant Comparator signals regarding Boundary-scan are shown in the first figure below. The Boundary-scan cell from the second figure below is attached to each of these signals. The signals are described in Table 29-4 Boundary-scan Signals for the Analog Comparator on page 366. The Comparator need not be used for pure connectivity testing, since all analog inputs are shared with a digital port pin as well. Figure 29-9 Analog comparator BANDGAP REFERENCE ACBG ACO AC_IDLE ACME ADCEN ADC MULTIP LEXER OUTP UT Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 365 Figure 29-10 General Boundary-scan Cell used for Signals for Comparator and ADC To Ne xt Ce ll S hiftDR EXTES T From Digita l Logic/ From Ana log Ciruitry 0 1 0 D 1 From P re vious Ce ll To Ana log Circuitry/ To Digita l Logic Q D Q G ClockDR Upda te DR Table 29-4 Boundary-scan Signals for the Analog Comparator Signal Name Direction as Seen from the Comparator Description Recommended Input Output values when when not in Use Recommended Inputs are Used AC_IDLE Input Turns off Analog comparator when true 1 Depends upon μC code being executed ACO Output Analog Comparator Output Will become input to μC code being executed 0 ACME Input Uses output signal from ADC mux when true 0 Depends upon μC code being executed ACBG Input Bandgap Reference 0 enable Depends upon μC code being executed 29.13.5. Scanning the ADC The figure below shows a block diagram of the ADC with all relevant control and observe signals. The Boundary-scan cell from Figure 29-7 Observe-only Cell on page 363 is attached to each of these signals. The ADC need not be used for pure connectivity testing, since all analog inputs are shared with a digital port pin as well. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 366 Figure 29-11 Analog to Digital Converter VCCREN AREF IREFEN 2.56V re f To Compa ra tor PAS S EN MUXEN_7 ADC_7 MUXEN_6 ADC_6 MUXEN_5 ADC_5 MUXEN_4 ADC_4 ADCBGEN S CTES T 1.22V re f EXTCH MUXEN_3 ADC_3 MUXEN_2 ADC_2 MUXEN_1 ADC_1 MUXEN_0 ADC_0 P RECH P RECH AREF AREF DACOUT DAC_9..0 10-bit DAC + COMP G20 G10 + 10x NEGS EL_2 - ADC_2 + 20x ADC_0 HOLD GNDEN ADC_1 NEGS EL_0 ACTEN - NEGS EL_1 COMP - ADCEN ST ACLK AMP EN The signals are described briefly in the following table. Table 29-5 Boundary-scan Signals for the ADC Signal Name Direction as Description Seen from the ADC Recommend ed Input when not in Use Output Values when Recommend ed Inputs are Used, and CPU is not Using the ADC COMP Output Comparator Output 0 0 ACLK Input Clock signal to gain stages implemented as 0 Switch-cap filters 0 ACTEN Input Enable path from gain stages to the comparator 0 0 ADCBGEN Input Enable Band-gap reference as negative input to comparator 0 0 ADCEN Input Power-on signal to the ADC 0 0 AMPEN Input Power-on signal to the gain stages 0 0 DAC_9 Input Bit 9 of digital value to DAC 1 1 DAC_8 Input Bit 8 of digital value to DAC 0 0 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 367 Signal Name Direction as Description Seen from the ADC Recommend ed Input when not in Use Output Values when Recommend ed Inputs are Used, and CPU is not Using the ADC DAC_7 Input Bit 7 of digital value to DAC 0 0 DAC_6 Input Bit 6 of digital value to DAC 0 0 DAC_5 Input Bit 5 of digital value to DAC 0 0 DAC_4 Input Bit 4 of digital value to DAC 0 0 DAC_3 Input Bit 3 of digital value to DAC 0 0 DAC_2 Input Bit 2 of digital value to DAC 0 0 DAC_1 Input Bit 1 of digital value to DAC 0 0 DAC_0 Input Bit 0 of digital value to DAC 0 0 EXTCH Input Connect ADC channels 0 - 3 to by-pass path around gain stages 1 1 G10 Input Enable 10x gain 0 0 G20 Input Enable 20x gain 0 0 GNDEN Input Ground the negative input to comparator when true 0 0 HOLD Input Sample & Hold signal. Sample analog signal when low. Hold signal when high. If gain stages are used, this signal must go active when ACLK is high. 1 1 IREFEN Input Enables Band-gap reference as AREF signal to DAC 0 0 MUXEN_7 Input Input Mux bit 7 0 0 MUXEN_6 Input Input Mux bit 6 0 0 MUXEN_5 Input Input Mux bit 5 0 0 MUXEN_4 Input Input Mux bit 4 0 0 MUXEN_3 Input Input Mux bit 3 0 0 MUXEN_2 Input Input Mux bit 2 0 0 MUXEN_1 Input Input Mux bit 1 0 0 MUXEN_0 Input Input Mux bit 0 1 1 NEGSEL_2 Input Input Mux for negative input for differential signal, bit 2 0 0 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 368 Signal Name Direction as Description Seen from the ADC Recommend ed Input when not in Use Output Values when Recommend ed Inputs are Used, and CPU is not Using the ADC NEGSEL_1 Input Input Mux for negative input for differential signal, bit 1 0 0 NEGSEL_0 Input Input Mux for negative input for differential signal, bit 0 0 0 PASSEN Input Enable pass-gate of gain stages. 1 1 PRECH Input Precharge output latch of comparator. (Active low) 1 1 SCTEST Input Switch-cap TEST enable. Output from x10 gain stage send out to Port Pin having ADC_4 0 0 ST Input Output of gain stages will settle faster if this 0 signal is high first two ACLK periods after AMPEN goes high. 0 VCCREN Input Selects Vcc as the ACC reference voltage. 0 0 Note: 1. Incorrect setting of the switches in Figure 29-11 Analog to Digital Converter on page 367 will make signal contention and may damage the part. There are several input choices to the S&H circuitry on the negative input of the output comparator in Figure 29-11 Analog to Digital Converter on page 367. Make sure only one path is selected from either one ADC pin, Bandgap reference source, or Ground. If the ADC is not to be used during scan, the recommended input values from the table above should be used. The user is recommended not to use the Differential Gain stages during scan. Switch-Cap based gain stages require fast operation and accurate timing which is difficult to obtain when used in a scan chain. Details concerning operations of the differential gain stage is therefore not provided. The AVR ADC is based on the analog circuitry shown in Figure 29-11 Analog to Digital Converter on page 367 with a successive approximation algorithm implemented in the digital logic. When used in Boundary-scan, the problem is usually to ensure that an applied analog voltage is measured within some limits. This can easily be done without running a successive approximation algorithm: apply the lower limit on the digital DAC[9:0] lines, make sure the output from the comparator is low, then apply the upper limit on the digital DAC[9:0] lines, and verify the output from the comparator to be high. The ADC need not be used for pure connectivity testing, since all analog inputs are shared with a digital port pin as well. When using the ADC, remember the following: • The Port Pin for the ADC channel in use must be configured to be an input with pull-up disabled to avoid signal contention. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 369 • • In normal mode, a dummy conversion (consisting of 10 comparisons) is performed when enabling the ADC. The user is advised to wait at least 200ns after enabling the ADC before controlling/ observing any ADC signal, or perform a dummy conversion before using the first result. The DAC values must be stable at the midpoint value 0x200 when having the HOLD signal low (Sample mode). As an example, consider the task of verifying a 1.5V ±5% input signal at ADC channel 3 when the power supply is 5.0V and AREF is externally connected to VCC. The lower limit is: 1024 ⋅ 1,5V ⋅ 0,95 ⁄ 5V = 291 = 0x123 The upper limit is: 1024 ⋅ 1,5V ⋅ 1,05 ⁄ 5V = 323 = 0x143 The recommended values from Table 29-5 Boundary-scan Signals for the ADC on page 367 are used unless other values are given in the algorithm in the following table. Only the DAC and Port Pin values of the Scan Chain are shown. The column “Actions” describes what JTAG instruction to be used before filling the Boundary-scan Register with the succeeding columns. The verification should be done on the data scanned out when scanning in the data on the same row in the table. Table 29-6 Algorithm for Using the ADC Step Actions ADCEN DAC MUXEN HOLD PRECH PA3. Data PA3. Control PA3. Pullup_ Enable 1 SAMPLE_P RELOAD 1 0x200 0x08 1 1 0 0 0 2 EXTEST 1 0x200 0x08 0 1 0 0 0 3 1 0x200 0x08 1 1 0 0 0 4 1 0x123 0x08 1 1 0 0 0 5 1 0x123 0x08 1 0 0 0 0 6 Verify the 1 COMP bit scanned out to be 0 0x200 0x08 1 1 0 0 0 7 1 0x200 0x08 0 1 0 0 0 8 1 0x200 0x08 1 1 0 0 0 9 1 0x143 0x08 1 1 0 0 0 10 1 0x143 0x08 1 0 0 0 0 11 Verify the 1 COMP bit scanned out to be 1 0x200 0x08 1 1 0 0 0 Using this algorithm, the timing constraint on the HOLD signal constrains the TCK clock frequency. As the algorithm keeps HOLD high for five steps, the TCK clock frequency has to be at least five times the number of scan bits divided by the maximum hold time, thold,max Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 370 29.14. ATmega324PB Boundary-scan Order The table below shows the Scan order between TDI and TDO when the Boundary-scan Chain is selected as data path. Bit 0 is the LSB; the first bit scanned in, and the first bit scanned out. The scan order follows the pin-out order as far as possible. Therefore, the bits of Port A are scanned in the opposite bit order of the other ports. Exceptions from the rules are the scan chains for the analog circuits, which constitute the most significant bits of the scan chain regardless of which physical pin they are connected to. In Figure 29-5 Boundaryscan Cell for Bi-directional Port Pin with Pull-Up Function. on page 362, PXn. Data corresponds to FF0, PXn. Control corresponds to FF1, and PXn. Pullup_enable corresponds to FF2. Bit 2, 3, 4, and 5 of Port C is not in the scan chain, since these pins constitute the TAP pins when the JTAG is enabled. Table 29-7 ATmega324PB Boundary-scan Order (TBD) Bit Number Signal Name Module 56 PB0.Data Port B 55 PB0.Control 54 PB1.Data 53 PB1.Control 52 PB2.Data 51 PB2.Control 50 PB3.Data 49 PB3.Control 48 PB4.Data 47 PB4.Control 46 PB5.Data 45 PB5.Control 44 PB6.Data 43 PB6.Control 42 PB7.Data 41 PB7.Control 40 RSTT Reset Logic (Observe Only) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 371 Bit Number Signal Name Module 39 PD0.Data Port D 38 PD0.Control 37 PD1.Data 36 PD1.Control 35 PD2.Data 34 PD2.Control 33 PD3.Data 32 PD3.Control 31 PD4.Data 30 PD4.Control 29 PD5.Data 28 PD5.Control 27 PD6.Data 26 PD6.Control 25 PD7.Data 24 PD7.Control 23 PC0.Data 22 PC0.Control 21 PC1.Data 20 PC1.Control 19 PC6.Data 18 PC6.Control 17 PC7.Data 16 PC7.Control Port C Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 372 Bit Number Signal Name Module 15 PA7.Data Port A 14 PA7.Control 13 PA6.Data 12 PA6.Control 11 PA5.Data 10 PA5.Control 9 PA4.Data 8 PA4.Control 7 PA3.Data 6 PA3.Control 5 PA2.Data 4 PA2.Control 3 PA1.Data 2 PA1.Control 1 PA0.Data 0 PA0.Control 29.15. Boundary-scan Description Language Files Boundary-scan Description Language (BSDL) files describe Boundary-scan capable devices in a standard format used by automated test-generation software. The order and function of bits in the Boundary-scan Data Register are included in this description. 29.16. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 373 29.16.1. OCDR – On-chip Debug Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: OCDR Offset: 0x51 Reset: 0x20 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x31 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 IDRD/OCDR7 OCDR6 OCDR5 OCDR4 OCDR3 OCDR2 OCDR1 OCDR0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Access Reset Bit 7 – IDRD/OCDR7: USART Receive Complete The OCDR Register provides a communication channel from the running program in the microcontroller to the debugger. The CPU can transfer a byte to the debugger by writing to this location. At the same time, an internal flag; I/O Debug Register Dirty – IDRD – is set to indicate to the debugger that the register has been written. When the CPU reads the OCDR Register the 7 LSB will be from the OCDR Register, while the MSB is the IDRD bit. The debugger clears the IDRD bit when it has read the information. In some AVR devices, this register is shared with a standard I/O location. In this case, the OCDR Register can only be accessed if the OCDEN fuse is programmed, and the debugger enables access to the OCDR Register. In all other cases, the standard I/O location is accessed. • • Bit 7 is MSB Bit 1 is LSB Refer to the debugger documentation for further information on how to use this register. Bits 6:0 – OCDRn: On-chip Debug Register n [n = 6:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 374 29.16.2. MCU Control Register When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: MCUCR Offset: 0x55 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x35 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 1 0 JTD BODS BODSE PUD 3 2 IVSEL IVCE R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – JTD When this bit is zero, the JTAG interface is enabled if the JTAGEN Fuse is programmed. If this bit is one, the JTAG interface is disabled. In order to avoid unintentional disabling or enabling of the JTAG interface, a timed sequence must be followed when changing this bit: The application software must write this bit to the desired value twice within four cycles to change its value. Note that this bit must not be altered when using the On-chip Debug system. Bit 6 – BODS: BOD Sleep The BODS bit must be written to '1' in order to turn off BOD during sleep. Writing to the BODS bit is controlled by a timed sequence and the enable bit BODSE. To disable BOD in relevant sleep modes, both BODS and BODSE must first be written to '1'. Then, BODS must be written to '1' and BODSE must be written to zero within four clock cycles. The BODS bit is active three clock cycles after it is set. A sleep instruction must be executed while BODS is active in order to turn off the BOD for the actual sleep mode. The BODS bit is automatically cleared after three clock cycles. Bit 5 – BODSE: BOD Sleep Enable BODSE enables setting of BODS control bit, as explained in BODS bit description. BOD disable is controlled by a timed sequence. Bit 4 – PUD: Pull-up Disable When this bit is written to one, the pull-ups in the I/O ports are disabled even if the DDxn and PORTxn Registers are configured to enable the pull-ups ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b01). Bit 1 – IVSEL: Interrupt Vector Select When the IVSEL bit is cleared (zero), the Interrupt Vectors are placed at the start of the Flash memory. When this bit is set (one), the Interrupt Vectors are moved to the beginning of the Boot Loader section of the Flash. The actual address of the start of the Boot Flash Section is determined by the BOOTSZ Fuses. To avoid unintentional changes of Interrupt Vector tables, a special write procedure must be followed to change the IVSEL bit: 1. 2. Write the Interrupt Vector Change Enable (IVCE) bit to one. Within four cycles, write the desired value to IVSEL while writing a zero to IVCE. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 375 Interrupts will automatically be disabled while this sequence is executed. Interrupts are disabled in the cycle IVCE is set, and they remain disabled until after the instruction following the write to IVSEL. If IVSEL is not written, interrupts remain disabled for four cycles. The I-bit in the Status Register is unaffected by the automatic disabling. Note: If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Boot Loader section and Boot Lock bit BLB02 is programmed, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Application section and Boot Lock bit BLB12 is programed, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader section. Bit 0 – IVCE: Interrupt Vector Change Enable The IVCE bit must be written to logic one to enable change of the IVSEL bit. IVCE is cleared by hardware four cycles after it is written or when IVSEL is written. Setting the IVCE bit will disable interrupts, as explained in the IVSEL description above. See Code Example below. Assembly Code Example Move_interrupts: ; Get MCUCR in r16, MCUCR mov r17, r16 ; Enable change of Interrupt Vectors ori r16, (1<<IVCE) out MCUCR, r16 ; Move interrupts to Boot Flash section ori r17, (1<<IVSEL) out MCUCR, r17 ret C Code Example void Move_interrupts(void) { uchar temp; /* GET MCUCR*/ temp = MCUCR; /* Enable change of Interrupt Vectors */ MCUCR = temp|(1<<IVCE); /* Move interrupts to Boot Flash section */ MCUCR = temp|(1<<IVSEL); } Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 376 29.16.3. MCU Status Register To make use of the Reset Flags to identify a reset condition, the user should read and then Reset the MCUSR as early as possible in the program. If the register is cleared before another reset occurs, the source of the reset can be found by examining the Reset Flags. When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: MCUSR Offset: 0x54 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x34 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 JTRF WDRF BORF EXTRF PORF R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 4 – JTRF: JTAG Reset Flag This bit is set if a reset is being caused by a logic one in the JTAG Reset Register selected by the JTAG instruction AVR_RESET. This bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a logic zero to the flag. Bit 3 – WDRF: Watchdog System Reset Flag This bit is set if a Watchdog System Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a '0' to it. Bit 2 – BORF: Brown-out Reset Flag This bit is set if a Brown-out Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a '0' to it. Bit 1 – EXTRF: External Reset Flag This bit is set if an External Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a '0' to it. Bit 0 – PORF: Power-on Reset Flag This bit is set if a Power-on Reset occurs. The bit is reset only by writing a '0' to it. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 377 30. BTLDR - Boot Loader Support – Read-While-Write Self-Programming 30.1. Features • • • • • • • Read-While-Write Self-Programming Flexible Boot Memory Size High Security (Separate Boot Lock Bits for a Flexible Protection) Separate Fuse to Select Reset Vector Optimized Page(1) Size Code Efficient Algorithm Efficient Read-Modify-Write Support Note: 1. A page is a section in the Flash consisting of several bytes (see Table. No. of Words in a Page and No. of Pages in the Flash in Page Size) used during programming. The page organization does not affect normal operation. Related Links Page Size on page 400 30.2. Overview In this device, the Boot Loader Support provides a real Read-While-Write Self-Programming mechanism for downloading and uploading program code by the MCU itself. This feature allows flexible application software updates controlled by the MCU using a Flash-resident Boot Loader program. The Boot Loader program can use any available data interface and associated protocol to read code and write (program) that code into the Flash memory, or read the code from the program memory. The program code within the Boot Loader section has the capability to write into the entire Flash, including the Boot Loader memory. The Boot Loader can thus even modify itself, and it can also erase itself from the code if the feature is not needed anymore. The size of the Boot Loader memory is configurable with fuses and the Boot Loader has two separate sets of Boot Lock bits which can be set independently. This gives the user a unique flexibility to select different levels of protection. 30.3. Application and Boot Loader Flash Sections The Flash memory is organized in two main sections, the Application section and the Boot Loader section. The size of the different sections is configured by the BOOTSZ Fuses. These two sections can have different level of protection since they have different sets of Lock bits. 30.3.1. Application Section The Application section is the section of the Flash that is used for storing the application code. The protection level for the Application section can be selected by the application Boot Lock bits (Boot Lock bits 0). The Application section can never store any Boot Loader code since the SPM instruction is disabled when executed from the Application section. 30.3.2. BLS – Boot Loader Section While the Application section is used for storing the application code, the Boot Loader software must be located in the BLS since the SPM instruction can initiate a programming when executing from the BLS only. The SPM instruction can access the entire Flash, including the BLS itself. The protection level for the Boot Loader section can be selected by the Boot Loader Lock bits (Boot Lock bits 1). Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 378 30.4. Read-While-Write and No Read-While-Write Flash Sections Whether the CPU supports Read-While-Write or if the CPU is halted during a Boot Loader software update is dependent on which address that is being programmed. In addition to the two sections that are configurable by the BOOTSZ Fuses as described above, the Flash is also divided into two fixed sections, the Read-While-Write (RWW) section and the No Read-While-Write (NRWW) section. The limit between the RWW- and NRWW sections is given in the Boot Loader Parameters section and Figure 30-2 Memory Sections on page 381. The main difference between the two sections is: • • When erasing or writing a page located inside the RWW section, the NRWW section can be read during the operation When erasing or writing a page located inside the NRWW section, the CPU is halted during the entire operation The user software can never read any code that is located inside the RWW section during a Boot Loader software operation. The syntax “Read-While-Write section” refers to which section that is being programmed (erased or written), not which section that actually is being read during a Boot Loader software update. Related Links ATmega324PB Boot Loader Parameters on page 391 30.4.1. RWW – Read-While-Write Section If a Boot Loader software update is programming a page inside the RWW section, it is possible to read code from the Flash, but only code that is located in the NRWW section. During an on-going programming, the software must ensure that the RWW section never is being read. If the user software is trying to read code that is located inside the RWW section (i.e., by a call/jmp/lpm or an interrupt) during programming, the software might end up in an unknown state. To avoid this, the interrupts should either be disabled or moved to the Boot Loader section. The Boot Loader section is always located in the NRWW section. The RWW Section Busy bit (RWWSB) in the Store Program Memory Control and Status Register (SPMCSR) will be read as logical one as long as the RWW section is blocked for reading. After a programming is completed, the RWWSB must be cleared by software before reading code located in the RWW section. Please refer to SPMCSR – Store Program Memory Control and Status Register in this chapter for details on how to clear RWWSB. 30.4.2. NRWW – No Read-While-Write Section The code located in the NRWW section can be read when the Boot Loader software is updating a page in the RWW section. When the Boot Loader code updates the NRWW section, the CPU is halted during the entire Page Erase or Page Write operation. Table 30-1 Read-While-Write Features Which Section does the Zpointer Address during the Programming? Which Section can be read during Programming? CPU Halted? Read-While-Write Supported? RWW Section NRWW Section No Yes NRWW Section None Yes No Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 379 Figure 30-1 Read-While-Write vs. No Read-While-Write Read-While-Write (RWW) Section Z-pointer Addresses RWW Section Code Located in NRWW Section Can be Read During the Operation Z-pointer Addresses NRWW Section No Read-While-Write (NRWW) Section CPU is Halted During the Operation Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 380 Figure 30-2 Memory Sections Program Memory BOOTSZ = '10' Program Memory BOOTSZ = '11' 0x0000 Application Flash Section Read-While-Write Section End Application Start Boot Loader Flashend 0x0000 Application Flash Section End RWW Start NRWW Application Flash Section End Application Start Boot Loader Boot Loader Flash Section Flashend Application Flash Section End RWW Start NRWW Application Flash Section Boot Loader Flash Section End Application Start Boot Loader Flashend Program Memory BOOTSZ = '00' Read-While-Write Section Boot Loader Flash Section Program Memory BOOTSZ = '01' No Read-While-Write Section Read-While-Write Section End RWW Start NRWW No Read-While-Write Section Application Flash Section No Read-While-Write Section No Read-While-Write Section Read-While-Write Section 0x0000 0x0000 Application Flash Section End RWW, End Application Start NRWW, Start Boot Loader Boot Loader Flash Section Flashend Related Links ATmega324PB Boot Loader Parameters on page 391 30.5. Entering the Boot Loader Program Entering the Boot Loader takes place by a jump or call from the application program. This may be initiated by a trigger such as a command received via USART, or SPI interface. Alternatively, the Boot Reset Fuse can be programmed so that the Reset Vector is pointing to the Boot Flash start address after a reset. In this case, the Boot Loader is started after a reset. After the application code is loaded, the program can start executing the application code. The fuses cannot be changed by the MCU itself. This means that once the Boot Reset Fuse is programmed, the Reset Vector will always point to the Boot Loader Reset and the fuse can only be changed through the serial or parallel programming interface. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 381 Table 30-2 Boot Reset Fuse BOOTRST Reset Address 1 Reset Vector = Application Reset (address 0x0000) 0 Reset Vector = Boot Loader Reset, as described by the Boot Loader Parameters Note: '1' means unprogrammed, '0' means programmed. 30.6. Boot Loader Lock Bits If no Boot Loader capability is needed, the entire Flash is available for application code. The Boot Loader has two separate sets of Boot Lock bits which can be set independently. This gives the user a unique flexibility to select different levels of protection. The user can select: • • • • To protect the entire Flash from a software update by the MCU To protect only the Boot Loader Flash section from a software update by the MCU To protect only the Application Flash section from a software update by the MCU Allow software update in the entire Flash The Boot Lock bits can be set in software and in Serial or Parallel Programming mode, but they can be cleared by a Chip Erase command only. The general Write Lock (Lock Bit mode 2) does not control the programming of the Flash memory by SPM instruction. Similarly, the general Read/Write Lock (Lock Bit mode 1) does not control reading nor writing by LPM/SPM, if it is attempted. Table 30-3 Boot Lock Bit0 Protection Modes (Application Section) BLB0 Mode BLB02 BLB01 Protection 1 1 1 No restrictions for SPM or LPM accessing the Application section. 2 1 0 SPM is not allowed to write to the Application section. 3 0 0 SPM is not allowed to write to the Application section, and LPM executing from the Boot Loader section is not allowed to read from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Boot Loader section, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Application section. 4 0 1 LPM executing from the Boot Loader section is not allowed to read from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Boot Loader section, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Application section. Note: “1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed. Table 30-4 Boot Lock Bit1 Protection Modes (Boot Loader Section) BLB1 Mode BLB12 BLB11 Protection 1 1 1 No restrictions for SPM or LPM accessing the Boot Loader section. 2 1 0 SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 382 BLB1 Mode BLB12 BLB11 Protection 3 0 0 SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section, and LPM executing from the Application section is not allowed to read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Application section, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader section. 4 0 1 LPM executing from the Application section is not allowed to read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Application section, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader section. Note: “1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed. 30.7. Addressing the Flash During Self-Programming The Z-pointer is used to address the SPM commands. Since the Flash is organized in pages, the Program Counter can be treated as having two different sections. One section, consisting of the least significant bits, is addressing the words within a page, while the most significant bits are addressing the pages. This is shown in the following figure. The Page Erase and Page Write operations are addressed independently. Therefore it is of major importance that the Boot Loader software addresses the same page in both the Page Erase and Page Write operation. Once a programming operation is initiated, the address is latched and the Z-pointer can be used for other operations. The only SPM operation that does not use the Z-pointer is Setting the Boot Loader Lock bits. The content of the Z-pointer is ignored and will have no effect on the operation. The LPM instruction does also use the Z-pointer to store the address. Since this instruction addresses the Flash byte-by-byte, also the LSB (bit Z0) of the Z-pointer is used. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 383 Figure 30-3 Addressing the Flash During SPM BIT 15 ZPAGEMSB ZPCMSB 1 0 0 Z - REGISTER PROGRAM COUNTER PCMSB PAGEMSB PCPAGE PCWORD PAGE ADDRESS WITHIN THE FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY PAGE WORD ADDRESS WITHIN A PAGE PAGE INSTRUCTION WORD PCWORD[PAGEMSB:0]: 00 01 02 PAGEEND Note: The different variables used in this figure are listed in the Related Links. 30.8. Self-Programming the Flash The program memory is updated in a page by page fashion. Before programming a page with the data stored in the temporary page buffer, the page must be erased. The temporary page buffer is filled one word at a time using SPM and the buffer can be filled either before the Page Erase command or between a Page Erase and a Page Write operation: Alternative 1, fill the buffer before a Page Erase • Fill temporary page buffer • Perform a Page Erase • Perform a Page Write Alternative 2, fill the buffer after Page Erase • Perform a Page Erase • Fill temporary page buffer • Perform a Page Write If only a part of the page needs to be changed, the rest of the page must be stored (for example in the temporary page buffer) before the erase, and then be rewritten. When using alternative 1, the Boot Loader provides an effective Read-Modify-Write feature which allows the user software to first read the page, do the necessary changes, and then write back the modified data. If alternative 2 is used, it is not possible to read the old data while loading since the page is already erased. The temporary page buffer Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 384 can be accessed in a random sequence. It is essential that the page address used in both the Page Erase and Page Write operation is addressing the same page. Please refer to Simple Assembly Code Example for a Boot Loader on page 388. 30.8.1. Performing Page Erase by SPM To execute Page Erase, set up the address in the Z-pointer, write “0x0000011” to Store Program Memory Control and Status Register (SPMCSR) and execute SPM within four clock cycles after writing SPMCSR. The data in R1 and R0 is ignored. The page address must be written to PCPAGE in the Z-register. Other bits in the Z-pointer will be ignored during this operation. • • 30.8.2. Page Erase to the RWW section: The NRWW section can be read during the Page Erase. Page Erase to the NRWW section: The CPU is halted during the operation. Filling the Temporary Buffer (Page Loading) To write an instruction word, set up the address in the Z-pointer and data in [R1:R0], write “0x00000001” to SPMCSR and execute SPM within four clock cycles after writing SPMCSR. The content of PCWORD ([Z5:Z1]) in the Z-register is used to address the data in the temporary buffer. The temporary buffer will auto-erase after a Page Write operation or by writing the RWWSRE bit in SPMCSR (SPMCSR.RWWSRE). It is also erased after a system reset. It is not possible to write more than one time to each address without erasing the temporary buffer. If the EEPROM is written in the middle of an SPM Page Load operation, all data loaded will be lost. 30.8.3. Performing a Page Write To execute Page Write, set up the address in the Z-pointer, write “0x0000101” to SPMCSR and execute SPM within four clock cycles after writing SPMCSR. The data in R1 and R0 is ignored. The page address must be written to PCPAGE ([Z5:Z1]). Other bits in the Z-pointer must be written to zero during this operation. • • 30.8.4. Page Write to the RWW section: The NRWW section can be read during the Page Write Page Write to the NRWW section: The CPU is halted during the operation Using the SPM Interrupt If the SPM interrupt is enabled, the SPM interrupt will generate a constant interrupt when the SPMEN bit in SPMCSR is cleared (SPMCSR.SPMEN). This means that the interrupt can be used instead of polling the SPMCSR Register in software. When using the SPM interrupt, the Interrupt Vectors should be moved to the Boot Loader Section (BLS) section to avoid that an interrupt is accessing the RWW section when it is blocked for reading. How to move the interrupts is described in Interrupts chapter. Related Links INT- Interrupts on page 80 30.8.5. Consideration While Updating Boot Loader Section (BLS) Special care must be taken if the user allows the Boot Loader Section (BLS) to be updated by leaving Boot Lock bit11 unprogrammed. An accidental write to the Boot Loader itself can corrupt the entire Boot Loader, and further software updates might be impossible. If it is not necessary to change the Boot Loader software itself, it is recommended to program the Boot Lock bit11 to protect the Boot Loader software from any internal software changes. 30.8.6. Prevent Reading the RWW Section During Self-Programming During Self-Programming (either Page Erase or Page Write), the RWW section is always blocked for reading. The user software itself must prevent that this section is addressed during the self programming operation. The RWWSB in the SPMCSR (SPMCSR.RWWSB) will be set as long as the RWW section is Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 385 busy. During Self-Programming the Interrupt Vector table should be moved to the BLS as described in Watchdog Timer chapter, or the interrupts must be disabled. Before addressing the RWW section after the programming is completed, the user software must clear the SPMCSR.RWWSB by writing the SPMCSR.RWWSRE. Please refer to Simple Assembly Code Example for a Boot Loader on page 388 for an example. Related Links Watchdog System Reset on page 73 30.8.7. Setting the Boot Loader Lock Bits by SPM To set the Boot Loader Lock bits and general Lock Bits, write the desired data to R0, write “0x0001001” to SPMCSR and execute SPM within four clock cycles after writing SPMCSR. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R0 1 1 BLB12 BLB11 BLB02 BLB01 LB2 LB1 The tables in Boot Loader Lock Bits on page 382 show how the different settings of the Boot Loader bits affect the Flash access. If bits 5...0 in R0 are cleared (zero), the corresponding Lock bit will be programmed if an SPM instruction is executed within four cycles after BLBSET and SPMEN are set in SPMCSR (SPMCSR.BLBSET and SPMCSR.SPMEN). The Z-pointer don’t care during this operation, but for future compatibility it is recommended to load the Z-pointer with 0x0001 (same as used for reading the lOck bits). For future compatibility it is also recommended to set bits 7 and 6 in R0 to “1” when writing the Lock bits. When programming the Lock bits the entire Flash can be read during the operation. 30.8.8. EEPROM Write Prevents Writing to SPMCSR An EEPROM write operation will block all software programming to Flash. Reading the Fuses and Lock bits from software will also be prevented during the EEPROM write operation. It is recommended that the user checks the status bit (EEPE) in the EECR Register (EECR.EEPE) and verifies that the bit is cleared before writing to the SPMCSR Register. 30.8.9. Reading the Fuse and Lock Bits from Software It is possible to read both the Fuse and Lock bits (LB) from software. To read the Lock bits, load the Zpointer with 0x0001 and set the BLBSET and SPMEN bits in SPMCSR (SPMCSR.BLBSET and SPMCSR.SPMEN). When an LPM instruction is executed within three CPU cycles after the BLBSET and SPMEN bits are set in SPMCSR (SPMCSR.BLBSET and SPMCSR.SPMEN), the value of the Lock bits will be loaded in the destination register. The SPMCSR.BLBSET and SPMCSR.SPMEN will auto-clear upon completion of reading the Lock bits or if no LPM instruction is executed within three CPU cycles or no SPM instruction is executed within four CPU cycles. When SPMCSR.BLBSET and SPMCSR.SPMEN are cleared, LPM will work as described in the Instruction set Manual. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Rd – – – BLB12 – BLB11 – BLB02 – BLB01 LB2 LB1 The algorithm for reading the Fuse Low byte (FLB) is similar to the one described above for reading the Lock bits. To read the Fuse Low byte, load the Z-pointer with 0x0000 and set the BLBSET and SPMEN bits in SPMCSR (SPMCSR.BLBSET and SPMCSR.SPMEN). When an LPM instruction is executed within three cycles after the SPMCSR.BLBSET and SPMCSR.SPMEN are set, the value of the Fuse Low byte (FLB) will be loaded in the destination register as shown below. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Rd FLB7 FLB6 FLB5 FLB4 FLB3 FLB2 FLB1 FLB0 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 386 Similarly, when reading the Fuse High byte (FHB), load 0x0003 in the Z-pointer. When an LPM instruction is executed within three cycles after the SPMCSR.BLBSET and SPMCSR.SPMEN are set, the value of the Fuse High byte (FHB) will be loaded in the destination register as shown below. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Rd FHB7 FHB6 FHB5 FHB4 FHB3 FHB2 FHB1 FHB0 When reading the Extended Fuse byte (EFB), load 0x0002 in the Z-pointer. When an LPM instruction is executed within three cycles after the SPMCSR.BLBSET and SPMCSR.SPMEN are set, the value of the Extended Fuse byte (EFB) will be loaded in the destination register as shown below. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Rd – – – – – EFB2 EFB1 EFB0 Fuse and Lock bits that are programmed read as '0'. Fuse and Lock bits that are unprogrammed, will read as '1'. Related Links Fuse Bits on page 397 30.8.10. Reading the Signature Row from Software To read the Signature Row from software, load the Z-pointer with the signature byte address given in the following table and set the SIGRD and SPMEN bits in SPMCSR (SPMCSR.SIGRD and SPMCSR.SPMEN). When an LPM instruction is executed within three CPU cycles after the SPMCSR.SIGRD and SPMCSR.SPMEN are set, the signature byte value will be loaded in the destination register. The SPMCSR.SIGRD and SPMCSR.SPMEN will auto-clear upon completion of reading the Signature Row Lock bits or if no LPM instruction is executed within three CPU cycles. When SPMCSR.SIGRD and SPMCSR.SPMEN are cleared, LPM will work as described in the Instruction set Manual. Table 30-5 Signature Row Addressing Signature Byte Z-pointer Address Device Signature Byte 1 0x0000 Device Signature Byte 2 0x0002 Device Signature Byte 3 0x0004 RC Oscillator Calibration Byte 0x0001 Serial Number Byte 0 0x000E Serial Number Byte 1 0x000F Serial Number Byte 2 0x0010 Serial Number Byte 3 0x0011 Serial Number Byte 4 0x0012 Serial Number Byte 5 0x0013 Serial Number Byte 6 0x0014 Serial Number Byte 7 0x0015 Serial Number Byte 8 0x0016 Serial Number Byte 9 0x0017 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 387 Note: All other addresses are reserved for future use. 30.8.11. Preventing Flash Corruption During periods of low VCC, the Flash program can be corrupted because the supply voltage is too low for the CPU and the Flash to operate properly. These issues are the same as for board level systems using the Flash, and the same design solutions should be applied. A Flash program corruption can be caused by two situations when the voltage is too low. First, a regular write sequence to the Flash requires a minimum voltage to operate correctly. Secondly, the CPU itself can execute instructions incorrectly, if the supply voltage for executing instructions is too low. Flash corruption can easily be avoided by following these design recommendations (one is sufficient): 1. 2. 3. If there is no need for a Boot Loader update in the system, program the Boot Loader Lock bits to prevent any Boot Loader software updates. Keep the AVR RESET active (low) during periods of insufficient power supply voltage. This can be done by enabling the internal Brown-out Detector (BOD) if the operating voltage matches the detection level. If not, an external low VCC reset protection circuit can be used. If a reset occurs while a write operation is in progress, the write operation will be completed provided that the power supply voltage is sufficient. Keep the AVR core in Power-down sleep mode during periods of low VCC. This will prevent the CPU from attempting to decode and execute instructions, effectively protecting the SPMCSR Register and thus the Flash from unintentional writes. 30.8.12. Programming Time for Flash when Using SPM The calibrated RC Oscillator is used to time Flash accesses. The following table shows the typical programming time for Flash accesses from the CPU. Table 30-6 SPM Programming Time Symbol Min. Programming Time Max. Programming Time Flash write (Page Erase, Page Write, and write Lock bits by SPM) 3.7ms 4.5ms Note: Minimum and maximum programming time is per individual operation. 30.8.13. Simple Assembly Code Example for a Boot Loader ;-the routine writes one page of data from RAM to Flash ; the first data location in RAM is pointed to by the Y pointer ; the first data location in Flash is pointed to by the Zpointer ;-error handling is not included ;-the routine must be placed inside the Boot space ; (at least the Do_spm sub routine). Only code inside NRWW section can ; be read during Self-Programming (Page Erase and Page Write). ;-registers used: r0, r1, temp1 (r16), temp2 (r17), looplo (r24), Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 388 ; loophi (r25), spmcrval (r20) ; storing and restoring of registers is not included in the routine ; register usage can be optimized at the expense of code size ;-It is assumed that either the interrupt table is moved to the Boot ; loader section or that the interrupts are disabled. .equ PAGESIZEB = PAGESIZE*2 ;PAGESIZEB is page size in BYTES, not words .org SMALLBOOTSTART Write_page: ; Page Erase ldi spmcrval, (1<<PGERS) | (1<<SPMEN) call Do_spm ; re-enable the RWW section ldi spmcrval, (1<<RWWSRE) | (1<<SPMEN) call Do_spm ; transfer data from RAM to Flash page buffer ldi looplo, low(PAGESIZEB) ;init loop variable ldi loophi, high(PAGESIZEB) ;not required for PAGESIZEB<=256 Wrloop: ld r0, Y+ ld r1, Y+ ldi spmcrval, (1<<SPMEN) call Do_spm adiw ZH:ZL, 2 sbiw loophi:looplo, 2 ;use subi for PAGESIZEB<=256 brne Wrloop ; execute Page Write Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 389 subi ZL, low(PAGESIZEB) ;restore pointer sbci ZH, high(PAGESIZEB) ;not required for PAGESIZEB<=256 ldi spmcrval, (1<<PGWRT) | (1<<SPMEN) call Do_spm ; re-enable the RWW section ldi spmcrval, (1<<RWWSRE) | (1<<SPMEN) call Do_spm ; read back and check, optional ldi looplo, low(PAGESIZEB) ;init loop variable ldi loophi, high(PAGESIZEB) ;not required for PAGESIZEB<=256 subi YL, low(PAGESIZEB) ;restore pointer sbci YH, high(PAGESIZEB) Rdloop: lpm r0, Z+ ld r1, Y+ cpse r0, r1 jmp Error sbiw loophi:looplo, 1 ;use subi for PAGESIZEB<=256 brne Rdloop ; return to RWW section ; verify that RWW section is safe to read Return: in temp1, SPMCSR sbrs temp1, RWWSB ; If RWWSB is set, the RWW section is not ready yet ret ; re-enable the RWW section ldi spmcrval, (1<<RWWSRE) | (1<<SPMEN) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 390 call Do_spm rjmp Return Do_spm: ; check for previous SPM complete Wait_spm: in temp1, SPMCSR sbrc temp1, SPMEN rjmp Wait_spm ; input: spmcrval determines SPM action ; disable interrupts if enabled, store status in temp2, SREG cli ; check that no EEPROM write access is present Wait_ee: sbic EECR, EEPE rjmp Wait_ee ; SPM timed sequence out SPMCSR, spmcrval spm ; restore SREG (to enable interrupts if originally enabled) out SREG, temp2 ret 30.8.14. ATmega324PB Boot Loader Parameters In the following tables, the parameters used in the description of the self programming are given. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 391 Table 30-7 Boot Size Configuration, ATmega324PB BOOTSZ1 BOOTSZ0 Boot Size Pages Application Flash Section Boot Loader Flash Section End Application Section Boot Reset Address (Start Boot Loader Section) 1 1 256 words 4 0x0000 0x3EFF 0x3F00 0x3FFF 0x3EFF 0x3F00 1 0 512 words 8 0x0000 0x1DFF 0x3E00 0x3FFF 0x3DFF 0x3E00 0 1 1024 words 16 0x0000 0x1BFF 0x3C00 0x3FFF 0x3BFF 0x3C00 0 0 2048 words 32 0x0000 0x37FF 0x3800 0x3FFF 0x37FF 0x3800 Note: The different BOOTSZ Fuse configurations are shown in Figure 30-2 Memory Sections on page 381 Table 30-8 Read-While-Write Limit, ATmega324PB Section Pages Address Read-While-Write section (RWW) 224 0x0000 - 0x1BFF No Read-While-Write section (NRWW) 32 0x1C00 - 0x1FFF Note: For details about these two section, see NRWW – No Read-While-Write Section on page 379 and RWW – Read-While-Write Section on page 379. Table 30-9 Explanation of Different Variables used in Figure and the Mapping to the Z-pointer, ATmega324PB Variable Corresponding Variable (1) Description PCMSB 13 Most significant bit in the Program Counter. (The Program Counter is 14 bits PC[13:0]) PAGEMSB 5 Most significant bit which is used to address the words within one page (64 words in a page requires 6 bits PC [5:0]). ZPCMSB Z14 Bit in Z-register that is mapped to PCMSB. Because Z0 is not used, the ZPCMSB equals PCMSB + 1. ZPAGEMSB Z7 Bit in Z-register that is mapped to PAGEMSB. Because Z0 is not used, the ZPAGEMSB equals PAGEMSB + 1. PCPAGE PC[13:6] Z14:Z7 Program counter page address: Page select, for page erase and page write PCWORD PC[5:0] Program counter word address: Word select, for filling temporary buffer (must be zero during page write operation) Z6:Z1 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 392 Note: 1. Z0: should be zero for all SPM commands, byte select for the LPM instruction. See Addressing the Flash During Self-Programming for details about the use of Z-pointer during Self- Programming. 30.9. Register Description Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 393 30.9.1. SPMCSR – Store Program Memory Control and Status Register The Store Program Memory Control and Status Register contains the control bits needed to control the Boot Loader operations. When addressing I/O Registers as data space using LD and ST instructions, the provided offset must be used. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the offset is reduced by 0x20, resulting in an I/O address offset within 0x00 - 0x3F. Name: SPMCSR Offset: 0x57 Reset: 0x00 Property: When addressing as I/O Register: address offset is 0x37 Bit Access Reset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SPMIE RWWSB SIGRD RWWSRE BLBSET PGWRT PGERS SPMEN R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 – SPMIE: SPM Interrupt Enable When the SPMIE bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the SPM ready interrupt will be enabled. The SPM ready Interrupt will be executed as long as the SPMEN bit in the SPMCSR Register is cleared. Bit 6 – RWWSB: Read-While-Write Section Busy When a Self-Programming (Page Erase or Page Write) operation to the RWW section is initiated, the RWWSB will be set (one) by hardware. When the RWWSB bit is set, the RWW section cannot be accessed. The RWWSB bit will be cleared if the RWWSRE bit is written to one after a Self-Programming operation is completed. Alternatively the RWWSB bit will automatically be cleared if a page load operation is initiated. Bit 5 – SIGRD: Signature Row Read If this bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next LPM instruction within three clock cycles will read a byte from the signature row into the destination register. Please refer to Reading the Fuse and Lock Bits from Software in this chapter. An SPM instruction within four cycles after SIGRD and SPMEN are set will have no effect. This operation is reserved for future use and should not be used. Bit 4 – RWWSRE: Read-While-Write Section Read Enable When programming (Page Erase or Page Write) to the RWW section, the RWW section is blocked for reading (the RWWSB will be set by hardware). To re-enable the RWW section, the user software must wait until the programming is completed (SPMEN will be cleared). Then, if the RWWSRE bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next SPM instruction within four clock cycles re-enables the RWW section. The RWW section cannot be re-enabled while the Flash is busy with a Page Erase or a Page Write (SPMEN is set). If the RWWSRE bit is written while the Flash is being loaded, the Flash load operation will abort and the data loaded will be lost. Bit 3 – BLBSET: Boot Lock Bit Set If this bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next SPM instruction within four clock cycles sets Boot Lock bits and Memory Lock bits, according to the data in R0. The data in R1 and the address in the Z-pointer are ignored. The BLBSET bit will automatically be cleared upon completion of the Lock bit set, or if no SPM instruction is executed within four clock cycles. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 394 An LPM instruction within three cycles after BLBSET and SPMEN are set in the SPMCSR Register (SPMCSR.BLBSET and SPMCSR.SPMEN), will read either the Lock bits or the Fuse bits (depending on Z0 in the Z-pointer) into the destination register. Please refer to Reading the Fuse and Lock Bits from Software in this chapter. Bit 2 – PGWRT: Page Write If this bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next SPM instruction within four clock cycles executes Page Write, with the data stored in the temporary buffer. The page address is taken from the high part of the Zpointer. The data in R1 and R0 are ignored. The PGWRT bit will auto-clear upon completion of a Page Write, or if no SPM instruction is executed within four clock cycles. The CPU is halted during the entire Page Write operation if the NRWW section is addressed. Bit 1 – PGERS: Page Erase If this bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next SPM instruction within four clock cycles executes Page Erase. The page address is taken from the high part of the Z-pointer. The data in R1 and R0 are ignored. The PGERS bit will auto-clear upon completion of a Page Erase, or if no SPM instruction is executed within four clock cycles. The CPU is halted during the entire Page Write operation if the NRWW section is addressed. Bit 0 – SPMEN: Store Program Memory This bit enables the SPM instruction for the next four clock cycles. If written to one together with either RWWSRE, BLBSET, PGWRT or PGERS, the following SPM instruction will have a special meaning, see description above. If only SPMEN is written, the following SPM instruction will store the value in R1:R0 in the temporary page buffer addressed by the Z-pointer. The LSB of the Z-pointer is ignored. The SPMEN bit will auto-clear upon completion of an SPM instruction, or if no SPM instruction is executed within four clock cycles. During Page Erase and Page Write, the SPMEN bit remains high until the operation is completed. Writing any other combination than “0x10001”, “0x01001”, “0x00101”, “0x00011” or “0x00001” in the lower five bits will have no effect. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 395 31. MEMPROG- Memory Programming 31.1. Program And Data Memory Lock Bits The device provides six Lock bits. These can be left unprogrammed ('1') or can be programmed ('0') to obtain the additional features listed in Table. Lock Bit Protection Modes in this section. The Lock bits can only be erased to “1” with the Chip Erase command. Table 31-1 Lock Bit Byte(1) Lock Bit Byte Bit No. Description Default Value NA 7 – 0 (unprogrammed) NA 6 – 0 (unprogrammed) BLB12 5 Boot Lock bit 1 (unprogrammed) BLB11 4 Boot Lock bit 1 (unprogrammed) BLB02 3 Boot Lock bit 1 (unprogrammed) BLB01 2 Boot Lock bit 1 (unprogrammed) LB2 1 Lock bit 1 (unprogrammed) LB1 0 Lock bit 1 (unprogrammed) Note: 1. '1' means unprogrammed, '0' means programmed. Table 31-2 Lock Bit Protection Modes(1)(2) Memory Lock Bits Protection Type LB Mode LB2 LB1 1 1 1 No memory lock features enabled. 2 1 0 Further programming of the Flash and EEPROM is disabled in Parallel and Serial Programming mode. The Fuse bits are locked in both Serial and Parallel Programming mode.(1) 3 0 0 Further programming and verification of the Flash and EEPROM is disabled in Parallel and Serial Programming mode. The Boot Lock bits and Fuse bits are locked in both Serial and Parallel Programming mode.(1) Note: 1. Program the Fuse bits and Boot Lock bits before programming the LB1 and LB2. 2. '1' means unprogrammed, '0' means programmed. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 396 Table 31-3 Lock Bit Protection - BLB0 Mode(1)(2). BLB0 Mode BLB02 BLB01 1 1 1 No restrictions for SPM or Load Program Memory (LPM) instruction accessing the Application section. 2 1 0 SPM is not allowed to write to the Application section. 3 0 0 SPM is not allowed to write to the Application section, and LPM executing from the Boot Loader section is not allowed to read from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Boot Loader section, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Application section. 4 0 1 LPM executing from the Boot Loader section is not allowed to read from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Boot Loader section, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Application section. Table 31-4 Lock Bit Protection - BLB1 Mode(1)(2) BLB1 Mode BLB12 BLB11 1 1 1 No restrictions for SPM or LPM accessing the Boot Loader section. 2 1 0 SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section. 3 0 0 SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section, and LPM executing from the Application section is not allowed to read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Application section, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader section. 4 0 1 LPM executing from the Application section is not allowed to read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Application section, interrupts are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader section. Note: 1. Program the Fuse bits and Boot Lock bits before programming the LB1 and LB2. 2. '1' means unprogrammed; '0' means programmed. 31.2. Fuse Bits The device has three Fuse bytes. The following tables describe briefly the functionality of all the fuses and how they are mapped into the Fuse bytes. Note that the fuses are read as logical zero, “0”, if they are programmed. Table 31-5 Extended Fuse Byte Extended Fuse Byte Bit No. Description Default Value – 7 – 0 – 6 – 0 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 397 Extended Fuse Byte Bit No. Description Default Value – 5 – 0 – 4 – 0 CFD 3 CFD 0 (0: Disabled) BODLEVEL2 (1) 2 Brown-out Detector trigger level 1 (unprogrammed) BODLEVEL1 (1) 1 Brown-out Detector trigger level 1 (unprogrammed) BODLEVEL0 (1) 0 Brown-out Detector trigger level 1 (unprogrammed) Note: 1. Please refer to Table. BODLEVEL Fuse Coding in System and Reset Characteristics for BODLEVEL Fuse decoding. TBD Table 31-6 Fuse High Byte. High Fuse Byte Bit No. Description Default Value OCDEN(1) 7 Enable OCD 1 (unprogrammed, OCD disabled) JTAGEN 6 Enable JTAG 0 (programmed, JTAG enabled) SPIEN(2) 5 Enable Serial Program and Data Downloading 0 (programmed, SPI prog. enabled) WDTON(3) 4 Watchdog Timer Always On 1 (unprogrammed) EESAVE 3 EEPROM memory is preserved through the Chip Erase 1 (unprogrammed), EEPROM not reserved BOOTSZ1(4) 2 Select Boot Size 0 (programmed) BOOTSZ0(4) 1 Select Boot Size 0 (programmed) BOOTRST(4) 0 Select Boot Size 1 (unprogrammed) Note: 1. Never ship a product with the OCDEN Fuse programmed regardless of the setting of Lock bits and JTAGEN Fuse. A programmed OCDEN Fuse enables some parts of the clock system to be running in all sleep modes. This may increase the power consumption. 2. The SPIEN Fuse is not accessible in serial programming mode. 3. Please refer to WDTCSR – Watchdog Timer Control Register for details. 4. The default value of BOOTSZ1..0 results in maximum Boot Size. See Boot size configuration table for details. Table 31-7 Fuse Low Byte Low Fuse Byte Bit No. Description Default Value CKDIV8(4) 7 Divide clock by 8 0 (programmed) CKOUT(3) 6 Clock output 1 (unprogrammed) SUT1 5 Select start-up time 1 (unprogrammed)(1) SUT0 4 Select start-up time 0 (programmed)(1) CKSEL3 3 Select Clock source 0 (programmed)(2) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 398 Low Fuse Byte Bit No. Description Default Value CKSEL2 2 Select Clock source 0 (programmed)(2) CKSEL1 1 Select Clock source 1 (unprogrammed)(2) CKSEL0 0 Select Clock source 0 (programmed)(2) Note: 1. The default value of SUT1...0 results in maximum start-up time for the default clock source. See Table. Start-up times for the internal calibrated RC Oscillator clock selection in Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator of System Clock and Clock Options chapter for details. 2. The default setting of CKSEL3...0 results in internal RC Oscillator @ 8MHz. See Table. Internal Calibrated RC Oscillator Operating Modes in Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator of the System Clock and Clock Options chapter for details. 3. The CKOUT Fuse allows the system clock to be output on PORTB0. Please refer to Clock Output Buffer section in the System Clock and Clock Options chapter for details. 4. Please refer to System Clock Prescaler section in the System Clock and Clock Options chapter for details. The status of the Fuse bits is not affected by Chip Erase. Note that the Fuse bits are locked if Lock bit1 (LB1) is programmed. Program the Fuse bits before programming the Lock bits. Related Links Alternate Port Functions on page 103 Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator on page 47 WDTCSR on page 78 System and Reset Characteristics on page 433 31.2.1. Latching of Fuses The fuse values are latched when the device enters programming mode and changes of the fuse values will have no effect until the part leaves Programming mode. This does not apply to the EESAVE Fuse which will take effect once it is programmed. The fuses are also latched on Power-up in Normal mode. 31.3. Signature Bytes All Atmel microcontrollers have a three-byte signature code which identifies the device. This code can be read in both serial and parallel mode, also when the device is locked. The three bytes reside in a separate address space. For the device the signature bytes are given in the following table. Table 31-8 Device and JTAG ID Part ATmega324PB 31.4. Signature Bytes Address JTAG 0x000 0x001 0x002 Part number Manufacture ID 0x1E 0x95 0x17 9517 0x1F Calibration Byte The device has a byte calibration value for the Internal RC Oscillator. This byte resides in the high byte of address 0x000 in the signature address space. During reset, this byte is automatically written into the OSCCAL Register to ensure correct frequency of the calibrated RC Oscillator. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 399 31.5. Serial Number Each individual part has a specific serial number. This can be used to identify a specify part while it is in the field. The serial number consists of nine bytes which can be accessed from the signature address space. 31.6. Page Size Table 31-9 No. of Words in a Page and No. of Pages in the Flash Device Flash Size Page Size PCWORD No. of Pages PCPAGE PCMSB ATmega324PB 16K words (32Kbytes) 64 words PC[5:0] 256 PC[13:6] 13 Table 31-10 No. of Words in a Page and No. of Pages in the EEPROM 31.7. Device EEPROM Size Page Size PCWORD No. of Pages PCPAGE EEAMSB ATmega324PB 1Kbytes 4bytes EEA[1:0] 256 EEA[9:2] 9 Parallel Programming Parameters, Pin Mapping, and Commands This section describes how to parallel program and verify Flash Program memory, EEPROM Data memory, Memory Lock bits, and Fuse bits in the device. Pulses are assumed to be at least 250ns unless otherwise noted. 31.7.1. Signal Names In this section, some pins of this device are referenced by signal names describing their functionality during parallel programming, please refer to Figure. Parallel Programming and Table. Pin Name Mapping in this section. Pins not described in the following table are referenced by pin names. The XA1/XA0 pins determine the action executed when the XTAL1 pin is given a positive pulse. The bit coding is shown in the table, XA1 and XA0 Coding. When pulsing WR or OE, the command loaded determines the action executed. The different Commands are shown in the table, Command Byte Bit Coding Command Byte Command Executed. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 400 Figure 31-1 Parallel Programming +4.5 - 5.5V RDY/BSY PD1 OE PD2 WR PD3 BS1 PD4 XA0 PD5 XA1 PD6 PAGEL PD7 +12V VCC +4.5 - 5.5V AVCC PB[7:0] DATA RESET BS2 PC2 XTAL1 GND Note: VCC - 0.3V < AVCC < VCC + 0.3V, however, AVCC should always be within 4.5 - 5.5V Table 31-11 Pin Name Mapping Signal Name in Programming Mode Pin Name I/O Function RDY/BSY PD1 O 0: Device is busy programming, 1: Device is ready for new command OE PD2 I Output Enable (Active low) WR PD3 I Write Pulse (Active low) BS1 PD4 I Byte Select 1 (“0” selects Low byte, “1” selects High byte) XA0 PD5 I XTAL Action Bit 0 XA1 PD6 I XTAL Action Bit 1 PAGEL PD7 I Program memory and EEPROM Data Page Load BS2 PC2 I Byte Select 2 (“0” selects Low byte, “1” selects 2’nd High byte) DATA PB[7:0] I/O Bi-directional Data bus (Output when OE is low) Table 31-12 Pin Values Used to Enter Programming Mode Pin Symbol Value PAGEL Prog_enable[3] 0 XA1 Prog_enable[2] 0 XA0 Prog_enable[1] 0 BS1 Prog_enable[0] 0 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 401 Table 31-13 XA1 and XA0 Coding XA1 XA0 Action when XTAL1 is Pulsed 0 0 Load Flash or EEPROM Address (High or low address byte determined by BS1) 0 1 Load Data (High or Low data byte for Flash determined by BS1) 1 0 Load Command 1 1 No Action, Idle Table 31-14 Command Byte Bit Coding Command Byte Command Executed 1000 0000 Chip Erase 0100 0000 Write Fuse bits 0010 0000 Write Lock bits 0001 0000 Write Flash 0001 0001 Write EEPROM 0000 1000 Read Signature Bytes and Calibration byte 0000 0100 Read Fuse and Lock bits 0000 0010 Read Flash 0000 0011 Read EEPROM 31.8. Parallel Programming 31.8.1. Enter Programming Mode The following algorithm puts the device in Parallel (High-voltage) Programming mode: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Set Prog_enable pins listed in Pin Values Used to Enter Programming Mode of Signal Names section “0x0000”, RESET pin to 0V and VCC to 0V. Apply 4.5 - 5.5V between VCC and GND. Ensure that VCC reaches at least 1.8V within the next 20μs. Wait 20 - 60μs, and apply 11.5 - 12.5V to RESET. Keep the Prog_enable pins unchanged for at least 10μs after the High-voltage has been applied to ensure the Prog_enable Signature has been latched. Wait at least 300μs before giving any parallel programming commands. Exit Programming mode by power the device down or by bringing RESET pin to 0V. If the rise time of the VCC is unable to fulfill the requirements listed above, the following alternative algorithm can be used. 1. 2. 3. Set Prog_enable pins listed in Pin Values Used to Enter Programming Mode of Signal Names section to “0000”, RESET pin to 0V and VCC to 0V. Apply 4.5 - 5.5V between VCC and GND. Monitor VCC, and as soon as VCC reaches 0.9 - 1.1V, apply 11.5 - 12.5V to RESET. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 402 4. 5. 6. 31.8.2. Considerations for Efficient Programming The loaded command and address are retained in the device during programming. For efficient programming, the following should be considered. • • • 31.8.3. Keep the Prog_enable pins unchanged for at least 10μs after the High-voltage has been applied to ensure the Prog_enable Signature has been latched. Wait until VCC actually reaches 4.5 - 5.5V before giving any parallel programming commands. Exit Programming mode by power the device down or by bringing RESET pin to 0V. The command needs only be loaded once when writing or reading multiple memory locations. Skip writing the data value 0xFF, that is the contents of the entire EEPROM (unless the EESAVE Fuse is programmed) and Flash after a Chip Erase. Address high byte needs only be loaded before programming or reading a new 256 word window in Flash or 256byte EEPROM. This consideration also applies to Signature bytes reading. Chip Erase The Chip Erase will erase the Flash and EEPROM memories plus Lock bits. The Lock bits are not reset until the program memory has been completely erased. The Fuse bits are not changed. A Chip Erase must be performed before the Flash and/or EEPROM are reprogrammed. Note: The EEPRPOM memory is preserved during Chip Erase if the EESAVE Fuse is programmed. Load Command “Chip Erase”: 31.8.4. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Set XA1, XA0 to “10”. This enables command loading. Set BS1 to “0”. Set DATA to “1000 0000”. This is the command for Chip Erase. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the command. Give WR a negative pulse. This starts the Chip Erase. RDY/BSY goes low. 6. Wait until RDY/BSY goes high before loading a new command. Programming the Flash The Flash is organized in pages as number of Words in a Page and number of Pages in the Flash. When programming the Flash, the program data is latched into a page buffer. This allows one page of program data to be programmed simultaneously. The following procedure describes how to program the entire Flash memory: Step A. Load Command “Write Flash”. 1. Set XA1, XA0 to “10”. This enables command loading. 2. Set BS1 to “0”. 3. Set DATA to “0001 0000”. This is the command for Write Flash. 4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the command. Step B. Load Address Low byte. 1. Set XA1, XA0 to “00”. This enables address loading. 2. Set BS1 to “0”. This selects low address. 3. Set DATA = Address low byte (0x00 - 0xFF). 4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the address low byte. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 403 Step C. Load Data Low Byte. 1. Set XA1, XA0 to “01”. This enables data loading. 2. Set DATA = Data low byte (0x00 - 0xFF). 3. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the data byte. Step D. Load Data Low Byte. 1. Set BS1 to “1”. This selects high data byte. 2. Set XA1, XA0 to “01”. This enables data loading. 3. Set DATA = Data high byte (0x00 - 0xFF). 4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the data byte. Step E. Latch Data. 1. Set BS1 to “1”. This selects high data byte. 2. Give PAGEL a positive pulse. This latches the data bytes. (Please refer to the figure, Programming the Flash Waveforms, in this section for signal waveforms) Step F. Repeat B through E until the entire buffer is filled or until all data within the page is loaded. While the lower bits in the address are mapped to words within the page, the higher bits address the pages within the FLASH. This is illustrated in the following figure, Addressing the Flash Which is Organized in Pages, in this section. Note that if less than eight bits are required to address words in the page (pagesize < 256), the most significant bit(s) in the address low byte are used to address the page when performing a Page Write. Step G. Load Address High byte. 1. Set XA1, XA0 to “00”. This enables address loading. 2. Set BS1 to “1”. This selects high address. 3. Set DATA = Address high byte (0x00 - 0xFF). 4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the address high byte. Step H. Program Page. 1. Give WR a negative pulse. This starts programming of the entire page of data. RDY/BSY goes low. 2. Wait until RDY/BSY goes high (Please refer to the figure, Programming the Flash Waveforms, in this section for signal waveforms). Step I. Repeat B through H until the entire Flash is programmed or until all data has been programmed. Step J. End Page Programming. 1. 1. Set XA1, XA0 to “10”. This enables command loading. 2. Set DATA to “0000 0000”. This is the command for No Operation. 3. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the command, and the internal write signals are reset. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 404 Figure 31-2 Addressing the Flash Which is Organized in Pages PROGRAM COUNTER PCMSB PAGEMSB PCPAGE PCWORD PAGE ADDRESS WITHIN THE FLASH WORD ADDRESS WITHIN A PAGE PROGRAM MEMORY PAGE PAGE PCWORD[PAGEMSB:0]: 00 INSTRUCTION WORD 01 02 PAGEEND Note: PCPAGE and PCWORD are listed in Table 31-9 No. of Words in a Page and No. of Pages in the Flash on page 400. Programming the Flash Waveforms F DATA A B C D E 0x10 ADDR. LOW DATA LOW DATA HIGH XX B ADDR. LOW C D DATA LOW DATA HIGH E XX G ADDR. HIGH H XX XA1 XA0 BS1 XTAL1 WR RDY/BSY RESET +12V OE PAGEL BS2 Note: “XX” is don’t care. The letters refer to the programming description above. 31.8.5. Programming the EEPROM The EEPROM is organized in pages, please refer to table, No. of Words in a Page and No. of Pages in the EEPROM, in the Page Size section. When programming the EEPROM, the program data is latched into a page buffer. This allows one page of data to be programmed simultaneously. The programming algorithm for the EEPROM data memory is as follows (For details on Command, Address and Data loading, please refer to Programming the Flash on page 403): Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 405 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Step A: Load Command “0001 0001”. Step G: Load Address High Byte (0x00 - 0xFF). Step B: Load Address Low Byte (0x00 - 0xFF). Step C: Load Data (0x00 - 0xFF). Step E: Latch data (give PAGEL a positive pulse). Step K:Repeat 3 through 5 until the entire buffer is filled. Step L: Program EEPROM page 7.1. Set BS1 to “0”. 7.2. Give WR a negative pulse. This starts programming of the EEPROM page. RDY/BSY goes low. Wait until to RDY/BSY goes high before programming the next page (Please refer to the following figure for signal waveforms). 7.3. Figure 31-3 Programming the EEPROM Waveforms K DATA A G B 0x11 ADDR. HIGH ADDR. LOW C DATA E XX B ADDR. LOW C DATA E L XX XA1 XA0 BS1 XTAL1 WR RDY/BSY RESET +12V OE PAGEL BS2 31.8.6. Reading the Flash The algorithm for reading the Flash memory is as follows (Please refer to Programming the Flash on page 403 in this chapter for details on Command and Address loading): 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 31.8.7. Step A: Load Command “0000 0010”. StepG: Load Address High Byte (0x00 - 0xFF). StepB: Load Address Low Byte (0x00 - 0xFF). Set OE to “0”, and BS1 to “0”. The Flash word low byte can now be read at DATA. Set BS1 to “1”. The Flash word high byte can now be read at DATA. Set OE to “1”. Reading the EEPROM The algorithm for reading the EEPROM memory is as follows (Please refer to Programming the Flash on page 403 for details on Command and Address loading): 1. 2. 3. Step A: Load Command “0000 0011”. Step G: Load Address High Byte (0x00 - 0xFF). Step B: Load Address Low Byte (0x00 - 0xFF). Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 406 4. 5. 31.8.8. Set OE to “0”, and BS1 to “0”. The EEPROM Data byte can now be read at DATA. Set OE to “1”. Programming the Fuse Low Bits The algorithm for programming the Fuse Low bits is as follows (Please refer to Programming the Flash on page 403 for details on Command and Data loading): 1. 2. 3. 31.8.9. Step A: Load Command “0100 0000”. Step C: Load Data Low Byte. Bit n = “0” programs and bit n = “1” erases the Fuse bit. Give WR a negative pulse and wait for RDY/BSY to go high. Programming the Fuse High Bits The algorithm for programming the Fuse High bits is as follows (Please refer to Programming the Flash on page 403 for details on Command and Data loading): 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Step A: Load Command “0100 0000”. Step C: Load Data Low Byte. Bit n = “0” programs and bit n = “1” erases the Fuse bit. Set BS1 to “1” and BS2 to “0”. This selects high data byte. Give WR a negative pulse and wait for RDY/BSY to go high. Set BS1 to “0”. This selects low data byte. 31.8.10. Programming the Extended Fuse Bits The algorithm for programming the Extended Fuse bits is as follows (Please refer to Programming the Flash on page 403 for details on Command and Data loading): 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Step A: Load Command “0100 0000”. Step C: Load Data Low Byte. Bit n = “0” programs and bit n = “1” erases the Fuse bit. Set BS1 to “0” and BS2 to “1”. This selects extended data byte. Give WR a negative pulse and wait for RDY/BSY to go high. Set BS2 to “0”. This selects low data byte. Figure 31-4 Programming the FUSES Waveforms Write Fuse Low byte A DATA 0x40 DATA Write Fuse high byte A C XX 0x40 C DATA Write Extended Fuse byte A XX 0x40 C DATA XX XA1 XA0 BS1 BS2 XTAL1 WR RDY/BSY RESET +12V OE PAGEL Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 407 31.8.11. Programming the Lock Bits The algorithm for programming the Lock bits is as follows (Please refer to Programming the Flash on page 403 for details on Command and Data loading): 1. 2. 3. Step A: Load Command “0010 0000”. Step C: Load Data Low Byte. Bit n = “0” programs the Lock bit. If LB mode 3 is programmed (LB1 and LB2 is programmed), it is not possible to program the Boot Lock bits by any External Programming mode. Give WR a negative pulse and wait for RDY/BSY to go high. The Lock bits can only be cleared by executing Chip Erase. 31.8.12. Reading the Fuse and Lock Bits The algorithm for reading the Fuse and Lock bits is as follows (Please refer to Programming the Flash on page 403 for details on Command loading): 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Step A: Load Command “0000 0100”. Set OE to “0”, BS2 to “0” and BS1 to “0”. The status of the Fuse Low bits can now be read at DATA (“0” means programmed). Set OE to “0”, BS2 to “1” and BS1 to “1”. The status of the Fuse High bits can now be read at DATA (“0” means programmed). Set OE to “0”, BS2 to “1”, and BS1 to “0”. The status of the Extended Fuse bits can now be read at DATA (“0” means programmed). Set OE to “0”, BS2 to “0” and BS1 to “1”. The status of the Lock bits can now be read at DATA (“0” means programmed). Set OE to “1”. Figure 31-5 Mapping Between BS1, BS2 and the Fuse and Lock Bits During Read 0 Fuse Low Byte 0 Extended Fuse Byte 1 DATA BS2 0 Lock Bits 1 Fuse High Byte 1 BS1 BS2 31.8.13. Reading the Signature Bytes The algorithm for reading the Signature bytes is as follows (Please refer to Programming the Flash on page 403 for details on Command and Address loading): 1. 2. 3. 4. Step A: Load Command “0000 1000”. Step B: Load Address Low Byte (0x00 - 0x02). Set OE to “0”, and BS1 to “0”. The selected Signature byte can now be read at DATA. Set OE to “1”. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 408 31.8.14. Reading the Calibration Byte The algorithm for reading the Calibration byte is as follows (Please refer to Programming the Flash on page 403 for details on Command and Address loading): 1. 2. 3. 4. Step A: Load Command “0000 1000”. Step B: Load Address Low Byte, 0x00. Set OE to “0”, and BS1 to “1”. The Calibration byte can now be read at DATA. Set OE to “1”. 31.8.15. Parallel Programming Characteristics For characteristics of the Parallel Programming, please refer to Parallel Programming Characteristics. Related Links Parallel Programming Characteristics on page 441 31.9. Serial Downloading Both the Flash and EEPROM memory arrays can be programmed using the serial SPI bus while RESET is pulled to GND. The serial interface consists of pins SCK, MOSI (input) and MISO (output). After RESET is set low, the Programming Enable instruction needs to be executed first before program/erase operations can be executed. Figure 31-6 Serial Programming and Verify +1.8 - 5.5V VCC +1.8 - 5.5V(2) MOSI AVCC MISO SCK EXTCLK RESET GND Note: 1. If the device is clocked by the internal Oscillator, it is no need to connect a clock source to the EXTCLK pin. 2. VCC - 0.3V < AVCC < VCC + 0.3V, however, AVCC should always be within 1.8 - 5.5V When programming the EEPROM, an auto-erase cycle is built into the self-timed programming operation (in the Serial mode ONLY) and there is no need to first execute the Chip Erase instruction. The Chip Erase operation turns the content of every memory location in both the Program and EEPROM arrays into 0xFF. Depending on CKSEL Fuses, a valid clock must be present. The minimum low and high periods for the serial clock (SCK) input are defined as follows: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 409 • • 31.9.1. Low: > 2 CPU clock cycles for fck < 12MHz, 3 CPU clock cycles for fck ≥ 12MHz High: > 2 CPU clock cycles for fck < 12MHz, 3 CPU clock cycles for fck ≥ 12MHz Serial Programming Pin Mapping Table 31-15 Pin Mapping Serial Programming Symbol Pins I/O Description MOSI PB5 I Serial Data in MISO PB6 O Serial Data out SCK PB7 I Serial Clock Note: The pin mapping for SPI programming is listed. Not all parts use the SPI pins dedicated for the internal SPI interface. 31.9.2. Serial Programming Algorithm When writing serial data to the device, data is clocked on the rising edge of SCK. When reading data from the device, data is clocked on the falling edge of SCK. Please refer to the figure, Serial Programming Waveforms in SPI Serial Programming Characteristics section for timing details. To program and verify the device in the serial programming mode, the following sequence is recommended (See Serial Programming Instruction set in Table 31-17 Serial Programming Instruction Set (Hexadecimal values) (Continued) on page 411: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Power-up sequence: Apply power between VCC and GND while RESET and SCK are set to “0”. In some systems, the programmer can not guarantee that SCK is held low during power-up. In this case, RESET must be given a positive pulse of at least two CPU clock cycles duration after SCK has been set to “0”. Wait for at least 20ms and enable serial programming by sending the Programming Enable serial instruction to pin MOSI. The serial programming instructions will not work if the communication is out of synchronization. When in sync. the second byte (0x53), will echo back when issuing the third byte of the Programming Enable instruction. Whether the echo is correct or not, all four bytes of the instruction must be transmitted. If the 0x53 did not echo back, give RESET a positive pulse and issue a new Programming Enable command. The Flash is programmed one page at a time. The memory page is loaded one byte at a time by supplying the 6 LSB of the address and data together with the Load Program Memory Page instruction. To ensure correct loading of the page, the data low byte must be loaded before data high byte is applied for a given address. The Program Memory Page is stored by loading the Write Program Memory Page instruction with the 7 MSB of the address. If polling (RDY/BSY) is not used, the user must wait at least tWD_FLASH before issuing the next page . Accessing the serial programming interface before the Flash write operation completes can result in incorrect programming. A: The EEPROM array is programmed one byte at a time by supplying the address and data together with the appropriate Write instruction. An EEPROM memory location is first automatically erased before new data is written. If polling (RDY/BSY) is not used, the user must wait at least tWD_EEPROM before issuing the next byte. In a chip erased device, no 0xFFs in the data file(s) need to be programmed. B: The EEPROM array is programmed one page at a time. The Memory page is loaded one byte at a time by supplying the 6 LSB of the address and data together with the Load EEPROM Memory Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 410 6. 7. 8. Page instruction. The EEPROM Memory Page is stored by loading the Write EEPROM Memory Page Instruction with the 7 MSB of the address. When using EEPROM page access only byte locations loaded with the Load EEPROM Memory Page instruction is altered. The remaining locations remain unchanged. If polling (RDY/BSY) is not used, the used must wait at least tWD_EEPROM before issuing the next byte. In a chip erased device, no 0xFF in the data file(s) need to be programmed. Any memory location can be verified by using the Read instruction which returns the content at the selected address at serial output MISO. At the end of the programming session, RESET can be set high to commence normal operation. Power-off sequence (if needed): Set RESET to “1”. Turn VCC power off. Table 31-16 Typical Wait Delay Before Writing the Next Flash or EEPROM Location 31.9.3. Symbol Minimum Wait Delay tWD_FLASH 4.5ms tWD_EEPROM 3.6ms tWD_ERASE 9.0ms tWD_FUSE 4.5ms Serial Programming Instruction Set This section describes the Instruction Set. Table 31-17 Serial Programming Instruction Set (Hexadecimal values) (Continued) Instruction Category Instruction/ Operation Instruction Format Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte 4 Programming Enable $AC $53 $00 $00 Chip Erase (Program Memory/ EEPROM) $AC $80 $00 $00 Poll RDY/BSY $F0 $00 $00 data byte out Load Extended Address byte(1) $4D $00 Extended adr $00 Load Program Memory Page, High byte $48 $00 adr LSB high data byte in Load Instructions Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 411 Instruction Category Instruction/ Operation Instruction Format Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte 4 $40 $00 adr LSB low data byte in Load EEPROM $C1 Memory Page (page access) $00 0000 000aa data byte in Read Program Memory, High byte $28 adr MSB adr LSB high data byte out Read Program Memory, Low byte $20 adr MSB adr LSB low data byte out Read EEPROM $A0 Memory 0000 00aa aaaa aaaa data byte out Read Lock bits $58 $00 $00 data byte out Read Signature $30 Byte $00 0000 000aa data byte out Read Fuse bits $50 $00 $00 data byte out Read Fuse High bits $58 $08 $00 data byte out Read Extended $50 Fuse Bits $08 $00 data byte out Read $38 Calibration Byte $00 $00 data byte out Write Program Memory Page $4C adr MSB(8) adr LSB(8) $00 Write EEPROM $C0 Memory 0000 00aa aaaa aaaa data byte in Write EEPROM $C2 Memory Page (page access) 0000 00aa aaaa aa00 $00 Write Lock bits $AC $E0 $00 data byte in Write Fuse bits $AC $A0 $00 data byte in Load Program Memory Page, Low byte Read Instructions Write Instructions(6) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 412 Instruction Category Instruction/ Operation Instruction Format Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte 4 $AC $A8 $00 data byte in Write Extended $AC Fuse Bits $A4 $00 data byte in Write Fuse High bits Note: 1. Not all instructions are applicable for all parts. 2. a = address. 3. Bits are programmed ‘0’, unprogrammed ‘1’. 4. To ensure future compatibility, unused Fuses and Lock bits should be unprogrammed (‘1’) . 5. Refer to the corresponding section for Fuse and Lock bits, Calibration and Signature bytes and Page size. 6. Instructions accessing program memory use a word address. This address may be random within the page range. 7. See http://www.atmel.com/avr for Application Notes regarding programming and programmers. 8. WORDS. If the LSB in RDY/BSY data byte out is ‘1’, a programming operation is still pending. Wait until this bit returns ‘0’ before the next instruction is carried out. Within the same page, the low data byte must be loaded prior to the high data byte. After data is loaded to the page buffer, program the EEPROM page, Please refer to the following figure. Figure 31-7 Serial Programming Instruction example Serial Programming Instruction Load Program Memory Page (High/Low Byte)/ Load EEPROM Memory Page (page access) Byte 1 Byte 2 Adr MSB Bit 15 B Byte 3 Write Program Memory Page/ Write EEPROM Memory Page Byte 1 Byte 4 Byte 2 Adr LSB Adr MSB Bit 15 B 0 Byte 3 Byte 4 Adr LSB 0 Page Buffer Page Offset Page 0 Page 1 Page 2 Page Number Page N-1 Program Memory/ EEPROM Memory Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 413 31.9.4. SPI Serial Programming Characteristics Figure 31-8 Serial Programming Waveforms SERIAL DATA INPUT (MOSI) MSB LSB SERIAL DATA OUTPUT (MISO) MSB LSB SERIAL CLOCK INPUT (SCK) SAMPLE 31.10. Programming Via the JTAG Interface Programming through the JTAG interface requires control of the four JTAG specific pins: TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO. Control of the Reset and clock pins is not required. To be able to use the JTAG interface, the JTAGEN fuse must be programmed. The device is default shipped with the Fuse programmed. In addition, the JTD bit in MCUCSR must be cleared. Alternatively, if the JTD bit is set, the external reset can be forced low. Then, the JTD bit will be cleared after two chip clocks, and the JTAG pins are available for programming. This provides a means of using the JTAG pins as normal port pins in running mode while still allowing In-System Programming via the JTAG interface. Note that this technique can not be used when using the JTAG pins for Boundary-scan or On-chip Debug. In these cases the JTAG pins must be dedicated for this purpose. As a definition in this data sheet, the LSB is shifted in and out first of all Shift Registers. 31.10.1. Programming Specific JTAG Instructions The instruction register is 4-bit wide, supporting up to 16 instructions. The JTAG instructions useful for Programming are listed below. The OPCODE for each instruction is shown behind the instruction name in hex format. The text describes which data register is selected as path between TDI and TDO for each instruction. The Run-Test/Idle state of the TAP controller is used to generate internal clocks. It can also be used as an idle state between JTAG sequences. The state machine sequence for changing the instruction word is shown in the figure below. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 414 Figure 31-9 State Machine Sequence for Changing the Instruction Word 1 Te s t-Logic-Re s e t 0 0 Run-Te s t/Idle 1 1 S e le ct-DR S ca n S e le ct-IR S ca n 0 0 1 1 Ca pture -DR Ca pture -IR 0 0 S hift-DR S hift-IR 0 1 Exit1-DR 1 Exit1-IR 0 0 Pa us e -DR 0 0 Pa us e -IR 1 1 0 Exit2-DR Exit2-IR 1 1 Upda te -DR 1 0 1 1 0 1 Upda te -IR 1 0 0 31.10.2. AVR_RESET (0xC) The AVR specific public JTAG instruction for setting the AVR device in the Reset mode or taking the device out from the Reset mode. The TAP controller is not reset by this instruction. The one bit Reset Register is selected as Data Register. Note that the reset will be active as long as there is a logic 'one' in the Reset Chain. The output from this chain is not latched. The active states are: • Shift-DR: The Reset Register is shifted by the TCK input. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 415 31.10.3. PROG_ENABLE (0x4) The AVR specific public JTAG instruction for enabling programming via the JTAG port. The 16-bit Programming Enable Register is selected as data register. The active states are the following: • • Shift-DR: the programming enable signature is shifted into the data register. Update-DR: the programming enable signature is compared to the correct value, and Programming mode is entered if the signature is valid. 31.10.4. PROG_COMMANDS (0x5) The AVR specific public JTAG instruction for entering programming commands via the JTAG port. The 15bit Programming Command Register is selected as data register. The active states are the following: • • • • Capture-DR: the result of the previous command is loaded into the data register. Shift-DR: the data register is shifted by the TCK input, shifting out the result of the previous command and shifting in the new command. Update-DR: the programming command is applied to the Flash inputs. Run-Test/Idle: one clock cycle is generated, executing the applied command. 31.10.5. PROG_PAGELOAD (0x6) The AVR specific public JTAG instruction to directly load the Flash data page via the JTAG port. The 2048-bit Virtual Flash Page Load Register is selected as data register. This is a virtual scan chain with length equal to the number of bits in one Flash page. Internally the Shift Register is 8-bit. Unlike most JTAG instructions, the Update-DR state is not used to transfer data from the Shift Register. The data are automatically transferred to the Flash page buffer byte by byte in the Shift-DR state by an internal state machine. This is the only active state: • Shift-DR: Flash page data are shifted in from TDI by the TCK input, and automatically loaded into the Flash page one byte at a time. Note: 1. The JTAG instruction PROG_PAGELOAD can only be used if the AVR device is the first device in JTAG scan chain. If the AVR cannot be the first device in the scan chain, the byte-wise programming algorithm must be used. 31.10.6. PROG_PAGEREAD (0x7) The AVR specific public JTAG instruction to read one full Flash data page via the JTAG port. The 2056-bit Virtual Flash Page Read Register is selected as data register. This is a virtual scan chain with length equal to the number of bits in one Flash page plus 8. Internally the Shift Register is 8-bit. Unlike most JTAG instructions, the Capture-DR state is not used to transfer data to the Shift Register. The data are automatically transferred from the Flash page buffer byte by byte in the Shift-DR state by an internal state machine. This is the only active state: • Shift-DR: Flash data are automatically read one byte at a time and shifted out on TDO by the TCK input. The TDI input is ignored. Note: 1. The JTAG instruction PROG_PAGEREAD can only be used if the AVR device is the first device in JTAG scan chain. If the AVR cannot be the first device in the scan chain, the byte-wise programming algorithm must be used. 31.10.7. Data Registers The data registers are selected by the JTAG instruction registers described in section Programming Specific JTAG Instructions on page 414. The data registers relevant for programming operations are: • Reset Register Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 416 • • • • Programming Enable Register Programming Command Register Virtual Flash Page Load Register Virtual Flash Page Read Register 31.10.8. Reset Register The Reset Register is a Test Data Register used to reset the part during programming. It is required to reset the part before entering programming mode. A high value in the Reset Register corresponds to pulling the external Reset low. The part is reset as long as there is a high value present in the Reset Register. Depending on the Fuse settings for the clock options, the part will remain reset for a Reset Time-Out Period (refer to Clock Sources) after releasing the Reset Register. The output from this Data Register is not latched, so the reset will take place immediately, as shown in figure Reset Register. 31.10.9. Programming Enable Register The Programming Enable Register is a 16-bit register. The contents of this register is compared to the programming enable signature, binary code 1010_0011_0111_0000. When the contents of the register is equal to the programming enable signature, programming via the JTAG port is enabled. The Register is reset to 0 on Power-on Reset, and should always be reset when leaving Programming mode. Figure 31-10 Programming Enable Register TDI D A T A $A370 = D Q P rogra mming e na ble ClockDR & P ROG_ENABLE TDO 31.10.10. Programming Command Register The Programming Command Register is a 15-bit register. This register is used to serially shift in programming commands, and to serially shift out the result of the previous command, if any. The JTAG Programming Instruction Set is shown in the following table. The state sequence when shifting in the programming commands is illustrated in State Machine Sequence for Changing/Reading the Data Word further down in this section. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 417 Figure 31-11 Programming Command Register TDI S T R O B E S Fla s h EEP ROM Fus e s Lock Bits A D D R E S S / D A T A TDO Table 31-18 JTAG Programming Instruction Set a = address high bits, b = address low bits, H = 0 - Low byte, 1 - High Byte, o = data out, i = data in, x = don’t care Instruction TDI sequence TDO sequence 1a. Chip erase 0100011_10000000 0110001_10000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110011_10000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110011_10000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 1b. Poll for chip erase complete 0110011_10000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx 2a. Enter Flash Write 0100011_00010000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 2b. Load Address High Byte 0000111_aaaaaaaa xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 2c. Load Address Low Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 2d. Load Data Low Byte 0010011_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 2e. Load Data High Byte 0010111_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 2f. Latch Data 0110111_00000000 1110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx Notes (2) (9) (1) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 418 Instruction TDI sequence TDO sequence Notes 2g. Write Flash Page 0110111_00000000 0110101_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (1) 0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 2h. Poll for Page Write complete 0110111_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx 3a. Enter Flash Read 0100011_00000010 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 3b. Load Address High Byte 0000111_aaaaaaaa xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 3c. Load Address Low Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 3d. Read Data Low and High Byte 0110010_00000000 0110110_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_oooooooo 0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo 4a. Enter EEPROM Write 0100011_00010001 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 4b. Load Address High Byte 0000111_aaaaaaaa xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 4c. Load Address Low Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 4d. Load Data Byte 0010011_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 4e. Latch Data 0110111_00000000 1110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110011_00000000 0110001_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 4g. Poll for Page Write complete 0110011_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx 5a. Enter EEPROM Read 0100011_00000011 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 5b. Load Address High Byte 0000111_aaaaaaaa xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 5c. Load Address Low Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 5d. Read Data Byte 0110011_bbbbbbbb 0110010_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo 6a. Enter Fuse Write 0100011_01000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 6b. Load Data Low Byte(6) 0010011_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 4f. Write EEPROM Page (2) (9) low byte high byte (9) (1) (1) (2) (9) (3) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 419 Instruction TDI sequence TDO sequence Notes 6c. Write Fuse Extended byte 0111011_00000000 0111001_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (1) 0111011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0111011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 6d. Poll for Fuse Write complete 0110111_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx (2) 6e. Load Data Low Byte(7) 0010011_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (3) 6f. Write Fuse High byte 0110111_00000000 0110101_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (1) 0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 6g. Poll for Fuse Write complete 0110111_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx (2) 6h. Load Data Low Byte(7) 0010011_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (3) 6i. Write Fuse Low byte 0110011_00000000 0110001_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (1) 0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 6j. Poll for Fuse Write complete 0110011_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx 7a. Enter Lock bit Write 0100011_00100000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 7b. Load Data Byte(9) 0010011_11iiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (4) 7c. Write Lock bits 0110011_00000000 0110001_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (1) 0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 7d. Poll for Lock bit Write complete 0110011_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx 8a. Enter Fuse/Lock bit Read 0100011_00000100 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 8b. Read Extended Fuse Byte(6) 0111010_00000000 0111011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_oooooooo 8c. Read Fuse High Byte(7) 0111110_00000000 0111111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_oooooooo 8d. Read Fuse Low Byte(8) 0110010_00000000 0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_oooooooo 8e. Read Lock bits(9) 0110110_00000000 0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxoooooo (2) (2) (5) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 420 Instruction TDI sequence TDO sequence Notes 8f. Read Fuses and Lock bits 0111010_00000000 0111110_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_oooooooo (5) fuse ext. byte 0110010_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo fuse high byte 0110110_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo fuse low byte 0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo lock bits 9a. Enter Signature Byte Read 0100011_00001000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 9b. Load Address Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 9c. Read Signature Byte 0110010_00000000 0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_oooooooo 10a. Enter Calibration Byte Read 0100011_00001000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 10b. Load Address Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx 10c. Read Calibration Byte 0110110_00000000 0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_oooooooo 11a. Load No Operation Command 0100011_00000000 0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx Note: 1. This command sequence is not required if the seven MSB are correctly set by the previous command sequence (which is normally the case). 2. Repeat until o = “1”. 3. Set bits to “0” to program the corresponding fuse, “1” to unprogram the Fuse. 4. Set bits to “0” to program the corresponding lock bit, “1” to leave the Lock bit unchanged. 5. “0” = programmed, “1” = unprogrammed. 6. The bit mapping for Fuses Extended byte is listed in Extended Fuse Byte table of Fuse Bits section. 7. The bit mapping for Fuses High byte is listed in Fuse High Byte table of Fuse Bits section. 8. The bit mapping for Fuses Low byte is listed in Fuse Low Byte table of Fuse Bits section. 9. The bit mapping for Lock bits byte is listed in Lock Bit Byte table of Program and Data Memory Lock Bits section. 10. Address bits exceeding PCMSB and EEAMSB (Command Byte Bit Coding in Signal Names section and Page Size section) are don’t care Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 421 Figure 31-12 State Machine Sequence for Changing/Reading the Data Word 1 Te s t-Logic-Re s e t 0 0 Run-Te s t/Idle 1 S e le ct-DR S ca n 1 S e le ct-IR S ca n 0 0 1 1 Ca pture -DR Ca pture -IR 0 0 S hift-DR S hift-IR 0 1 Exit1-DR 1 Exit1-IR 0 0 Pa us e -DR 0 0 Pa us e -IR 1 1 0 Exit2-DR Exit2-IR 1 1 Upda te -DR 1 0 1 1 0 1 Upda te -IR 0 1 0 31.10.11. Virtual Flash Page Load Register The Virtual Flash Page Load Register is a virtual scan chain with length equal to the number of bits in one Flash page. Internally the Shift Register is 8-bit, and the data are automatically transferred to the Flash page buffer byte by byte. Shift in all instruction words in the page, starting with the LSB of the first instruction in the page and ending with the MSB of the last instruction in the page. This provides an efficient way to load the entire Flash page buffer before executing Page Write. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 422 Figure 31-13 Virtual Flash Page Load Register S TROBES TDI S ta te ma chine ADDRES S Fla s h EEP ROM Fus e s Lock Bits D A T A TDO 31.10.12. Virtual Flash Page Read Register The Virtual Flash Page Read Register is a virtual scan chain with length equal to the number of bits in one Flash page plus 8. Internally the Shift Register is 8-bit, and the data are automatically transferred from the Flash data page byte by byte. The first eight cycles are used to transfer the first byte to the internal Shift Register, and the bits that are shifted out during these 8 cycles should be ignored. Following this initialization, data are shifted out starting with the LSB of the first instruction in the page and ending with the MSB of the last instruction in the page. This provides an efficient way to read one full Flash page to verify programming. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 423 Figure 31-14 Virtual Flash Page Read Register S TROBES TDI S ta te ma chine ADDRES S Fla s h EEP ROM Fus e s Lock Bits D A T A TDO 31.10.13. Programming Algorithm All references below of type “1a”, “1b”, and so on, refer to Table 31-18 JTAG Programming Instruction Set on page 418. 31.10.14. Entering Programming Mode 1. 2. Enter JTAG instruction AVR_RESET and shift 1 in the Reset Register. Enter instruction PROG_ENABLE and shift 1010_0011_0111_0000 in the Programming Enable Register. 31.10.15. Leaving Programming Mode 1. 2. 3. 4. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Disable all programming instructions by using no operation instruction 11a. Enter instruction PROG_ENABLE and shift 0000_0000_0000_0000 in the programming Enable Register. Enter JTAG instruction AVR_RESET and shift 0 in the Reset Register. 31.10.16. Performing Chip Erase 1. 2. 3. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Start chip erase using programming instruction 1a. Poll for chip erase complete using programming instruction 1b, or wait for tWLRH_CE (refer to table Command Byte Bit Coding in section Parallel Programming Parameters, Pin Mapping, and Commands). 31.10.17. Programming the Flash Before programming the Flash a Chip Erase must be performed. See Performing Chip Erase on page 424. 1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 424 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Enable Flash write using programming instruction 2a. Load address high byte using programming instruction 2b. Load address low byte using programming instruction 2c. Load data using programming instructions 2d, 2e and 2f. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for all instruction words in the page. Write the page using programming instruction 2g. Poll for Flash write complete using programming instruction 2h, or wait for tWLRH (refer to table Parallel Programming Characteristics, VCC = 5V ±10% in chapter Parallel Programming Characteristics). 9. Repeat steps 3 to 7 until all data have been programmed. A more efficient data transfer can be achieved using the PROG_PAGELOAD instruction: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Enable Flash write using programming instruction 2a. Load the page address using programming instructions 2b and 2c. PCWORD (refer to Command Byte Bit Coding table in Signal Names section) is used to address within one page and must be written as 0. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_PAGELOAD. Load the entire page by shifting in all instruction words in the page, starting with the LSB of the first instruction in the page and ending with the MSB of the last instruction in the page. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Write the page using programming instruction 2g. Poll for Flash write complete using programming instruction 2h, or wait for tWLRH (refer to table Parallel Programming Characteristics, VCC = 5V ±10% in chapter Parallel Programming Characteristics). Repeat steps 3 to 8 until all data have been programmed. 31.10.18. Reading the Flash 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Enable Flash read using programming instruction 3a. Load address using programming instructions 3b and 3c. Read data using programming instruction 3d. Repeat steps 3 and 4 until all data have been read. A more efficient data transfer can be achieved using the PROG_PAGEREAD instruction: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Enable Flash read using programming instruction 3a. Load the page address using programming instructions 3b and 3c. PCWORD (refer to table Command Byte Bit Coding in section Parallel Programming Parameters, Pin Mapping, and Commands) is used to address within one page and must be written as 0. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_PAGEREAD. Read the entire page by shifting out all instruction words in the page, starting with the LSB of the first instruction in the page and ending with the MSB of the last instruction in the page. Remember that the first 8 bits shifted out should be ignored. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Repeat steps 3 to 6 until all data have been read. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 425 31.10.19. Programming the EEPROM Before programming the EEPROM a Chip Erase must be performed. See Performing Chip Erase on page 424. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Enable EEPROM write using programming instruction 4a. Load address high byte using programming instruction 4b. Load address low byte using programming instruction 4c. Load data using programming instructions 4d and 4e. 6. 7. 8. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for all data bytes in the page. Write the data using programming instruction 4f. Poll for EEPROM write complete using programming instruction 4g, or wait for tWLRH (refer to table Parallel Programming Characteristics, VCC = 5V ±10% in chapter Parallel Programming Characteristics). Repeat steps 3 to 8 until all data have been programmed. 9. Note that the PROG_PAGELOAD instruction can not be used when programming the EEPROM 31.10.20. Reading the EEPROM 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Enable EEPROM read using programming instruction 5a. Load address using programming instructions 5b and 5c. Read data using programming instruction 5d. Repeat steps 3 and 4 until all data have been read. Note that the PROG_PAGEREAD instruction can not be used when reading the EEPROM 31.10.21. Programming the Fuses 1. 2. 3. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Enable Fuse write using programming instruction 6a. Load data byte using programming instructions 6b. A bit value of “0” will program the corresponding fuse, a “1” will unprogram the fuse. 4. Write Extended Fuse byte using programming instruction 6c. 5. Poll for Fuse write complete using programming instruction 6d, or wait for tWLRH (refer to table Parallel Programming Characteristics, VCC = 5V ±10% in chapter Parallel Programming Characteristics). 6. Load data byte using programming instructions 6e. A bit value of “0” will program the corresponding fuse, a “1” will unprogram the fuse. 7. Write Fuse high byte using programming instruction 6f. 8. Poll for Fuse write complete using programming instruction 6g, or wait for tWLRH (refer to table Parallel Programming Characteristics, VCC = 5V ±10% in chapter Parallel Programming Characteristics). 9. Load data byte using programming instructions 6h. A “0” will program the fuse, a “1” will unprogram the fuse. 10. Write Fuse low byte using programming instruction 6i. 11. Poll for Fuse write complete using programming instruction 6j, or wait for tWLRH (refer to table Parallel Programming Characteristics, VCC = 5V ±10% in chapter Parallel Programming Characteristics). Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 426 31.10.22. Programming the Lock Bits 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Enable Lock bit write using programming instruction 7a. Load data using programming instructions 7b. A bit value of “0” will program the corresponding lock bit, a “1” will leave the lock bit unchanged. Write Lock bits using programming instruction 7c. Poll for Lock bit write complete using programming instruction 7d, or wait for tWLRH (refer to table Parallel Programming Characteristics, VCC = 5V ±10% in chapter Parallel Programming Characteristics). 31.10.23. Reading the Fuses and Lock Bits 1. 2. 3. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Enable Fuse/Lock bit read using programming instruction 8a. – To read all Fuses and Lock bits, use programming instruction 8f. – To only read Extended Fuse byte, use programming instruction 8b. – To only read Fuse high byte, use programming instruction 8c. – To only read Fuse low byte, use programming instruction 8d. – To only read Lock bits, use programming instruction 8e. 31.10.24. Reading the Signature Bytes 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Enable Signature byte read using programming instruction 9a. Load address 0x00 using programming instruction 9b. Read first signature byte using programming instruction 9c. Repeat steps 3 and 4 with address 0x01 and address 0x02 to read the second and third signature bytes, respectively. 31.10.25. Reading the Calibration Byte 1. 2. 3. 4. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS. Enable Calibration byte read using programming instruction 10a. Load address 0x00 using programming instruction 10b. Read the calibration byte using programming instruction 10c. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 427 32. Electrical Characteristics 32.1. Absolute Maximum Ratings Table 32-1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Operating Temperature -40°C to +105°C Storage Temperature -65°C to +150°C Voltage on any Pin except RESET with respect to Ground -0.5V to VCC+0.5V Voltage on RESET with respect to Ground -0.5V to +13.0V Maximum Operating Voltage 6.0V DC Current per I/O Pin 40.0mA DC Current VCC and GND Pins 100.0mA Note: Stresses beyond those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or other conditions beyond those indicated in the operational sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. 32.2. DC Characteristics Table 32-2 Common DC characteristics TA = -40°C to 105°C, VCC = 1.8V to 5.5V (unless otherwise noted) (Continued) Symbol Parameter Condition Min. VIL VCC = 1.8V - 2.4V -0.5 0.2VCC(1) V VCC = 2.4V - 5.5V -0.5 0.3VCC(1) 0.7VCC(2) VCC + 0.5 V 0.6VCC(2) VCC + 0.5 VIH Input Low Voltage, except XTAL1 and RESET pin Input High Voltage, except XTAL1 VCC = 1.8V - 2.4V and RESET pins VCC = 2.4V - 5.5V Typ. Max. Units VIL1 Input Low Voltage, XTAL1 pin VCC = 1.8V - 5.5V -0.5 0.1VCC(1) V VIH1 Input High Voltage, XTAL1 pin VCC = 1.8V - 2.4V 0.8VCC(2) VCC + 0.5 V VCC = 2.4V - 5.5V 0.7VCC(2) VCC + 0.5 VIL2 Input Low Voltage, RESET pin VCC = 1.8V - 5.5V -0.5 0.1VCC(1) V VIH2 Input High Voltage, RESET pin VCC = 1.8V - 5.5V 0.9VCC(2) VCC + 0.5 V VIL3 Input Low Voltage, RESET pin as I/O VCC = 1.8V - 2.4V -0.5 0.2VCC(1) V VCC = 2.4V - 5.5V -0.5 0.3VCC(1) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 428 Symbol Parameter Condition Min. VIH3 VCC = 1.8V - 2.4V 0.7VCC(2) VCC + 0.5 V VCC = 2.4V - 5.5V 0.6VCC(2) VCC + 0.5 VOL VOH Input High Voltage, RESET pin as I/O Output Low Voltage(4) except RESET pin Output High Voltage(3) except Reset pin Typ. Max. IOL = 20mA, TA=85°C TA=105°C VCC = 5V 0.9 IOL = 10mA, TA=85°C TA=105°C VCC = 3V 0.6 Units V 1.0 0.7 IOH = 20mA, TA=85°C 4.0 TA=105°C 3.9 VCC = 5V V IOH = 10mA, TA=85°C 2.1 TA=105°C 2.0 VCC = 3V IIL Input Leakage Current I/O Pin VCC = 5.5V, pin low (absolute value) 1 μA IIH Input Leakage Current I/O Pin VCC = 5.5V, pin high (absolute value) 1 μA RRST Reset Pull-up Resistor 30 60 kΩ RPU I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor 20 50 kΩ VACIO Analog Comparator Input Offset Voltage <10 40 mV 50 nA VCC = 5V, Vin = VCC/2 IACLK Analog Comparator Input Leakage Current -50 VCC=5V , Vin = VCC/2 tACID Analog Comparator Propagation Delay 400 ns Note: 1. “Max.” means the highest value where the pin is guaranteed to be read as low. 2. “Min.” means the lowest value where the pin is guaranteed to be read as high. 3. Although each I/O port can source more than the test conditions (20mA at VCC = 5V, 10mA at VCC = 3V) under steady state conditions (non-transient), the following must be observed: 3.1. The sum of all IOH, for ports C0 - C5, D0- D4, ADC7, RESET should not exceed 100mA. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 429 3.2. 4. The sum of all IOH, for ports B0 - B5, D5 - D7, ADC6, XTAL1, XTAL2 should not exceed 100mA. If IIOH exceeds the test condition, VOH may exceed the related specification. Pins are not guaranteed to source current greater than the listed test condition. Although each I/O port can sink more than the test conditions (20mA at VCC = 5V, 10mA at VCC = 3V) under steady state conditions (non-transient), the following must be observed: 4.1. The sum of all IOL, for ports C0 - C5, ADC7, ADC6 should not exceed 100mA. 4.2. The sum of all IOL, for ports B0 - B5, D5 - D7, XTAL1, XTAL2 should not exceed 100mA. 4.3. The sum of all IOL, for ports D0 - D4, RESET should not exceed 100mA. If IOL exceeds the test condition, VOL may exceed the related specification. Pins are not guaranteed to sink current greater than the listed test condition. Related Links Minimizing Power Consumption on page 61 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 430 32.2.1. Power Consumption Table 32-3 ATmega324PB DC Characteristics - TA = -40°C to 105°C, VCC = 1.8V to 5.5V (unless otherwise noted) Symbol Parameter ICC Power Supply Current(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Condition Active 1MHz, VCC = 2V Active 4MHz, VCC = 3V Active 8MHz, VCC = 5V Idle 1MHz, VCC = 2V Idle 4MHz, VCC = 3V Idle 8MHz, VCC = 5V Power-save mode(3) 32kHz TOSC enabled, VCC = 1.8V 32kHz TOSC enabled, VCC = 3V Power-down mode(3)(4) WDT enabled, VCC = 3V WDT disabled, VCC = 3V T=85°C - 0.3 0.5 T=105°C - 0.3 0.7 T=85°C - 1.3 2.7 T=105°C - 1.3 3.0 T=85°C - 5.2 9.0 T=105°C - 5.2 11 T=85°C - 0.06 0.15 T=105°C - 0.06 0.17 T=85°C - 0.32 0.7 T=105°C - 0.32 0.85 T=85°C - 1.4 5.0 T=105°C - 1.4 6.0 T = 25°C - TBD - T = 85°C - TBD - T = 105°C - TBD - T = 25°C - TBD - T = 85°C - TBD - T = 105°C - TBD - T = 25°C - 2.9 - T = 85°C - 3.8 8 T = 105°C - 4.2 15 T = 25°C - 0.24 - T = 85°C - 0.7 2 T = 105°C - 1.3 5 mA μA Note: 1. Values with Minimizing Power Consumption enabled (0xFF). 2. Typical values are at 25°C unless otherwise noted. 3. The current consumption values include input leakage current. Note: No clock is applied to the pad during power-down mode. Related Links Minimizing Power Consumption on page 61 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 431 32.3. Speed Grades Maximum frequency is dependent on VCC. As shown in Figure. Maximum Frequency vs. VCC, the Maximum Frequency vs. VCC curve is linear between 1.8V < VCC < 2.7V and between 2.7V < VCC < 4.5V. Figure 32-1 Maximum Frequency vs. VCC 20MHz 10MHz Safe Operating Area 4MHz 1.8V 2.7V 32.4. Clock Characteristics 32.4.1. Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator Accuracy 4.5V 5.5V Table 32-4 Calibration Accuracy of Internal RC Oscillator Factory Calibration User Calibration Frequency VCC Temperature Calibration Accuracy 8.0MHz 2.7V - 4.2V 0°C to +50°C ±2% 8.0MHz 1.8V - 5.5V 0°C to +70°C ±3.5% 8.0MHz 1.8V - 5.5V -40°C to +105°C ±5% 7.3 - 8.1MHz 1.8V - 5.5V -40°C to - 85°C ±1% Table 32-5 Capacitance for Low-Frequency Oscillator (TBD) 32kHz Osc. Type Cap. (XTAL1/TOSC1) Cap. (XTAL2/TSOC2) System Osc. 18pF 8pF Timer Osc. 6pF 6pF Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 432 32.4.2. External Clock Drive Waveforms Figure 32-2 External Clock Drive Waveforms VIH1 VIL1 32.4.3. External Clock Drive Table 32-6 External Clock Drive Symbol Parameter 32.5. VCC= 1.8 - 5.5V VCC= 2.7 - 5.5V VCC= 4.5 - 5.5V Units Min. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max. 1/tCLCL Oscillator Frequency 0 4 0 10 0 20 MHz tCLCL Clock Period 250 - 100 - 50 - ns tCHCX High Time 100 - 40 - 20 - ns tCLCX Low Time 100 - 40 - 20 - ns tCLCH Rise Time - 2.0 - 1.6 - 0.5 μs tCHCL Fall Time - 2.0 - 1.6 - 0.5 μs ΔtCLCL Change in period from one clock cycle to the next - 2 - 2 - 2 % System and Reset Characteristics Table 32-7 Reset, Brown-out and Internal Voltage Characteristics(1) Symbol Parameter Min. Typ Max Units Power-on Reset Threshold Voltage (rising) 0.7 1.0 1.4 V Power-on Reset Threshold Voltage (falling)(2) 0.6 0.9 1.3 V SRON Power-on Slope Rate 0.01 - 10 V/ms VRST RESET Pin Threshold Voltage 0.2 VCC - 0.9 VCC V tRST Minimum pulse width on RESET Pin - - 2.5 μs VHYST Brown-out Detector Hysteresis - 50 - mV tBOD Min. Pulse Width on Brown-out Reset - 2 - μs VBG Bandgap reference voltage 1.0 1.1 1.2 V VPOT Condition VCC=2.7 TA=25°C Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 433 Symbol Parameter Condition Min. Typ Max Units tBG Bandgap reference start-up time VCC=2.7 TA=25°C - 40 70 μs IBG Bandgap reference current consumption VCC=2.7 TA=25°C - 10 - μA Note: 1. Values are guidelines only. 2. The Power-on Reset will not work unless the supply voltage has been below VPOT (falling) Related Links Fuse Bits on page 397 32.6. SPI Timing Characteristics Table 32-8 SPI Timing Parameters Description Mode SCK period Typ Max Units Master - See Table. Relationship Between SCK and the Oscillator Frequency in "SPCR – SPI Control Register" - SCK high/low Master - 50% duty cycle - Rise/Fall time Master - 3.6 - Setup Master - 10 - Hold Master - 10 - Out to SCK Master - 0.5 • tsck - SCK to out Master - 10 - SCK to out high Master - 10 - SS low to out Slave - 15 - SCK period Slave 4 • tck - - SCK high/low(1) Slave 2 • tck - - Rise/Fall time Slave - - 1600 Setup Slave 10 - - Hold Slave tck - - SCK to out Slave - 15 - SCK to SS high Slave 20 - - 10 - SS high to tri-state Slave SS low to SCK Slave Min. 2 • tck - ns - Note: In SPI Programming mode the minimum SCK high/low period is: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 434 • • 2 tCLCL for fCK < 12MHz 3 tCLCL for fCK > 12MHz Figure 32-3 SPI Interface Timing Requirements (Master Mode) SS 6 1 SCK (CPOL = 0) 2 2 SCK (CPOL = 1) 4 MISO (Data Input) 5 3 MSB ... LSB 7 MOSI (Data Output) 8 MSB ... LSB Figure 32-4 SPI Interface Timing Requirements (Slave Mode) SS 10 9 16 SCK (CPOL = 0) 11 11 SCK (CPOL = 1) 13 MOSI (Data Input) 14 12 ... MSB LSB 15 MISO (Data Output) 32.7. 17 MSB ... LSB X Two-wire Serial Interface Characteristics Table in this section describes the requirements for devices connected to the 2-wire Serial Bus. The 2wire Serial Interface meets or exceeds these requirements under the noted conditions. Timing symbols refer to Figure 1. Table 32-9 Two-wire Serial Bus Requirements Symbol Parameter Condition Min. Max Units V VIL Input Low-voltage -0.5 0.3 VCC VIH Input High-voltage 0.7 VCC VCC + 0.5 V Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 435 Symbol Parameter Vhys(1) Hysteresis of Schmitt Trigger Inputs VOL(1) Output Low-voltage tr(1) Rise Time for both SDA and SCL tof(1) Output Fall Time from VIHmin to VILmax tSP(1) Spikes Suppressed by Input Filter Ii Input Current each I/O Pin Ci(1) Capacitance for each I/O Pin fSCL SCL Clock Frequency Rp Value of Pull-up resistor tHD;STA tLOW tHIGH tSU;STA tHD;DAT tSU;DAT tSU;STO tBUF Hold Time (repeated) START Condition Low Period of the SCL Clock High period of the SCL clock Set-up time for a repeated START condition Data hold time Data setup time Setup time for STOP condition Bus free time between a STOP and START condition Condition 3mA sink current 10pF < Cb < 400pF(3) Min. Max Units 0.05 VCC(2) – V 0 0.4 V 20 + 0.1Cb(3)(2) 300 ns 20 + 0.1Cb(3)(2) 250 ns 0 50(2) ns -10 10 μA – 10 pF fCK(4) > max(16fSCL, 250kHz)(5) 0 400 kHz fSCL ≤ 100kHz 1000ns �� � fSCL > 100kHz �CC + − 0 3mA 0.1VCC < Vi < 0.9VCC fSCL ≤ 100kHz �CC + − 0 3mA 4.0 300ns �� – μs fSCL > 100kHz 0.6 – μs fSCL ≤ 100kHz 4.7 – μs fSCL > 100kHz 1.3 – μs fSCL ≤ 100kHz 4.0 – μs fSCL > 100kHz 0.6 – μs fSCL ≤ 100kHz 4.7 – μs fSCL > 100kHz 0.6 – μs fSCL ≤ 100kHz 0 3.45 μs fSCL > 100kHz 0 0.9 μs fSCL ≤ 100kHz 250 – ns fSCL > 100kHz 100 – ns fSCL ≤ 100kHz 4.0 – μs fSCL > 100kHz 0.6 – μs fSCL ≤ 100kHz 4.7 – μs fSCL > 100kHz 1.3 – μs � Note: Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 436 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. This parameter is characterized and not 100% tested. Required only for fSCL > 100kHz. Cb = capacitance of one bus line in pF. fCK = CPU clock frequency. This requirement applies to all 2-wire Serial Interface operation. Other devices connected to the 2wire Serial Bus need only obey the general fSCL requirement. Figure 32-5 Two-wire Serial Bus Timing t of t HIGH t LOW tr t LOW SCL t SU;STA t HD;STA t HD;DAT t SU;DAT t SU;STO SDA t BUF 32.8. ADC Characteristics Table 32-10 ADC Characteristics, Single Ended Channel Symbol Parameter Condition Min. Typ Max Units - 10 - Bits VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, ADC clock = 200kHz - 3.3 - LSB VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, ADC clock = 1MHz - 3.5 - LSB VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, ADC clock = 200kHz Noise Reduction Mode - 2.75 - LSB VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, ADC clock = 1MHz Noise Reduction Mode - 3.5 - LSB Integral Non-Linearity (INL) VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, ADC clock = 200kHz - 1.5 - LSB Differential Non-Linearity (DNL) VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, ADC clock = 200kHz - 0.3 - LSB Gain Error VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, ADC clock = 200kHz - 2.5 - LSB Offset Error VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, ADC clock = 200kHz - 2.5 - LSB Conversion Time Free Running Conversion 13 - 260 μs Clock Frequency 50 - 1000 kHz Resolution Absolute accuracy (Including INL, DNL, quantization error, gain and offset error) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 437 Symbol Parameter Condition Min. Typ Max Units AVCC(1) Analog Supply Voltage VCC - 0.3 - VCC + 0.3 V VREF Reference Voltage 1.0 - AVCC V VIN Input Voltage GND - VREF V Input Bandwidth - 38.5 - kHz VINT Internal Voltage Reference 1.0 1.1 1.2 V RREF Reference Input Resistance - 32 - kΩ RAIN Analog Input Resistance - 100 - MΩ Note: 1. AVCC absolute min./max: 1.8V/5.5V Table 32-11 ADC Characteristics, Differential Channels Symbol Parameter Condition Min Typ Max Units Resolution Gain = 1× - 10 - Bits Gain = 10× - 10 - Gain = 200× - 7 - Gain = 1×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz - 19.5 - Gain = 10×, VCC = 5 V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz - 20.5 - 8.5 - Absolute Accuracy (Including INL, DNL Quantization Error and Offset Error) Gain = 200×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz LSB Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 438 Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Units Integral Non- Gain = 1×, linearity (INL) VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz - 2.25 - LSB Gain = 10×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz - 4.25 - Gain = 200×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz 11.5 - Gain = 1×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz - 0.75 - Gain = 10×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz - 0.75 - Gain = 200×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz 9.5 - Gain = 1×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz - 19.5 - Gain = 10×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz - 19.5 - 6.5 - Differential Non-linearity (DNL) Gain Error Condition Gain = 200×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz LSB LSB Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 439 Symbol Parameter Condition Min Typ Max Units Gain = 1×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz - 1 - LSB Gain = 10×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz - 1.25 - 2.5 - Gain = 200×, VCC = 5V, VREF = 4V ADC clock = 200 kHz Conversion Time 13 - 260 μs Clock Frequency 50 - 1000 kHz AVCC Analog Supply Voltage VCC - 0.3 - VCC + 0.3 V VREF Reference Voltage 2.0 - AVCC - 0.5 VIN Input Differential Voltage 0 - AVCC ADC Conversion Output -511 - 511 LSB Input Bandwidth - 4 - kHz V VINT1 Internal Voltage Reference 1.1V 1.0 1.1 1.2 VINT2 Internal Voltage Reference 2.56V 2.33 2.56 2.79 RREF Reference Input Resistance - 32 - kΩ Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 440 32.9. Parallel Programming Characteristics Table 32-12 Parallel programming characteristics, VCC = 5V ±10%. Symbol Parameter Min. Typ. Max. Units VPP Programming Enable Voltage 11.5 - 12.5 V IPP Programming Enable Current - 250 µA tDVXH Data and Control Valid before XTAL1 High 67 - - ns tXLXH XTAL1 Low to XTAL1 High 200 - - ns tXHXL XTAL1 Pulse Width High 150 - - ns tXLDX Data and Control Hold after XTAL1 Low 67 - - ns tXLWL XTAL1 Low to WR Low 0 - - ns tXLPH XTAL1 Low to PAGEL high 0 - - ns tPLXH PAGEL low to XTAL1 high 150 - - ns tBVPH BS1 Valid before PAGEL High 67 - - ns tPHPL PAGEL Pulse Width High 150 - - ns tPLBX BS1 Hold after PAGEL Low 67 - - ns tWLBX BS2/1 Hold after WR Low 67 - - ns tPLWL PAGEL Low to WR Low 67 - - ns tBVWL BS2/1 Valid to WR Low 67 - - ns tWLWH WR Pulse Width Low 150 - - ns tWLRL WR Low to RDY/BSY Low 0 - 1 µs tWLRH WR Low to RDY/BSY High(1) 3.7 - 4.5 ms tWLRH_CE WR Low to RDY/BSY High for Chip Erase(2) 7.5 - 9 tXLOL XTAL1 Low to OE Low 0 - - tBVDV BS1 Valid to DATA valid 0 - 250 tOLDV OE Low to DATA Valid - - 250 tOHDZ OE High to DATA Tri-stated - - 250 ns Note: 1. tWLRH is valid for the Write Flash, Write EEPROM, Write Fuse bits and Write Lock bits commands. 2. tWLRH_CE is valid for the Chip Erase command. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 441 Figure 32-6 Parallel programming timing, including some general timing requirements. tXLWL tXHXL XTAL1 tDVXH Da ta & Contol (DATA, XA0/1, BS 1, BS 2) tXLDX tP LBX t BVWL tBVP H P AGEL tWLBX tP HP L tWLWH WR tP LWL WLRL RDY/BS Y tWLRH Figure 32-7 Parallel programming timing, loading sequence with timing requirements . LOAD ADDRESS (LOW BYTE) LOAD DATA LOAD DATA (HIGH BYTE) LOAD DATA (LOW BYTE) tXLP H t XLXH LOAD ADDRESS (LOW BYTE) tP LXH XTAL1 BS1 PAGEL DATA ADDR0 (Low Byte) DATA (Low Byte) DATA (High Byte) ADDR1 (Low Byte) XA0 XA1 Note: The timing requirements shown in Figure 32-6 Parallel programming timing, including some general timing requirements. on page 442 (that is, tDVXH, tXHXL, and tXLDX) also apply to loading operation. Figure 32-8 Parallel programming timing, reading sequence (within the same page) with timing requirements LOAD ADDRESS (LOW BYTE) READ DATA (LOW BYTE) READ DATA (HIGH BYTE) LOAD ADDRESS (LOW BYTE) tXLOL XTAL1 tBVDV BS1 tOLDV OE DATA tOHDZ ADDR0 (Low Byte) DATA (Low Byte) DATA (High Byte) ADDR1 (Low Byte) XA0 XA1 Note: The timing requirements shown in Figure 32-6 Parallel programming timing, including some general timing requirements. on page 442 (that is, tDVXH, tXHXL, and tXLDX) also apply to loading operation. Related Links Parallel Programming Characteristics on page 409 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 442 33. Typical Characteristics 33.1. Active Supply Current Figure 33-1 ATmega324PB: Active Supply Current vs. Low Frequency (0.1-1.0MHz) 0.8 0.7 ICC (mA) 0.6 Vcc [V] 0.5 5.5 0.4 5 4.5 0.3 4 0.2 3.3 0.1 2.7 1.8 0 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1 Fre que ncy (MHz) Figure 33-2 ATmega324PB: Active Supply Current vs. Frequency (1-20MHz) 14 12 Vcc [V] 10 ICC (mA) 5.5 8 5 4.5 6 4 4 3.6 2 2.7 1.8 0 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 Fre que ncy (MHz) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 443 33.2. Idle Supply Current Figure 33-3 ATmega324PB: Idle Supply Current vs. Low Frequency (0.1-1.0MHz) 0.2 0.18 0.16 Vcc [V] ICC (mA) 0.14 5.5 0.12 5 0.1 0.08 4.5 0.06 4 0.04 3.6 0.02 2.7 1.8 0 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1 Fre que ncy (MHz) Figure 33-4 ATmega324PB: Idle Supply Current vs. Frequency (1-20MHz) 4 3.5 Vcc [V] 3 5.5 ICC (mA) 2.5 5 2 4.5 1.5 4 1 3.6 0.5 2.7 1.8 0 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 Fre que ncy (MHz) Power-down Supply Current Figure 33-5 ATmega324PB: Power-Down Supply Current vs. VCC (Watchdog Timer Disabled) 4 3.5 3 2.5 ICC (uA) 33.3. Temperature [°C] 2 105 1.5 85 1 25 -40 0.5 0 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 VCC (V) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 444 Figure 33-6 ATmega324PB: Power-Down Supply Current vs. VCC (Watchdog Timer Enabled) 10 9 8 ICC (uA) 7 6 Temperature [°C] 5 105 4 85 3 25 2 -40 1 0 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 VCC (V) Pin Pull-Up I/O PIN PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. INPUT VOLTAGE Vcc = 1.8V vs. Input Voltage (VCC = 1.8V) Figure 33-7 ATmega324PB: I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor Current 60 Temp [°C] 105 50 85 25 40 IOP (uA) 33.4. -40 30 20 10 0 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 VOP (V) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 445 I/O PIN PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. INPUT VOLTAGE Vcc = 2.7V Figure 33-8 ATmega324PB: I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Input Voltage (VCC = 2.7V) IOP (µA) 100 Temp [°C] 90 105 80 85 70 25 60 -40 50 40 30 20 10 0 0 0.3 0.6 0.9 1.2 1.5 1.8 2.1 2.4 2.7 VOP (V) I/O PIN PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. INPUT VOLTAGE = 5V vs. Input Voltage (V Figure 33-9 ATmega324PB: I/O Pin Pull-up ResistorVcc Current CC = 5V) Temp [°C] 200 105 IOP (µA) 180 160 85 140 25 120 -40 100 80 60 40 20 0 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 VOP (V) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 446 Figure 33-10 ATmega324PB: Reset Pull-up ResistorCURRENT Current vs. PinPIN Voltage RESET PULL-UP RESISTOR vs.Reset RESET VOLTAGE Vcc = 1.8V (VCC = 1.8V) 45 Temp [°C] 40 105 35 85 25 IRESET (µA) 30 -40 25 20 15 10 5 0 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 VRESET (V) Figure 33-11 ATmega324PB: Pull-up ResistorCURRENT Current vs.vs. Reset Pin PIN Voltage RESET Reset PULL-UP RESISTOR RESET VOLTAGE Vcc = 2.7V (VCC = 2.7V) Temp [°C] 70 IRESET (µA) 105 60 85 50 25 -40 40 30 20 10 0 0 0.3 0.6 0.9 1.2 1.5 1.8 2.1 2.4 2.7 VRESET (V) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 447 RESET PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. RESET PIN VOLTAGE = 5V vs. Reset Pin Voltage (VCC = 5V) Figure 33-12 ATmega324PB: Reset Pull-up Resistor VCurrent CC 140 Temp [°C] 105 120 85 IRESET (µA) 100 25 -40 80 60 40 20 0 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 VRESET (V) Pin Driver Strength I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SINK CURRENT Figure 33-13 ATmega324PB: I/O Pin Output Voltage vs. Sink NORMAL POWER PINS,Current VCC= 3V (VCC = 3V) 1 VOL (V) 33.5. Temp [°C] 0.9 105 0.8 85 0.7 25 0.6 -40 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 0 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 IOL (mA) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 448 I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SINK CURRENT Figure 33-14 ATmega324PB: I/O Pin Output Voltage vs. Sink Current NORMAL POWER PINS, V = 5V(VCC = 5V) CC 0.6 Temp [°C] 105 0.5 85 25 VOL (V) 0.4 -40 0.3 0.2 0.1 0 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 IOL (mA) I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SOURCE CURRENT Figure 33-15 ATmega324PB: I/O Pin Output Voltage vs. Source (VCC = 3V) NORMAL POWER PINS, VCCCurrent = 3V 3.1 Temp [°C] 105 2.9 85 2.7 25 VOH (V) 2.5 -40 2.3 2.1 1.9 1.7 1.5 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 IOH (mA) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 449 I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SOURCE CURRENT Figure 33-16 ATmega324PB: I/O Pin Output Voltage Source Current NORMALvs. POWER PINS Vcc = 5V(VCC = 5V) 5.1 Temp [°C] 105 VOH (V) 5 4.9 85 4.8 25 4.7 -40 4.6 4.5 4.4 4.3 4.2 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 IOH (mA) Pin Threshold and Hysteresis I/O PIN INPUT THRESHOLD VOLTAGE vs. VCC VIH, IO Voltage PIN READvs. AS V '1'CC (VIH, I/O Pin read as ‘1’) Figure 33-17 ATmega324PB I/O Pin Input Threshold 3.3 Temp [°C] 3.1 105 2.9 85 2.7 Threshold (V) 33.6. 2.5 25 2.3 -40 2.1 1.9 1.7 1.5 1.3 1.1 0.9 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 VCC (V) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 450 I/O PIN INPUT THRESHOLD VOLTAGE vs. VCC VIL, IO PIN READ AS Figure 33-18 ATmega324PB I/O Pin Input Threshold Voltage vs.'0'VCC (VIL, I/O Pin read as ‘0’) 2.1 Temp [°C] 105 Threshold (V) 1.9 85 1.7 25 1.5 -40 1.3 1.1 0.9 0.7 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 VCC (V) BOD Threshold Figure 33-19 ATmega324PB: BOD Thresholds vs. Temperature (BODLEVEL is 1.8V) 1.85 Thre s hold (V) 1.83 1.81 1.79 1 0 1.77 1.75 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 Te mpe ra ture (°C) Figure 33-20 ATmega324PB: BOD Thresholds vs. Temperature (BODLEVEL is 2.7V) 2.9 2.85 2.8 Thre s hold (V) 33.7. 2.75 2.7 2.65 1 2.6 0 2.55 2.5 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 Te mpe ra ture (°C) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 451 Figure 33-21 ATmega324PB: BOD Thresholds vs. Temperature (BODLEVEL is 4.3V) 4.5 4.45 Thre s hold (V) 4.4 4.35 1 4.3 0 4.25 4.2 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 Te mpe ra ture (°C) BANDGAP VOLTAGE vs. TEMPERATURE Figure 33-22 ATmega324PB: Calibrated Bandgap Voltage AREF vs. Temperature 1.125 Vcc [V] 5.5 1.12 5 1.115 4.5 4 BG 1.11 3.6 1.105 3.3 1.1 2.7 1.8 1.095 1.09 -45 -35 -25 -15 -5 5 15 25 35 45 55 65 75 85 95 105 Temperature [°C] Figure 33-23 ATmega324PB: Calibrated Bandgap Voltage vs. Vcc 1.115 1.11 Ba ndga p volta ge [V] 1.105 1.1 Temperature [°C] 1.095 125 1.09 105 1.085 85 1.08 25 1.075 0 1.07 -40 1.065 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 Vcc[V] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 452 Internal Oscillator Speed WATCHDOG OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. TEMPERATURE Figure 33-24 ATmega324PB: Watchdog Oscillator Frequency vs. Temperature 128kHz OSCILLATOR 116000 FRC[Hz] Vcc [V] 115000 5.5 114000 5 3.3 113000 2.7 112000 1.8 111000 110000 109000 -45 -35 -25 -15 -5 5 15 25 35 45 55 65 75 85 95 105 Temperature [°C] Figure 33-25 ATmega324PB: Watchdog Oscillator Frequency vs. VCC 112 111 110 109 F RC (kHz) 33.8. Temperature [°C] 108 105 107 85 106 25 -40 105 104 1.8 2.3 2.8 3.3 3.8 4.3 4.8 5.3 VCC (V) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 453 CALIBRATED 8MHz RC OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. OPERATING VOLTAGE Figure 33-26 ATmega324PB: Calibrated 8MHz RC Oscillator Frequency vs. VCC 8.2 Temp [°C] 8.15 105 8.1 85 FRC [MHz] 8.05 25 8 -40 7.95 7.9 7.85 7.8 7.75 7.7 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 VCC [V] CALIBRATED 8MHz RC OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. TEMPERATURE Figure 33-27 ATmega324PB: Calibrated 8MHz RC Oscillator Frequency vs. Temperature 8.2 Vcc [V] 5.5 8.15 5 FRC [MHz] 8.1 8.05 4.5 8 3.3 2.7 7.95 1.8 7.9 7.85 7.8 7.75 -45 -35 -25 -15 -5 5 15 25 35 45 55 65 75 85 95 105 Temperature [°C] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 454 CALIBRATED 8MHz RC8MHz OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY Figure 33-28 ATmega324PB: Calibrated RC Oscillator Frequencyvs. vs.OSCCAL OSCCALVALUE Value 20 Temp [°C] 18 105 16 85 FRC [MHz] 14 25 12 -40 10 8 6 4 2 0 0 16 32 48 64 80 96 112 128 144 160 176 192 208 224 240 256 OSCCAL (X1) OSCCAL VALUE STEPSIZE IN % Figure 33-29 ATmega324PB: OSCCAL Value StepSize in %. Base Frequency = 8.0MHz Base frequency = 8.0MHz 1.6 1.4 Temp [°C] FRC change (%) 1.2 25 1 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 0 16 32 48 64 80 96 112 128 144 160 176 192 208 224 240 OSCCAL (X1) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 455 Current Consumption in Reset and Reset Pulse Width Figure 33-30 ATmega324PB: Minimum Reset Pulse Width vs. Vcc 1200 1000 P uls e width (ns ) 33.9. 800 Temp [°C] 600 105 85 400 25 -40 200 0 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 VCC (V) Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 456 34. Register Summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x20 PINA 7:0 0x21 DDRA 7:0 DDRA7 DDRA6 DDRA5 DDRA4 DDRA3 DDRA2 DDRA1 DDRA0 0x22 PORTA 7:0 PORTA7 PORTA6 PORTA5 PORTA4 PORTA3 PORTA2 PORTA1 PORTA0 0x23 PINB 7:0 PINB7 PINB6 PINB5 PINB4 PINB3 PINB2 PINB1 PINB0 0x24 DDRB 7:0 DDRB7 DDRB6 DDRB5 DDRB4 DDRB3 DDRB2 DDRB1 DDRB0 0x25 PORTB 7:0 PORTB7 PORTB6 PORTB5 PORTB4 PORTB3 PORTB2 PORTB1 PORTB0 0x26 PINC 7:0 PINC7 PINC6 PINC5 PINC4 PINC3 PINC2 PINC1 PINC0 0x27 DDRC 7:0 DDRC7 DDRC6 DDRC5 DDRC4 DDRC3 DDRC2 DDRC1 DDRC0 0x28 PORTC 7:0 PORTC7 PORTC6 PORTC5 PORTC4 PORTC3 PORTC2 PORTC1 PORTC0 PINA7 PINA6 PINA5 PINA4 PINA3 PINA2 PINA1 PINA0 0x29 PIND 7:0 PIND7 PIND6 PIND5 PIND4 PIND3 PIND2 PIND1 PIND0 0x2A DDRD 7:0 DDRD7 DDRD6 DDRD5 DDRD4 DDRD3 DDRD2 DDRD1 DDRD0 PORTD7 PORTD0 0x2B PORTD 7:0 PORTD6 PORTD5 PORTD4 PORTD3 PORTD2 PORTD1 0x2C PINE 7:0 PINE6 PINE5 PINE4 PINE3 PINE2 PINE1 PINE0 0x2D DDRE 7:0 DDRE6 DDRE5 DDRE4 DDRE3 DDRE2 DDRE1 DDRE0 0x2E PORTE 7:0 PORTE6 PORTE5 PORTE4 PORTE3 PORTE2 PORTE1 PORTE0 OCF0B OCF0A TOV0 OCFB OCFA TOV 0x2F ... Reserved 0x34 0x35 TIFR0 7:0 0x36 TIFR1 7:0 0x37 TIFR2 7:0 OCF2B OCF2A TOV2 0x38 TIFR3 7:0 ICF OCFB OCFA TOV 0x39 TIFR4 7:0 ICF OCFB OCFA TOV 0x3A Reserved 0x3B PCIFR 7:0 PCIF2 PCIF1 PCIF0 0x3C EIFR 7:0 INTF2 INTF1 INTF0 0x3D EIMSK 7:0 INT2 INT1 INT0 0x3E GPIOR0 7:0 0x3F EECR 7:0 EEMPE EEPE EERE 0x40 EEDR 7:0 0x41 EEARL 7:0 EEAR3 EEAR2 EEAR1 EEAR0 0x42 EEARH 7:0 EEAR11 EEAR10 0x43 GTCCR 7:0 TSM ICF PCIF4 PCIF3 GPIOR0[7:0] EEPM1 EEPM0 EERIE EEDR[7:0] EEAR7 EEAR6 EEAR5 COM0B1 EEAR4 0x44 TCCR0A 7:0 COM0A1 COM0A0 0x45 TCCR0B 7:0 FOC0A FOC0B COM0B0 0x46 TCNT0 7:0 TCNT0[7:0] 0x47 OCR0A 7:0 OCR0A[7:0] 0x48 OCR0B 7:0 OCR0B[7:0] 0x49 Reserved 0x4A GPIOR1 7:0 GPIOR1[7:0] 0x4B GPIOR2 7:0 GPIOR2[7:0] 0x4C SPCR0 7:0 SPIE0 SPE0 0x4D SPSR0 7:0 SPIF0 WCOL0 0x4E SPDR0 7:0 WGM02 DORD0 MSTR0 CPOL0 EEAR9 EEAR8 PSRASY PSRSYNC WGM01 WGM00 CS02 CS01 CS00 CPHA0 SPR01 SPR00 SPI2X0 SPID[7:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 457 Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x4F ACSRB 7:0 0x50 ACSR 7:0 ACD ACBG ACO ACI ACIE ACIC ACIS1 ACIS0 0x51 OCDR 7:0 IDRD/OCDR7 OCDR6 OCDR5 OCDR4 OCDR3 OCDR2 OCDR1 OCDR0 0x52 Reserved 0x53 SMCR 7:0 SM2 SM1 SM0 SE 0x54 MCUSR 7:0 WDRF BORF EXTRF PORF 0x55 MCUCR 7:0 JTD BODS BODSE PUD IVSEL IVCE 0x56 Reserved 0x57 SPMCSR 7:0 SPMIE RWWSB SIGRD RWWSRE PGERS SPMEN ACOE JTRF BLBSET PGWRT 0x58 ... Reserved 0x5C 0x5D SPL 7:0 0x5E SPH 7:0 (SP[7:0]) SPL[7:0] 0x5F SREG 7:0 I T H S V 0x60 WDTCSR 7:0 WDIF WDIE WDP[3] WDCE WDE 0x61 CLKPR 7:0 CLKPCE 0x62 XFDCSR 7:0 0x63 PRR2 7:0 0x64 PRR0 7:0 0x65 PRR1 7:0 0x66 OSCCAL 7:0 0x67 Reserved 0x68 PCICR 7:0 0x69 EICRA 7:0 0x6A Reserved 0x6B PCMSK0 7:0 PCINT7 (SP[11:8]) SPH[3:0] PRTWI0 CAL7 PRTIM2 CAL6 PRTIM0 CAL5 PRUSART1 N Z C WDP[2:0] CLKPS3 CLKPS2 CLKPS1 CLKPS0 XFDIF XFDIE PRPTC PRUSART2 PRSPI1 PRTWI1 PRTIM1 PRSPI0 PRUSART0 PRADC PRTIM4 PRTIM3 CAL4 CAL3 CAL2 CAL1 CAL0 PCIE4 PCIE3 PCIE2 PCIE1 PCIE0 ISC21 ISC20 ISC11 ISC10 ISC01 ISC00 PCINT6 PCINT5 PCINT4 PCINT3 PCINT2 PCINT1 PCINT0 0x6C PCMSK1 7:0 PCINT15 PCINT14 PCINT13 PCINT12 PCINT11 PCINT10 PCINT9 PCINT8 0x6D PCMSK2 7:0 PCINT23 PCINT22 PCINT21 PCINT20 PCINT19 PCINT18 PCINT17 PCINT16 0x6E TIMSK0 7:0 OCIE0B OCIE0A TOIE0 0x6F TIMSK1 7:0 0x70 TIMSK2 7:0 0x71 TIMSK3 7:0 0x72 TIMSK4 7:0 OCIEB OCIEA TOIE 0x73 PCMSK3 7:0 PCINT31 PCINT30 PCINT29 PCINT28 PCINT27 PCINT26 PCINT25 PCINT24 0x74 PCMSK4 7:0 PCINT7 PCINT38 PCINT37 PCINT36 PCINT35 PCINT34 PCINT33 PCINT32 ADC7 ADC6 ADC5 ADC4 ADC3 ADC2 ADC1 ADC0 ADC9 ADC8 ADPS2 ADPS1 ADPS0 ADTS2 ADTS1 ADTS0 ICIE ICIE ICIE OCIEB OCIEA TOIE OCIE2B OCIE2A TOIE2 OCIEB OCIEA TOIE 0x75 ... Reserved 0x77 0x78 ADCL 7:0 0x79 ADCH 7:0 0x7A ADCSRA 7:0 0x7B ADCSRB 7:0 0x7C ADMUX 7:0 REFS1 REFS0 ADLAR MUX4 MUX3 MUX2 MUX1 MUX0 0x7D Reserved 0x7E DIDR0 7:0 ADC7D ADC6D ADC5D ADC4D ADC3D ADC2D ADC1D ADC0D 0x7F DIDR1 7:0 AIN1D AIN0D ADEN ADSC ADATE ADIF ADIE GPIOEN Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 458 Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x80 TCCR1A 7:0 0x81 TCCR1B 7:0 ICNC ICES 0x82 TCCR1C 7:0 FOCA FOCB 0x83 Reserved 0x84 TCNT1L 7:0 TCNTL[7:0] 0x85 TCNT1H 7:0 TCNTH[7:0] 0x86 ICR1L 7:0 ICRL[7:0] 0x87 ICR1H 7:0 ICRH[7:0] 0x88 OCR1AL 7:0 OCRAL[7:0] 0x89 OCR1AH 7:0 OCRAH[7:0] 0x8A OCR1BL 7:0 OCRBL[7:0] 0x8B OCR1BH 7:0 OCRBH[7:0] COMA[1:0] COMB[1:0] WGM[1:0] WGM3 WGM2 CS[2:0] 0x8C ... Reserved 0x8F 0x90 TCCR3A 7:0 0x91 TCCR3B 7:0 ICNC COMA[1:0] ICES 0x92 TCCR3C 7:0 FOCA FOCB 0x93 Reserved COMB[1:0] WGM[1:0] WGM3 WGM2 0x94 TCNT3L 7:0 TCNTL[7:0] 0x95 TCNT3H 7:0 TCNTH[7:0] 0x96 ICR3L 7:0 ICRL[7:0] 0x97 ICR3H 7:0 ICRH[7:0] 0x98 OCR3AL 7:0 OCRAL[7:0] 0x99 OCR3AH 7:0 OCRAH[7:0] 0x9A OCR3BL 7:0 OCRBL[7:0] 0x9B OCR3BH 7:0 OCRBH[7:0] CS[2:0] 0x9C ... Reserved 0x9F 0xA0 TCCR4A 7:0 COMA[1:0] 0xA1 TCCR4B 7:0 ICNC ICES 0xA2 TCCR4C 7:0 FOCA FOCB 0xA3 Reserved COMB[1:0] WGM[1:0] WGM3 WGM2 0xA4 TCNT4L 7:0 TCNTL[7:0] 0xA5 TCNT4H 7:0 TCNTH[7:0] 0xA6 ICR4L 7:0 ICRL[7:0] 0xA7 ICR4H 7:0 ICRH[7:0] 0xA8 OCR4AL 7:0 OCRAL[7:0] 0xA9 OCR4AH 7:0 OCRAH[7:0] 0xAA OCR4BL 7:0 OCRBL[7:0] 0xAB OCR4BH 7:0 0xAC SPCR1 7:0 SPIE1 SPE1 0xAD SPSR1 7:0 SPIF1 WCOL1 0xAE SPDR1 7:0 0xAF Reserved 0xB0 TCCR2A 7:0 CS[2:0] OCRBH[7:0] DORD1 MSTR1 CPOL1 CPHA1 SPR11 SPR10 SPI2X1 SPID1[7:0] COM2A1 COM2A0 COM2B1 COM2B0 WGM21 WGM20 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 459 Offset Name Bit Pos. 0xB1 TCCR2B 7:0 0xB2 TCNT2 7:0 TCNT2[7:0] 0xB3 OCR2A 7:0 OCR2A[7:0] 0xB4 OCR2B 7:0 OCR2B[7:0] 0xB5 Reserved 0xB6 ASSR 0xB7 Reserved 0xB8 TWBR0 7:0 FOC2A 7:0 0xB9 TWSR0 7:0 0xBA TWAR0 7:0 0xBB TWDR0 7:0 0xBC TWCR0 7:0 0xBD TWAMR0 7:0 FOC2B WGM22 CS22 CS21 CS20 EXCLK AS2 TCN2UB OCR2AUB OCR2BUB TCR2AUB TCR2BUB TWBR7 TWBR6 TWBR5 TWBR4 TWBR3 TWBR2 TWBR1 TWBR0 TWS7 TWS6 TWS5 TWS4 TWS3 TWPS1 TWA[6:0] TWPS0 TWGCE TWD[7:0] TWINT TWEA TWSTA TWSTO TWWC TWEN UPE TWIE TWAM[6:0] 0xBE ... Reserved 0xBF 0xC0 UCSR0A 7:0 RXC TXC UDRE FE DOR 0xC1 UCSR0B 7:0 RXCIE TXCIE UDRIE RXEN TXEN RXB8 UCSZ0 / UDORD UCPHA 7:0 0xC3 UCSR0D 7:0 0xC4 UBBR0L 7:0 0xC5 UBBR0H 7:0 0xC6 UDR0 7:0 0xC7 Reserved 0xC8 UCSR1A 7:0 RXC TXC UDRE FE DOR UPE U2X MPCM 0xC9 UCSR1B 7:0 RXCIE TXCIE UDRIE RXEN TXEN UCSZ2 RXB8 TXB8 UCSZ1 / UCSZ0 / UDORD UCPHA UCSR1C 7:0 RXS USBS TXB8 UCSZ2 UCSZ1 / UCSR0C RXIE UPM[1:0] MPCM 0xC2 0xCA UMSEL[1:0] U2X UCPOL SFDE UBBR[7:0] UBBR[3:0] TXB / RXB[7:0] UMSEL[1:0] RXIE RXS UPM[1:0] USBS UCPOL 0xCB UCSR1D 7:0 0xCC UBBR1L 7:0 SFDE 0xCD UBBR1H 7:0 0xCE UDR1 7:0 0xCF Reserved 0xD0 UCSR2A 7:0 RXC TXC UDRE FE DOR UPE U2X MPCM 0xD1 UCSR2B 7:0 RXCIE TXCIE UDRIE RXEN TXEN UCSZ2 RXB8 TXB8 0xD2 UCSR2C 7:0 UCSZ1 / UCSZ0 / UDORD UCPHA 0xD3 UCSR2D 7:0 UBBR[7:0] UBBR[3:0] TXB / RXB[7:0] UMSEL[1:0] RXIE RXS UPM[1:0] 0xD4 UBBR2L 7:0 UBBR2H 7:0 0xD6 UDR2 7:0 0xD7 Reserved 0xD8 TWBR1 7:0 TWBR7 TWBR6 TWBR5 TWS7 TWS6 TWS5 0xD9 TWSR1 7:0 TWAR1 7:0 0xDB TWDR1 7:0 UCPOL SFDE 0xD5 0xDA USBS UBBR[7:0] UBBR[3:0] TXB / RXB[7:0] TWBR4 TWBR3 TWS4 TWS3 TWA[6:0] TWBR2 TWBR1 TWPS1 TWBR0 TWPS0 TWGCE TWD[7:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 460 Offset Name Bit Pos. 0xDC TWCR1 7:0 0xDD TWAMR1 7:0 TWINT TWEA TWSTA TWSTO TWWC TWEN TWIE TWAM[6:0] 0xDE ... Reserved 0xEF 0xF0 SNOBR8 7:0 SNOBR[7:0] 0xF1 SNOBR7 7:0 SNOBR[7:0] 0xF2 SNOBR6 7:0 SNOBR[7:0] 0xF3 SNOBR0 7:0 SNOBR[7:0] 0xF4 SNOBR1 7:0 SNOBR[7:0] 0xF5 SNOBR2 7:0 SNOBR[7:0] 0xF6 SNOBR3 7:0 SNOBR[7:0] 0xF7 SNOBR4 7:0 SNOBR[7:0] 0xF8 SNOBR5 7:0 SNOBR[7:0] Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 461 35. Instruction Set Summary ARITHMETIC AND LOGIC INSTRUCTIONS Mnemonics Operands Description Operation Flags #Clocks ADD Rd, Rr Add two Registers without Carry Rd ← Rd + Rr Z,C,N,V,H 1 ADC Rd, Rr Add two Registers with Carry Rd ← Rd + Rr + C Z,C,N,V,H 1 ADIW Rdl,K Add Immediate to Word Rdh:Rdl ← Rdh:Rdl + K Z,C,N,V,S 2 SUB Rd, Rr Subtract two Registers Rd ← Rd - Rr Z,C,N,V,H 1 SUBI Rd, K Subtract Constant from Register Rd ← Rd - K Z,C,N,V,H 1 SBC Rd, Rr Subtract two Registers with Carry Rd ← Rd - Rr - C Z,C,N,V,H 1 SBCI Rd, K Subtract Constant from Reg with Carry. Rd ← Rd - K - C Z,C,N,V,H 1 SBIW Rdl,K Subtract Immediate from Word Rdh:Rdl ← Rdh:Rdl - K Z,C,N,V,S 2 AND Rd, Rr Logical AND Registers Rd ← Rd · Rr Z,N,V 1 ANDI Rd, K Logical AND Register and Constant Rd ← Rd · K Z,N,V 1 OR Rd, Rr Logical OR Registers Rd ← Rd v Rr Z,N,V 1 ORI Rd, K Logical OR Register and Constant Rd ← Rd v K Z,N,V 1 EOR Rd, Rr Exclusive OR Registers Rd ← Rd ⊕ Rr Z,N,V 1 COM Rd One’s Complement Rd ← 0xFF - Rd Z,C,N,V 1 NEG Rd Two’s Complement Rd ← 0x00 - Rd Z,C,N,V,H 1 SBR Rd,K Set Bit(s) in Register Rd ← Rd v K Z,N,V 1 CBR Rd,K Clear Bit(s) in Register Rd ← Rd · (0xFF - K) Z,N,V 1 INC Rd Increment Rd ← Rd + 1 Z,N,V 1 DEC Rd Decrement Rd ← Rd - 1 Z,N,V 1 TST Rd Test for Zero or Minus Rd ← Rd · Rd Z,N,V 1 CLR Rd Clear Register Rd ← Rd ⊕ Rd Z,N,V 1 SER Rd Set Register Rd ← 0xFF None 1 MUL Rd, Rr Multiply Unsigned R1:R0 ← Rd x Rr Z,C 2 MULS Rd, Rr Multiply Signed R1:R0 ← Rd x Rr Z,C 2 MULSU Rd, Rr Multiply Signed with Unsigned R1:R0 ← Rd x Rr Z,C 2 FMUL Rd, Rr Fractional Multiply Unsigned R1:R0 ← (Rd x Rr) << 1 Z,C 2 FMULS Rd, Rr Fractional Multiply Signed R1:R0 ← (Rd x Rr) << 1 Z,C 2 FMULSU Rd, Rr Fractional Multiply Signed with Unsigned R1:R0 ← (Rd x Rr) << 1 Z,C 2 BRANCH INSTRUCTIONS Mnemonics Operands Description Operation Flags #Clocks RJMP k Relative Jump PC ← PC + k + 1 None 2 Indirect Jump to (Z) PC ← Z None 2 IJMP JMP(1) k Direct Jump PC ← k None 3 RCALL k Relative Subroutine Call PC ← PC + k + 1 None 3 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 462 BRANCH INSTRUCTIONS Mnemonics Operands Description Operation Flags #Clocks Indirect Call to (Z) PC ← Z None 3 Direct Subroutine Call PC ← k None 4 RET Subroutine Return PC ← STACK None 4 RETI Interrupt Return PC ← STACK I 4 ICALL CALL(1) k CPSE Rd,Rr Compare, Skip if Equal if (Rd = Rr) PC ← PC + 2 or 3 None 1/2/3 CP Rd,Rr Compare Rd - Rr Z, N,V,C,H 1 CPC Rd,Rr Compare with Carry Rd - Rr - C Z, N,V,C,H 1 CPI Rd,K Compare Register with Immediate Rd - K Z, N,V,C,H 1 SBRC Rr, b Skip if Bit in Register Cleared if (Rr(b)=0) PC ← PC + 2 or 3 None 1/2/3 SBRS Rr, b Skip if Bit in Register is Set if (Rr(b)=1) PC ← PC + 2 or 3 None 1/2/3 SBIC A, b Skip if Bit in I/O Register Cleared if (I/O(A,b)=1) PC ← PC + 2 or 3 None 1/2/3 SBIS A, b Skip if Bit in I/O Register is Set if (I/O(A,b)=1) PC ← PC + 2 or 3 None 1/2/3 BRBS s, k Branch if Status Flag Set if (SREG(s) = 1) then PC←PC+k + 1 None 1/2 BRBC s, k Branch if Status Flag Cleared if (SREG(s) = 0) then PC←PC+k + 1 None 1/2 BREQ k Branch if Equal if (Z = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRNE k Branch if Not Equal if (Z = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRCS k Branch if Carry Set if (C = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRCC k Branch if Carry Cleared if (C = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRSH k Branch if Same or Higher if (C = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRLO k Branch if Lower if (C = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRMI k Branch if Minus if (N = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRPL k Branch if Plus if (N = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRGE k Branch if Greater or Equal, Signed if (N ⊕ V= 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRLT k Branch if Less Than Zero, Signed if (N ⊕ V= 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRHS k Branch if Half Carry Flag Set if (H = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRHC k Branch if Half Carry Flag Cleared if (H = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRTS k Branch if T Flag Set if (T = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRTC k Branch if T Flag Cleared if (T = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRVS k Branch if Overflow Flag is Set if (V = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRVC k Branch if Overflow Flag is Cleared if (V = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRIE k Branch if Interrupt Enabled if ( I = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BRID k Branch if Interrupt Disabled if ( I = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2 BIT AND BIT-TEST INSTRUCTIONS Mnemonics Operands Description Operation Flags #Clocks SBI P,b Set Bit in I/O Register I/O(P,b) ← 1 None 2 CBI P,b Clear Bit in I/O Register I/O(P,b) ← 0 None 2 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 463 BIT AND BIT-TEST INSTRUCTIONS Mnemonics Operands Description Operation Flags #Clocks LSL Rd Logical Shift Left Rd(n+1) ← Rd(n), Rd(0) ← 0 Z,C,N,V 1 LSR Rd Logical Shift Right Rd(n) ← Rd(n+1), Rd(7) ← 0 Z,C,N,V 1 ROL Rd Rotate Left Through Carry Rd(0)←C,Rd(n+1)← Rd(n),C¬Rd(7) Z,C,N,V 1 ROR Rd Rotate Right Through Carry Rd(7)←C,Rd(n)← Rd(n+1),C←Rd(0) Z,C,N,V 1 ASR Rd Arithmetic Shift Right Rd(n) ← Rd(n+1), n=0...6 Z,C,N,V 1 SWAP Rd Swap Nibbles Rd(3...0)←Rd(7...4),Rd(7...4)¬Rd(3...0) None 1 BSET s Flag Set SREG(s) ← 1 SREG(s) 1 BCLR s Flag Clear SREG(s) ← 0 SREG(s) 1 BST Rr, b Bit Store from Register to T T ← Rr(b) T 1 BLD Rd, b Bit load from T to Register Rd(b) ← T None 1 SEC Set Carry C←1 C 1 CLC Clear Carry C←0 C 1 SEN Set Negative Flag N←1 N 1 CLN Clear Negative Flag N←0 N 1 SEZ Set Zero Flag Z←1 Z 1 CLZ Clear Zero Flag Z←0 Z 1 SEI Global Interrupt Enable I←1 I 1 CLI Global Interrupt Disable I←0 I 1 SES Set Signed Test Flag S←1 S 1 CLS Clear Signed Test Flag S←0 S 1 SEV Set Two’s Complement Overflow. V←1 V 1 CLV Clear Two’s Complement Overflow V←0 V 1 SET Set T in SREG T←1 T 1 CLT Clear T in SREG T←0 T 1 SEH Set Half Carry Flag in SREG H←1 H 1 CLH Clear Half Carry Flag in SREG H←0 H 1 DATA TRANSFER INSTRUCTIONS Mnemonics Operands Description Operation Flags #Clocks MOV Rd, Rr Move Between Registers Rd ← Rr None 1 MOVW Rd, Rr Copy Register Word Rd+1:Rd ← Rr+1:Rr None 1 LDI Rd, K Load Immediate Rd ← K None 1 LD Rd, X Load Indirect Rd ← (X) None 2 LD Rd, X+ Load Indirect and Post-Increment Rd ← (X), X ← X + 1 None 2 LD Rd, - X Load Indirect and Pre-Decrement X ← X - 1, Rd ← (X) None 2 LD Rd, Y Load Indirect Rd ← (Y) None 2 LD Rd, Y+ Load Indirect and Post-Increment Rd ← (Y), Y ← Y + 1 None 2 Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 464 DATA TRANSFER INSTRUCTIONS Mnemonics Operands Description Operation Flags #Clocks LD Rd, - Y Load Indirect and Pre-Decrement Y ← Y - 1, Rd ← (Y) None 2 LDD Rd,Y+q Load Indirect with Displacement Rd ← (Y + q) None 2 LD Rd, Z Load Indirect Rd ← (Z) None 2 LD Rd, Z+ Load Indirect and Post-Increment Rd ← (Z), Z ← Z+1 None 2 LD Rd, -Z Load Indirect and Pre-Decrement Z ← Z - 1, Rd ← (Z) None 2 LDD Rd, Z+q Load Indirect with Displacement Rd ← (Z + q) None 2 LDS Rd, k Load Direct from SRAM Rd ← (k) None 2 ST X, Rr Store Indirect (X) ← Rr None 2 ST X+, Rr Store Indirect and Post-Increment (X) ← Rr, X ← X + 1 None 2 ST - X, Rr Store Indirect and Pre-Decrement X ← X - 1, (X) ← Rr None 2 ST Y, Rr Store Indirect (Y) ← Rr None 2 ST Y+, Rr Store Indirect and Post-Increment (Y) ← Rr, Y ← Y + 1 None 2 ST - Y, Rr Store Indirect and Pre-Decrement Y ← Y - 1, (Y) ← Rr None 2 STD Y+q,Rr Store Indirect with Displacement (Y + q) ← Rr None 2 ST Z, Rr Store Indirect (Z) ← Rr None 2 ST Z+, Rr Store Indirect and Post-Increment (Z) ← Rr, Z ← Z + 1 None 2 ST -Z, Rr Store Indirect and Pre-Decrement Z ← Z - 1, (Z) ← Rr None 2 STD Z+q,Rr Store Indirect with Displacement (Z + q) ← Rr None 2 STS k, Rr Store Direct to SRAM (k) ← Rr None 2 Load Program Memory R0 ← (Z) None 3 LPM LPM Rd, Z Load Program Memory Rd ← (Z) None 3 LPM Rd, Z+ Load Program Memory and Post-Inc Rd ← (Z), Z ← Z+1 None 3 Store Program Memory (Z) ← R1:R0 None - SPM IN Rd, A In from I/O Location Rd ← I/O (A) None 1 OUT A, Rr Out to I/O Location I/O (A) ← Rr None 1 PUSH Rr Push Register on Stack STACK ← Rr None 2 POP Rd Pop Register from Stack Rd ← STACK None 2 MCU CONTROL INSTRUCTIONS Mnemonics Operands Description Operation Flags #Clocks NOP No Operation No Operation None 1 SLEEP Sleep (see specific descr. for Sleep function) None 1 WDR Watchdog Reset (see specific descr. for WDR/timer) None 1 BREAK Break For On-chip Debug Only None N/A Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 465 36. Packaging Information 36.1. 44A P IN 1 IDENTIFIER P IN 1 B e E1 E A1 A2 D1 D C 0°~7° L A COMMON DIMENS IONS (Unit of Me a s ure = mm) MIN NOM MAX A – – 1.20 A1 0.05 – 0.15 S YMBOL Note s : 1. This pa cka ge conforms to J EDEC re fe re nce MS -026, Va ria tion ACB. 2. Dime ns ions D1 a nd E1 do not include mold protrus ion. Allowa ble protrus ion is 0.25mm pe r s ide . Dime ns ions D1 a nd E1 a re ma ximum pla s tic body s ize dime ns ions including mold mis ma tch. 3. Le a d copla na rity is 0.10mm ma ximum. A2 0.95 1.00 1.05 D 11.75 12.00 12.25 D1 9.90 10.00 10.10 E 11.75 12.00 12.25 E1 9.90 10.00 10.10 B 0.30 0.37 0.45 C 0.09 (0.17) 0.20 L 0.45 0.60 0.75 e NOTE Note 2 Note 2 0.80 TYP 06/02/2014 44A, 44-le a d, 10 x 10mm body s ize , 1.0mm body thickne s s , 0.8 mm le a d pitch, thin profile pla s tic qua d fla t pa cka ge (TQFP ) 44A Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 C 466 36.2. 44M1 D Marked Pin# 1 I D E SE ATING PLANE A1 TOP VIEW A3 A K L Pin #1 Co rne r D2 1 2 3 Option A SIDE VIEW Pin #1 Triangl e COMMON DIMENSIONS (Unit of Measure = mm) MIN NOM MAX A 0.80 0.90 1.00 A1 – 0.02 0.05 SYMBOL E2 Option B K Option C b e Pin #1 Cham fe r (C 0.30) Pin #1 Notch (0.20 R) BOTTOM VIEW A3 0.20 REF b 0.18 0.23 D 6.90 7.00 7.10 D2 5.00 5.20 5.40 E 6.90 7.00 7.10 E2 5.00 5.20 5.40 e Note : JEDEC Standard MO-220, Fig . 1 (S AW Singulation) VKKD-3 . NOTE 0.30 0.50 BSC L 0.59 0.64 0.69 K 0.20 0.26 0.41 9/26/08 Package Drawing Contact: [email protected] TITLE 44M1, 44-pad, 7 x 7 x 1.0mm body, lead pitch 0.50mm, 5.20mm exposed pad, thermally enhanced plastic very thin quad flat no lead package (VQFN) GPC ZWS DRAWING NO. REV. 44M1 H Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 467 37. Errata 37.1. Rev.A-H Rev. A to H are not sampled. 37.2. Rev. I Description: If Chip Erase is performed at low supply voltage (VCC<3V), a flash read performed immediately after the chip erase (within 500ms) may show wrong results. Workaround: If chip erase is executed at a low voltage, wait for 500ms before reading the flash contents. Description: ADC differential inputs have inverted polarity. When positive ADC input is higher than negative input the resulting ADC code is negative (and vice-versa). Workaround: Take the inversion into account by software when using the ADC differential mode or swap the ADC differential inputs externally. Note that the inversion may be fixed on future die revisions. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 468 38. Datasheet Revision History Doc Rev. Date Comments 42546A Nov./2015 Initial document release. Atmel ATmega324PB [DATASHEET] Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 469 Atmel Corporation © 1600 Technology Drive, San Jose, CA 95110 USA T: (+1)(408) 441.0311 F: (+1)(408) 436.4200 | www.atmel.com 2015 Atmel Corporation. / Rev.: Atmel-42546A-8-bit AVR ATmega324PB_Datasheet_Preliminary-11/2015 ® ® ® Atmel , Atmel logo and combinations thereof, Enabling Unlimited Possibilities , AVR , and others are registered trademarks or trademarks of Atmel Corporation in U.S. and other countries. Other terms and product names may be trademarks of others. DISCLAIMER: The information in this document is provided in connection with Atmel products. No license, express or implied, by estoppel or otherwise, to any intellectual property right is granted by this document or in connection with the sale of Atmel products. EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN THE ATMEL TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF SALES LOCATED ON THE ATMEL WEBSITE, ATMEL ASSUMES NO LIABILITY WHATSOEVER AND DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY WARRANTY RELATING TO ITS PRODUCTS INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, OR NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL ATMEL BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE, SPECIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS AND PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, OR LOSS OF INFORMATION) ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DOCUMENT, EVEN IF ATMEL HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Atmel makes no representations or warranties with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this document and reserves the right to make changes to specifications and products descriptions at any time without notice. Atmel does not make any commitment to update the information contained herein. Unless specifically provided otherwise, Atmel products are not suitable for, and shall not be used in, automotive applications. Atmel products are not intended, authorized, or warranted for use as components in applications intended to support or sustain life. SAFETY-CRITICAL, MILITARY, AND AUTOMOTIVE APPLICATIONS DISCLAIMER: Atmel products are not designed for and will not be used in connection with any applications where the failure of such products would reasonably be expected to result in significant personal injury or death (“Safety-Critical Applications”) without an Atmel officer's specific written consent. Safety-Critical Applications include, without limitation, life support devices and systems, equipment or systems for the operation of nuclear facilities and weapons systems. Atmel products are not designed nor intended for use in military or aerospace applications or environments unless specifically designated by Atmel as military-grade. Atmel products are not designed nor intended for use in automotive applications unless specifically designated by Atmel as automotive-grade.